|  | 
| scholarship under this program, as determined by the  | 
| Department, does not exceed 300% of the federal poverty
 | 
| level and, once the child receives a scholarship, does not  | 
| exceed 400% of the federal poverty
level;
 | 
|         (2) is eligible to attend a public elementary school or  | 
| high school in Illinois  in the semester immediately  | 
| preceding the semester for which he or she first receives a  | 
| scholarship or is
starting school in Illinois for the first  | 
| time when he or she first receives a scholarship; and
 | 
|         (3) resides in Illinois while receiving a scholarship. | 
|     "Family member" means a parent, child, or sibling, whether  | 
| by whole blood, half blood, or adoption; spouse; or stepchild. | 
|     "Focus district" means  a school district which has a school  | 
| that is either (i) a school that has one or more subgroups in  | 
| which the average student performance is at or below the State  | 
| average for the lowest 10% of student performance in that  | 
| subgroup or (ii) a school with an average graduation rate of  | 
| less than 60% and not identified for priority.
 | 
|     "Necessary costs and fees" includes the customary charge  | 
| for instruction and use of facilities in general
and the  | 
| additional fixed fees charged for specified purposes that are  | 
| required generally of non-scholarship recipients for each  | 
| academic period for which the scholarship applicant actually  | 
| enrolls, including costs associated with student assessments,  | 
| but does not
include fees payable only once and other  | 
| contingent deposits that are refundable in whole or in part.  | 
|  | 
| The Board may prescribe, by rules consistent with this Act,  | 
| detailed provisions concerning the computation of necessary  | 
| costs and fees.
 | 
|     "Scholarship granting organization" means an entity that:
 | 
|         (1) is exempt from taxation under Section 501(c)(3) of  | 
| the Internal Revenue Code;
 | 
|         (2) uses at least 95% of the qualified contributions  | 
| received during a taxable year for scholarships;
 | 
|         (3) provides scholarships to students according to the  | 
| guidelines of this Act;
 | 
|         (4) deposits and holds qualified contributions and any  | 
| income derived from qualified contributions
in an account  | 
| that is separate from the organization's operating fund or  | 
| other funds until such qualified contributions or income  | 
| are withdrawn for use; and
 | 
|         (5) is approved to issue certificates of receipt.
 | 
|     "Qualified contribution" means the authorized contribution  | 
| made by a taxpayer to a scholarship granting organization for  | 
| which the taxpayer has received a certificate of receipt from  | 
| such organization.
 | 
|     "Qualified school" means a non-public school located in  | 
| Illinois and recognized by the Board pursuant to Section  | 
| 2-3.25o of the School Code.
 | 
|     "Scholarship" means an educational scholarship awarded to  | 
| an eligible student to attend a qualified school
of their  | 
| custodians' choice in an amount not exceeding the necessary  | 
|  | 
| costs and fees to attend that school.
 | 
|     "Taxpayer" means any individual, corporation, partnership,  | 
| trust, or other entity subject to the Illinois income tax. For  | 
| the purposes of this Act, 2 individuals filing a joint return  | 
| shall be considered one taxpayer.
 | 
|     Section 10. Credit awards.  | 
|     (a) The Department shall award credits against the tax   | 
| imposed under subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of the  | 
| Illinois Income Tax Act to taxpayers who make qualified  | 
| contributions. For contributions made  under this Act, the  | 
| credit shall be equal to 75% of the total  amount of
qualified  | 
| contributions made by the taxpayer during a taxable year, not  | 
| to exceed a credit of $1,000,000 per taxpayer.
 | 
|     (b) The aggregate amount of all credits the Department may  | 
| award under this Act in any calendar year may not exceed  | 
| $75,000,000.  | 
|     (c) Contributions made by corporations (including  | 
| Subchapter S corporations), partnerships, and trusts under  | 
| this Act may not be directed to a particular subset of schools,  | 
| a particular school, a particular group of students, or a  | 
| particular student.
Contributions made by individuals under  | 
| this Act may be directed to a particular subset of schools or a  | 
| particular school but may not be directed to a particular group  | 
| of students or a particular student. | 
|     (d) No credit shall be taken under this Act for any  | 
|  | 
| qualified contribution for which the taxpayer claims a federal  | 
| income tax deduction. | 
|     (e) Credits shall be awarded in a manner, as determined by  | 
| the Department, that is geographically proportionate to  | 
| enrollment in recognized non-public schools in  Illinois. If the  | 
| cap on the aggregate credits that may be awarded by the  | 
| Department is not reached by June 1 of a given year, the  | 
| Department shall award remaining credits on a first-come,  | 
| first-served basis, without regard to the limitation of this  | 
| subsection.
 | 
|     Section 15. Approval to issue certificates of receipt.  | 
|     (a) A scholarship granting organization shall submit an  | 
| application for approval to issue certificates of receipt in  | 
| the form and manner prescribed by the Department, provided that  | 
| each application shall include:
 | 
|         (1) documentary evidence that the scholarship granting  | 
| organization has been granted an exemption from taxation  | 
| under Section 501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code;
 | 
|         (2) certification that all qualified contributions and  | 
| any income derived from qualified contributions are  | 
| deposited  and  held  in an account that is separate from  the  | 
| scholarship granting organization's operating or other  | 
| funds until such qualified contributions or income are  | 
| withdrawn  for  use;
 | 
|         (3) certification that the scholarship granting  | 
|  | 
| organization will use at least 95% of its annual revenue  | 
| from qualified contributions for scholarships;
 | 
|         (4) certification that the scholarship granting  | 
| organization will provide scholarships to eligible  | 
| students;
 | 
|         (5) a list of the names and addresses of all members of  | 
| the governing board of the scholarship granting  | 
| organization; and
 | 
|         (6) a copy of the most recent financial audit of the  | 
| scholarship granting organization's accounts and records  | 
| conducted by an independent certified public accountant in  | 
| accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in  | 
| the United States, government auditing standards, and  | 
| rules adopted by the Department.
 | 
|     (b) A scholarship granting organization whose owner or  | 
| operator in the last 7 years has filed for personal bankruptcy  | 
| or corporate bankruptcy in a corporation of which he or she  | 
| owned more than 20% shall not be eligible to provide  | 
| scholarships.
 | 
|     (c) A  scholarship granting organization  must  not have an  | 
| owner or operator who owns or operates a qualified school or  | 
| has a family member who is a paid staff or board member of a  | 
| participating qualified  school.
 | 
|     (d) A scholarship granting organization shall comply with  | 
| the anti-discrimination provisions of 42 U.S.C. 2000d.
 | 
|     (e) The Department shall review and either approve or deny  | 
|  | 
| each application  to issue certificates of receipt  pursuant to  | 
| this Act. Approval  or denial of an application shall be made on  | 
| a periodic basis. Applicants shall be notified of the  | 
| Department's determination within 30 business days after the  | 
| application is received.
 | 
|     (f) No scholarship granting organization shall issue any  | 
| certificates of receipt without first being approved to issue  | 
| certificates of receipt.
 | 
|     Section 20. Annual review.  | 
|     (a) Each scholarship granting organization  that receives  | 
| approval  to issue certificates of receipt shall file an  | 
| application for recertification on an annual basis. Such  | 
| application for recertification shall be in the form and manner  | 
| prescribed by the Department and shall include:
 | 
|         (1)  certification from the Director or Chief Executive  | 
| Officer of the organization that the organization  has  | 
| complied with and continues to comply   with the requirements  | 
| of this Act, including evidence of that compliance; and
 | 
|         (2) a copy of the organization's current  financial  | 
| statements.
 | 
|     (b) The Department may revoke the approval of a scholarship  | 
| granting organization to issue certificates of receipt upon a  | 
| finding that the organization has violated this Act or any  | 
| rules adopted under this Act. These violations shall include,  | 
| but need not be limited to, any of the following:  | 
|  | 
|         (1)  failure to meet the requirements of this Act;
 | 
|         (2) failure to maintain  full and adequate records with  | 
| respect to the receipt of qualified contributions;
 | 
|         (3) failure to supply such records to the Department;  | 
| or
 | 
|         (4) failure to provide  notice to the Department of the  | 
| issuance of certificates of receipt pursuant to Section  35  | 
| of this Act.
 | 
|     (c) Within 5 days after the determination to revoke  | 
| approval, the Department shall provide notice of the  | 
| determination to the scholarship granting organization and  | 
| information regarding the process to request a hearing to  | 
| appeal the determination.
 | 
|     Section 25. Contribution  authorization  certificates.  | 
|     (a) A taxpayer shall not be allowed a credit pursuant to  | 
| this Act for any contribution to a scholarship granting  | 
| organization that was made prior to the Department's issuance  | 
| of a contribution authorization certificate for such  | 
| contribution to the taxpayer.
 | 
|     (b) Prior to making a contribution to a scholarship  | 
| granting organization, the taxpayer shall apply to the  | 
| Department for a contribution authorization certificate. | 
|     (c) A taxpayer who makes more than one contribution to a  | 
| scholarship granting organization must make a separate  | 
| application for each such contribution authorization  | 
|  | 
| certificate. The application shall be in the form and manner  | 
| prescribed by the Department, provided that the application   | 
| includes:
 | 
|         (1)  the taxpayer's name and address;
 | 
|         (2) the amount the taxpayer will contribute; and | 
|         (3) any other information the Department deems  | 
| necessary. | 
|     (d) The Department may allow taxpayers to make multiple  | 
| applications on the same form, provided that each application  | 
| shall be treated as a separate application.
 | 
|     (e) The Department shall  issue credit authorization  | 
| certificates on a first-come, first-served basis based upon  the  | 
| date that the Department received  the taxpayer's application   | 
| for the certificate subject to the provisions of subsection (e)  | 
| of Section 10 of this Act.
 | 
|     (f) A taxpayer's aggregate authorized contribution amount  | 
| as listed on one or more authorized contribution certificates  | 
| issued to the taxpayer shall not exceed the aggregate of the  | 
| amounts listed on the taxpayer's applications submitted in  | 
| accordance with this Section.
 | 
|     (g) Each  contribution authorization certificate shall   | 
| state:  | 
|         (1)  the date such certificate was  issued;
 | 
|         (2) the date by which the authorized contributions  | 
| listed in the certificate must be made, which shall be 60  | 
| days from the date of the issuance of a credit  | 
|  | 
| authorization  certificate;
 | 
|         (3) the total amount of authorized contributions;
and | 
|         (4) any other information the Department deems  | 
| necessary.
 | 
|     (h) Credit authorization certificates shall be mailed to  | 
| the appropriate taxpayers within 3 business days after their  | 
| issuance.
 | 
|     (i) A taxpayer may rescind all or part of an authorized  | 
| contribution approved under this Act by providing written  | 
| notice to the Department. Amounts rescinded shall no longer be  | 
| deducted from the cap prescribed in Section 10 of this Act. | 
|     (j) The Department shall maintain on its website a running  | 
| total of the amount of credits for which taxpayers may make  | 
| applications for contribution authorization certification. The  | 
| running total shall be updated  every business  day.
 | 
|     Section 30. Certificates of receipt.  | 
|     (a) No scholarship granting organization shall issue a  | 
| certificate of receipt for any qualified contribution made by a  | 
| taxpayer under this Act unless that scholarship granting  | 
| organization has been approved to issue certificates of receipt  | 
| pursuant to Section 15 of this Act.
 | 
|     (b) No scholarship granting organization shall issue a  | 
| certificate of receipt for a contribution made by a taxpayer  | 
| unless the taxpayer has been issued a credit authorization  | 
| certificate by the Department. | 
|  | 
|     (c) If a taxpayer makes a contribution to a scholarship  | 
| granting organization prior to the date by which the authorized  | 
| contribution shall be made, the scholarship granting  | 
| organization shall, within 30 days of receipt of the authorized  | 
| contribution, issue to the taxpayer a written certificate of  | 
| receipt.
 | 
|     (d) If a taxpayer fails to make all or a portion of  a  | 
| contribution prior to the date by which such authorized  | 
| contribution is required to be made, the taxpayer shall  not be  | 
| entitled to a certificate of receipt for that portion of the  | 
| authorized contribution not made. | 
|     (e) Each certificate of receipt shall state:
 | 
|         (1)  the name and  address of the issuing scholarship  | 
| granting organization;
 | 
|         (2) the taxpayer's name and address;
 | 
|         (3) the date for each qualified contribution; | 
|         (4) the amount of each qualified contribution; | 
|         (5) the total qualified contribution amount; and
 | 
|         (6) any other information that the Department may deem  | 
| necessary.
 | 
|     (f) Upon  the issuance of a certificate of receipt, the   | 
| issuing scholarship granting organization  shall, within 10  | 
| days after issuing the certificate of receipt, provide the  | 
| Department  with notification  of the issuance of such  | 
| certificate in the form and manner prescribed  by the  | 
| Department, provided  that such notification shall include:
 | 
|  | 
|         (1)  the taxpayer's name and address;
 | 
|         (2) the date of the issuance of a certificate of  | 
| receipt;
 | 
|         (3) the qualified contribution date or dates and the  | 
| amounts contributed on such dates;
 | 
|         (4) the total qualified  contribution  listed on such  | 
| certificates;
 | 
|         (5) the issuing scholarship granting organization's  | 
| name and address; and
 | 
|         (6) any other information the Department may deem  | 
| necessary.
 | 
|     (g) Any portion of a contribution that a taxpayer fails to  | 
| make by the date indicated on the authorized contribution  | 
| certificate shall no longer be deducted from the cap prescribed  | 
| in Section 10 of this Act.
 | 
|     Section 35. Reports.  | 
|     (a) Within 180 days after the end of its fiscal year, each  | 
| scholarship granting organization must provide to the  | 
| Department a copy of a financial audit of its accounts and  | 
| records conducted by an independent certified public  | 
| accountant in accordance with auditing standards generally  | 
| accepted in the United States, government auditing standards,  | 
| and rules adopted by the Department. The audit must include a  | 
| report on financial statements presented in accordance with  | 
| generally accepted accounting principles. The audit must  | 
|  | 
| include evidence that no less than 95% of qualified  | 
| contributions received were used to provide scholarships to  | 
| eligible students. The Department shall review all audits  | 
| submitted pursuant to this subsection. The Department shall  | 
| request any significant items that were omitted in violation of  | 
| a rule adopted by the Department. The items must be provided  | 
| within 45 days after the date of request. If a scholarship  | 
| granting organization does not comply with the Department's  | 
| request, the Department may revoke the scholarship granting  | 
| organization's ability to issue certificates of receipt. | 
|     (b) A scholarship granting organization that is approved to  | 
| receive qualified contributions shall report to the  | 
| Department, on a form prescribed by the Department, by January  | 
| 31 of each calendar year. The report shall include:
 | 
|         (1) the total number of certificates of receipt issued  | 
| during the immediately preceding calendar year;
 | 
|         (2) the total dollar amount of qualified contributions  | 
| received, as set forth in the certificates of receipt  | 
| issued during the immediately preceding calendar year;
 | 
|         (3) the total number of eligible students utilizing  | 
| scholarships for the immediately preceding calendar year  | 
| and the school year in progress and the total dollar value  | 
| of the scholarships;
 | 
|         (4) the name and address of each qualified school for  | 
| which scholarships using qualified contributions were  | 
| issued during the immediately preceding calendar year,  | 
|  | 
| detailing the number, grade, race, gender, income level,  | 
| and residency by Zip Code of eligible students and the  | 
| total dollar value of
scholarships being utilized at each  | 
| qualified school by priority group, as identified in  | 
| subsection (d) of Section 40 of this Act; and
 | 
|         (5) any additional information requested by the  | 
| Department.
 | 
|     (c) On or before the last day of March for each calendar  | 
| year, for the immediately preceding calendar year, the  | 
| Department shall submit a written report to the Governor, the  | 
| President of the Senate, the Speaker of the House of  | 
| Representatives, the Minority Leader of the Senate, and the  | 
| Minority Leader of the House of Representatives regarding this  | 
| Act. The report shall include, but not be limited to, the  | 
| following information: | 
|         (1) the names and addresses of all scholarship granting  | 
| organizations approved to issue certificates of receipt; | 
|         (2) the number and aggregate total of certificates of  | 
| receipt issued by each scholarship granting organization;  | 
| and | 
|         (3) the information reported to the Department  | 
| required by subsection (b) of this Section. | 
|     (d) The sharing and reporting of student data under this  | 
| Section must be in accordance with the requirements of the  | 
| Family Educational Rights and Privacy Act and the Illinois  | 
| School Student Records Act. All parties must preserve the  | 
|  | 
| confidentiality of such information as required by law. Data  | 
| reported by the Department under subsection (c) of this Section  | 
| must not disaggregate data to a level that will disclose  | 
| demographic data of individual students.
 | 
|     Section 40. Scholarship granting organization  | 
| responsibilities.  | 
|     (a) Before granting a scholarship for an academic year, all  | 
| scholarship granting organizations shall assess and document  | 
| each student's eligibility for the academic year.
 | 
|     (b) A scholarship granting organization shall grant  | 
| scholarships only to eligible students.
 | 
|     (c) A scholarship granting organization shall allow an  | 
| eligible student to attend any qualified school of the  | 
| student's choosing, subject to the availability of funds.
 | 
|     (d) In granting scholarships, a scholarship granting  | 
| organization shall give priority to the following priority  | 
| groups: | 
|         (1) eligible students who received a scholarship from a  | 
| scholarship granting organization during the previous  | 
| school year;
 | 
|         (2) eligible students who are members of a household  | 
| whose previous year's total annual income does not exceed  | 
| 185% of the federal poverty level;
 | 
|         (3) eligible students who reside within a focus  | 
| district; and
 | 
|  | 
|         (4) eligible students who are siblings of students  | 
| currently receiving a scholarship.
 | 
|     (d-5) A scholarship granting organization shall begin  | 
| granting scholarships no later than February 1 preceding the  | 
| school year for which the scholarship is sought. The priority  | 
| groups identified in subsection (d) of this Section shall be  | 
| eligible to receive scholarships on a first-come, first-served  | 
| basis until the April 1 immediately preceding the school year  | 
| for which the scholarship is sought. Applications for  | 
| scholarships for eligible students meeting the qualifications  | 
| of one or more priority groups that are received before April 1  | 
| must be either approved or denied within 10 business days after  | 
| receipt. Beginning April 1, all eligible students shall be  | 
| eligible to receive scholarships without regard to the priority  | 
| groups identified in subsection (d) of this Section. | 
|     (e) Except as provided in subsection (e-5) of this Section,  | 
| scholarships shall not exceed the lesser of (i) the statewide  | 
| average operational expense per
student among public schools or  | 
| (ii) the necessary costs and fees for attendance at the  | 
| qualified school.
Scholarships shall be prorated as follows: | 
|         (1) for eligible students whose household income is  | 
| less than 185% of the federal poverty level, the  | 
| scholarship shall be 100% of the amount determined pursuant  | 
| to this subsection (e) and subsection (e-5) of this  | 
| Section; | 
|         (2) for eligible students whose household income is  | 
|  | 
| 185% or more of the federal poverty level but less than  | 
| 250% of the federal poverty level, the average of  | 
| scholarships shall be 75% of the amount determined pursuant  | 
| to this subsection (e) and subsection (e-5) of this  | 
| Section; and | 
|         (3) for eligible students whose household income is  | 
| 250% or more of the federal poverty level, the average of  | 
| scholarships shall be 50% of the amount determined pursuant  | 
| to this subsection (e) and subsection (e-5) of this  | 
| Section. | 
|     (e-5) The statewide average operational expense per  | 
| student among public schools shall be multiplied by the  | 
| following factors: | 
|         (1) for students determined eligible to receive  | 
| services under the federal Individuals with Disabilities  | 
| Education Act, 2; | 
|         (2) for students who are English learners, as defined  | 
| in subsection (d) of Section 14C-2 of the School Code, 1.2;  | 
| and | 
|         (3) for students who are gifted and talented children,  | 
| as defined in  Section 14A-20 of the School Code, 1.1. | 
|     (f) A scholarship granting organization shall distribute  | 
| scholarship payments to the participating school where the  | 
| student is enrolled.
 | 
|     (g) For the 2018-2019 school year through the 2021-2022  | 
| school year, each scholarship granting organization shall  | 
|  | 
| expend no less than 75% of the qualified contributions received  | 
| during the calendar year in which the qualified contributions  | 
| were received. No more than 25% of the
qualified contributions  | 
| may be carried forward to the following calendar year.
 | 
|     (h) For the 2022-2023 school year, each scholarship  | 
| granting organization shall expend all qualified contributions  | 
| received during the calendar year in which the qualified  | 
| contributions were
received. No qualified contributions may be  | 
| carried forward to the following calendar year.
 | 
|     (i) A scholarship granting organization shall allow an  | 
| eligible student to transfer a scholarship during a school year  | 
| to any other participating school of the custodian's choice.  | 
| Such scholarships shall  be prorated.
 | 
|     (j)  With the prior approval of the Department, a  | 
| scholarship granting organization may transfer funds to  | 
| another scholarship granting organization if additional funds  | 
| are required to meet scholarship demands at the receiving  | 
| scholarship granting organization. All transferred funds must  | 
| be
deposited by the receiving scholarship granting  | 
| organization into its scholarship accounts. All transferred  | 
| amounts received by any scholarship granting organization must  | 
| be separately
disclosed to the Department.
 | 
|     (k) If the approval of a scholarship granting organization  | 
| is revoked as provided in Section 20 of this Act or the  | 
| scholarship granting organization is dissolved, all remaining  | 
| qualified contributions of the scholarship granting  | 
|  | 
| organization shall be transferred to another scholarship  | 
| granting organization. All transferred funds must be deposited  | 
| by the receiving scholarship granting organization into its  | 
| scholarship accounts. | 
|     (l) Scholarship granting organizations shall make  | 
| reasonable efforts to advertise the availability of  | 
| scholarships to eligible students.
 | 
|     Section 45. State Board responsibilities.  | 
|     (a) Beginning in the 2019-2020 school year, students who  | 
| have been granted a scholarship under this Act shall be  | 
| annually assessed at the qualified school where the student  | 
| attends school in the same manner in which students that attend  | 
| public schools are annually assessed pursuant to Section  | 
| 2-3.64a-5 of the School Code. Such qualified school shall pay  | 
| costs associated with this requirement. | 
|     (b) The Board shall select an independent research  | 
| organization, which may be a public or private entity or  | 
| university, to which participating qualified schools must  | 
| report the scores of students who are receiving scholarships  | 
| and are assessed pursuant to subsection (a) of this Section.  | 
| Costs associated with the independent research organization  | 
| shall be paid by the scholarship granting organizations on a  | 
| per-pupil basis or by gifts, grants, or donations received by  | 
| the Board under subsection (d) of this Section, as determined  | 
| by the Board. The independent research organization must  | 
|  | 
| annually report to the Board on the year-to-year learning gains  | 
| of students receiving scholarships on a statewide basis. The  | 
| report shall also include, to the extent possible, a comparison  | 
| of these learning gains to the statewide learning gains of  | 
| public school students with socioeconomic backgrounds similar  | 
| to those of students receiving scholarships. The annual report  | 
| shall be delivered to the Board and published on its website.  | 
|     (c) Beginning within 120 days after the Board first  | 
| receives the annual report by the independent research  | 
| organization as provided in subsection (b) of this Section and  | 
| on an annual basis thereafter, the Board shall submit a written  | 
| report to the Governor, the President of the Senate, the  | 
| Speaker of the House of Representatives, the Minority Leader of  | 
| the Senate, and the Minority Leader of the House of  | 
| Representatives regarding this Act. Such report shall include  | 
| an evaluation of the academic performance of students receiving  | 
| scholarships and recommendations for improving student  | 
| performance. | 
|     (d) Subject to the State Officials and Employees Ethics  | 
| Act, the Board may receive and expend gifts, grants, and  | 
| donations of any kind from any public or private entity to  | 
| carry out the purposes of this Section, subject to the terms  | 
| and conditions under which the gifts are given, provided that  | 
| all such terms and conditions are permissible under law.  | 
|     (e) The sharing and reporting of student learning gain data  | 
| under this Section must be in accordance with requirements of  | 
|  | 
| the Family Educational Rights and Privacy Act and the Illinois  | 
| School Student Records Act. All parties must preserve the  | 
| confidentiality of such information as required by law. The  | 
| annual report must not disaggregate data to a level that will  | 
| disclose the academic level of individual students.
 | 
|     Section 50. Qualified school  responsibilities. A qualified  | 
| school that accepts scholarship students must do all of the  | 
| following: | 
|         (1) provide to a scholarship granting organization,  | 
| upon request, all documentation required for the student's  | 
| participation, including the non-public school's cost and  | 
| student's fee schedules; | 
|         (2) be academically accountable to the custodian for  | 
| meeting the educational needs of the student by: | 
|             (A) at a minimum, annually providing to the  | 
| custodian a written explanation of the student's  | 
| progress; and | 
|             (B) annually administering assessments required by  | 
| subsection (a) of Section 45 of this Act in the same  | 
| manner in which they are administered at public schools  | 
| pursuant to Section 2-3.64a-5 of the School Code; the  | 
| Board shall bill participating qualified schools for  | 
| all costs associated with administering assessments  | 
| required by this paragraph; the participating  | 
| qualified schools shall ensure that all test security  | 
|  | 
| and assessment administration procedures are followed;  | 
| participating qualified schools must report individual  | 
| student scores to the custodians of the students; the  | 
| independent research organization described in  | 
| subsection (b) of Section 45 of this Act shall be  | 
| provided all student score data in a secure manner by  | 
| the participating qualified school. | 
|     The inability of a qualified school to meet the  | 
| requirements of this Section shall constitute a basis for the  | 
| ineligibility of the qualified school to participate in the  | 
| scholarship program as determined by the Board.
 | 
|     Section 55. Custodian and student responsibilities.  | 
|     (a) The custodian must select a qualified school and apply  | 
| for the admission of his or her child. | 
|     (b) The custodian shall ensure that the student  | 
| participating in the scholarship program takes the assessment  | 
| required by subsection (a) of Section 45 of this Act. | 
|     (c) Each custodian and each student has an obligation to  | 
| comply with the qualified school's published policies.
 | 
|     (d) The custodian shall authorize the scholarship granting  | 
| organization to access information needed for income  | 
| eligibility determinations.
 | 
|     Section 60. Recordkeeping; rulemaking; violations.  | 
|     (a) Each taxpayer shall, for each taxable year for which  | 
|  | 
| the tax credit provided for under this Act is claimed, maintain  | 
| records of the following information: (i) contribution  | 
| authorization certificates obtained under Section  25 of this  | 
| Act and (ii) certificates of receipt obtained under Section 30  | 
| of this Act.
 | 
|     (b) The Board and the Department may adopt rules consistent  | 
| with and necessary
for the implementation of this Act. | 
|     (c) Violations of State laws or rules and complaints  | 
| relating to program participation shall be referred to the  | 
| Attorney General.
 | 
|     Section 65. Credit period; repeal.  | 
|     (a) A taxpayer may take a credit under this Act for tax  | 
| years beginning on or after January 1, 2018 and ending before  | 
| January 1, 2023. A taxpayer may not take a credit pursuant to  | 
| this Act for tax years beginning on or after January  1, 2023.
 | 
|     (b) This Act is repealed on January 1, 2024.
 | 
|     Section 900. The Open Meetings Act is amended by changing  | 
| Section 2 as follows:
 
 | 
|     (5 ILCS 120/2)  (from Ch. 102, par. 42)
 | 
|     Sec. 2. Open meetings. 
 | 
|     (a) Openness required.  All meetings of public
bodies shall  | 
| be open to the public unless excepted in subsection (c)
and  | 
| closed in accordance with Section 2a.
 | 
|  | 
|     (b) Construction of exceptions.  The exceptions contained  | 
| in subsection
(c) are in derogation of the requirement that  | 
| public bodies
meet in the open, and therefore, the exceptions  | 
| are to be strictly
construed, extending only to subjects  | 
| clearly within their scope.
 The exceptions authorize but do not  | 
| require the holding of
a closed meeting to discuss a subject  | 
| included within an enumerated exception.
 | 
|     (c) Exceptions.  A public body may hold closed meetings to  | 
| consider the
following subjects:
 | 
|         (1) The appointment, employment, compensation,  | 
| discipline, performance,
or dismissal of specific  | 
| employees of the public body or legal counsel for
the  | 
| public body, including hearing
testimony on a complaint  | 
| lodged against an employee of the public body or
against  | 
| legal counsel for the public body to determine its  | 
| validity. However, a meeting to consider an increase in  | 
| compensation to a specific employee of a public body that  | 
| is subject to the Local Government Wage Increase  | 
| Transparency Act may not be closed and shall be open to the  | 
| public and posted and held in accordance with this Act.
 | 
|         (2) Collective negotiating matters between the public  | 
| body and its
employees or their representatives, or  | 
| deliberations concerning salary
schedules for one or more  | 
| classes of employees.
 | 
|         (3) The selection of a person to fill a public office,
 | 
| as defined in this Act, including a vacancy in a public  | 
|  | 
| office, when the public
body is given power to appoint  | 
| under law or ordinance, or the discipline,
performance or  | 
| removal of the occupant of a public office, when the public  | 
| body
is given power to remove the occupant under law or  | 
| ordinance. 
 | 
|         (4) Evidence or testimony presented in open hearing, or  | 
| in closed
hearing where specifically authorized by law, to
 | 
| a quasi-adjudicative body, as defined in this Act, provided  | 
| that the body
prepares and makes available for public  | 
| inspection a written decision
setting forth its  | 
| determinative reasoning.
 | 
|         (5) The purchase or lease of real property for the use  | 
| of
the public body, including meetings held for the purpose  | 
| of discussing
whether a particular parcel should be  | 
| acquired.
 | 
|         (6) The setting of a price for sale or lease of  | 
| property owned
by the public body.
 | 
|         (7) The sale or purchase of securities, investments, or  | 
| investment
contracts. This exception shall not apply to the  | 
| investment of assets or income of funds deposited into the  | 
| Illinois Prepaid Tuition Trust Fund. 
 | 
|         (8) Security procedures, school building safety and  | 
| security, and the use of personnel and
equipment to respond  | 
| to an actual, a threatened, or a reasonably
potential  | 
| danger to the safety of employees, students, staff, the  | 
| public, or
public
property.
 | 
|  | 
|         (9) Student disciplinary cases.
 | 
|         (10) The placement of individual students in special  | 
| education
programs and other matters relating to  | 
| individual students.
 | 
|         (11) Litigation, when an action against, affecting or  | 
| on behalf of the
particular public body has been filed and  | 
| is pending before a court or
administrative tribunal, or  | 
| when the public body finds that an action is
probable or  | 
| imminent, in which case the basis for the finding shall be
 | 
| recorded and entered into the minutes of the closed  | 
| meeting.
 | 
|         (12) The establishment of reserves or settlement of  | 
| claims as provided
in the Local Governmental and  | 
| Governmental Employees Tort Immunity Act, if
otherwise the  | 
| disposition of a claim or potential claim might be
 | 
| prejudiced, or the review or discussion of claims, loss or  | 
| risk management
information, records, data, advice or  | 
| communications from or with respect
to any insurer of the  | 
| public body or any intergovernmental risk management
 | 
| association or self insurance pool of which the public body  | 
| is a member.
 | 
|         (13) Conciliation of complaints of discrimination in  | 
| the sale or rental
of housing, when closed meetings are  | 
| authorized by the law or ordinance
prescribing fair housing  | 
| practices and creating a commission or
administrative  | 
| agency for their enforcement.
 | 
|  | 
|         (14) Informant sources, the hiring or assignment of  | 
| undercover personnel
or equipment, or ongoing, prior or  | 
| future criminal investigations, when
discussed by a public  | 
| body with criminal investigatory responsibilities.
 | 
|         (15) Professional ethics or performance when  | 
| considered by an advisory
body appointed to advise a  | 
| licensing or regulatory agency on matters
germane to the  | 
| advisory body's field of competence.
 | 
|         (16) Self evaluation, practices and procedures or  | 
| professional ethics,
when meeting with a representative of  | 
| a statewide association of which the
public body is a  | 
| member.
 | 
|         (17) The recruitment, credentialing, discipline or  | 
| formal peer review
of physicians or other
health care  | 
| professionals, or for the discussion of matters protected  | 
| under the federal Patient Safety and Quality Improvement  | 
| Act of 2005, and the regulations promulgated thereunder,  | 
| including 42 C.F.R. Part 3 (73 FR 70732), or the federal  | 
| Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of  | 
| 1996, and the regulations promulgated thereunder,  | 
| including 45 C.F.R. Parts 160, 162, and 164, by a hospital,  | 
| or
other institution providing medical care, that is  | 
| operated by the public body.
 | 
|         (18) Deliberations for decisions of the Prisoner  | 
| Review Board.
 | 
|         (19) Review or discussion of applications received  | 
|  | 
| under the
Experimental Organ Transplantation Procedures  | 
| Act.
 | 
|         (20) The classification and discussion of matters  | 
| classified as
confidential or continued confidential by  | 
| the State Government Suggestion Award
Board.
 | 
|         (21) Discussion of minutes of meetings lawfully closed  | 
| under this Act,
whether for purposes of approval by the  | 
| body of the minutes or semi-annual
review of the minutes as  | 
| mandated by Section 2.06.
 | 
|         (22) Deliberations for decisions of the State
 | 
| Emergency Medical Services Disciplinary
Review Board.
 | 
|         (23) The operation by a municipality of a municipal  | 
| utility or the
operation of a
municipal power agency or  | 
| municipal natural gas agency when the
discussion involves  | 
| (i) contracts relating to the
purchase, sale, or delivery  | 
| of electricity or natural gas or (ii) the results
or  | 
| conclusions of load forecast studies.
 | 
|         (24) Meetings of a residential health care facility  | 
| resident sexual
assault and death review
team or
the  | 
| Executive
Council under the Abuse Prevention Review
Team  | 
| Act.
 | 
|         (25) Meetings of an independent team of experts under  | 
| Brian's Law.  | 
|         (26) Meetings of a mortality review team appointed  | 
| under the Department of Juvenile Justice Mortality Review  | 
| Team Act.  | 
|  | 
|         (27) (Blank).  | 
|         (28) Correspondence and records (i) that may not be  | 
| disclosed under Section 11-9 of the Illinois Public Aid  | 
| Code or (ii) that pertain to appeals under Section 11-8 of  | 
| the Illinois Public Aid Code.  | 
|         (29) Meetings  between internal or external auditors  | 
| and governmental audit committees, finance committees, and  | 
| their equivalents, when the discussion involves internal  | 
| control weaknesses, identification of potential fraud risk  | 
| areas, known or suspected frauds, and fraud interviews  | 
| conducted in accordance with generally accepted auditing  | 
| standards of the United States of America. | 
|         (30) Those meetings or portions of meetings of a  | 
| fatality review team or the Illinois Fatality Review Team  | 
| Advisory Council during which a review of the death of an  | 
| eligible adult in which abuse or neglect is suspected,  | 
| alleged, or substantiated is conducted pursuant to Section  | 
| 15 of the Adult Protective Services Act.  | 
|         (31) Meetings and deliberations for decisions of the  | 
| Concealed Carry Licensing Review Board under the Firearm  | 
| Concealed Carry Act.  | 
|         (32) Meetings between the Regional Transportation  | 
| Authority Board and its Service Boards when the discussion  | 
| involves review by the Regional Transportation Authority  | 
| Board of employment contracts under Section 28d of the  | 
| Metropolitan Transit Authority Act and Sections 3A.18 and  | 
|  | 
| 3B.26 of the Regional Transportation Authority Act. | 
|         (33) Those meetings or portions of meetings of the  | 
| advisory committee and peer review subcommittee created  | 
| under Section 320 of the Illinois Controlled Substances Act  | 
| during which specific controlled substance prescriber,  | 
| dispenser, or patient information is discussed. | 
|         (34) Meetings of the Tax Increment Financing Reform  | 
| Task Force under Section 2505-800 of the Department of  | 
| Revenue Law of the Civil Administrative Code of Illinois.  | 
|     (d) Definitions.  For purposes of this Section:
 | 
|     "Employee" means a person employed by a public body whose  | 
| relationship
with the public body constitutes an  | 
| employer-employee relationship under
the usual common law  | 
| rules, and who is not an independent contractor.
 | 
|     "Public office" means a position created by or under the
 | 
| Constitution or laws of this State, the occupant of which is  | 
| charged with
the exercise of some portion of the sovereign  | 
| power of this State. The term
"public office" shall include  | 
| members of the public body, but it shall not
include  | 
| organizational positions filled by members thereof, whether
 | 
| established by law or by a public body itself, that exist to  | 
| assist the
body in the conduct of its business.
 | 
|     "Quasi-adjudicative body" means an administrative body  | 
| charged by law or
ordinance with the responsibility to conduct  | 
| hearings, receive evidence or
testimony and make  | 
| determinations based
thereon, but does not include
local  | 
|  | 
| electoral boards when such bodies are considering petition  | 
| challenges.
 | 
|     (e) Final action.  No final action may be taken at a closed  | 
| meeting.
Final action shall be preceded by a public recital of  | 
| the nature of the
matter being considered and other information  | 
| that will inform the
public of the business being conducted. 
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-49, eff. 7-1-13; 98-63, eff. 7-9-13; 98-756,  | 
| eff. 7-16-14; 98-1027, eff. 1-1-15; 98-1039, eff. 8-25-14;  | 
| 99-78, eff. 7-20-15; 99-235, eff. 1-1-16; 99-480, eff. 9-9-15;  | 
| 99-642, eff. 7-28-16; 99-646, eff. 7-28-16; 99-687, eff.  | 
| 1-1-17; revised 9-21-16.)
 | 
|     Section 902. The Freedom of Information Act is amended  by  | 
| changing Section 7.5 as follows:
 | 
|     (5 ILCS 140/7.5) | 
|     Sec. 7.5. Statutory exemptions. To the extent provided for  | 
| by the statutes referenced below, the following shall be exempt  | 
| from inspection and copying: | 
|         (a) All information determined to be confidential  | 
| under Section 4002 of the Technology Advancement and  | 
| Development Act. | 
|         (b) Library circulation and order records identifying  | 
| library users with specific materials under the Library  | 
| Records Confidentiality Act. | 
|         (c) Applications, related documents, and medical  | 
|  | 
| records received by the Experimental Organ Transplantation  | 
| Procedures Board and any and all documents or other records  | 
| prepared by the Experimental Organ Transplantation  | 
| Procedures Board or its staff relating to applications it  | 
| has received. | 
|         (d) Information and records held by the Department of  | 
| Public Health and its authorized representatives relating  | 
| to known or suspected cases of sexually transmissible  | 
| disease or any information the disclosure of which is  | 
| restricted under the Illinois Sexually Transmissible  | 
| Disease Control Act. | 
|         (e) Information the disclosure of which is exempted  | 
| under Section 30 of the Radon Industry Licensing Act. | 
|         (f) Firm performance evaluations under Section 55 of  | 
| the Architectural, Engineering, and Land Surveying  | 
| Qualifications Based Selection Act. | 
|         (g) Information the disclosure of which is restricted  | 
| and exempted under Section 50 of the Illinois Prepaid  | 
| Tuition Act. | 
|         (h) Information the disclosure of which is exempted  | 
| under the State Officials and Employees Ethics Act, and  | 
| records of any lawfully created State or  local inspector  | 
| general's office that would be exempt if created or  | 
| obtained by an Executive Inspector General's office under  | 
| that Act. | 
|         (i) Information contained in a local emergency energy  | 
|  | 
| plan submitted to a municipality in accordance with a local  | 
| emergency energy plan ordinance that is adopted under  | 
| Section 11-21.5-5 of the Illinois Municipal Code. | 
|         (j) Information and data concerning the distribution  | 
| of surcharge moneys collected and remitted by wireless  | 
| carriers under the Wireless Emergency Telephone Safety  | 
| Act. | 
|         (k) Law enforcement officer identification information  | 
| or driver identification information compiled by a law  | 
| enforcement agency or the Department of Transportation  | 
| under Section 11-212 of the Illinois Vehicle Code. | 
|         (l) Records and information provided to a residential  | 
| health care facility resident sexual assault and death  | 
| review team or the Executive Council under the Abuse  | 
| Prevention Review Team Act. | 
|         (m) Information provided to the predatory lending  | 
| database created pursuant to Article 3 of the Residential  | 
| Real Property Disclosure Act, except to the extent  | 
| authorized under that Article. | 
|         (n) Defense budgets and petitions for certification of  | 
| compensation and expenses for court appointed trial  | 
| counsel as provided under Sections 10 and 15 of the Capital  | 
| Crimes Litigation Act. This subsection (n) shall apply  | 
| until the conclusion of the trial of the case, even if the  | 
| prosecution chooses not to pursue the death penalty prior  | 
| to trial or sentencing. | 
|  | 
|         (o) Information that is prohibited from being  | 
| disclosed under Section 4 of the Illinois Health and  | 
| Hazardous Substances Registry Act. | 
|         (p) Security portions of system safety program plans,  | 
| investigation reports, surveys, schedules, lists, data, or  | 
| information compiled, collected, or prepared by or for the  | 
| Regional Transportation Authority under Section 2.11 of  | 
| the Regional Transportation Authority Act or the St. Clair  | 
| County Transit District under the Bi-State Transit Safety  | 
| Act.  | 
|         (q) Information prohibited from being disclosed by the  | 
| Personnel Records Review Act.  | 
|         (r) Information prohibited from being disclosed by the  | 
| Illinois School Student Records Act.  | 
|         (s) Information the disclosure of which is restricted  | 
| under Section 5-108 of the Public Utilities Act. 
 | 
|         (t) All identified or deidentified health information  | 
| in the form of health data or medical records contained in,  | 
| stored in, submitted to, transferred by, or released from  | 
| the Illinois Health Information Exchange, and identified  | 
| or deidentified health information in the form of  health  | 
| data and medical records of the Illinois Health Information  | 
| Exchange  in the possession of the Illinois Health  | 
| Information Exchange Authority due to its administration  | 
| of the Illinois Health Information Exchange. The terms  | 
| "identified" and "deidentified" shall be given the same  | 
|  | 
| meaning as in the Health Insurance Portability and  | 
| Accountability Act of 1996, Public Law 104-191, or any  | 
| subsequent amendments thereto, and any regulations  | 
| promulgated thereunder.  | 
|         (u) Records and information provided to an independent  | 
| team of experts under Brian's Law.  | 
|         (v) Names and information of people who have applied  | 
| for or received Firearm Owner's Identification Cards under  | 
| the Firearm Owners Identification Card Act or applied for  | 
| or received a concealed carry license under the Firearm  | 
| Concealed Carry Act, unless otherwise authorized by the  | 
| Firearm Concealed Carry Act; and databases under the  | 
| Firearm Concealed Carry Act, records of the Concealed Carry  | 
| Licensing Review Board under the Firearm Concealed Carry  | 
| Act, and law enforcement agency objections under the  | 
| Firearm Concealed Carry Act.  | 
|         (w) Personally identifiable information which is  | 
| exempted from disclosure under subsection (g) of Section  | 
| 19.1 of the Toll Highway Act. | 
|         (x) Information which is exempted from disclosure  | 
| under Section 5-1014.3 of the Counties Code or Section  | 
| 8-11-21 of the Illinois Municipal Code.  | 
|         (y) Confidential information under the Adult  | 
| Protective Services Act and its predecessor enabling  | 
| statute, the Elder Abuse and Neglect Act, including  | 
| information about the identity and administrative finding  | 
|  | 
| against any caregiver of a verified and substantiated  | 
| decision of abuse, neglect, or financial exploitation of an  | 
| eligible adult maintained in the Registry established  | 
| under Section 7.5 of the Adult Protective Services Act.  | 
|         (z) Records and information provided to a fatality  | 
| review team or the Illinois Fatality Review Team Advisory  | 
| Council under Section 15 of the Adult Protective Services  | 
| Act.  | 
|         (aa) Information which is exempted from disclosure  | 
| under Section 2.37 of the Wildlife Code.  | 
|         (bb) Information which is or was prohibited from  | 
| disclosure by the Juvenile Court Act of 1987.  | 
|         (cc) Recordings made under the Law Enforcement  | 
| Officer-Worn Body Camera Act, except to the extent  | 
| authorized under that Act. | 
|         (dd) Information that is prohibited from being  | 
| disclosed under Section 45 of the Condominium and Common  | 
| Interest Community Ombudsperson Act.  | 
|         (ee) (dd) Information that is exempted from disclosure  | 
| under Section 30.1 of the Pharmacy Practice Act.  | 
|         (ff) Information which is exempted from disclosure  | 
| under Section 2505-800 of the Department of Revenue Law of  | 
| the Civil Administrative Code of Illinois.  | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-49, eff. 7-1-13; 98-63, eff. 7-9-13; 98-756,  | 
| eff. 7-16-14; 98-1039, eff. 8-25-14; 98-1045, eff. 8-25-14;  | 
| 99-78, eff. 7-20-15; 99-298, eff. 8-6-15; 99-352, eff. 1-1-16;  | 
|  | 
| 99-642, eff. 7-28-16; 99-776, eff. 8-12-16; 99-863, eff.  | 
| 8-19-16; revised 9-1-16.)
 | 
|     Section 904. The Election Code is amended  by changing  | 
| Section 28-2 as follows:
 
 | 
|     (10 ILCS 5/28-2)  (from Ch. 46, par. 28-2)
 | 
|     Sec. 28-2. (a) Except as otherwise provided in this  | 
| Section, petitions
for the submission of public questions to  | 
| referendum must be filed with the
appropriate officer or board  | 
| not less than 92 days prior to a regular
election to be  | 
| eligible for submission on the ballot at such election; and
 | 
| petitions for the submission of a question under Section 18-120  | 
| or Section 18-206 of the
Property Tax Code must be filed with  | 
| the appropriate officer or board not more
than 10 months nor  | 
| less than 6 months prior to the election at which such
question  | 
| is to be submitted to the voters.
 | 
|     (b) However, petitions for the submission of a public  | 
| question to
referendum which proposes the creation or formation  | 
| of a political
subdivision must be filed with the appropriate  | 
| officer or board not less
than 122 days prior to a regular  | 
| election to be eligible for submission on
the ballot at such  | 
| election.
 | 
|     (c) Resolutions or ordinances of governing boards of  | 
| political
subdivisions which initiate the submission of public  | 
| questions pursuant
to law must be adopted not less than 79 days  | 
|  | 
| before a regularly scheduled
election to be eligible for  | 
| submission on the ballot at such election.
 | 
|     (d) A petition, resolution or ordinance initiating the  | 
| submission of a
public question may specify a regular election  | 
| at which the question is
to be submitted, and must so specify  | 
| if the statute authorizing the
public question requires  | 
| submission at a particular election. However,
no petition,  | 
| resolution or ordinance initiating the submission of a
public  | 
| question, other than a legislative resolution initiating an
 | 
| amendment to the Constitution, may specify such submission at  | 
| an
election more than one year, or 15 months in the case of a  | 
| back door referendum as defined in subsection (f), after the  | 
| date on which it is filed or
adopted, as the case may be. A  | 
| petition, resolution or ordinance
initiating a public question  | 
| which specifies a particular election at
which the question is  | 
| to be submitted shall be so limited, and shall not
be valid as  | 
| to any other election, other than an emergency referendum
 | 
| ordered pursuant to Section 2A-1.4.
 | 
|     (e) If a petition initiating a public question does not  | 
| specify a
regularly scheduled election, the public question  | 
| shall be submitted to
referendum at the next regular election  | 
| occurring not less than 92 days
after the filing of the  | 
| petition, or not less than 122 days after the
filing of a  | 
| petition for referendum to create a political subdivision.  If
a  | 
| resolution or ordinance initiating a public question does not  | 
| specify a
regularly scheduled election, the public question  | 
|  | 
| shall be submitted to
referendum at the next regular election  | 
| occurring not less than 79 days
after the adoption of the  | 
| resolution or ordinance.
 | 
|     (f) In the case of back door referenda, any limitations in  | 
| another
statute authorizing such a referendum which restrict  | 
| the time in which
the initiating petition may be validly filed  | 
| shall apply to such
petition, in addition to the filing  | 
| deadlines specified in this Section
for submission at a  | 
| particular election.  In the case of any back door
referendum,  | 
| the publication of the ordinance or resolution of the political
 | 
| subdivision shall include a notice of (1) the specific number  | 
| of voters
required to sign a petition requesting that a public  | 
| question be submitted
to the voters of the subdivision; (2) the  | 
| time within which the petition must
be filed; and (3) the date  | 
| of the prospective referendum.  The secretary or
clerk of the  | 
| political subdivision shall provide a petition form to any
 | 
| individual requesting one. The legal sufficiency of that form,  | 
| if provided by the secretary or clerk of the political  | 
| subdivision, cannot be the basis of a challenge to placing the  | 
| back door referendum on the ballot. As used herein, a "back  | 
| door
referendum" is the submission of a public question to the  | 
| voters of a
political subdivision, initiated by a petition of  | 
| voters or residents of
such political subdivision, to determine  | 
| whether an action by the
governing body of such subdivision  | 
| shall be adopted or rejected.
 | 
|     (g) A petition for the incorporation or formation of a new
 | 
|  | 
| political subdivision whose officers are to be elected rather  | 
| than appointed
must have attached to it an affidavit attesting  | 
| that at least 122 days and
no more than 152 days prior to such  | 
| election notice of intention to file
such petition was  | 
| published in a newspaper published within the proposed
 | 
| political subdivision, or if none, in a newspaper of general  | 
| circulation
within the territory of the proposed political  | 
| subdivision in substantially
the following form:
 | 
| NOTICE OF PETITION TO FORM A NEW........
 | 
|     Residents of the territory described below are notified  | 
| that a petition
will or has been filed in the Office  | 
| of............requesting a referendum
to establish a  | 
| new........, to be called the............
 | 
|     *The officers of the new...........will be elected on the  | 
| same day as the
referendum.  Candidates for the governing board  | 
| of the new......may file
nominating petitions with the officer  | 
| named above until...........
 | 
|     The territory proposed to comprise the new........is  | 
| described as follows:
 | 
|         (description of territory included in petition)
 | 
|         (signature)....................................
 | 
|         Name and address of person or persons proposing
 | 
|         the new political subdivision.
 | 
|     * Where applicable.
 | 
|     Failure to file such affidavit, or failure to publish the  | 
| required notice
with the correct information contained therein  | 
|  | 
| shall render the petition,
and any referendum held pursuant to  | 
| such petition, null and void.
 | 
|     Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this  | 
| subsection (g) or any
other provisions of this Code, the  | 
| publication of notice and affidavit
requirements of this  | 
| subsection (g) shall not apply to any petition filed
under  | 
| Article 7 or 11E of the School Code nor to any
referendum
held  | 
| pursuant to any such petition, and neither any petition filed  | 
| under
any of those Articles nor any referendum held pursuant to  | 
| any such petition
shall be rendered null and void because of  | 
| the failure to file an affidavit
or publish a notice with  | 
| respect to the petition or referendum as required
under this  | 
| subsection (g) for petitions that are not filed under any of
 | 
| those Articles of the School Code.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 96-1008, eff. 7-6-10.)
 | 
|     Section 905. The Economic Development Area Tax Increment  | 
| Allocation Act is amended  by changing Section 7 as follows:
 
 | 
|     (20 ILCS 620/7)  (from Ch. 67 1/2, par. 1007)
 | 
|     Sec. 7. Creation of special tax allocation fund. If a  | 
| municipality
has adopted tax increment allocation financing  | 
| for an economic development
project area by ordinance, the  | 
| county clerk has thereafter certified the "total
initial  | 
| equalized assessed value" of the taxable real property within  | 
| such
economic development project area in the manner provided  | 
|  | 
| in Section 6 of this
Act, and the Department has approved and  | 
| certified the economic development
project area, each year  | 
| after the date of the certification by the county clerk
of the  | 
| "total initial equalized assessed value" until economic  | 
| development
project costs and all municipal obligations  | 
| financing economic development
project costs have been paid,  | 
| the ad valorem taxes, if any, arising from the
levies upon the  | 
| taxable real property in the economic development project area
 | 
| by taxing districts and tax rates determined in the manner  | 
| provided in
subsection (b) of Section 6 of this Act shall be  | 
| divided as follows:
 | 
|     (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable lot,  | 
| block, tract
or parcel of real property which is attributable  | 
| to the lower of the current
equalized assessed value or the  | 
| initial equalized assessed value of each such
taxable lot,  | 
| block, tract, or parcel of real property existing at the time  | 
| tax
increment allocation financing was adopted, shall be  | 
| allocated to and when
collected shall be paid by the county  | 
| collector to the respective affected
taxing districts in the  | 
| manner required by law in the absence of the adoption
of tax  | 
| increment allocation financing.
 | 
|     (2) That portion, if any, of those taxes which is  | 
| attributable to the
increase in the current equalized assessed  | 
| valuation of each taxable lot,
block, tract, or parcel of real  | 
| property in the economic development project
area, over and  | 
| above the initial equalized assessed value of each property
 | 
|  | 
| existing at the time tax increment allocation financing was  | 
| adopted,
shall be allocated to and when collected shall be paid  | 
| to the municipal
treasurer, who shall deposit those taxes into  | 
| a special fund called the special
tax allocation fund of the  | 
| municipality for the purpose of paying economic
development  | 
| project costs and obligations incurred in the payment thereof.
 | 
|     The municipality, by an ordinance adopting tax increment  | 
| allocation
financing, may pledge the funds in and to be  | 
| deposited in the special tax
allocation fund for the payment of  | 
| obligations issued under this Act and for
the payment of  | 
| economic development project costs. No part of the current
 | 
| equalized assessed valuation of each property in the economic  | 
| development
project area attributable to any increase above the  | 
| total initial equalized
assessed value, of such properties  | 
| shall be used in calculating the general
State school aid  | 
| formula, provided for in Section 18-8 of the School Code, or  | 
| the evidence-based funding formula, provided for in Section  | 
| 18-8.15 of the School Code,
until such time as all economic  | 
| development projects costs have been paid as
provided for in  | 
| this Section.
 | 
|     When the economic development project costs, including  | 
| without
limitation all municipal obligations financing  | 
| economic development project
costs incurred under this Act,  | 
| have been paid, all surplus funds then
remaining in the special  | 
| tax allocation fund shall be distributed by being
paid by the  | 
| municipal treasurer to the county collector, who shall
 | 
|  | 
| immediately thereafter pay those funds to the taxing districts  | 
| having
taxable property in the economic development project  | 
| area in the same
manner and proportion as the most recent  | 
| distribution by the county
collector to those taxing districts  | 
| of real property taxes from real
property in the economic  | 
| development project area.
 | 
|     Upon the payment of all economic development project costs,  | 
| retirement of
obligations and the distribution of any excess  | 
| monies pursuant to this
Section the municipality shall adopt an  | 
| ordinance dissolving the special
tax allocation fund for the  | 
| economic development project area,
terminating the economic  | 
| development project area, and terminating the use
of tax  | 
| increment allocation financing for the economic development  | 
| project
area. Thereafter the rates of the taxing districts  | 
| shall be extended and taxes
levied, collected and distributed  | 
| in the manner applicable in the absence of
the adoption of tax  | 
| increment allocation financing.
 | 
|     Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving  | 
| property in
economic development project areas from being  | 
| assessed as provided in the
Property Tax Code, or as relieving
 | 
| owners of that property from paying a uniform rate of taxes, as  | 
| required by
Section 4 of Article IX of the Illinois  | 
| Constitution.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13.)
 | 
|     Section 910. The Civil Administrative Code of Illinois  | 
|  | 
| (Department of Revenue Law) is amended by adding Section  | 
| 2505-800 as follows:
 | 
|     (20 ILCS 2505/2505-800 new) | 
|     Sec. 2505-800. Tax Increment Financing Reform Task Force. | 
|     (a) There is hereby created the Tax Increment Financing  | 
| Reform Task Force which shall consist of the following members: | 
|         (1) 3 members of the General Assembly, appointed by the  | 
| President of the Senate; | 
|         (2) 3 members of the General Assembly, appointed by the  | 
| Minority Leader of the Senate; | 
|         (3) 3 members of the General Assembly, appointed by the  | 
| Speaker of the House of Representatives; and | 
|         (4) 3 members of the General Assembly, appointed by the  | 
| Minority Leader of the House of Representatives. | 
|     (b) The members of the Task Force shall elect one co-chair   | 
| from each legislative caucus, who shall call meetings of the  | 
| Task Force to order. The Task Force shall hold an initial  | 
| meeting within 60 days after the effective date of this  | 
| amendatory Act of the 100th General Assembly. | 
|     (c) The Task Force shall conduct a study examining current  | 
| Tax Increment Financing (TIF) laws in this State and issues  | 
| that include, but are not limited to: | 
|         (1) the benefits and costs of TIF districts; | 
|         (2) the interaction between TIF law and school funding; | 
|         (3) the expenditure of TIF funds; and | 
|  | 
|         (4) the expenditure of TIF surplus funds. | 
|     (d) The Task Force shall report the findings of the study  | 
| and any recommendations to the General Assembly on or before  | 
| April 1, 2018, at which time the Task Force shall be dissolved. | 
|     (e) The Department of Revenue shall provide staff and  | 
| administrative support to the Task Force, and shall post on its  | 
| website the report under subsection (d) of this Section. | 
|     (f) The Task Force is exempt from any requirements under  | 
| the Freedom of Information Act and Open Meetings Act. | 
|     (g) This Section is repealed on April 30, 2018. 
 | 
|     Section 915. The State Finance Act is amended  by changing  | 
| Section 13.2 as follows:
 
 | 
|     (30 ILCS 105/13.2)  (from Ch. 127, par. 149.2)
 | 
|     Sec. 13.2. Transfers among line item appropriations.  | 
|     (a) Transfers among line item appropriations from the same
 | 
| treasury fund for the objects specified in this Section may be  | 
| made in
the manner provided in this Section when the balance  | 
| remaining in one or
more such line item appropriations is  | 
| insufficient for the purpose for
which the appropriation was  | 
| made. | 
|     (a-1) No transfers may be made from one
agency to another  | 
| agency, nor may transfers be made from one institution
of  | 
| higher education to another institution of higher education  | 
| except as provided by subsection (a-4).
 | 
|  | 
|     (a-2) Except as otherwise provided in this Section,  | 
| transfers may be made only among the objects of expenditure  | 
| enumerated
in this Section, except that no funds may be  | 
| transferred from any
appropriation for personal services, from  | 
| any appropriation for State
contributions to the State  | 
| Employees' Retirement System, from any
separate appropriation  | 
| for employee retirement contributions paid by the
employer, nor  | 
| from any appropriation for State contribution for
employee  | 
| group insurance.   During State fiscal year 2005, an agency may  | 
| transfer amounts among its appropriations within the same  | 
| treasury fund for personal services, employee retirement  | 
| contributions paid by employer, and State Contributions to  | 
| retirement systems; notwithstanding and in addition to the  | 
| transfers authorized in subsection (c) of this Section, the  | 
| fiscal year 2005 transfers authorized in this sentence may be  | 
| made in an amount not to exceed 2% of the aggregate amount  | 
| appropriated to an agency within the same treasury fund. During  | 
| State fiscal year 2007, the Departments of Children and Family  | 
| Services, Corrections, Human Services, and Juvenile Justice  | 
| may transfer amounts among their respective appropriations  | 
| within the same treasury fund for personal services, employee  | 
| retirement contributions paid by employer, and State  | 
| contributions to retirement systems.  During State fiscal year  | 
| 2010, the Department of Transportation may transfer amounts  | 
| among their respective appropriations within the same treasury  | 
| fund for personal services, employee retirement contributions  | 
|  | 
| paid by employer, and State contributions to retirement  | 
| systems. During State fiscal years 2010 and 2014 only, an  | 
| agency may transfer amounts among its respective  | 
| appropriations within the same treasury fund for personal  | 
| services, employee retirement contributions paid by employer,  | 
| and State contributions to retirement systems.  | 
| Notwithstanding, and in addition to, the transfers authorized  | 
| in subsection (c) of this Section, these transfers may be made  | 
| in an amount not to exceed 2% of the aggregate amount  | 
| appropriated to an agency within the same treasury fund.
 | 
|     (a-2.5) During State fiscal year 2015 only, the State's  | 
| Attorneys Appellate Prosecutor may transfer amounts among its  | 
| respective appropriations contained in operational line items  | 
| within the same treasury fund. Notwithstanding, and in addition  | 
| to, the transfers authorized in subsection (c) of this Section,  | 
| these transfers may be made in an amount not to exceed 4% of  | 
| the aggregate amount appropriated to the State's Attorneys  | 
| Appellate Prosecutor within the same treasury fund.  | 
|     (a-3) Further, if an agency receives a separate
 | 
| appropriation for employee retirement contributions paid by  | 
| the employer,
any transfer by that agency into an appropriation  | 
| for personal services
must be accompanied by a corresponding  | 
| transfer into the appropriation for
employee retirement  | 
| contributions paid by the employer, in an amount
sufficient to  | 
| meet the employer share of the employee contributions
required  | 
| to be remitted to the retirement system. | 
|  | 
|     (a-4) Long-Term Care Rebalancing.  The Governor may  | 
| designate amounts set aside for institutional services  | 
| appropriated from the General Revenue Fund or any other State  | 
| fund that receives monies for long-term care services to be  | 
| transferred to all State agencies responsible for the  | 
| administration of community-based long-term care programs,  | 
| including, but not limited to, community-based long-term care  | 
| programs administered by the Department of Healthcare and  | 
| Family Services, the Department of Human Services, and the  | 
| Department on Aging, provided that the Director of Healthcare  | 
| and Family Services first certifies that the amounts being  | 
| transferred are necessary for the purpose of assisting persons  | 
| in or at risk of being in institutional care to transition to  | 
| community-based settings, including the financial data needed  | 
| to prove the need for the transfer of funds. The total amounts  | 
| transferred shall not exceed 4% in total of the amounts  | 
| appropriated from the General Revenue Fund or any other State  | 
| fund that receives monies for long-term care services for each  | 
| fiscal year. A notice of the fund transfer must be made to the  | 
| General Assembly and posted at a minimum on the Department of  | 
| Healthcare and Family Services website, the Governor's Office  | 
| of Management and Budget website, and any other website the  | 
| Governor sees fit. These postings shall serve as notice to the  | 
| General Assembly of the amounts to be transferred. Notice shall  | 
| be given at least 30 days prior to transfer.  | 
|     (b) In addition to the general transfer authority provided  | 
|  | 
| under
subsection (c), the following agencies have the specific  | 
| transfer authority
granted in this subsection: | 
|     The Department of Healthcare and Family Services is  | 
| authorized to make transfers
representing savings attributable  | 
| to not increasing grants due to the
births of additional  | 
| children from line items for payments of cash grants to
line  | 
| items for payments for employment and social services for the  | 
| purposes
outlined in subsection (f) of Section 4-2 of the  | 
| Illinois Public Aid Code. | 
|     The Department of Children and Family Services is  | 
| authorized to make
transfers not exceeding 2% of the aggregate  | 
| amount appropriated to it within
the same treasury fund for the  | 
| following line items among these same line
items: Foster Home  | 
| and Specialized Foster Care and Prevention, Institutions
and  | 
| Group Homes and Prevention, and Purchase of Adoption and  | 
| Guardianship
Services. | 
|     The Department on Aging is authorized to make transfers not
 | 
| exceeding 2% of the aggregate amount appropriated to it within  | 
| the same
treasury fund for the following Community Care Program  | 
| line items among these
same line items: purchase of services  | 
| covered by the Community Care Program and Comprehensive Case  | 
| Coordination. | 
|     The State Treasurer is authorized to make transfers among  | 
| line item
appropriations
from the Capital Litigation Trust  | 
| Fund, with respect to costs incurred in
fiscal years 2002 and  | 
| 2003 only, when the balance remaining in one or
more such
line  | 
|  | 
| item appropriations is insufficient for the purpose for which  | 
| the
appropriation was
made, provided that no such transfer may  | 
| be made unless the amount transferred
is no
longer required for  | 
| the purpose for which that appropriation was made. | 
|     The State Board of Education is authorized to make  | 
| transfers from line item appropriations within the same  | 
| treasury fund for General State Aid, and General State Aid -  | 
| Hold Harmless, and Evidence-Based Funding, provided that no  | 
| such transfer may be made unless the amount transferred is no  | 
| longer required for the purpose for which that appropriation  | 
| was made, to the line item appropriation for Transitional  | 
| Assistance when the balance remaining in such line item  | 
| appropriation is insufficient for the purpose for which the  | 
| appropriation was made. | 
|     The State Board of Education is authorized to make  | 
| transfers between the following line item appropriations  | 
| within the same treasury fund:  Disabled Student  | 
| Services/Materials (Section 14-13.01 of the School Code),  | 
| Disabled Student Transportation Reimbursement (Section  | 
| 14-13.01 of the School Code), Disabled Student Tuition -  | 
| Private Tuition (Section 14-7.02 of the School Code),  | 
| Extraordinary Special Education (Section 14-7.02b of the  | 
| School Code), Reimbursement for Free Lunch/Breakfast Program,  | 
| Summer School Payments (Section 18-4.3 of the School Code), and  | 
| Transportation - Regular/Vocational Reimbursement (Section  | 
| 29-5 of the School Code).  Such transfers shall be made only  | 
|  | 
| when the balance remaining in one or more such line item  | 
| appropriations is insufficient for the purpose for which the  | 
| appropriation was made and provided that no such transfer may  | 
| be made unless the amount transferred is no longer required for  | 
| the purpose for which that appropriation was made.  | 
|     The Department of Healthcare and Family Services is  | 
| authorized to make transfers not exceeding 4% of the aggregate  | 
| amount appropriated to it, within the same treasury fund, among  | 
| the various line items appropriated for Medical Assistance.  | 
|     (c) The sum of such transfers for an agency in a fiscal  | 
| year shall not
exceed 2% of the aggregate amount appropriated  | 
| to it within the same treasury
fund for the following objects:  | 
| Personal Services; Extra Help; Student and
Inmate  | 
| Compensation; State Contributions to Retirement Systems; State
 | 
| Contributions to Social Security; State Contribution for  | 
| Employee Group
Insurance; Contractual Services; Travel;  | 
| Commodities; Printing; Equipment;
Electronic Data Processing;  | 
| Operation of Automotive Equipment;
Telecommunications  | 
| Services; Travel and Allowance for Committed, Paroled
and  | 
| Discharged Prisoners; Library Books; Federal Matching Grants  | 
| for
Student Loans; Refunds; Workers' Compensation,  | 
| Occupational Disease, and
Tort Claims; and, in appropriations  | 
| to institutions of higher education,
Awards and Grants.   | 
| Notwithstanding the above, any amounts appropriated for
 | 
| payment of workers' compensation claims to an agency to which  | 
| the authority
to evaluate, administer and pay such claims has  | 
|  | 
| been delegated by the
Department of Central Management Services  | 
| may be transferred to any other
expenditure object where such  | 
| amounts exceed the amount necessary for the
payment of such  | 
| claims. | 
|     (c-1) Special provisions for State fiscal year 2003.  | 
| Notwithstanding any
other provision of this Section to the  | 
| contrary, for State fiscal year 2003
only, transfers among line  | 
| item appropriations to an agency from the same
treasury fund  | 
| may be made provided that the sum of such transfers for an  | 
| agency
in State fiscal year 2003 shall not exceed 3% of the  | 
| aggregate amount
appropriated to that State agency for State  | 
| fiscal year 2003 for the following
objects: personal services,  | 
| except that no transfer may be approved which
reduces the  | 
| aggregate appropriations for personal services within an  | 
| agency;
extra help; student and inmate compensation; State
 | 
| contributions to retirement systems; State contributions to  | 
| social security;
State contributions for employee group  | 
| insurance; contractual services; travel;
commodities;  | 
| printing; equipment; electronic data processing; operation of
 | 
| automotive equipment; telecommunications services; travel and  | 
| allowance for
committed, paroled, and discharged prisoners;  | 
| library books; federal matching
grants for student loans;  | 
| refunds; workers' compensation, occupational disease,
and tort  | 
| claims; and, in appropriations to institutions of higher  | 
| education,
awards and grants. | 
|     (c-2)  Special provisions for State fiscal year 2005.   | 
|  | 
| Notwithstanding subsections (a), (a-2), and (c), for State  | 
| fiscal year 2005 only, transfers may be made among any line  | 
| item appropriations from the same or any other treasury fund  | 
| for any objects or purposes, without limitation, when the  | 
| balance remaining in one or more such line item appropriations  | 
| is insufficient for the purpose for which the appropriation was  | 
| made, provided that the sum of those transfers by a State  | 
| agency shall not exceed 4% of the aggregate amount appropriated  | 
| to that State agency for fiscal year 2005.
 | 
|     (c-3) Special provisions for State fiscal year 2015.   | 
| Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for State  | 
| fiscal year 2015, transfers among line item appropriations to a  | 
| State agency from the same State treasury fund may be made for  | 
| operational or lump sum expenses only, provided that the sum of  | 
| such transfers for a State agency in State fiscal year 2015  | 
| shall not exceed 4% of the aggregate amount appropriated to  | 
| that State agency for operational or lump sum expenses for  | 
| State fiscal year 2015. For the purpose of this subsection,  | 
| "operational or lump sum expenses" includes the following  | 
| objects: personal services; extra help; student and inmate  | 
| compensation; State contributions to retirement systems; State  | 
| contributions to social security; State contributions for  | 
| employee group insurance; contractual services; travel;  | 
| commodities; printing; equipment; electronic data processing;  | 
| operation of automotive equipment; telecommunications  | 
| services; travel and allowance for committed, paroled, and  | 
|  | 
| discharged prisoners; library books; federal matching grants  | 
| for student loans; refunds; workers' compensation,  | 
| occupational disease, and tort claims; lump sum and other  | 
| purposes; and lump sum operations.  For the purpose of this  | 
| subsection (c-3), "State agency" does not include the Attorney  | 
| General, the Secretary of State, the Comptroller, the  | 
| Treasurer, or the legislative or judicial branches.  | 
|     (d) Transfers among appropriations made to agencies of the  | 
| Legislative
and Judicial departments and to the  | 
| constitutionally elected officers in the
Executive branch  | 
| require the approval of the officer authorized in Section 10
of  | 
| this Act to approve and certify vouchers.  Transfers among  | 
| appropriations
made to the University of Illinois, Southern  | 
| Illinois University, Chicago State
University, Eastern  | 
| Illinois University, Governors State University, Illinois
 | 
| State University, Northeastern Illinois University, Northern  | 
| Illinois
University, Western Illinois University, the Illinois  | 
| Mathematics and Science
Academy and the Board of Higher  | 
| Education require the approval of the Board of
Higher Education  | 
| and the Governor.  Transfers among appropriations to all other
 | 
| agencies require the approval of the Governor. | 
|     The officer responsible for approval shall certify that the
 | 
| transfer is necessary to carry out the programs and purposes  | 
| for which
the appropriations were made by the General Assembly  | 
| and shall transmit
to the State Comptroller a certified copy of  | 
| the approval which shall
set forth the specific amounts  | 
|  | 
| transferred so that the Comptroller may
change his records  | 
| accordingly.  The Comptroller shall furnish the
Governor with  | 
| information copies of all transfers approved for agencies
of  | 
| the Legislative and Judicial departments and transfers  | 
| approved by
the constitutionally elected officials of the  | 
| Executive branch other
than the Governor, showing the amounts  | 
| transferred and indicating the
dates such changes were entered  | 
| on the Comptroller's records. | 
|     (e) The State Board of Education, in consultation with the  | 
| State Comptroller, may transfer line item appropriations for  | 
| General State Aid or Evidence-Based Funding between the Common  | 
| School Fund and the Education Assistance Fund. With the advice  | 
| and consent of the Governor's Office of Management and Budget,  | 
| the State Board of Education, in consultation with the State  | 
| Comptroller, may transfer line item appropriations between the  | 
| General Revenue Fund and the Education Assistance Fund for the  | 
| following programs: | 
|         (1)  Disabled Student Personnel Reimbursement (Section  | 
| 14-13.01 of the School Code); | 
|         (2)  Disabled Student Transportation Reimbursement  | 
| (subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of the School Code); | 
|         (3)  Disabled Student Tuition - Private Tuition  | 
| (Section 14-7.02 of the School Code); | 
|         (4)  Extraordinary Special Education (Section 14-7.02b  | 
| of the School Code); | 
|         (5)  Reimbursement for Free Lunch/Breakfast Programs; | 
|  | 
|         (6)  Summer School Payments (Section 18-4.3 of the  | 
| School Code); | 
|         (7)  Transportation - Regular/Vocational Reimbursement  | 
| (Section 29-5 of the School Code); | 
|         (8)  Regular Education Reimbursement (Section 18-3 of  | 
| the School Code); and | 
|         (9)  Special Education Reimbursement (Section 14-7.03  | 
| of the School Code).  | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-24, eff. 6-19-13; 98-674, eff. 6-30-14; 99-2,  | 
| eff. 3-26-15.)
 | 
|     Section 920. The Illinois Income Tax Act is amended  by  | 
| adding Section 224 as follows:
 | 
|     (35 ILCS 5/224 new) | 
|     Sec. 224. Invest in Kids credit.  | 
|     (a) For taxable years beginning on or after January 1, 2018  | 
| and ending before January 1, 2023, each taxpayer for whom a tax  | 
| credit has been awarded by the Department under the Invest in  | 
| Kids Act is entitled to a credit against the tax imposed under  | 
| subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of this Act in an amount  | 
| equal to the amount awarded under the Invest in Kids Act.  | 
|     (b) For partners, shareholders of subchapter S  | 
| corporations, and owners of limited liability companies, if the  | 
| liability company is treated as a partnership for purposes of  | 
| federal and State income taxation, the credit under this  | 
|  | 
| Section shall be determined in accordance with the  | 
| determination of income and distributive share of income under  | 
| Sections 702 and 704 and subchapter S of the Internal Revenue  | 
| Code.  | 
|     (c) The credit may not be carried back and may not reduce  | 
| the taxpayer's liability to less than zero. If the amount of  | 
| the credit exceeds the tax liability for the year, the excess  | 
| may be carried forward and applied to the tax liability of the  | 
| 5 taxable years following the excess credit year. The tax  | 
| credit shall be applied to the earliest year for which there is  | 
| a tax liability. If there are credits for more than one year  | 
| that are available to offset the liability, the earlier credit  | 
| shall be applied first.  | 
|     (d) A tax credit awarded by the Department under the Invest  | 
| in Kids Act may not be claimed for any qualified contribution  | 
| for which  the taxpayer claims a federal income tax deduction.
 | 
|     Section 925. The Property Tax Code is amended  by changing  | 
| Sections 18-185, 18-200, and 18-249 and by adding Section  | 
| 18-206 as follows:
 | 
|     (35 ILCS 200/18-185)
 | 
|     Sec. 18-185. Short title; definitions.   This Division 5 may  | 
| be cited as the
Property Tax Extension Limitation Law.  As used  | 
| in this Division 5:
 | 
|     "Consumer Price Index" means the Consumer Price Index for  | 
|  | 
| All Urban
Consumers for all items published by the United  | 
| States Department of Labor.
 | 
|     "Extension limitation" means (a) the lesser of 5% or the  | 
| percentage increase
in the Consumer Price Index during the  | 
| 12-month calendar year preceding the
levy year or (b) the rate  | 
| of increase approved by voters under Section 18-205.
 | 
|     "Affected county" means a county of 3,000,000 or more  | 
| inhabitants or a
county contiguous to a county of 3,000,000 or  | 
| more inhabitants.
 | 
|     "Taxing district" has the same meaning provided in Section  | 
| 1-150, except as
otherwise provided in this Section.  For the  | 
| 1991 through 1994 levy years only,
"taxing district" includes  | 
| only each non-home rule taxing district having the
majority of  | 
| its
1990 equalized assessed value within any county or counties  | 
| contiguous to a
county with 3,000,000 or more inhabitants.   | 
| Beginning with the 1995 levy
year, "taxing district" includes  | 
| only each non-home rule taxing district
subject to this Law  | 
| before the 1995 levy year and each non-home rule
taxing  | 
| district not subject to this Law before the 1995 levy year  | 
| having the
majority of its 1994 equalized assessed value in an  | 
| affected county or
counties.  Beginning with the levy year in
 | 
| which this Law becomes applicable to a taxing district as
 | 
| provided in Section 18-213, "taxing district" also includes  | 
| those taxing
districts made subject to this Law as provided in  | 
| Section 18-213.
 | 
|     "Aggregate extension" for taxing districts to which this  | 
|  | 
| Law applied before
the 1995 levy year means the annual  | 
| corporate extension for the taxing
district and those special  | 
| purpose extensions that are made annually for
the taxing  | 
| district, excluding special purpose extensions: (a) made for  | 
| the
taxing district to pay interest or principal on general  | 
| obligation bonds
that were approved by referendum; (b) made for  | 
| any taxing district to pay
interest or principal on general  | 
| obligation bonds issued before October 1,
1991; (c) made for  | 
| any taxing district to pay interest or principal on bonds
 | 
| issued to refund or continue to refund those bonds issued  | 
| before October 1,
1991; (d)
made for any taxing district to pay  | 
| interest or principal on bonds
issued to refund or continue to  | 
| refund bonds issued after October 1, 1991 that
were approved by  | 
| referendum; (e)
made for any taxing district to pay interest
or  | 
| principal on revenue bonds issued before October 1, 1991 for  | 
| payment of
which a property tax levy or the full faith and  | 
| credit of the unit of local
government is pledged; however, a  | 
| tax for the payment of interest or principal
on those bonds  | 
| shall be made only after the governing body of the unit of  | 
| local
government finds that all other sources for payment are  | 
| insufficient to make
those payments; (f) made for payments  | 
| under a building commission lease when
the lease payments are  | 
| for the retirement of bonds issued by the commission
before  | 
| October 1, 1991, to pay for the building project; (g) made for  | 
| payments
due under installment contracts entered into before  | 
| October 1, 1991;
(h) made for payments of principal and  | 
|  | 
| interest on bonds issued under the
Metropolitan Water  | 
| Reclamation District Act to finance construction projects
 | 
| initiated before October 1, 1991; (i) made for payments of  | 
| principal and
interest on limited bonds, as defined in Section  | 
| 3 of the Local Government Debt
Reform Act, in an amount not to  | 
| exceed the debt service extension base less
the amount in items  | 
| (b), (c), (e), and (h) of this definition for
non-referendum  | 
| obligations, except obligations initially issued pursuant to
 | 
| referendum; (j) made for payments of principal and interest on  | 
| bonds
issued under Section 15 of the Local Government Debt  | 
| Reform Act; (k)
made
by a school district that participates in  | 
| the Special Education District of
Lake County, created by  | 
| special education joint agreement under Section
10-22.31 of the  | 
| School Code, for payment of the school district's share of the
 | 
| amounts required to be contributed by the Special Education  | 
| District of Lake
County to the Illinois Municipal Retirement  | 
| Fund under Article 7 of the
Illinois Pension Code; the amount  | 
| of any extension under this item (k) shall be
certified by the  | 
| school district to the county clerk; (l) made to fund
expenses  | 
| of providing joint recreational programs for persons with  | 
| disabilities under
Section 5-8 of
the
Park District Code or  | 
| Section 11-95-14 of the Illinois Municipal Code; (m) made for  | 
| temporary relocation loan repayment purposes pursuant to  | 
| Sections 2-3.77 and 17-2.2d of the School Code;  (n) made for  | 
| payment of principal and interest on any bonds issued under the  | 
| authority of Section 17-2.2d of the School Code; (o) made for  | 
|  | 
| contributions to a firefighter's pension fund created under  | 
| Article 4 of the Illinois Pension Code, to the extent of the  | 
| amount certified under item (5) of Section 4-134 of the  | 
| Illinois Pension Code; and (p) made for road purposes in the  | 
| first year after a township assumes the rights, powers, duties,  | 
| assets, property, liabilities, obligations, and
 | 
| responsibilities of a road district abolished under the  | 
| provisions of Section 6-133 of  the Illinois Highway Code.
 | 
|     "Aggregate extension" for the taxing districts to which  | 
| this Law did not
apply before the 1995 levy year (except taxing  | 
| districts subject to this Law
in
accordance with Section  | 
| 18-213) means the annual corporate extension for the
taxing  | 
| district and those special purpose extensions that are made  | 
| annually for
the taxing district, excluding special purpose  | 
| extensions: (a) made for the
taxing district to pay interest or  | 
| principal on general obligation bonds that
were approved by  | 
| referendum; (b) made for any taxing district to pay interest
or  | 
| principal on general obligation bonds issued before March 1,  | 
| 1995; (c) made
for any taxing district to pay interest or  | 
| principal on bonds issued to refund
or continue to refund those  | 
| bonds issued before March 1, 1995; (d) made for any
taxing  | 
| district to pay interest or principal on bonds issued to refund  | 
| or
continue to refund bonds issued after March 1, 1995 that  | 
| were approved by
referendum; (e) made for any taxing district  | 
| to pay interest or principal on
revenue bonds issued before  | 
| March 1, 1995 for payment of which a property tax
levy or the  | 
|  | 
| full faith and credit of the unit of local government is  | 
| pledged;
however, a tax for the payment of interest or  | 
| principal on those bonds shall be
made only after the governing  | 
| body of the unit of local government finds that
all other  | 
| sources for payment are insufficient to make those payments;  | 
| (f) made
for payments under a building commission lease when  | 
| the lease payments are for
the retirement of bonds issued by  | 
| the commission before March 1, 1995 to
pay for the building  | 
| project; (g) made for payments due under installment
contracts  | 
| entered into before March 1, 1995; (h) made for payments of
 | 
| principal and interest on bonds issued under the Metropolitan  | 
| Water Reclamation
District Act to finance construction  | 
| projects initiated before October 1,
1991; (h-4) made for  | 
| stormwater management purposes by the Metropolitan Water  | 
| Reclamation District of Greater Chicago under Section 12 of the  | 
| Metropolitan Water Reclamation District Act; (i) made for  | 
| payments of principal and interest on limited bonds,
as defined  | 
| in Section 3 of the Local Government Debt Reform Act, in an  | 
| amount
not to exceed the debt service extension base less the  | 
| amount in items (b),
(c), and (e) of this definition for  | 
| non-referendum obligations, except
obligations initially  | 
| issued pursuant to referendum and bonds described in
subsection  | 
| (h) of this definition; (j) made for payments of
principal and  | 
| interest on bonds issued under Section 15 of the Local  | 
| Government
Debt Reform Act; (k) made for payments of principal  | 
| and interest on bonds
authorized by Public Act 88-503 and  | 
|  | 
| issued under Section 20a of the Chicago
Park District Act for  | 
| aquarium or
museum projects; (l) made for payments of principal  | 
| and interest on
bonds
authorized by Public Act 87-1191 or  | 
| 93-601 and (i) issued pursuant to Section 21.2 of the Cook  | 
| County Forest
Preserve District Act, (ii) issued under Section  | 
| 42 of the Cook County
Forest Preserve District Act for  | 
| zoological park projects, or (iii) issued
under Section 44.1 of  | 
| the Cook County Forest Preserve District Act for
botanical  | 
| gardens projects; (m) made
pursuant
to Section 34-53.5 of the  | 
| School Code, whether levied annually or not;
(n) made to fund  | 
| expenses of providing joint recreational programs for persons  | 
| with disabilities under Section 5-8 of the Park
District Code  | 
| or Section 11-95-14 of the Illinois Municipal Code;
 (o) made by  | 
| the
Chicago Park
District for recreational programs for persons  | 
| with disabilities under subsection (c) of
Section
7.06 of the  | 
| Chicago Park District Act; (p) made for contributions to a  | 
| firefighter's pension fund created under Article 4 of the  | 
| Illinois Pension Code, to the extent of the amount certified  | 
| under item (5) of Section 4-134 of the Illinois Pension Code;  | 
| (q) made by Ford Heights School District 169 under Section  | 
| 17-9.02 of the School Code; and (r) made for the purpose of  | 
| making employer contributions to the Public School Teachers'  | 
| Pension and Retirement Fund of Chicago under Section 34-53 of  | 
| the School Code.
 | 
|     "Aggregate extension" for all taxing districts to which  | 
| this Law applies in
accordance with Section 18-213, except for  | 
|  | 
| those taxing districts subject to
paragraph (2) of subsection  | 
| (e) of Section 18-213, means the annual corporate
extension for  | 
| the
taxing district and those special purpose extensions that  | 
| are made annually for
the taxing district, excluding special  | 
| purpose extensions: (a) made for the
taxing district to pay  | 
| interest or principal on general obligation bonds that
were  | 
| approved by referendum; (b) made for any taxing district to pay  | 
| interest
or principal on general obligation bonds issued before  | 
| the date on which the
referendum making this
Law applicable to  | 
| the taxing district is held; (c) made
for any taxing district  | 
| to pay interest or principal on bonds issued to refund
or  | 
| continue to refund those bonds issued before the date on which  | 
| the
referendum making this Law
applicable to the taxing  | 
| district is held;
(d) made for any
taxing district to pay  | 
| interest or principal on bonds issued to refund or
continue to  | 
| refund bonds issued after the date on which the referendum  | 
| making
this Law
applicable to the taxing district is held if  | 
| the bonds were approved by
referendum after the date on which  | 
| the referendum making this Law
applicable to the taxing  | 
| district is held; (e) made for any
taxing district to pay  | 
| interest or principal on
revenue bonds issued before the date  | 
| on which the referendum making this Law
applicable to the
 | 
| taxing district is held for payment of which a property tax
 | 
| levy or the full faith and credit of the unit of local  | 
| government is pledged;
however, a tax for the payment of  | 
| interest or principal on those bonds shall be
made only after  | 
|  | 
| the governing body of the unit of local government finds that
 | 
| all other sources for payment are insufficient to make those  | 
| payments; (f) made
for payments under a building commission  | 
| lease when the lease payments are for
the retirement of bonds  | 
| issued by the commission before the date on which the
 | 
| referendum making this
Law applicable to the taxing district is  | 
| held to
pay for the building project; (g) made for payments due  | 
| under installment
contracts entered into before the date on  | 
| which the referendum making this Law
applicable to
the taxing  | 
| district is held;
(h) made for payments
of principal and  | 
| interest on limited bonds,
as defined in Section 3 of the Local  | 
| Government Debt Reform Act, in an amount
not to exceed the debt  | 
| service extension base less the amount in items (b),
(c), and  | 
| (e) of this definition for non-referendum obligations, except
 | 
| obligations initially issued pursuant to referendum; (i) made  | 
| for payments
of
principal and interest on bonds issued under  | 
| Section 15 of the Local Government
Debt Reform Act;
(j)
made  | 
| for a qualified airport authority to pay interest or principal  | 
| on
general obligation bonds issued for the purpose of paying  | 
| obligations due
under, or financing airport facilities  | 
| required to be acquired, constructed,
installed or equipped  | 
| pursuant to, contracts entered into before March
1, 1996 (but  | 
| not including any amendments to such a contract taking effect  | 
| on
or after that date); (k) made to fund expenses of providing  | 
| joint
recreational programs for persons with disabilities  | 
| under Section 5-8 of
the
Park District Code or Section 11-95-14  | 
|  | 
| of the Illinois Municipal Code; (l) made for contributions to a  | 
| firefighter's pension fund created under Article 4 of the  | 
| Illinois Pension Code, to the extent of the amount certified  | 
| under item (5) of Section 4-134 of the Illinois Pension Code;  | 
| and (m) made for the taxing district to pay interest or  | 
| principal on general obligation bonds issued pursuant to  | 
| Section 19-3.10 of the School Code.
 | 
|     "Aggregate extension" for all taxing districts to which  | 
| this Law applies in
accordance with paragraph (2) of subsection  | 
| (e) of Section 18-213 means the
annual corporate extension for  | 
| the
taxing district and those special purpose extensions that  | 
| are made annually for
the taxing district, excluding special  | 
| purpose extensions: (a) made for the
taxing district to pay  | 
| interest or principal on general obligation bonds that
were  | 
| approved by referendum; (b) made for any taxing district to pay  | 
| interest
or principal on general obligation bonds issued before  | 
| the effective date of
this amendatory Act of 1997;
(c) made
for  | 
| any taxing district to pay interest or principal on bonds  | 
| issued to refund
or continue to refund those bonds issued  | 
| before the effective date
of this amendatory Act of 1997;
(d)  | 
| made for any
taxing district to pay interest or principal on  | 
| bonds issued to refund or
continue to refund bonds issued after  | 
| the effective date of this amendatory Act
of 1997 if the bonds  | 
| were approved by referendum after the effective date of
this  | 
| amendatory Act of 1997;
(e) made for any
taxing district to pay  | 
| interest or principal on
revenue bonds issued before the  | 
|  | 
| effective date of this amendatory Act of 1997
for payment of  | 
| which a property tax
levy or the full faith and credit of the  | 
| unit of local government is pledged;
however, a tax for the  | 
| payment of interest or principal on those bonds shall be
made  | 
| only after the governing body of the unit of local government  | 
| finds that
all other sources for payment are insufficient to  | 
| make those payments; (f) made
for payments under a building  | 
| commission lease when the lease payments are for
the retirement  | 
| of bonds issued by the commission before the effective date
of  | 
| this amendatory Act of 1997
to
pay for the building project;  | 
| (g) made for payments due under installment
contracts entered  | 
| into before the effective date of this amendatory Act of
1997;
 | 
| (h) made for payments
of principal and interest on limited  | 
| bonds,
as defined in Section 3 of the Local Government Debt  | 
| Reform Act, in an amount
not to exceed the debt service  | 
| extension base less the amount in items (b),
(c), and (e) of  | 
| this definition for non-referendum obligations, except
 | 
| obligations initially issued pursuant to referendum; (i) made  | 
| for payments
of
principal and interest on bonds issued under  | 
| Section 15 of the Local Government
Debt Reform Act;
(j)
made  | 
| for a qualified airport authority to pay interest or principal  | 
| on
general obligation bonds issued for the purpose of paying  | 
| obligations due
under, or financing airport facilities  | 
| required to be acquired, constructed,
installed or equipped  | 
| pursuant to, contracts entered into before March
1, 1996 (but  | 
| not including any amendments to such a contract taking effect  | 
|  | 
| on
or after that date); (k) made to fund expenses of providing  | 
| joint
recreational programs for persons with disabilities  | 
| under Section 5-8 of
the
Park District Code or Section 11-95-14  | 
| of the Illinois Municipal Code; and (l) made for contributions  | 
| to a firefighter's pension fund created under Article 4 of the  | 
| Illinois Pension Code, to the extent of the amount certified  | 
| under item (5) of Section 4-134 of the Illinois Pension Code.
 | 
|     "Debt service extension base" means an amount equal to that  | 
| portion of the
extension for a taxing district for the 1994  | 
| levy year, or for those taxing
districts subject to this Law in  | 
| accordance with Section 18-213, except for
those subject to  | 
| paragraph (2) of subsection (e) of Section 18-213, for the
levy
 | 
| year in which the referendum making this Law applicable to the  | 
| taxing district
is held, or for those taxing districts subject  | 
| to this Law in accordance with
paragraph (2) of subsection (e)  | 
| of Section 18-213 for the 1996 levy year,
constituting an
 | 
| extension for payment of principal and interest on bonds issued  | 
| by the taxing
district without referendum,  but not including  | 
| excluded non-referendum bonds.  For park districts (i) that were  | 
| first
subject to this Law in 1991 or 1995 and (ii) whose  | 
| extension for the 1994 levy
year for the payment of principal  | 
| and interest on bonds issued by the park
district without  | 
| referendum (but not including excluded non-referendum bonds)
 | 
| was less than 51% of the amount for the 1991 levy year  | 
| constituting an
extension for payment of principal and interest  | 
| on bonds issued by the park
district without referendum (but  | 
|  | 
| not including excluded non-referendum bonds),
"debt service  | 
| extension base" means an amount equal to that portion of the
 | 
| extension for the 1991 levy year constituting an extension for  | 
| payment of
principal and interest on bonds issued by the park  | 
| district without referendum
(but not including excluded  | 
| non-referendum bonds).  A debt service extension base  | 
| established or increased at any time pursuant to any provision  | 
| of this Law, except Section 18-212, shall be increased each  | 
| year commencing with the later of (i) the 2009 levy year or  | 
| (ii) the first levy year in which this Law becomes applicable  | 
| to the taxing district, by the lesser of 5% or the percentage  | 
| increase in the Consumer Price Index during the 12-month  | 
| calendar year preceding the levy year. The debt service  | 
| extension
base may be established or increased as provided  | 
| under Section 18-212.
"Excluded non-referendum bonds" means  | 
| (i) bonds authorized by Public
Act 88-503 and issued under  | 
| Section 20a of the Chicago Park District Act for
aquarium and  | 
| museum projects; (ii) bonds issued under Section 15 of the
 | 
| Local Government Debt Reform Act; or (iii) refunding  | 
| obligations issued
to refund or to continue to refund  | 
| obligations initially issued pursuant to
referendum.
 | 
|     "Special purpose extensions" include, but are not limited  | 
| to, extensions
for levies made on an annual basis for  | 
| unemployment and workers'
compensation, self-insurance,  | 
| contributions to pension plans, and extensions
made pursuant to  | 
| Section 6-601 of the Illinois Highway Code for a road
 | 
|  | 
| district's permanent road fund whether levied annually or not.   | 
| The
extension for a special service area is not included in the
 | 
| aggregate extension.
 | 
|     "Aggregate extension base" means the taxing district's  | 
| last preceding
aggregate extension as adjusted under Sections  | 
| 18-135, 18-215,
and 18-230, and 18-206.
 An adjustment under  | 
| Section 18-135 shall be made for the 2007 levy year and all  | 
| subsequent levy years whenever one or more counties within  | 
| which a taxing district is located (i) used estimated  | 
| valuations or rates when extending taxes in the taxing district  | 
| for the last preceding levy year that resulted in the over or  | 
| under extension of taxes, or (ii) increased or decreased the  | 
| tax extension for the last preceding levy year as required by  | 
| Section 18-135(c). Whenever an adjustment is required under  | 
| Section 18-135, the aggregate extension base of the taxing  | 
| district shall be equal to the amount that the aggregate  | 
| extension of the taxing district would have been for the last  | 
| preceding levy year if either or both (i) actual, rather than  | 
| estimated, valuations or rates had been used to calculate the  | 
| extension of taxes for the last levy year, or (ii) the tax  | 
| extension for the last preceding levy year had not been  | 
| adjusted as required by subsection (c) of Section 18-135.
 | 
|     Notwithstanding any other provision of law, for levy year  | 
| 2012, the aggregate extension base for West Northfield School  | 
| District No. 31 in Cook County shall be $12,654,592.  | 
|     "Levy year" has the same meaning as "year" under Section
 | 
|  | 
| 1-155.
 | 
|     "New property" means (i) the assessed value, after final  | 
| board of review or
board of appeals action, of new improvements  | 
| or additions to existing
improvements on any parcel of real  | 
| property that increase the assessed value of
that real property  | 
| during the levy year multiplied by the equalization factor
 | 
| issued by the Department under Section 17-30, (ii) the assessed  | 
| value, after
final board of review or board of appeals action,  | 
| of real property not exempt
from real estate taxation, which  | 
| real property was exempt from real estate
taxation for any  | 
| portion of the immediately preceding levy year, multiplied by
 | 
| the equalization factor issued by the Department under Section  | 
| 17-30, including the assessed value, upon final stabilization  | 
| of occupancy after new construction is complete, of any real  | 
| property located within the boundaries of an otherwise or  | 
| previously exempt military reservation that is intended for  | 
| residential use and owned by or leased to a private corporation  | 
| or other entity,
(iii) in counties that classify in accordance  | 
| with Section 4 of Article
IX of the
Illinois Constitution, an  | 
| incentive property's additional assessed value
resulting from  | 
| a
scheduled increase in the level of assessment as applied to  | 
| the first year
final board of
review market value, and (iv) any  | 
| increase in assessed value due to oil or gas production from an  | 
| oil or gas well required to be permitted under the Hydraulic  | 
| Fracturing Regulatory Act that was not produced in or accounted  | 
| for during the previous levy year.
In addition, the county  | 
|  | 
| clerk in a county containing a population of
3,000,000 or more  | 
| shall include in the 1997
recovered tax increment value for any  | 
| school district, any recovered tax
increment value that was  | 
| applicable to the 1995 tax year calculations.
 | 
|     "Qualified airport authority" means an airport authority  | 
| organized under
the Airport Authorities Act and located in a  | 
| county bordering on the State of
Wisconsin and having a  | 
| population in excess of 200,000 and not greater than
500,000.
 | 
|     "Recovered tax increment value" means, except as otherwise  | 
| provided in this
paragraph, the amount of the current year's  | 
| equalized assessed value, in the
first year after a  | 
| municipality terminates
the designation of an area as a  | 
| redevelopment project area previously
established under the  | 
| Tax Increment Allocation Development Act in the Illinois
 | 
| Municipal Code, previously established under the Industrial  | 
| Jobs Recovery Law
in the Illinois Municipal Code, previously  | 
| established under the Economic Development Project Area Tax  | 
| Increment Act of 1995, or previously established under the  | 
| Economic
Development Area Tax Increment Allocation Act, of each  | 
| taxable lot, block,
tract, or parcel of real property in the  | 
| redevelopment project area over and
above the initial equalized  | 
| assessed value of each property in the
redevelopment project  | 
| area.
For the taxes which are extended for the 1997 levy year,  | 
| the recovered tax
increment value for a non-home rule taxing  | 
| district that first became subject
to this Law for the 1995  | 
| levy year because a majority of its 1994 equalized
assessed  | 
|  | 
| value was in an affected county or counties shall be increased  | 
| if a
municipality terminated the designation of an area in 1993  | 
| as a redevelopment
project area previously established under  | 
| the Tax Increment Allocation
Development Act in the Illinois  | 
| Municipal Code, previously established under
the Industrial  | 
| Jobs Recovery Law in the Illinois Municipal Code, or previously
 | 
| established under the Economic Development Area Tax Increment  | 
| Allocation Act,
by an amount equal to the 1994 equalized  | 
| assessed value of each taxable lot,
block, tract, or parcel of  | 
| real property in the redevelopment project area over
and above  | 
| the initial equalized assessed value of each property in the
 | 
| redevelopment project area.
In the first year after a  | 
| municipality
removes a taxable lot, block, tract, or parcel of  | 
| real property from a
redevelopment project area established  | 
| under the Tax Increment Allocation
Development Act in the  | 
| Illinois
Municipal Code, the Industrial Jobs Recovery Law
in  | 
| the Illinois Municipal Code, or the Economic
Development Area  | 
| Tax Increment Allocation Act, "recovered tax increment value"
 | 
| means the amount of the current year's equalized assessed value  | 
| of each taxable
lot, block, tract, or parcel of real property  | 
| removed from the redevelopment
project area over and above the  | 
| initial equalized assessed value of that real
property before  | 
| removal from the redevelopment project area.
 | 
|     Except as otherwise provided in this Section, "limiting  | 
| rate" means a
fraction the numerator of which is the last
 | 
| preceding aggregate extension base times an amount equal to one  | 
|  | 
| plus the
extension limitation defined in this Section and the  | 
| denominator of which
is the current year's equalized assessed  | 
| value of all real property in the
territory under the  | 
| jurisdiction of the taxing district during the prior
levy year.   | 
| For those taxing districts that reduced their aggregate
 | 
| extension for the last preceding levy year, except for school  | 
| districts that reduced their extension for educational  | 
| purposes pursuant to Section 18-206, the highest aggregate  | 
| extension
in any of the last 3 preceding levy years shall be  | 
| used for the purpose of
computing the limiting rate.  The  | 
| denominator shall not include new
property or the recovered tax  | 
| increment
value.
If a new rate, a rate decrease, or a limiting  | 
| rate increase has been approved at an election held after March  | 
| 21, 2006, then (i) the otherwise applicable limiting rate shall  | 
| be increased by the amount of the new rate or shall be reduced  | 
| by the amount of the rate decrease, as the case may be, or (ii)  | 
| in the case of a limiting rate increase, the limiting rate  | 
| shall be equal to the rate set forth
in the proposition  | 
| approved by the voters for each of the years specified in the  | 
| proposition, after
which the limiting rate of the taxing  | 
| district shall be calculated as otherwise provided. In the case  | 
| of a taxing district that obtained referendum approval for an  | 
| increased limiting rate on March 20, 2012, the limiting rate  | 
| for tax year 2012 shall be the rate that generates the  | 
| approximate total amount of taxes extendable for that tax year,  | 
| as set forth in the proposition approved by the voters; this  | 
|  | 
| rate shall be the final rate applied by the county clerk for  | 
| the aggregate of all capped funds of the district for tax year  | 
| 2012.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-6, eff. 3-29-13; 98-23, eff. 6-17-13; 99-143,  | 
| eff. 7-27-15; 99-521, eff. 6-1-17.)
 
 | 
|     (35 ILCS 200/18-200)
 | 
|     Sec. 18-200. School Code. A school district's State aid  | 
| shall not be
reduced under the computation under subsections  | 
| 5(a) through 5(h) of Part A of
Section 18-8 of the School Code  | 
| or under Section 18-8.15 of the School Code due to the  | 
| operating tax rate falling from
above the minimum requirement  | 
| of that Section of the School Code to below the
minimum  | 
| requirement of that Section of the School Code due to the  | 
| operation of
this Law.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 87-17; 88-455.)
 | 
|     (35 ILCS 200/18-206 new) | 
|     Sec. 18-206. Decrease in extension for educational  | 
| purposes. | 
|     (a) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, for those  | 
| school districts whose adequacy targets, as defined in Section  | 
| 18-8.15 of this Code, exceed 110% for the school year that  | 
| begins during the calendar year immediately preceding the levy  | 
| year for which the reduction under this Section is sought, the  | 
| question of whether the school district shall reduce its  | 
|  | 
| extension for educational purposes for the levy year in which  | 
| the election is held to an amount that is less than the  | 
| extension for educational purposes for the immediately  | 
| preceding levy year shall be submitted to the voters of the  | 
| school district at the next consolidated election but only upon  | 
| submission of a petition signed by not fewer than 10% of the  | 
| registered voters in the school district. In no event shall the  | 
| reduced extension be more than 10% lower than the amount  | 
| extended for educational purposes in the previous levy year,  | 
| and in no event shall the reduction cause the school district's  | 
| adequacy target to fall below 110% for the levy year for which  | 
| the reduction is sought. | 
|     (b) The petition shall be filed with the applicable  | 
| election authority, as defined in Section 1-3 of the Election  | 
| Code, or, in the case of multiple election authorities, with  | 
| the State Board of Elections, not more than 10 months nor less  | 
| than 6 months prior to the election at which the question is to  | 
| be submitted to the voters, and its validity shall be  | 
| determined as provided by Article 28 of the Election Code and  | 
| general election law. The election authority or Board, as  | 
| applicable, shall certify the question and the proper election  | 
| authority or authorities shall submit the question to the  | 
| voters. Except as otherwise provided in this Section, this  | 
| referendum shall be subject to all other general election law  | 
| requirements. | 
|     (c) The proposition seeking to reduce the extension for  | 
|  | 
| educational purposes shall be in substantially the following  | 
| form: | 
|         Shall the amount extended for educational purposes by  | 
| (school district) be reduced from (previous levy year's  | 
| extension) to (proposed extension) for (levy year), but in  | 
| no event lower than the amount required to maintain an  | 
| adequacy target of 110%? | 
|     Votes shall be recorded as "Yes" or "No". | 
|     If a majority of all votes cast on the proposition are in  | 
| favor of the proposition, then, for the levy year in which the  | 
| election is held, the amount extended by the school district  | 
| for educational purposes shall be reduced as provided in the  | 
| referendum; however, in no event shall the reduction exceed the  | 
| amount that would cause the school district to have an adequacy  | 
| target of 110% for the applicable school year. | 
|     Once the question is submitted to the voters, then the  | 
| question may not be submitted again for the same school  | 
| district at any of the next 2 consolidated elections. | 
|     (d) For school districts that approve a reduction under  | 
| this Section, the county clerk shall extend a rate for  | 
| educational purposes that is no greater than the limiting rate  | 
| for educational purposes. If the school district is otherwise  | 
| subject to this Law for the applicable levy year, then, for the  | 
| levy year in which the reduction occurs,  the county clerk shall  | 
| calculate separate limiting rates for educational purposes and  | 
| for the aggregate of the school district's other funds. | 
|  | 
|     As used in this Section: | 
|     "School district" means each school district in the State,  | 
| regardless of whether or not that school district is otherwise  | 
| subject to this Law. | 
|     "Limiting rate for educational purposes" means a fraction  | 
| the numerator of which is the greater of  (i) the amount  | 
| approved by the voters in the referendum under subsection (c)  | 
| of this Section or (ii) the amount that would cause the school  | 
| district to have an adequacy target of 110% for the applicable  | 
| school year, but in no event more than the school district's  | 
| extension for educational purposes in the immediately  | 
| preceding levy year, and  the denominator of which is the  | 
| current year's equalized assessed value of all real property  | 
| under the jurisdiction of the school district during the prior  | 
| levy year. 
 
 | 
|     (35 ILCS 200/18-249)
 | 
|     Sec. 18-249. Miscellaneous provisions. 
 | 
|     (a) Certification of new property.  For the 1994 levy year,  | 
| the chief county
assessment officer shall certify to the county  | 
| clerk, after all changes by the
board of review or board of  | 
| appeals, as the case may be, the assessed value of
new property  | 
| by taxing district for the 1994 levy year under rules  | 
| promulgated
by the Department.
 | 
|     (b) School Code.  A school district's State aid shall not be  | 
| reduced under
the computation under subsections 5(a) through  | 
|  | 
| 5(h) of Part A of Section 18-8
of the School Code or under  | 
| Section 18-8.15 of the School Code due to the
operating tax  | 
| rate falling from above the minimum requirement of that Section
 | 
| of the School Code to below the minimum requirement of that  | 
| Section of the
School Code due to the operation of this Law.
 | 
|     (c) Rules.  The Department shall make and promulgate  | 
| reasonable rules
relating to the administration of the purposes  | 
| and provisions of Sections
18-246 through 18-249 as may be  | 
| necessary or appropriate.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 89-1, eff. 2-12-95.)
 | 
|     Section 930. The Illinois Pension Code is amended  by  | 
| changing Section 17-127 as follows:
 
 | 
|     (40 ILCS 5/17-127)  (from Ch. 108 1/2, par. 17-127)
 | 
|     Sec. 17-127. Financing; revenues for the Fund. 
 | 
|     (a) The revenues for the Fund shall consist of: (1) amounts  | 
| paid into
the Fund by contributors thereto and from employer  | 
| contributions and State
appropriations in accordance with this  | 
| Article; (2) amounts contributed to the
Fund by an Employer;  | 
| (3) amounts contributed to the Fund pursuant to any law
now in  | 
| force or hereafter to be enacted; (4) contributions from any  | 
| other
source; and (5) the earnings on investments.
 | 
|     (b) The General Assembly finds that for many years the  | 
| State has
contributed to the Fund an annual amount that is  | 
| between 20% and 30% of the
amount of the annual State  | 
|  | 
| contribution to the Article 16 retirement system,
and the  | 
| General Assembly declares that it is its goal and intention to  | 
| continue
this level of contribution to the Fund in the future.
 | 
|     (c) Beginning in State fiscal year 1999, the State shall  | 
| include in its annual
contribution to the Fund an additional  | 
| amount equal to 0.544% of the Fund's
total teacher payroll;  | 
| except that this additional contribution need not be
made in a  | 
| fiscal year if the Board has certified in the previous fiscal  | 
| year
that the Fund is at least 90% funded, based on actuarial  | 
| determinations.  These
additional State contributions are  | 
| intended to offset a portion of the cost to
the Fund of the  | 
| increases in retirement benefits resulting from this  | 
| amendatory
Act of 1998.
 | 
|     (d) In addition to any other contribution required under  | 
| this Article, including the contribution required under  | 
| subsection (c), the State shall contribute to the Fund the  | 
| following amounts: | 
|         (1) For State fiscal year 2018, the State shall  | 
| contribute $221,300,000 for the employer normal cost for  | 
| fiscal year 2018 and the amount allowed under paragraph (3)  | 
| of Section 17-142.1 of this Code to defray health insurance  | 
| costs. Funds for this paragraph (1) shall come from funds  | 
| appropriated for Evidence-Based Funding pursuant to  | 
| Section 18-8.15 of the School Code.  | 
|         (2) Beginning in State fiscal year 2019, the State
 | 
| shall contribute for each fiscal year an amount to be
 | 
|  | 
| determined by the Fund, equal to the employer normal cost
 | 
| for that fiscal year, plus the amount allowed pursuant to  | 
| paragraph (3) of Section 17-142.1 to defray health  | 
| insurance costs. | 
|     (e) The Board shall determine the amount of State  | 
| contributions required for each fiscal year on the basis of the  | 
| actuarial tables and other assumptions adopted by the Board and  | 
| the recommendations of the actuary. On or before November 1 of  | 
| each year, beginning November 1, 2017, the Board shall submit  | 
| to the State Actuary, the Governor, and the General Assembly a  | 
| proposed certification of the amount of the required State  | 
| contribution to the Fund for the next fiscal year, along with  | 
| all of the actuarial assumptions, calculations, and data upon  | 
| which that proposed certification is based. | 
|     On or before January 1 of each year, beginning January 1,
 | 
| 2018, the State Actuary shall issue a preliminary report
 | 
| concerning the proposed certification and identifying, if
 | 
| necessary, recommended changes in actuarial assumptions that
 | 
| the Board must consider before finalizing its certification of
 | 
| the required State contributions. | 
|     (f) On or before January 15, 2018 and each January 15  | 
| thereafter, the Board shall certify to the Governor and the
 | 
| General Assembly the amount of the required State contribution
 | 
| for the next fiscal year. The certification shall include a
 | 
| copy of the actuarial recommendations upon which it is based
 | 
| and shall specifically identify the Fund's projected employer
 | 
|  | 
| normal cost for that fiscal year. The Board's certification
 | 
| must note any deviations from the State Actuary's recommended
 | 
| changes, the reason or reasons for not following the State
 | 
| Actuary's recommended changes, and the fiscal impact of not
 | 
| following the State Actuary's recommended changes on the
 | 
| required State contribution. | 
|     For the purposes of this Article, including issuing  | 
| vouchers, and for the purposes of subsection (h) of Section 1.1  | 
| of the State Pension Funds Continuing Appropriation Act, the  | 
| State contribution specified for State fiscal year 2018 shall  | 
| be deemed to have been certified, by operation of law  and  | 
| without official action by the Board or the State Actuary, in  | 
| the amount provided in subsection (c) and subsection (d) of  | 
| this Section. | 
|     (g) For State fiscal year 2018, the State Board of  | 
| Education shall submit vouchers, as directed by the Board, for  | 
| payment of State contributions to the Fund for the required  | 
| annual State contribution under subsection (d) of this Section.  | 
| These vouchers shall be paid by the State Comptroller and  | 
| Treasurer by warrants drawn on the amount appropriated to the  | 
| State Board of Education from the Common School Fund in Section  | 
| 5 of Article 97 of Public Act 100-21. If State appropriations  | 
| for State fiscal year 2018 are less than the amount lawfully  | 
| vouchered under this subsection, the difference shall be paid  | 
| from the Common School Fund under the continuing appropriation  | 
| authority provided in Section 1.1 of the State Pension Funds  | 
|  | 
| Continuing Appropriation Act. | 
|     (h) For State fiscal year 2018, the Board shall submit  | 
| vouchers for the payment of State contributions to the Fund for  | 
| the required annual State contribution under subsection (c) of  | 
| this Section. Beginning in State fiscal year 2019, the Board  | 
| shall submit vouchers for payment of State contributions to the  | 
| Fund for the required annual State contribution under  | 
| subsections (c) and (d) of this Section. These vouchers shall  | 
| be paid by the State Comptroller and Treasurer by warrants  | 
| drawn on the funds appropriated to the Fund for that fiscal  | 
| year. If State appropriations to the Fund for the applicable  | 
| fiscal year are less than the amount lawfully vouchered under  | 
| this subsection, the difference shall be paid from the Common  | 
| School Fund under the continuing appropriation authority  | 
| provided in Section 1.1 of the State Pension Funds Continuing  | 
| Appropriation Act.  | 
| (Source: P.A. 90-548, eff. 12-4-97; 90-566, eff. 1-2-98;  | 
| 90-582, eff.
5-27-98; 90-655, eff. 7-30-98.)
 | 
|     Section 935. The State Pension Funds Continuing  | 
| Appropriation Act is amended by changing Section 1.1 as  | 
| follows:
 
 | 
|     (40 ILCS 15/1.1)
 | 
|     Sec. 1.1. Appropriations to certain retirement systems. 
 | 
|     (a) There is hereby appropriated from the General Revenue  | 
|  | 
| Fund to the
General Assembly Retirement System, on a continuing  | 
| monthly basis, the amount,
if any, by which the total available  | 
| amount of all other appropriations to that
retirement system  | 
| for the payment of State contributions is less than the total
 | 
| amount of the vouchers for required State contributions  | 
| lawfully submitted by
the retirement system for that month  | 
| under Section 2-134 of the Illinois
Pension Code.
 | 
|     (b) There is hereby appropriated from the General Revenue  | 
| Fund to the
State Universities Retirement System, on a  | 
| continuing monthly basis, the
amount, if any, by which the  | 
| total available amount of all other appropriations
to that  | 
| retirement system for the payment of State contributions,  | 
| including
any deficiency in the required contributions of the  | 
| optional
retirement program established under Section 15-158.2  | 
| of the Illinois Pension
Code,
is less than
the total amount of  | 
| the vouchers for required State contributions lawfully
 | 
| submitted by the retirement system for that month under Section  | 
| 15-165 of the
Illinois Pension Code.
 | 
|     (c) There is hereby appropriated from the Common School  | 
| Fund to the
Teachers' Retirement System of the State of  | 
| Illinois,
on a continuing monthly basis, the amount, if any, by  | 
| which the total
available amount of all other appropriations to  | 
| that retirement system for the
payment of State contributions  | 
| is less than the total amount of the vouchers
for required  | 
| State contributions lawfully submitted by the retirement  | 
| system
for that month under Section 16-158 of the Illinois  | 
|  | 
| Pension Code.
 | 
|     (d) There is hereby appropriated from the General Revenue  | 
| Fund to the Judges
Retirement System of Illinois, on a  | 
| continuing monthly basis, the amount, if
any, by which the  | 
| total available amount of all other appropriations to that
 | 
| retirement system for the payment of State contributions is  | 
| less than the total
amount of the vouchers for required State  | 
| contributions lawfully submitted by
the retirement system for  | 
| that month under Section 18-140 of the Illinois
Pension Code.
 | 
|     (e) The continuing appropriations provided by subsections  | 
| (a), (b), (c), and (d) of this Section shall first
be available  | 
| in State fiscal year 1996. The continuing appropriations  | 
| provided by subsection (h) of this Section shall first
be  | 
| available as provided in that subsection (h). 
 | 
|     (f) For State fiscal year 2010 only, the continuing  | 
| appropriations provided by this Section are equal to the amount  | 
| certified by each System on or before December 31, 2008, less  | 
| (i) the gross proceeds of the bonds sold in fiscal year 2010  | 
| under the authorization contained in subsection (a) of Section  | 
| 7.2 of the General Obligation Bond Act and (ii) any amounts  | 
| received from the State Pensions Fund.  | 
|     (g) For State fiscal year 2011 only, the continuing  | 
| appropriations provided by this Section are equal to the amount
 | 
| certified by each System on or before April 1, 2011, less
(i)  | 
| the gross proceeds of the bonds sold in fiscal year 2011
under  | 
| the authorization contained in subsection (a) of Section
7.2 of  | 
|  | 
| the General Obligation Bond Act and (ii) any amounts
received  | 
| from the State Pensions Fund.  | 
|     (h) There is hereby appropriated from the Common School  | 
| Fund to the
Public School Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund  | 
| of Chicago,
on a continuing basis, the amount, if any, by which  | 
| the total
available amount of all other State appropriations to  | 
| that Retirement Fund for the
payment of State contributions  | 
| under Section 17-127 of the Illinois Pension Code is less than  | 
| the total amount of the vouchers
for required State  | 
| contributions lawfully submitted by the Retirement Fund or the  | 
| State Board of Education, under that Section 17-127.  | 
| (Source: P.A. 96-43, eff. 7-15-09; 96-1497, eff. 1-14-11;  | 
| 96-1511, eff. 1-27-11.)
 | 
|     Section 940. The Innovation Development and Economy Act is  | 
| amended  by changing Section 33 as follows:
 | 
|     (50 ILCS 470/33)
 | 
|     Sec. 33. STAR Bonds School Improvement and Operations Trust  | 
| Fund.  | 
|     (a) The STAR Bonds School Improvement and Operations Trust  | 
| Fund is created as a trust fund in the State treasury. Deposits  | 
| into the Trust Fund shall be made as provided under this  | 
| Section. Moneys in the Trust Fund shall be used by the  | 
| Department of Revenue only for the purpose of making payments  | 
| to school districts in educational service regions that include  | 
|  | 
| or are adjacent to the STAR bond district. Moneys in the Trust  | 
| Fund are not subject to appropriation and shall be used solely  | 
| as provided in this Section. All deposits into the Trust Fund  | 
| shall be held in the Trust Fund by the State Treasurer as ex  | 
| officio custodian separate and apart from all public moneys or  | 
| funds of this State and shall be administered by the Department  | 
| exclusively for the purposes set forth in this Section.  All  | 
| moneys in the Trust Fund shall be invested and reinvested by  | 
| the State Treasurer.  All interest accruing from these  | 
| investments shall be deposited in the Trust Fund.  | 
|     (b) Upon approval of a STAR bond district, the political  | 
| subdivision shall immediately transmit to the county clerk of  | 
| the county in which the district is located a certified copy of  | 
| the ordinance creating the district, a legal description of the  | 
| district, a map of the district, identification of the year  | 
| that the county clerk shall use for determining the total  | 
| initial equalized assessed value of the district consistent  | 
| with subsection (c), and a list of the parcel or tax  | 
| identification number of each parcel of property included in  | 
| the district. | 
|     (c) Upon approval of a STAR bond district, the county clerk  | 
| immediately thereafter shall determine (i) the most recently  | 
| ascertained equalized assessed value of each lot, block, tract,  | 
| or parcel of real property within the STAR bond district, from  | 
| which shall be deducted the homestead exemptions under Article  | 
| 15 of the Property Tax Code, which value shall be the initial  | 
|  | 
| equalized assessed value of each such piece of property, and  | 
| (ii) the total equalized assessed value of all taxable real  | 
| property within the district by adding together the most  | 
| recently ascertained equalized assessed value of each taxable  | 
| lot, block, tract, or parcel of real property within the  | 
| district, from which shall be deducted the homestead exemptions  | 
| under Article 15 of the Property Tax Code, and shall certify  | 
| that amount as the total initial equalized assessed value of  | 
| the taxable real property within the STAR bond district.  | 
|     (d) In reference to any STAR bond district created within  | 
| any political subdivision, and in respect to which the county  | 
| clerk has certified the total initial equalized assessed value  | 
| of the property in the area, the political subdivision may  | 
| thereafter request the clerk in writing to adjust the initial  | 
| equalized value of all taxable real property within the STAR  | 
| bond district by deducting therefrom the exemptions under  | 
| Article 15 of the Property Tax Code applicable to each lot,  | 
| block, tract, or parcel of real property within the STAR bond  | 
| district. The county clerk shall immediately, after the written  | 
| request to adjust the total initial equalized value is  | 
| received, determine the total homestead exemptions in the STAR  | 
| bond district as provided under Article 15 of the Property Tax  | 
| Code by adding together the homestead exemptions provided by  | 
| said Article on each lot, block, tract, or parcel of real  | 
| property within the STAR bond district and then shall deduct  | 
| the total of said exemptions from the total initial equalized  | 
|  | 
| assessed value. The county clerk shall then promptly certify  | 
| that amount as the total initial equalized assessed value as  | 
| adjusted of the taxable real property within the STAR bond  | 
| district. | 
|     (e) The county clerk or other person authorized by law  | 
| shall compute the tax rates for each taxing district with all  | 
| or a portion of its equalized assessed value located in the  | 
| STAR bond district. The rate per cent of tax determined shall  | 
| be extended to the current equalized assessed value of all  | 
| property in the district in the same manner as the rate per  | 
| cent of tax is extended to all other taxable property in the  | 
| taxing district. | 
|     (f) Beginning with the assessment year in which the first  | 
| destination user in the first STAR bond project in a STAR bond  | 
| district makes its first retail sales and for each assessment  | 
| year thereafter until final maturity of the last STAR bonds  | 
| issued in the district, the county clerk or other person  | 
| authorized by law shall determine the increase in equalized  | 
| assessed value of all real property within the STAR bond  | 
| district by subtracting the initial equalized assessed value of  | 
| all property in the district certified under subsection (c)  | 
| from the current equalized assessed value of all property in  | 
| the district. Each year, the property taxes arising from the  | 
| increase in equalized assessed value in the STAR bond district  | 
| shall be determined for each taxing district and shall be  | 
| certified to the county collector. | 
|  | 
|     (g) Beginning with the year in which taxes are collected  | 
| based on the assessment year in which the first destination  | 
| user in the first STAR bond project in a STAR bond district  | 
| makes its first retail sales and for each year thereafter until  | 
| final maturity of the last STAR bonds issued in the district,  | 
| the county collector shall, within 30 days after receipt of  | 
| property taxes, transmit to the Department to be deposited into  | 
| the STAR Bonds School Improvement and Operations Trust Fund 15%  | 
| of property taxes attributable to the increase in equalized  | 
| assessed value within the STAR bond district from each taxing  | 
| district as certified in subsection (f). | 
|     (h) The Department shall pay to the regional superintendent  | 
| of schools whose educational service region includes Franklin  | 
| and Williamson Counties, for each year for which money is  | 
| remitted to the Department and paid into the STAR Bonds School  | 
| Improvement and Operations Trust Fund, the money in the Fund as  | 
| provided in this Section.  The amount paid to each school  | 
| district shall be allocated
proportionately, based on each  | 
| qualifying school district's
fall enrollment for the  | 
| then-current school year, such that the school
district with  | 
| the largest fall enrollment receives the largest
proportionate  | 
| share of money paid out of the Fund or by any other method or  | 
| formula that the regional superintendent of schools deems fit,  | 
| equitable, and in the public interest. The regional  | 
| superintendent may allocate moneys to school districts that are  | 
| outside of his or her educational service region or to other  | 
|  | 
| regional superintendents. | 
|     The Department shall determine the distributions under  | 
| this Section using its best judgment and information.  The  | 
| Department shall be held harmless for the distributions made  | 
| under this Section and all distributions shall be final. | 
|     (i) In any year that an assessment appeal is filed, the  | 
| extension of taxes on any assessment so appealed shall not be  | 
| delayed. In the case of an assessment that is altered, any  | 
| taxes extended upon the unauthorized assessment or part thereof  | 
| shall be abated, or, if already paid, shall be refunded with  | 
| interest as provided in Section 23-20 of the Property Tax Code.   | 
| In the case of an assessment appeal, the county collector shall  | 
| notify the Department that an assessment appeal has been filed  | 
| and the amount of the tax that would have been deposited in the  | 
| STAR Bonds School Improvement and Operations Trust Fund. The  | 
| county collector shall hold that amount in a separate fund  | 
| until the appeal process is final. After the appeal process is  | 
| finalized, the county collector shall transmit to the  | 
| Department the amount of tax that remains, if any, after all  | 
| required refunds are made.  The Department shall pay any amount  | 
| deposited into the Trust Fund under this Section in the same  | 
| proportion as determined for payments for that taxable year  | 
| under subsection (h). | 
|     (j) In any year that ad valorem taxes are allocated to the  | 
| STAR Bonds School Improvement and Operations Trust Fund, that  | 
| allocation shall not reduce or otherwise impact the school aid  | 
|  | 
| provided to any school district under the general State school  | 
| aid formula provided for in Section 18-8.05 of the School Code  | 
| or the evidence-based funding formula provided for in Section  | 
| 18-8.15 of the School Code.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 96-939, eff. 6-24-10.)
 | 
|     Section 945. The County Economic Development Project Area  | 
| Property
Tax Allocation Act is amended  by changing Section 7 as  | 
| follows:
 
 | 
|     (55 ILCS 85/7)  (from Ch. 34, par. 7007)
 | 
|     Sec. 7. Creation of special tax allocation fund. If a  | 
| county has
adopted property tax allocation financing by  | 
| ordinance for an economic
development project area, the  | 
| Department has approved and certified the
economic development  | 
| project area, and the county clerk has thereafter
certified the  | 
| "total initial equalized value" of the taxable real property
 | 
| within such economic development project area in the manner  | 
| provided in
subsection (b) of Section 6 of this Act, each year  | 
| after the date of the
certification by the county clerk of the  | 
| "initial equalized assessed value"
until economic development  | 
| project costs and all county obligations
financing economic  | 
| development project costs have been paid, the ad valorem
taxes,  | 
| if any, arising from the levies upon the taxable real property  | 
| in
the economic development project area by taxing districts  | 
| and tax rates
determined in the manner provided in subsection  | 
|  | 
| (b) of Section 6 of this Act
shall be divided as follows:
 | 
|         (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable  | 
| lot, block, tract
or parcel of real property which is  | 
| attributable to the lower of the current
equalized assessed  | 
| value or the initial equalized assessed value of each
such  | 
| taxable lot, block, tract, or parcel of real property  | 
| existing at the
time property tax allocation financing was  | 
| adopted shall be allocated and
when collected shall be paid  | 
| by the county collector to the respective
affected taxing  | 
| districts in the manner required by the law in the absence
 | 
| of the adoption of property tax allocation financing.
 | 
|         (2) That portion, if any, of those taxes which is  | 
| attributable to the
increase in the current equalized  | 
| assessed valuation of each taxable lot,
block, tract, or  | 
| parcel of real property in the economic development
project  | 
| are, over and above the initial equalized assessed value of  | 
| each
property existing at the time property tax allocation  | 
| financing was
adopted shall be allocated to and when  | 
| collected shall be paid to the
county treasurer, who shall  | 
| deposit those taxes into a special fund called
the special  | 
| tax allocation fund of the county for the purpose of paying
 | 
| economic development project costs and obligations  | 
| incurred in the payment
thereof.
 | 
|     The county, by an ordinance adopting property tax  | 
| allocation financing,
may pledge the funds in and to be  | 
| deposited in the special tax allocation
fund for the payment of  | 
|  | 
| obligations issued under this Act and for the
payment of  | 
| economic development project costs.  No part of the current
 | 
| equalized assessed valuation of each property in the economic  | 
| development
project area attributable to any increase above the  | 
| total initial equalized
assessed value of such properties shall  | 
| be used in calculating the general
State school aid formula,  | 
| provided for in Section 18-8 of the School Code, or the  | 
| evidence-based funding formula, provided for in Section  | 
| 18-8.15 of the School Code,
until such time as all economic  | 
| development projects costs have been paid
as provided for in  | 
| this Section.
 | 
|     Whenever a county issues bonds for the purpose of financing  | 
| economic
development project costs, the county may provide by  | 
| ordinance for the
appointment of a trustee, which may be any  | 
| trust company within the State,
and for the establishment of  | 
| the funds or accounts to be maintained by such
trustee as the  | 
| county shall deem necessary to provide for the security and
 | 
| payment of the bonds.  If the county provides for the  | 
| appointment of a
trustee, the trustee shall be considered the  | 
| assignee of any payments
assigned by the county pursuant to the  | 
| ordinance and this Section.  Any
amounts paid to the trustee as  | 
| assignee shall be deposited in the funds or
accounts  | 
| established pursuant to the trust agreement, and shall be held  | 
| by
the trustee in trust for the benefit of the holders of the  | 
| bonds, and the
holders shall have a lien on and a security  | 
| interest in those bonds or
accounts so long as the bonds remain  | 
|  | 
| outstanding and unpaid.  Upon
retirement of the bonds, the  | 
| trustee shall pay over any excess amounts held
to the county  | 
| for deposit in the special tax allocation fund.
 | 
|     When the economic development project costs, including  | 
| without limitation
all county obligations financing economic  | 
| development project costs
incurred under this Act, have been  | 
| paid, all surplus funds then remaining
in the special tax  | 
| allocation funds shall be distributed by being paid by
the  | 
| county treasurer to the county collector, who shall immediately
 | 
| thereafter pay those funds to the taxing districts having  | 
| taxable property
in the economic development project area in  | 
| the same manner and proportion
as the most recent distribution  | 
| by the county collector to those taxing
districts of real  | 
| property taxes from real property in the economic
development  | 
| project area.
 | 
|     Upon the payment of all economic development project costs,  | 
| retirement of
obligations and the distribution of any excess  | 
| monies pursuant to this
Section and not later than 23 years  | 
| from the date of adoption of the
ordinance adopting property  | 
| tax allocation financing, the county shall
adopt an ordinance  | 
| dissolving the special tax allocation fund for the
economic  | 
| development project area and terminating the designation of the
 | 
| economic development project area as an economic development  | 
| project area; however, in relation to one or more contiguous  | 
| parcels not exceeding a total area of 120 acres within which an  | 
| electric generating facility is intended to be constructed, and  | 
|  | 
| with respect to which the owner of that proposed electric  | 
| generating facility has entered into a redevelopment agreement  | 
| with Grundy County on or before July 25, 2017, the ordinance of  | 
| the county required in this paragraph shall not dissolve the  | 
| special tax allocation fund for the existing economic  | 
| development project area and shall only terminate the  | 
| designation of the economic development project area as to  | 
| those portions of the economic development project area  | 
| excluding the area covered by the redevelopment agreement  | 
| between the owner of the proposed electric generating facility  | 
| and Grundy County; the county shall adopt an ordinance  | 
| dissolving the special tax allocation fund for the economic  | 
| development project area and terminating the designation of the  | 
| economic development project area as an economic development  | 
| project area with regard to the electric generating facility   | 
| property not later than 35 years from the date of adoption of  | 
| the ordinance adopting property tax allocation financing.
 | 
| Thereafter the rates of the taxing districts shall be extended  | 
| and taxes
levied, collected and distributed in the manner  | 
| applicable in the absence
of the adoption of property tax  | 
| allocation financing.
 | 
|     Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving  | 
| property in
economic development project areas from being  | 
| assessed as provided in the
Property Tax Code or as relieving  | 
| owners of that
property from paying a uniform rate of taxes, as  | 
| required by Section 4 of
Article IX of the Illinois  | 
|  | 
| Constitution of 1970.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13; 99-513, eff. 6-30-16.)
 | 
|     Section 950. The County Economic Development Project Area  | 
| Tax Increment
Allocation Act of 1991 is amended  by changing  | 
| Section 50 as follows:
 
 | 
|     (55 ILCS 90/50)  (from Ch. 34, par. 8050)
 | 
|     Sec. 50. Special tax allocation fund. 
 | 
|     (a) If a county clerk has certified the "total initial  | 
| equalized
assessed value" of the taxable real property within  | 
| an economic development
project area in the manner provided in  | 
| Section 45, each year
after the date of the certification by  | 
| the county clerk of the "total
initial equalized assessed  | 
| value", until economic development project costs
and all county  | 
| obligations financing economic development
project costs have  | 
| been paid, the ad valorem taxes, if any, arising from
the  | 
| levies upon the taxable real property in the economic  | 
| development
project area by taxing districts and tax rates  | 
| determined in the manner
provided in subsection (b) of Section  | 
| 45 shall be divided as follows:
 | 
|         (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable  | 
| lot, block,
tract, or parcel of real property that is  | 
| attributable to the lower of the
current equalized assessed  | 
| value or the initial equalized assessed value of
each  | 
| taxable lot, block, tract, or parcel of real property  | 
|  | 
| existing at
the time tax increment financing was adopted  | 
| shall be allocated to (and
when collected shall be paid by  | 
| the county collector to) the respective
affected taxing  | 
| districts in the manner required by law in the absence of
 | 
| the adoption of tax increment allocation financing.
 | 
|         (2) That portion, if any, of the taxes that is  | 
| attributable to the
increase in the current equalized  | 
| assessed valuation of each taxable lot,
block, tract, or  | 
| parcel of real property in the economic development
project  | 
| area, over and above the initial equalized assessed value  | 
| of each
property existing at the time tax increment  | 
| financing was adopted, shall be
allocated to (and when  | 
| collected shall be paid to) the county treasurer,
who shall  | 
| deposit the taxes into a special fund (called the special  | 
| tax
allocation fund of the county) for the purpose of  | 
| paying economic development
project costs and obligations  | 
| incurred in the payment of those costs.
 | 
|     (b) The county, by an ordinance adopting tax increment
 | 
| allocation financing, may pledge the monies in and to be  | 
| deposited into the
special tax allocation fund for the payment  | 
| of obligations issued under
this Act and for the payment of  | 
| economic development project costs.  No
part of the current  | 
| equalized assessed valuation of each property in the
economic  | 
| development project area attributable to any increase above the
 | 
| total initial equalized assessed value of those properties  | 
| shall be used in
calculating the general State school aid  | 
|  | 
| formula under Section
18-8 of the School Code or the  | 
| evidence-based funding formula under Section 18-8.15 of the  | 
| School Code until all economic development
projects costs have  | 
| been paid as provided for in this Section.
 | 
|     (c) When the economic development projects costs,  | 
| including without
limitation all county obligations financing  | 
| economic
development project costs incurred under this Act,  | 
| have been paid, all
surplus monies then remaining in the  | 
| special tax allocation fund shall be
distributed by being paid  | 
| by the county treasurer to the
county collector, who shall  | 
| immediately pay the monies to the
taxing districts having  | 
| taxable property in the economic development
project area in  | 
| the same manner and proportion as the most recent
distribution  | 
| by the county collector to those taxing districts of real
 | 
| property taxes from real property in the economic development  | 
| project area.
 | 
|     (d) Upon the payment of all economic development project  | 
| costs,
retirement of obligations, and distribution of any  | 
| excess monies
under this Section, the county shall adopt an  | 
| ordinance dissolving the
special tax allocation fund for the  | 
| economic development project area and
terminating the  | 
| designation of the economic development project area as an
 | 
| economic development project area.  Thereafter, the rates of the  | 
| taxing
districts shall be extended and taxes shall be levied,  | 
| collected, and
distributed in the manner applicable in the  | 
| absence of the adoption of tax
increment allocation financing.
 | 
|  | 
|     (e) Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving  | 
| property in
the economic development project areas from being  | 
| assessed as provided in
the Property Tax Code or as relieving  | 
| owners of
that property from paying a uniform rate of taxes as  | 
| required by Section 4 of
Article IX of the Illinois  | 
| Constitution.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13.)
 | 
|     Section 955. The Illinois Municipal Code is amended  by  | 
| changing Sections 11-74.4-3, 11-74.4-8, and 11-74.6-35 as  | 
| follows:
 
 | 
|     (65 ILCS 5/11-74.4-3)  (from Ch. 24, par. 11-74.4-3)
 | 
|     Sec. 11-74.4-3. Definitions. The following terms, wherever  | 
| used or
referred to in this Division 74.4 shall have the  | 
| following respective meanings,
unless in any case a different  | 
| meaning clearly appears from the context.
 | 
|     (a) For any redevelopment project area that has been  | 
| designated pursuant
to this
Section by an ordinance adopted  | 
| prior to November 1, 1999 (the effective
date of Public Act
 | 
| 91-478), "blighted area" shall have the meaning set
forth in  | 
| this Section
prior to that date.
 | 
|     On and after November 1, 1999,
"blighted area" means any  | 
| improved or vacant area within the boundaries
of a  | 
| redevelopment project area located within the territorial  | 
| limits of
the municipality where:
 | 
|  | 
|         (1) If improved, industrial, commercial, and  | 
| residential buildings or
improvements are detrimental to  | 
| the public safety, health, or welfare
because of a  | 
| combination of 5 or more of the following factors, each of  | 
| which
is (i) present, with that presence documented, to a  | 
| meaningful extent so
that a municipality may reasonably  | 
| find that the factor is clearly
present within the intent  | 
| of the Act and (ii) reasonably distributed throughout
the  | 
| improved part of the redevelopment project area:
 | 
|             (A) Dilapidation.  An advanced state of disrepair  | 
| or neglect of
necessary
repairs to the primary  | 
| structural components of buildings or improvements in
 | 
| such a combination that a documented building  | 
| condition analysis determines
that major repair is  | 
| required or the defects are so serious and so extensive
 | 
| that the buildings must be removed.
 | 
|             (B) Obsolescence.  The condition or process of  | 
| falling into disuse.
Structures have become ill-suited  | 
| for the original use.
 | 
|             (C) Deterioration.  With respect to buildings,  | 
| defects
including, but not limited to, major defects in
 | 
| the secondary building components such as doors,  | 
| windows, porches, gutters and
downspouts, and fascia.   | 
| With respect to surface improvements, that the
 | 
| condition of roadways, alleys, curbs, gutters,  | 
| sidewalks, off-street parking,
and surface storage  | 
|  | 
| areas evidence deterioration, including, but not  | 
| limited
to, surface cracking, crumbling, potholes,  | 
| depressions, loose paving material,
and weeds  | 
| protruding through paved surfaces.
 | 
|             (D) Presence of structures below minimum code  | 
| standards.  All structures
that do not meet the  | 
| standards of zoning, subdivision, building, fire, and
 | 
| other governmental codes applicable to property, but  | 
| not including housing and
property maintenance codes.
 | 
|             (E) Illegal use of individual structures.  The use  | 
| of structures in
violation of applicable federal,  | 
| State, or local laws, exclusive of those
applicable to  | 
| the presence of structures below minimum code  | 
| standards.
 | 
|             (F) Excessive vacancies.  The presence of
buildings  | 
| that are unoccupied or under-utilized and that  | 
| represent an adverse
influence on the area because of  | 
| the frequency, extent, or duration of the
vacancies.
 | 
|             (G) Lack of ventilation, light, or sanitary  | 
| facilities.  The absence of
adequate ventilation for  | 
| light or air circulation in spaces or rooms without
 | 
| windows, or that require the removal of dust, odor,  | 
| gas, smoke, or other
noxious airborne materials.   | 
| Inadequate natural light and ventilation means
the  | 
| absence of skylights or windows for interior spaces or  | 
| rooms and improper
window sizes and amounts by room  | 
|  | 
| area to window area ratios.  Inadequate
sanitary  | 
| facilities refers to the absence or inadequacy of  | 
| garbage storage and
enclosure,
bathroom facilities,  | 
| hot water and kitchens, and structural inadequacies
 | 
| preventing ingress and egress to and from all rooms and  | 
| units within a
building.
 | 
|             (H) Inadequate utilities.  Underground and overhead  | 
| utilities
such as storm sewers and storm drainage,  | 
| sanitary sewers, water lines, and
gas, telephone, and
 | 
| electrical services that are shown to be inadequate.   | 
| Inadequate utilities are
those that are: (i) of  | 
| insufficient capacity to serve the uses in the
 | 
| redevelopment project area, (ii) deteriorated,
 | 
| antiquated, obsolete, or in disrepair, or (iii)  | 
| lacking within the
redevelopment project area.
 | 
|             (I) Excessive land coverage and overcrowding of  | 
| structures and community
facilities.  The  | 
| over-intensive use of property and the crowding of  | 
| buildings
and accessory facilities onto a site.   | 
| Examples of problem conditions
warranting the  | 
| designation of an area as one exhibiting excessive land  | 
| coverage
are: (i) the presence of buildings either  | 
| improperly situated on parcels or
located
on parcels of  | 
| inadequate size and shape in relation to present-day  | 
| standards of
development for health and safety and (ii)  | 
| the presence of multiple buildings
on a
single parcel.   | 
|  | 
| For there to be a finding of excessive land coverage,
 | 
| these parcels must exhibit one or more of the following  | 
| conditions:
insufficient provision for
light and air  | 
| within or around buildings, increased threat of spread  | 
| of fire
due to the close proximity of buildings, lack  | 
| of adequate or proper access to a
public right-of-way,  | 
| lack of reasonably required off-street parking, or
 | 
| inadequate provision for loading and service.
 | 
|             (J) Deleterious land use or layout.  The existence  | 
| of incompatible
land-use
relationships, buildings  | 
| occupied by inappropriate mixed-uses, or uses
 | 
| considered to be noxious, offensive, or unsuitable for  | 
| the
surrounding area.
 | 
|             (K) Environmental clean-up.  The proposed  | 
| redevelopment project area
has incurred Illinois  | 
| Environmental Protection Agency or United States
 | 
| Environmental Protection Agency remediation costs for,  | 
| or a study conducted by
an independent consultant  | 
| recognized as having expertise in environmental
 | 
| remediation has determined a need for, the
clean-up of  | 
| hazardous
waste, hazardous substances, or underground  | 
| storage tanks required by State or
federal law,  | 
| provided that the remediation costs constitute a  | 
| material
impediment to the development or  | 
| redevelopment of the redevelopment project
area.
 | 
|             (L) Lack of community planning.  The proposed  | 
|  | 
| redevelopment project area
was
developed prior to or  | 
| without the benefit or guidance of a community plan.
 | 
| This means that the development occurred prior to the  | 
| adoption by the
municipality of a comprehensive or  | 
| other community plan or that the plan was
not followed  | 
| at the time of the area's development.  This factor must  | 
| be
documented by evidence of adverse or incompatible  | 
| land-use relationships,
inadequate street layout,  | 
| improper subdivision, parcels of inadequate shape and
 | 
| size to meet contemporary development standards, or  | 
| other evidence
demonstrating
an absence of effective  | 
| community planning.
 | 
|             (M) The total equalized assessed value of the  | 
| proposed redevelopment
project area has declined for 3  | 
| of the last 5 calendar years
prior to the year in which  | 
| the redevelopment project area is designated
or is  | 
| increasing at an
annual rate that is less
than the  | 
| balance of the municipality for 3 of the last 5  | 
| calendar years
for which
information is available or is  | 
| increasing at an annual rate that is less than
the  | 
| Consumer Price Index
for All Urban Consumers published  | 
| by the United States Department of Labor or
successor  | 
| agency for 3 of the last 5 calendar years
prior to the  | 
| year in which the redevelopment project area is  | 
| designated.
 | 
|         (2) If vacant, the sound growth of the redevelopment  | 
|  | 
| project area
is impaired by a
combination of 2 or more of  | 
| the following factors, each of which
is (i) present, with  | 
| that presence documented, to a meaningful extent so
that
a  | 
| municipality may reasonably find that the factor is clearly  | 
| present
within the intent of the Act and (ii) reasonably  | 
| distributed throughout the
vacant part of the
 | 
| redevelopment project area to which it pertains:
 | 
|             (A) Obsolete platting of vacant land that results  | 
| in parcels of
limited or
narrow size or configurations  | 
| of parcels of irregular size or shape that would
be  | 
| difficult to develop on
a planned basis and in a manner  | 
| compatible with contemporary standards and
 | 
| requirements, or platting that failed to create  | 
| rights-of-ways for streets or
alleys or that created  | 
| inadequate right-of-way widths for streets, alleys, or
 | 
| other public rights-of-way or that omitted easements  | 
| for public utilities.
 | 
|             (B) Diversity of ownership of parcels of vacant  | 
| land sufficient in
number to
retard or impede the  | 
| ability to assemble the land for development.
 | 
|             (C) Tax and special assessment delinquencies exist  | 
| or the property has
been the subject of tax sales under  | 
| the Property Tax Code within the last 5
years.
 | 
|             (D) Deterioration of structures or site  | 
| improvements in neighboring
areas adjacent to the  | 
| vacant land.
 | 
|  | 
|             (E) The area has incurred Illinois Environmental  | 
| Protection Agency or
United States Environmental  | 
| Protection Agency remediation costs for, or a study
 | 
| conducted by an independent consultant recognized as  | 
| having expertise in
environmental remediation has  | 
| determined a need for, the
clean-up of hazardous
waste,  | 
| hazardous substances, or underground storage tanks  | 
| required by State or
federal law, provided that the  | 
| remediation costs
constitute a material impediment to  | 
| the development or redevelopment of
the
redevelopment  | 
| project area.
 | 
|             (F) The total equalized assessed value of the  | 
| proposed redevelopment
project area has declined for 3  | 
| of the last 5 calendar years
prior to the year in which  | 
| the redevelopment project area is designated
or is  | 
| increasing at an
annual rate that is less
than the  | 
| balance of the municipality for 3 of the last 5  | 
| calendar years for
which information is available or is  | 
| increasing at an annual rate that is less
than
the  | 
| Consumer Price Index
for All Urban Consumers published  | 
| by the United States Department of Labor or
successor  | 
| agency for 3 of the last 5 calendar years
prior to the  | 
| year in which the redevelopment project area is  | 
| designated.
 | 
|         (3) If vacant, the sound growth of the redevelopment  | 
| project area is
impaired by one of the
following factors  | 
|  | 
| that (i) is present, with that presence documented, to a
 | 
| meaningful extent so that a municipality may reasonably  | 
| find that the factor is
clearly
present within the intent  | 
| of the Act and (ii) is reasonably distributed
throughout  | 
| the vacant part of the
redevelopment project area to which  | 
| it pertains:
 | 
|             (A) The area consists of one or more unused  | 
| quarries, mines, or strip
mine ponds.
 | 
|             (B) The area consists of unused rail yards, rail  | 
| tracks, or railroad
rights-of-way.
 | 
|             (C) The area, prior to its designation, is subject  | 
| to (i) chronic
flooding
that adversely impacts on real  | 
| property in the area as certified by a
registered
 | 
| professional engineer or appropriate regulatory agency  | 
| or (ii) surface water
that
discharges from all or a  | 
| part of the area and contributes to flooding within
the
 | 
| same watershed, but only if the redevelopment project  | 
| provides for facilities
or
improvements to contribute  | 
| to the alleviation of all or part of the
flooding.
 | 
|             (D) The area consists of an unused or illegal  | 
| disposal site containing
earth,
stone, building  | 
| debris, or similar materials that were removed from
 | 
| construction, demolition, excavation, or dredge sites.
 | 
|             (E) Prior to November 1, 1999, the area
is not less  | 
| than 50 nor more than 100 acres and 75%
of which is  | 
| vacant (notwithstanding that the area has been used
for  | 
|  | 
| commercial agricultural purposes within 5 years prior  | 
| to the designation
of the redevelopment project area),  | 
| and the area meets at least one of
the factors itemized  | 
| in paragraph (1) of this subsection, the area
has been  | 
| designated as a town or village center by ordinance or  | 
| comprehensive
plan adopted prior to January 1, 1982,  | 
| and the area has not been developed
for that designated  | 
| purpose.
 | 
|             (F) The area qualified as a blighted improved area  | 
| immediately prior to
becoming vacant, unless there has  | 
| been substantial private investment in the
immediately  | 
| surrounding area.
 | 
|     (b) For any redevelopment project area that has been  | 
| designated pursuant
to this
Section by an ordinance adopted  | 
| prior to November 1, 1999 (the effective
date of Public Act
 | 
| 91-478), "conservation area" shall have the meaning
set forth  | 
| in this
Section prior to that date.
 | 
|     On and after November 1, 1999,
"conservation area" means  | 
| any improved area within the boundaries
of a redevelopment  | 
| project area located within the territorial limits of
the  | 
| municipality in which 50% or more of the structures in the area  | 
| have
an age of 35 years or more.
Such an  area is not yet a  | 
| blighted area but
because of a combination of 3 or more of the  | 
| following factors is detrimental
to the public safety, health,  | 
| morals
or welfare and such an area may become a blighted area:
 | 
|         (1) Dilapidation.  An advanced state of disrepair or  | 
|  | 
| neglect of
necessary
repairs to the primary structural  | 
| components of buildings or improvements in
such a  | 
| combination that a documented building condition analysis  | 
| determines
that major repair is required or the defects are  | 
| so serious and so extensive
that the buildings must be  | 
| removed.
 | 
|         (2) Obsolescence.  The condition or process of falling  | 
| into disuse.
Structures have become ill-suited for the  | 
| original use.
 | 
|         (3) Deterioration.  With respect to buildings, defects
 | 
| including, but not limited to, major defects in
the  | 
| secondary building components such as doors, windows,  | 
| porches, gutters and
downspouts, and fascia.  With respect  | 
| to surface improvements, that the
condition of roadways,  | 
| alleys, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, off-street parking,
and  | 
| surface storage areas evidence deterioration, including,  | 
| but not limited
to, surface cracking, crumbling, potholes,  | 
| depressions, loose paving material,
and weeds protruding  | 
| through paved surfaces.
 | 
|         (4) Presence of structures below minimum code  | 
| standards.  All structures
that do not meet the standards of  | 
| zoning, subdivision, building, fire, and
other  | 
| governmental codes applicable to property, but not  | 
| including housing and
property maintenance codes.
 | 
|         (5) Illegal use of individual structures.  The use of  | 
| structures in
violation of applicable federal, State, or  | 
|  | 
| local laws, exclusive of those
applicable to the presence  | 
| of structures below minimum code standards.
 | 
|         (6) Excessive vacancies.  The presence of
buildings  | 
| that are unoccupied or under-utilized and that represent an  | 
| adverse
influence on the area because of the frequency,  | 
| extent, or duration of the
vacancies.
 | 
|         (7) Lack of ventilation, light, or sanitary  | 
| facilities.  The absence of
adequate ventilation for light  | 
| or air circulation in spaces or rooms without
windows, or  | 
| that require the removal of dust, odor, gas, smoke, or  | 
| other
noxious airborne materials.  Inadequate natural light  | 
| and ventilation means
the absence or inadequacy of  | 
| skylights or windows for interior spaces or rooms
and  | 
| improper
window sizes and amounts by room area to window  | 
| area ratios.  Inadequate
sanitary facilities refers to the  | 
| absence or inadequacy of garbage storage and
enclosure,
 | 
| bathroom facilities, hot water and kitchens, and  | 
| structural inadequacies
preventing ingress and egress to  | 
| and from all rooms and units within a
building.
 | 
|         (8) Inadequate utilities.  Underground and overhead  | 
| utilities
such as storm sewers and storm drainage, sanitary  | 
| sewers, water lines, and gas,
telephone, and
electrical  | 
| services that are shown to be inadequate.  Inadequate  | 
| utilities are
those that are: (i) of insufficient capacity  | 
| to serve the uses in the
redevelopment project area, (ii)  | 
| deteriorated,
antiquated, obsolete, or in disrepair, or  | 
|  | 
| (iii) lacking within the
redevelopment project area.
 | 
|         (9) Excessive land coverage and overcrowding of  | 
| structures and community
facilities.  The over-intensive  | 
| use of property and the crowding of buildings
and accessory  | 
| facilities onto a site.  Examples of problem conditions
 | 
| warranting the designation of an area as one exhibiting  | 
| excessive land coverage
are: the presence of buildings  | 
| either improperly situated on parcels or located
on parcels  | 
| of inadequate size and shape in relation to present-day  | 
| standards of
development for health and safety and the  | 
| presence of multiple buildings on a
single parcel.  For  | 
| there to be a finding of excessive land coverage,
these  | 
| parcels must exhibit one or more of the following  | 
| conditions:
insufficient provision for
light and air  | 
| within or around buildings, increased threat of spread of  | 
| fire
due to the close proximity of buildings, lack of  | 
| adequate or proper access to a
public right-of-way, lack of  | 
| reasonably required off-street parking, or
inadequate  | 
| provision for loading and service.
 | 
|         (10) Deleterious land use or layout.  The existence of  | 
| incompatible
land-use
relationships, buildings occupied by  | 
| inappropriate mixed-uses, or uses
considered to be  | 
| noxious, offensive, or unsuitable for the
surrounding  | 
| area.
 | 
|         (11) Lack of community planning.  The proposed  | 
| redevelopment project area
was
developed prior to or  | 
|  | 
| without the benefit or guidance of a community plan.
This  | 
| means that the development occurred prior to the adoption  | 
| by the
municipality of a comprehensive or other community  | 
| plan or that the plan was
not followed at the time of the  | 
| area's development.  This factor must be
documented by  | 
| evidence of adverse or incompatible land-use  | 
| relationships,
inadequate street layout, improper  | 
| subdivision, parcels of inadequate shape and
size to meet  | 
| contemporary development standards, or other evidence
 | 
| demonstrating
an absence of effective community planning.
 | 
|         (12) The area has incurred Illinois Environmental  | 
| Protection Agency or
United
States Environmental  | 
| Protection Agency remediation costs for, or a study
 | 
| conducted by an independent consultant recognized as  | 
| having expertise in
environmental remediation has  | 
| determined a need for, the clean-up of hazardous
waste,  | 
| hazardous substances, or underground storage tanks  | 
| required by State
or federal law, provided that the  | 
| remediation costs constitute a material
impediment to the  | 
| development or redevelopment of the redevelopment project
 | 
| area.
 | 
|         (13) The total equalized assessed value of the proposed  | 
| redevelopment
project area has declined for 3 of the last 5  | 
| calendar years
for which information is
available or is  | 
| increasing at an annual rate that is less than the balance  | 
| of
the municipality for 3 of the last 5 calendar years for  | 
|  | 
| which information is
available or is increasing at an  | 
| annual rate that is less
than the Consumer Price Index for  | 
| All Urban Consumers published by the United
States  | 
| Department of Labor or successor agency for 3 of the last 5  | 
| calendar
years for which information is available.
 | 
|     (c) "Industrial park" means an area in a blighted or  | 
| conservation
area suitable for use by any manufacturing,  | 
| industrial, research or
transportation enterprise, of  | 
| facilities to include but not be limited to
factories, mills,  | 
| processing plants, assembly plants, packing plants,
 | 
| fabricating plants, industrial distribution centers,  | 
| warehouses, repair
overhaul or service facilities, freight  | 
| terminals, research facilities,
test facilities or railroad  | 
| facilities.
 | 
|     (d) "Industrial park conservation area" means an area  | 
| within the
boundaries of a redevelopment project area located  | 
| within the territorial
limits of a municipality that is a labor  | 
| surplus municipality or within 1
1/2 miles of the territorial  | 
| limits of a municipality that is a labor
surplus municipality  | 
| if the area is annexed to the municipality; which
area is zoned  | 
| as industrial no later than at the time the municipality by
 | 
| ordinance designates the redevelopment project area, and which  | 
| area
includes both vacant land suitable for use as an  | 
| industrial park and a
blighted area or conservation area  | 
| contiguous to such vacant land.
 | 
|     (e) "Labor surplus municipality" means a municipality in  | 
|  | 
| which, at any
time during the 6 months before the municipality  | 
| by ordinance designates
an industrial park conservation area,  | 
| the unemployment rate was over 6% and was
also 100% or more of  | 
| the national average unemployment rate for that same
time as  | 
| published in the United States Department of Labor Bureau of  | 
| Labor
Statistics publication entitled "The Employment  | 
| Situation" or its successor
publication. For the purpose of  | 
| this subsection, if unemployment rate
statistics for the  | 
| municipality are not available, the unemployment rate in
the  | 
| municipality shall be deemed to be the same as the unemployment  | 
| rate in
the principal county in which the municipality is  | 
| located.
 | 
|     (f) "Municipality" shall mean a city, village,  | 
| incorporated town, or a township that is located in the  | 
| unincorporated portion of a county with 3 million or more  | 
| inhabitants, if the county  adopted an ordinance that approved  | 
| the township's redevelopment plan.
 | 
|     (g) "Initial Sales Tax Amounts" means the amount of taxes  | 
| paid under
the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act, Use Tax Act,  | 
| Service Use Tax Act, the
Service Occupation Tax Act, the  | 
| Municipal Retailers' Occupation Tax Act,
and the Municipal  | 
| Service Occupation Tax Act by
retailers and servicemen on  | 
| transactions at places located in a
State Sales Tax Boundary  | 
| during the calendar year 1985.
 | 
|     (g-1) "Revised Initial Sales Tax Amounts" means the amount  | 
| of taxes paid
under the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act, Use Tax  | 
|  | 
| Act, Service Use Tax Act, the
Service Occupation Tax Act, the  | 
| Municipal Retailers' Occupation Tax Act,
and the Municipal  | 
| Service Occupation Tax Act by retailers and servicemen on
 | 
| transactions at places located within the State Sales Tax  | 
| Boundary
revised pursuant to Section 11-74.4-8a(9) of this Act.
 | 
|     (h) "Municipal Sales Tax Increment" means an amount equal  | 
| to the
increase in the aggregate amount of taxes paid to a  | 
| municipality from the
Local Government Tax Fund arising from  | 
| sales by retailers and servicemen
within the redevelopment  | 
| project area or State Sales Tax Boundary, as
the case may be,  | 
| for as long as the redevelopment project area or State
Sales  | 
| Tax Boundary, as the case may be, exist over and above the  | 
| aggregate
amount of taxes as certified by the Illinois  | 
| Department of Revenue and paid
under the Municipal Retailers'  | 
| Occupation Tax Act and the Municipal Service
Occupation Tax Act  | 
| by retailers and servicemen, on transactions at places
of  | 
| business located in the redevelopment project area or State  | 
| Sales Tax
Boundary, as the case may be, during the
base year  | 
| which shall be the calendar year immediately prior to the year  | 
| in
which the municipality adopted tax increment allocation  | 
| financing.  For
purposes of computing the aggregate amount of  | 
| such taxes for base years
occurring prior to 1985, the  | 
| Department of Revenue shall determine the
Initial Sales Tax  | 
| Amounts for such taxes and deduct therefrom an amount
equal to  | 
| 4% of the aggregate amount of taxes per year for each year the
 | 
| base year is prior to 1985, but not to exceed a total deduction  | 
|  | 
| of 12%.
The amount so determined shall be known as the  | 
| "Adjusted Initial Sales Tax
Amounts".  For purposes of  | 
| determining the Municipal Sales Tax Increment,
the Department  | 
| of Revenue shall for each period subtract from the amount
paid  | 
| to the municipality from the Local Government Tax Fund arising  | 
| from
sales by retailers and servicemen on transactions
located  | 
| in the redevelopment project area or the State Sales Tax  | 
| Boundary,
as the case may be, the certified Initial Sales Tax
 | 
| Amounts, the Adjusted Initial Sales Tax Amounts or the Revised  | 
| Initial
Sales Tax Amounts for the Municipal Retailers'
 | 
| Occupation Tax Act and the Municipal Service
Occupation Tax  | 
| Act.  For the State Fiscal Year 1989, this calculation shall
be  | 
| made by utilizing the calendar year 1987 to determine the tax  | 
| amounts
received.  For the State Fiscal Year 1990, this  | 
| calculation shall be made
by utilizing the period from January  | 
| 1, 1988, until September 30, 1988, to
determine the tax amounts  | 
| received from retailers and servicemen pursuant
to the  | 
| Municipal Retailers' Occupation Tax and the Municipal Service
 | 
| Occupation Tax Act, which shall have deducted therefrom
 | 
| nine-twelfths of the certified Initial Sales Tax Amounts, the  | 
| Adjusted Initial
Sales Tax Amounts or the Revised Initial Sales  | 
| Tax Amounts as appropriate.
For the State Fiscal Year 1991,  | 
| this calculation shall be made by utilizing
the period from  | 
| October 1, 1988, to June 30, 1989, to determine the tax
amounts  | 
| received from retailers and servicemen pursuant to the  | 
| Municipal
Retailers' Occupation Tax and the Municipal Service  | 
|  | 
| Occupation Tax Act
which shall have deducted therefrom  | 
| nine-twelfths of the
certified Initial Sales Tax Amounts,  | 
| Adjusted Initial Sales Tax
Amounts or the Revised Initial Sales  | 
| Tax Amounts as appropriate. For every
State Fiscal Year  | 
| thereafter, the applicable period shall be the 12 months
 | 
| beginning July 1 and ending June 30 to determine the tax  | 
| amounts received
which shall have deducted therefrom the  | 
| certified Initial Sales Tax
Amounts, the Adjusted Initial Sales  | 
| Tax Amounts or the Revised Initial
Sales Tax Amounts, as the  | 
| case may be.
 | 
|     (i) "Net State Sales Tax Increment" means the sum of the  | 
| following: (a)
80% of the first $100,000 of State Sales Tax  | 
| Increment annually generated
within a State Sales Tax Boundary;  | 
| (b) 60% of the amount in excess of
$100,000 but not exceeding  | 
| $500,000 of State Sales Tax Increment annually
generated within  | 
| a State Sales Tax Boundary; and (c) 40% of all amounts in
 | 
| excess of $500,000 of State Sales Tax Increment annually  | 
| generated within a
State Sales Tax Boundary.  If, however, a  | 
| municipality established a tax
increment financing district in  | 
| a county with a population in excess of
3,000,000 before  | 
| January 1, 1986, and the municipality entered into a
contract  | 
| or issued bonds after January 1, 1986, but before December 31,  | 
| 1986,
to finance redevelopment project costs within a State  | 
| Sales Tax
Boundary, then the Net State Sales Tax Increment  | 
| means, for the fiscal years
beginning July 1, 1990, and July 1,  | 
| 1991, 100% of the State Sales Tax
Increment annually generated  | 
|  | 
| within a State Sales Tax Boundary; and
notwithstanding any  | 
| other provision of this Act, for those fiscal years the
 | 
| Department of Revenue shall distribute to those municipalities  | 
| 100% of
their Net State Sales Tax Increment before any  | 
| distribution to any other
municipality and regardless of  | 
| whether or not those other municipalities
will receive 100% of  | 
| their Net State Sales Tax Increment.  For Fiscal Year
1999, and  | 
| every year thereafter until the year 2007, for any municipality
 | 
| that has not entered into a contract or has not issued bonds  | 
| prior to June
1, 1988 to finance redevelopment project costs  | 
| within a State Sales Tax
Boundary, the Net State Sales Tax  | 
| Increment shall be calculated as follows:
By multiplying the  | 
| Net State Sales Tax Increment by 90% in the State Fiscal
Year  | 
| 1999; 80% in the State Fiscal Year 2000; 70% in the State  | 
| Fiscal Year
2001; 60% in the State Fiscal Year 2002; 50% in the  | 
| State Fiscal Year 2003; 40%
in the State Fiscal Year 2004; 30%  | 
| in the State Fiscal Year 2005; 20% in
the State Fiscal Year  | 
| 2006; and 10% in the State Fiscal Year 2007. No
payment shall  | 
| be made for State Fiscal Year 2008 and thereafter.
 | 
|     Municipalities that issued bonds in connection with a  | 
| redevelopment project
in a redevelopment project area within  | 
| the State Sales Tax Boundary prior to
July 29, 1991,
or that  | 
| entered into contracts in connection with a redevelopment  | 
| project in
a redevelopment project area before June 1, 1988,
 | 
| shall continue to receive their proportional share of the
 | 
| Illinois Tax Increment Fund distribution until the date on  | 
|  | 
| which the
redevelopment project is completed or terminated.
If,  | 
| however, a municipality that issued bonds in connection with a
 | 
| redevelopment project in a redevelopment project area within  | 
| the State Sales
Tax Boundary prior to July 29, 1991 retires the  | 
| bonds prior to June 30, 2007 or
a municipality that entered  | 
| into contracts in connection with a redevelopment
project in a  | 
| redevelopment project area before June 1, 1988 completes the
 | 
| contracts prior to June 30, 2007, then so long as the  | 
| redevelopment project is
not
completed or is not terminated,  | 
| the Net State Sales Tax Increment shall be
calculated,  | 
| beginning on the date on which the bonds are retired or the
 | 
| contracts are completed, as follows:  By multiplying the Net  | 
| State Sales Tax
Increment by 60% in the State Fiscal Year
2002;  | 
| 50% in the State Fiscal Year 2003; 40% in the State Fiscal Year  | 
| 2004; 30%
in the State Fiscal Year 2005; 20% in the State  | 
| Fiscal Year 2006; and 10% in
the State Fiscal Year 2007.  No  | 
| payment shall be made for State Fiscal Year
2008 and  | 
| thereafter.
Refunding of any bonds issued
prior to July 29,  | 
| 1991, shall not alter the Net State Sales Tax Increment.
 | 
|     (j) "State Utility Tax Increment Amount" means an amount  | 
| equal to the
aggregate increase in State electric and gas tax  | 
| charges imposed on owners
and tenants, other than residential  | 
| customers, of properties located within
the redevelopment  | 
| project area under Section 9-222 of the Public Utilities
Act,  | 
| over and above the aggregate of such charges as certified by  | 
| the
Department of Revenue and paid by owners and tenants, other  | 
|  | 
| than
residential customers, of properties within the  | 
| redevelopment project area
during the base year, which shall be  | 
| the calendar year immediately prior to
the year of the adoption  | 
| of the ordinance authorizing tax increment allocation
 | 
| financing.
 | 
|     (k) "Net State Utility Tax Increment" means the sum of the  | 
| following:
(a) 80% of the first $100,000 of State Utility Tax  | 
| Increment annually
generated by a redevelopment project area;  | 
| (b) 60% of the amount in excess
of $100,000 but not exceeding  | 
| $500,000 of the State Utility Tax Increment
annually generated  | 
| by a redevelopment project area; and (c) 40% of all
amounts in  | 
| excess of $500,000 of State Utility Tax Increment annually
 | 
| generated by a redevelopment project area. For the State Fiscal  | 
| Year 1999,
and every year thereafter until the year 2007, for  | 
| any municipality that
has not entered into a contract or has  | 
| not issued bonds prior to June 1,
1988 to finance redevelopment  | 
| project costs within a redevelopment project
area, the Net  | 
| State Utility Tax Increment shall be calculated as follows:
By  | 
| multiplying the Net State Utility Tax Increment by 90% in the  | 
| State
Fiscal Year 1999; 80% in the State Fiscal Year 2000; 70%  | 
| in the State
Fiscal Year 2001; 60% in the State Fiscal Year  | 
| 2002; 50% in the State
Fiscal Year 2003; 40% in the State  | 
| Fiscal Year 2004; 30% in the State
Fiscal Year 2005; 20% in the  | 
| State Fiscal Year 2006; and 10% in the State
Fiscal Year 2007.  | 
| No payment shall be made for the State Fiscal Year 2008
and  | 
| thereafter.
 | 
|  | 
|     Municipalities that issue bonds in connection with the  | 
| redevelopment project
during the period from June 1, 1988 until  | 
| 3 years after the effective date
of this Amendatory Act of 1988  | 
| shall receive the Net State Utility Tax
Increment, subject to  | 
| appropriation, for 15 State Fiscal Years after the
issuance of  | 
| such bonds.  For the 16th through the 20th State Fiscal Years
 | 
| after issuance of the bonds, the Net State Utility Tax  | 
| Increment shall be
calculated as follows: By multiplying the  | 
| Net State Utility Tax Increment
by 90% in year 16; 80% in year  | 
| 17; 70% in year 18; 60% in year 19; and 50%
in year 20.  | 
| Refunding of any bonds issued prior to June 1, 1988, shall not
 | 
| alter the revised Net State Utility Tax Increment payments set  | 
| forth above.
 | 
|     (l) "Obligations" mean bonds, loans, debentures, notes,  | 
| special certificates
or other evidence of indebtedness issued  | 
| by the municipality to carry out
a redevelopment project or to  | 
| refund outstanding obligations.
 | 
|     (m) "Payment in lieu of taxes" means those estimated tax  | 
| revenues from
real property in a redevelopment project area  | 
| derived from real property that
has been acquired by a  | 
| municipality
which according to the redevelopment project or  | 
| plan is to be used for a
private use which taxing districts  | 
| would have received had a municipality
not acquired the real  | 
| property and adopted tax increment allocation
financing and  | 
| which would result from
levies made after the time of the  | 
| adoption of tax increment allocation
financing to the time the  | 
|  | 
| current equalized value of real property in the
redevelopment  | 
| project area exceeds the total initial equalized value of
real  | 
| property in said area.
 | 
|     (n) "Redevelopment plan" means the comprehensive program  | 
| of
the municipality for development or redevelopment intended  | 
| by the payment of
redevelopment project costs to reduce or  | 
| eliminate those conditions the
existence of which qualified the  | 
| redevelopment project area as
a "blighted
area" or  | 
| "conservation area" or combination thereof or "industrial park
 | 
| conservation area," and thereby to enhance the tax bases of the  | 
| taxing
districts which extend into the redevelopment project  | 
| area, provided that, with respect to redevelopment project  | 
| areas described in subsections (p-1) and (p-2), "redevelopment  | 
| plan" means the comprehensive program of the affected  | 
| municipality for the development of qualifying transit  | 
| facilities.
On and after November 1, 1999 (the effective date  | 
| of
Public Act 91-478), no
redevelopment plan may be approved or  | 
| amended that includes the development of
vacant land (i) with a  | 
| golf course and related clubhouse and other facilities
or (ii)  | 
| designated by federal, State, county, or municipal government  | 
| as public
land for outdoor recreational activities or for  | 
| nature preserves and used for
that purpose within 5
years prior  | 
| to the adoption of the redevelopment plan.  For the  purpose of
 | 
| this subsection, "recreational activities" is limited to mean  | 
| camping and
hunting.
Each
redevelopment plan shall set forth in  | 
| writing the program to be undertaken
to accomplish the  | 
|  | 
| objectives  and shall include but not be limited to:
 | 
|         (A) an itemized list of estimated redevelopment  | 
| project costs;
 | 
|         (B) evidence indicating that the redevelopment project  | 
| area on the whole
has not been subject to growth and  | 
| development through investment by private
enterprise,  | 
| provided that such evidence shall not be required for any  | 
| redevelopment project area located within a transit  | 
| facility improvement area established pursuant to Section  | 
| 11-74.4-3.3;
 | 
|         (C) an assessment of any financial impact of the  | 
| redevelopment project
area on or any increased demand for  | 
| services from any taxing district affected
by the plan and  | 
| any program to address such financial impact or increased
 | 
| demand;
 | 
|         (D) the sources of funds to pay costs;
 | 
|         (E) the nature and term of the obligations to be  | 
| issued;
 | 
|         (F) the most recent equalized assessed valuation of the  | 
| redevelopment
project area;
 | 
|         (G) an estimate as to the equalized assessed valuation  | 
| after redevelopment
and the general land uses to apply in  | 
| the redevelopment project area;
 | 
|         (H) a commitment to fair employment practices and an  | 
| affirmative action
plan;
 | 
|         (I) if it concerns an industrial park
conservation  | 
|  | 
| area, the plan shall
also include a general description
of  | 
| any proposed developer, user and tenant of any property, a  | 
| description
of the type, structure and general character of  | 
| the facilities to be
developed, a description of the type,  | 
| class and number of new employees to
be employed in the  | 
| operation of the facilities to be developed; and
 | 
|         (J) if property is to be annexed to the municipality,  | 
| the plan shall
include the terms of the annexation  | 
| agreement.
 | 
|     The provisions of items (B) and (C) of this subsection (n)  | 
| shall not apply to
a municipality that before March 14, 1994  | 
| (the effective date of Public Act
88-537) had fixed, either by  | 
| its
corporate authorities or by a commission designated under  | 
| subsection (k) of
Section 11-74.4-4, a time and place for a  | 
| public hearing as required by
subsection (a) of Section  | 
| 11-74.4-5.
No redevelopment plan shall be adopted unless a
 | 
| municipality complies with all of the following requirements:
 | 
|         (1) The municipality finds that the redevelopment  | 
| project area on
the whole has not been subject to growth  | 
| and development through investment
by private enterprise  | 
| and would not reasonably be anticipated to be
developed  | 
| without the adoption of the redevelopment plan, provided,  | 
| however, that such a finding shall not be required with  | 
| respect to any redevelopment project area located within a  | 
| transit facility improvement area established pursuant to  | 
| Section 11-74.4-3.3.
 | 
|  | 
|         (2) The municipality finds that the redevelopment plan  | 
| and project conform
to the comprehensive plan for the  | 
| development of the municipality as a whole,
or, for  | 
| municipalities with a population of 100,000 or more,  | 
| regardless of when
the redevelopment plan and project was  | 
| adopted, the redevelopment plan and
project either: (i)  | 
| conforms to the strategic economic development or
 | 
| redevelopment plan issued by the designated planning  | 
| authority of the
municipality, or (ii) includes land uses  | 
| that have been approved by the
planning commission of the  | 
| municipality.
 | 
|         (3) The redevelopment plan establishes the estimated  | 
| dates of completion
of the redevelopment project and  | 
| retirement of obligations issued to finance
redevelopment  | 
| project costs.  Those dates may not be later than the dates  | 
| set forth under Section 11-74.4-3.5.
 | 
|         A municipality may by municipal ordinance amend an  | 
| existing redevelopment
plan to conform to this paragraph  | 
| (3) as amended by Public Act 91-478, which
municipal  | 
| ordinance may be adopted without
further hearing or
notice  | 
| and without complying with the procedures provided in this  | 
| Act
pertaining to an amendment to or the initial approval  | 
| of a redevelopment plan
and project and
designation of a  | 
| redevelopment project area.
 | 
|         (3.5) The municipality finds, in the case of an  | 
| industrial
park
conservation area, also that the  | 
|  | 
| municipality is a labor surplus municipality
and that the  | 
| implementation of the redevelopment plan will reduce  | 
| unemployment,
create new jobs and by the provision of new  | 
| facilities enhance the tax base of
the taxing districts  | 
| that extend into the redevelopment project area.
 | 
|         (4) If any incremental revenues are being utilized  | 
| under
Section 8(a)(1)
or 8(a)(2) of this Act in  | 
| redevelopment project areas approved by ordinance
after  | 
| January 1, 1986, the municipality finds: (a) that the  | 
| redevelopment
project area would not reasonably be  | 
| developed without the use of such
incremental revenues, and  | 
| (b) that such incremental revenues will be
exclusively  | 
| utilized for the development of the redevelopment project  | 
| area.
 | 
|         (5) If: (a)
the redevelopment plan will not result in
 | 
| displacement of
residents from 10 or more inhabited  | 
| residential units, and the
municipality certifies in the  | 
| plan that
such displacement will not result from the plan;  | 
| or (b) the redevelopment plan is for a redevelopment  | 
| project area located within a transit facility improvement  | 
| area established pursuant to Section 11-74.4-3.3, and the  | 
| applicable project is subject to the process for evaluation  | 
| of environmental effects under the National Environmental  | 
| Policy Act of 1969, 42 U.S.C. § 4321 et seq., then a  | 
| housing impact study
need not be performed.
If, however,  | 
| the redevelopment plan would result in the displacement
of
 | 
|  | 
| residents from 10 or more inhabited
residential units,
or  | 
| if the redevelopment project area contains 75 or more  | 
| inhabited residential
units and no
certification is made,
 | 
| then the municipality shall prepare, as part of the  | 
| separate
feasibility report required by subsection (a) of  | 
| Section 11-74.4-5, a housing
impact study.
 | 
|         Part I of the housing impact study shall include (i)  | 
| data as to whether
the residential units are single family  | 
| or multi-family units,
(ii) the number and type of rooms  | 
| within the units, if that information is
available, (iii)  | 
| whether
the
units are inhabited or uninhabited, as  | 
| determined not less than 45
days before the date that the  | 
| ordinance or resolution required
by subsection (a) of  | 
| Section 11-74.4-5 is passed, and (iv) data as to the
racial  | 
| and ethnic composition of the residents in the inhabited  | 
| residential
units.  The data requirement as to the racial  | 
| and ethnic composition of the
residents in the inhabited  | 
| residential units shall be deemed to be fully
satisfied by  | 
| data from the most recent federal census.
 | 
|         Part II of the housing impact study shall identify the  | 
| inhabited
residential units in the proposed redevelopment  | 
| project area that are to be or
may be removed.  If inhabited  | 
| residential units are to be removed, then the
housing  | 
| impact study shall identify (i) the number and location of  | 
| those units
that will or may be removed, (ii) the  | 
| municipality's plans for relocation
assistance for those  | 
|  | 
| residents in the proposed redevelopment project area
whose  | 
| residences are to be removed, (iii) the availability of  | 
| replacement
housing for those residents whose residences  | 
| are to be removed, and shall
identify the type, location,  | 
| and cost of the housing, and (iv) the type and
extent
of  | 
| relocation assistance to be provided.
 | 
|         (6) On and after November 1, 1999, the
housing impact  | 
| study required by paragraph (5) shall be
incorporated in  | 
| the redevelopment plan for the
redevelopment project area.
 | 
|         (7) On and after November 1, 1999, no
redevelopment  | 
| plan shall be adopted, nor an
existing plan amended, nor  | 
| shall residential housing that is
occupied by households of  | 
| low-income and very low-income
persons in currently  | 
| existing redevelopment project
areas be removed after  | 
| November 1, 1999 unless the redevelopment plan provides,  | 
| with
respect to inhabited housing units that are to be  | 
| removed for
households of low-income and very low-income  | 
| persons, affordable
housing and relocation assistance not  | 
| less than that which would
be provided under the federal  | 
| Uniform Relocation Assistance and
Real Property  | 
| Acquisition Policies Act of 1970 and the regulations
under  | 
| that Act, including the eligibility criteria.
Affordable  | 
| housing may be either existing or newly constructed
 | 
| housing. For purposes of this paragraph (7), "low-income
 | 
| households", "very low-income households", and "affordable
 | 
| housing" have the meanings set forth in the Illinois  | 
|  | 
| Affordable
Housing Act.
The municipality shall make a good  | 
| faith effort to ensure that this affordable
housing is  | 
| located in or near the redevelopment project area within  | 
| the
municipality.
 | 
|         (8) On and after November 1, 1999, if,
after the  | 
| adoption of the redevelopment plan for the
redevelopment  | 
| project area, any municipality desires to amend its
 | 
| redevelopment plan
to remove more inhabited residential  | 
| units than
specified in its original redevelopment plan,  | 
| that change shall be made in
accordance with the procedures  | 
| in subsection (c) of Section 11-74.4-5.
 | 
|         (9) For redevelopment project areas designated prior  | 
| to November 1,
1999, the redevelopment plan may be amended  | 
| without further joint review board
meeting or hearing,  | 
| provided that the municipality shall give notice of any
 | 
| such changes by mail to each affected taxing district and  | 
| registrant on the
interested party registry, to authorize  | 
| the municipality to expend tax
increment revenues for  | 
| redevelopment project costs defined by paragraphs (5)
and  | 
| (7.5), subparagraphs (E) and (F) of paragraph (11), and  | 
| paragraph (11.5) of
subsection (q) of Section 11-74.4-3, so  | 
| long as the changes do not increase the
total estimated  | 
| redevelopment project costs set out in the redevelopment  | 
| plan
by more than 5% after adjustment for inflation from  | 
| the date the plan was
adopted.
 | 
|     (o) "Redevelopment project" means any public and private  | 
|  | 
| development project
in furtherance of the objectives of a  | 
| redevelopment plan.
On and after November 1, 1999 (the  | 
| effective date of Public Act 91-478), no
redevelopment plan may  | 
| be approved or amended that includes the development
of vacant  | 
| land (i) with a golf course and related clubhouse and other
 | 
| facilities
or (ii) designated by federal, State, county, or  | 
| municipal government as public
land for outdoor recreational  | 
| activities or for nature preserves and used for
that purpose  | 
| within 5
years prior to the adoption of the redevelopment plan.   | 
| For the  purpose of
this subsection, "recreational activities"  | 
| is limited to mean camping and
hunting.
 | 
|     (p) "Redevelopment project area" means an area designated  | 
| by
the
municipality, which is not less in the aggregate than 1  | 
| 1/2 acres and in
respect to which the municipality has made a  | 
| finding that there exist
conditions which cause the area to be  | 
| classified as an industrial park
conservation area or a  | 
| blighted area or a conservation area, or a
combination of both  | 
| blighted areas and conservation areas.
 | 
|     (p-1) Notwithstanding any provision of this Act to the  | 
| contrary, on and after August 25, 2009 (the effective date of  | 
| Public Act 96-680), a redevelopment project area may include  | 
| areas within a one-half mile radius of an existing or proposed  | 
| Regional Transportation Authority Suburban Transit Access  | 
| Route (STAR Line) station without a finding that the area is  | 
| classified as an industrial park conservation area, a blighted  | 
| area, a conservation area, or a combination thereof, but only  | 
|  | 
| if the municipality receives unanimous consent from the joint  | 
| review board created to review the proposed redevelopment  | 
| project area.  | 
|     (p-2) Notwithstanding any provision of this Act to the  | 
| contrary, on and after the effective date of this amendatory  | 
| Act of the 99th General Assembly, a redevelopment project area  | 
| may include areas within a transit facility improvement area  | 
| that has been established pursuant to Section 11-74.4-3.3  | 
| without a finding that the area is classified as an industrial  | 
| park conservation area, a blighted area, a conservation area,  | 
| or any combination thereof.  | 
|     (q) "Redevelopment project costs", except for  | 
| redevelopment project areas created pursuant to subsection  | 
| subsections (p-1) or (p-2), means and includes the sum total of  | 
| all
reasonable or necessary costs incurred or estimated to be  | 
| incurred, and
any such costs incidental to a redevelopment plan  | 
| and a redevelopment
project.  Such costs include, without  | 
| limitation, the following:
 | 
|         (1) Costs of studies, surveys, development of plans,  | 
| and
specifications, implementation and administration of  | 
| the redevelopment
plan including but not limited to staff  | 
| and professional service costs for
architectural,  | 
| engineering, legal, financial, planning or other
services,  | 
| provided however that no charges for professional services  | 
| may be
based on a percentage of the tax increment  | 
| collected; except that on and
after November 1, 1999 (the  | 
|  | 
| effective date of Public Act 91-478), no
contracts for
 | 
| professional services, excluding architectural and  | 
| engineering services, may be
entered into if the terms of  | 
| the contract extend
beyond a period of 3 years.  In  | 
| addition, "redevelopment project costs" shall
not include  | 
| lobbying expenses.
After consultation with the  | 
| municipality, each tax
increment consultant or advisor to a  | 
| municipality that plans to designate or
has designated a  | 
| redevelopment project area shall inform the municipality  | 
| in
writing of any contracts that the consultant or advisor  | 
| has entered into with
entities or individuals that have  | 
| received, or are receiving, payments financed
by tax
 | 
| increment revenues produced by the redevelopment project  | 
| area with respect to
which the consultant or advisor has  | 
| performed, or will be performing, service
for the
 | 
| municipality.  This requirement shall be satisfied by the  | 
| consultant or advisor
before the commencement of services  | 
| for the municipality and thereafter
whenever any other  | 
| contracts with those individuals or entities are executed  | 
| by
the consultant or advisor;
 | 
|         (1.5) After July 1, 1999, annual administrative costs  | 
| shall
not include general overhead or
administrative costs  | 
| of the municipality
that would still have been incurred by  | 
| the municipality if the municipality had
not
designated a  | 
| redevelopment project area or approved a redevelopment  | 
| plan;
 | 
|  | 
|         (1.6) The cost of
marketing sites within the  | 
| redevelopment project area to prospective
businesses,  | 
| developers, and investors;
 | 
|         (2) Property assembly costs, including but not limited  | 
| to acquisition
of land and other property, real or  | 
| personal, or rights or interests therein,
demolition of  | 
| buildings, site preparation, site improvements that serve  | 
| as an
engineered barrier addressing ground level or below  | 
| ground environmental
contamination, including, but not  | 
| limited to parking lots and other concrete
or asphalt  | 
| barriers, and the clearing and grading of
land;
 | 
|         (3) Costs of rehabilitation, reconstruction or repair  | 
| or remodeling of
existing public or private buildings,  | 
| fixtures, and leasehold
improvements; and the cost of  | 
| replacing
an existing public building if pursuant to the  | 
| implementation of a
redevelopment project the existing  | 
| public building is to be demolished to use
the site for  | 
| private investment or
devoted to a different use requiring  | 
| private investment; including any direct or indirect costs  | 
| relating to Green Globes or LEED certified construction  | 
| elements or construction elements with an equivalent  | 
| certification;
 | 
|         (4) Costs of the construction of public works or  | 
| improvements, including any direct or indirect costs  | 
| relating to Green Globes or LEED certified construction  | 
| elements or construction elements with an equivalent  | 
|  | 
| certification, except
that on and after November 1, 1999,
 | 
| redevelopment
project costs shall not include the cost of  | 
| constructing a
new municipal public building principally  | 
| used to provide
offices, storage space, or conference  | 
| facilities or vehicle storage,
maintenance, or repair for  | 
| administrative,
public safety, or public works personnel
 | 
| and that is not intended to replace an existing
public  | 
| building as provided under paragraph (3) of subsection (q)  | 
| of Section
11-74.4-3
unless either (i) the construction of  | 
| the new municipal building
implements a redevelopment  | 
| project that was included in a redevelopment plan
that was  | 
| adopted by the municipality prior to November 1, 1999, (ii)  | 
| the
municipality makes a reasonable
determination in the  | 
| redevelopment plan, supported by information that provides
 | 
| the basis for that determination, that the new municipal  | 
| building is required
to meet an increase in the need for  | 
| public safety purposes anticipated to
result from the  | 
| implementation of the redevelopment plan, or (iii) the new  | 
| municipal public building is for the storage, maintenance,  | 
| or repair of transit vehicles and is located in a transit  | 
| facility improvement area that has been established  | 
| pursuant to Section 11-74.4-3.3;
 | 
|         (5) Costs of job training and retraining projects,  | 
| including the cost of
"welfare to work" programs  | 
| implemented by businesses located within the
redevelopment  | 
| project area;
 | 
|  | 
|         (6) Financing costs, including but not limited to all  | 
| necessary and
incidental expenses related to the issuance  | 
| of obligations and which may
include payment of interest on  | 
| any obligations issued hereunder including
interest  | 
| accruing
during the estimated period of construction of any  | 
| redevelopment project
for which such obligations are  | 
| issued and for not exceeding 36 months
thereafter and  | 
| including reasonable reserves related thereto;
 | 
|         (7) To the extent the municipality by written agreement  | 
| accepts and
approves
the same, all or a portion of a taxing  | 
| district's capital costs resulting
from the redevelopment  | 
| project necessarily incurred or to be incurred within a
 | 
| taxing district in
furtherance of the objectives of the  | 
| redevelopment plan and project;.
 | 
|         (7.5) For redevelopment project areas designated (or  | 
| redevelopment
project areas amended to add or increase the  | 
| number of
tax-increment-financing assisted housing units)  | 
| on or after November 1,
1999,
an elementary, secondary,
or  | 
| unit school
district's increased costs attributable to  | 
| assisted housing units located
within the
redevelopment  | 
| project area for which the developer or redeveloper  | 
| receives
financial assistance through an agreement with  | 
| the municipality or because the
municipality incurs the  | 
| cost of necessary infrastructure improvements within
the  | 
| boundaries of the assisted housing sites necessary for the  | 
| completion of
that housing
as authorized by this Act, and  | 
|  | 
| which costs shall be paid by the municipality
from the  | 
| Special Tax Allocation Fund when the tax increment revenue  | 
| is received
as a result of the assisted housing units and  | 
| shall be calculated annually as
follows:
 | 
|             (A) for foundation districts, excluding any school  | 
| district in a
municipality with a population in excess  | 
| of 1,000,000, by multiplying the
district's increase  | 
| in attendance resulting from the net increase in new
 | 
| students enrolled in that school district who reside in  | 
| housing units within
the redevelopment project area  | 
| that have received financial assistance through
an  | 
| agreement with the municipality or because the  | 
| municipality incurs the cost
of necessary  | 
| infrastructure improvements within the boundaries of  | 
| the housing
sites necessary for the completion of that  | 
| housing as authorized by this Act
since the designation  | 
| of the redevelopment project area by the most recently
 | 
| available per capita tuition cost as defined in Section  | 
| 10-20.12a of the School
Code less any increase in  | 
| general State aid as defined in Section 18-8.05 of
the  | 
| School Code or evidence-based funding as defined in  | 
| Section 18-8.15 of the School Code attributable to  | 
| these added new students subject to the
following  | 
| annual limitations:
 | 
|                 (i) for unit school districts with a district  | 
| average 1995-96 Per
Capita
Tuition Charge of less  | 
|  | 
| than $5,900, no more than 25% of the total amount  | 
| of
property tax increment revenue produced by  | 
| those housing units that have
received tax  | 
| increment finance assistance under this Act;
 | 
|                 (ii) for elementary school districts with a  | 
| district average 1995-96
Per
Capita Tuition Charge  | 
| of less than $5,900, no more than 17% of the total  | 
| amount
of property tax increment revenue produced  | 
| by those housing units that have
received tax  | 
| increment finance assistance under this Act; and
 | 
|                 (iii) for secondary school districts with a  | 
| district average 1995-96
Per
Capita Tuition Charge  | 
| of less than $5,900, no more than 8% of the total  | 
| amount
of property tax increment revenue produced  | 
| by those housing units that have
received tax  | 
| increment finance assistance under this Act.
 | 
|             (B) For alternate method districts, flat grant  | 
| districts, and foundation
districts with a district  | 
| average 1995-96 Per Capita Tuition Charge equal to or
 | 
| more than $5,900, excluding any school district with a  | 
| population in excess of
1,000,000, by multiplying the  | 
| district's increase in attendance
resulting
from the  | 
| net increase in new students enrolled in that school  | 
| district who
reside in
 housing units within the  | 
| redevelopment project area that have received
 | 
| financial assistance through an agreement with the  | 
|  | 
| municipality or because the
 municipality incurs the  | 
| cost of necessary infrastructure improvements within
 | 
| the boundaries of the housing sites necessary for the  | 
| completion of that
housing as authorized by this Act  | 
| since the designation of the redevelopment
project  | 
| area by the most recently available per capita tuition  | 
| cost as defined
in Section 10-20.12a of the School Code  | 
| less any increase in general state aid
as defined in  | 
| Section 18-8.05 of the School Code or evidence-based  | 
| funding as defined in Section 18-8.15 of the School  | 
| Code attributable to these added
new students subject  | 
| to the following annual limitations:
 | 
|                 (i) for unit school districts, no more than 40%  | 
| of the total amount of
property tax increment  | 
| revenue produced by those housing units that have
 | 
| received tax increment finance assistance under  | 
| this Act;
 | 
|                 (ii) for elementary school districts, no more  | 
| than 27% of the total
amount
of property tax  | 
| increment revenue produced by those housing units  | 
| that have
received tax increment finance  | 
| assistance under this Act; and
 | 
|                 (iii) for secondary school districts, no more  | 
| than 13% of the total
amount
of property tax  | 
| increment revenue produced by those housing units  | 
| that have
received tax increment finance  | 
|  | 
| assistance under this Act.
 | 
|             (C) For any school district in a municipality with  | 
| a population in
excess of
1,000,000, the following  | 
| restrictions shall apply to the
reimbursement of  | 
| increased costs under this paragraph (7.5):
 | 
|                 (i) no increased costs shall be reimbursed  | 
| unless the school district
certifies that each of  | 
| the schools affected by the assisted housing  | 
| project
is at or over its student capacity;
 | 
|                 (ii) the amount reimbursable shall be reduced  | 
| by the value of any
land
donated to the school  | 
| district by the municipality or developer, and by  | 
| the
value of any physical improvements made to the  | 
| schools by the
municipality or developer; and
 | 
|                 (iii) the amount reimbursed may not affect  | 
| amounts otherwise obligated
by
the terms of any  | 
| bonds, notes, or other funding instruments, or the  | 
| terms of
any redevelopment agreement.
 | 
|         Any school district seeking payment under this  | 
| paragraph (7.5) shall,
after July 1 and before  | 
| September 30 of each year,
provide the municipality  | 
| with reasonable evidence to support its claim for
 | 
| reimbursement before the municipality shall be  | 
| required to approve or make
the payment to the school  | 
| district.  If the school district fails to provide
the  | 
| information during this period in any year, it shall  | 
|  | 
| forfeit any claim to
reimbursement for that year.   | 
| School districts may adopt a resolution
waiving the  | 
| right to all or a portion of the reimbursement  | 
| otherwise required
by this paragraph
(7.5).  By  | 
| acceptance of this reimbursement the school
district  | 
| waives the right to directly or indirectly set aside,  | 
| modify, or
contest in any manner the establishment of  | 
| the redevelopment project area or
projects;
 | 
|         (7.7) For redevelopment project areas designated (or  | 
| redevelopment
project areas amended to add or increase the  | 
| number of
tax-increment-financing assisted housing units)  | 
| on or after
January 1, 2005 (the effective date of Public  | 
| Act 93-961),
a public library
district's increased costs  | 
| attributable to assisted housing units located
within the
 | 
| redevelopment project area for which the developer or  | 
| redeveloper receives
financial assistance through an  | 
| agreement with the municipality or because the
 | 
| municipality incurs the cost of necessary infrastructure  | 
| improvements within
the boundaries of the assisted housing  | 
| sites necessary for the completion of
that housing
as  | 
| authorized by this Act shall be paid to the library  | 
| district by the
municipality
from the Special Tax  | 
| Allocation Fund when the tax increment revenue is received
 | 
| as a result of the assisted housing units.  This paragraph  | 
| (7.7) applies only if (i) the  library district is located  | 
| in a county that is subject to the Property Tax Extension  | 
|  | 
| Limitation Law or (ii) the  library district is not located  | 
| in a county that is subject to the Property Tax Extension  | 
| Limitation Law but  the district is prohibited by any other  | 
| law from increasing its tax levy rate without a prior voter  | 
| referendum.
 | 
|         The amount paid to a library district under this  | 
| paragraph (7.7) shall be
calculated
by multiplying (i) the  | 
| net increase in the number of persons eligible to obtain
a
 | 
| library card
in that district who reside in housing units  | 
| within
the redevelopment project area that have received  | 
| financial assistance through
an agreement with the  | 
| municipality or because the municipality incurs the cost
of  | 
| necessary infrastructure improvements within the  | 
| boundaries of the housing
sites necessary for the  | 
| completion of that housing as authorized by this Act
since  | 
| the designation of the redevelopment project area by (ii)
 | 
| the per-patron cost of providing library services so long  | 
| as it does not exceed $120.
The per-patron cost shall be  | 
| the Total Operating Expenditures Per Capita for the library  | 
| in the previous fiscal year.
The municipality may deduct  | 
| from the amount that it must pay to a library district  | 
| under this paragraph any amount that it has voluntarily  | 
| paid to the library district from the tax increment  | 
| revenue. The amount paid to a library district under this  | 
| paragraph (7.7) shall be no
more
than 2% of the amount  | 
| produced by the  assisted housing units and deposited into  | 
|  | 
| the Special Tax Allocation Fund.
 | 
|         A library district is not eligible for any payment  | 
| under this paragraph
(7.7)
unless the library district has  | 
| experienced an increase in the
number of patrons from the  | 
| municipality that created the tax-increment-financing  | 
| district since the designation of the redevelopment  | 
| project area.
 | 
|         Any library district seeking payment under this  | 
| paragraph (7.7) shall,
after July 1 and before September 30  | 
| of each year,
provide the municipality with convincing  | 
| evidence to support its claim for
reimbursement before the  | 
| municipality shall be required to approve or make
the  | 
| payment to the library district.  If the library district  | 
| fails to provide
the information during this period in any  | 
| year, it shall forfeit any claim to
reimbursement for that  | 
| year.  Library districts may adopt a resolution
waiving the  | 
| right to all or a portion of the reimbursement otherwise  | 
| required by this paragraph (7.7). By acceptance of such  | 
| reimbursement, the library district shall forfeit any  | 
| right to directly or indirectly set aside, modify, or  | 
| contest in any manner whatsoever the establishment of the  | 
| redevelopment project area or
projects; | 
|         (8) Relocation costs to the extent that a municipality  | 
| determines that
relocation costs shall be paid or is  | 
| required to make payment of relocation
costs by federal or  | 
| State law or in order to satisfy subparagraph (7) of
 | 
|  | 
| subsection (n);
 | 
|         (9) Payment in lieu of taxes;
 | 
|         (10) Costs of job training, retraining, advanced  | 
| vocational education
or career
education, including but  | 
| not limited to courses in occupational,
semi-technical or  | 
| technical fields leading directly to employment, incurred
 | 
| by one or more taxing districts, provided that such costs  | 
| (i) are related
to the establishment and maintenance of  | 
| additional job training, advanced
vocational education or  | 
| career education programs for persons employed or
to be  | 
| employed by employers located in a redevelopment project  | 
| area; and
(ii) when incurred by a taxing district or taxing  | 
| districts other than the
municipality, are set forth in a  | 
| written agreement by or among the
municipality and the  | 
| taxing district or taxing districts, which agreement
 | 
| describes the program to be undertaken, including but not  | 
| limited to the
number of employees to be trained, a  | 
| description of the training and
services to be provided,  | 
| the number and type of positions available or to
be  | 
| available, itemized costs of the program and sources of  | 
| funds to pay for the
same, and the term of the agreement.  | 
| Such costs include, specifically, the
payment by community  | 
| college districts of costs pursuant to Sections 3-37,
3-38,  | 
| 3-40 and 3-40.1 of the Public Community College Act and by  | 
| school
districts of costs pursuant to Sections 10-22.20a  | 
| and 10-23.3a of the The School
Code;
 | 
|  | 
|         (11) Interest cost incurred by a redeveloper related to  | 
| the
construction, renovation or rehabilitation of a  | 
| redevelopment project
provided that:
 | 
|             (A) such costs are to be paid directly from the  | 
| special tax
allocation fund established pursuant to  | 
| this Act;
 | 
|             (B) such payments in any one year may not exceed  | 
| 30% of the annual
interest costs incurred by the  | 
| redeveloper with regard to the redevelopment
project  | 
| during that year;
 | 
|             (C) if there are not sufficient funds available in  | 
| the special tax
allocation fund to make the payment  | 
| pursuant to this paragraph (11) then
the amounts so due  | 
| shall accrue and be payable when sufficient funds are
 | 
| available in the special tax allocation fund;
 | 
|             (D) the total of such interest payments paid  | 
| pursuant to this Act
may not exceed 30% of the total  | 
| (i) cost paid or incurred by the
redeveloper for the  | 
| redevelopment project plus (ii) redevelopment project
 | 
| costs excluding any property assembly costs and any  | 
| relocation costs
incurred by a municipality pursuant  | 
| to this Act; and
 | 
|             (E) the cost limits set forth in subparagraphs (B)  | 
| and (D) of
paragraph (11) shall be modified for the  | 
| financing of rehabilitated or
new housing units for  | 
| low-income households and very low-income households,  | 
|  | 
| as
defined in
Section 3 of the Illinois Affordable  | 
| Housing Act.  The percentage of
75% shall be substituted  | 
| for 30% in subparagraphs (B) and (D) of
paragraph (11);  | 
| and.
 | 
|             (F) instead Instead of the eligible costs provided  | 
| by subparagraphs (B) and (D)
of
paragraph (11), as  | 
| modified by this subparagraph, and notwithstanding
any  | 
| other provisions of this Act to the contrary, the  | 
| municipality may
pay from tax increment revenues up to  | 
| 50% of the cost of construction
of new housing units to  | 
| be occupied by low-income households and very
 | 
| low-income
households as defined in Section 3 of the  | 
| Illinois Affordable Housing
Act.  The cost of  | 
| construction of those units may be derived from the
 | 
| proceeds of bonds issued by the municipality under this  | 
| Act or
other constitutional or statutory authority or  | 
| from other sources of
municipal revenue that may be  | 
| reimbursed from tax increment
revenues or the proceeds  | 
| of bonds issued to finance the construction
of that  | 
| housing.
 | 
|             The eligible costs provided under this  | 
| subparagraph (F) of paragraph (11)
shall
be
an eligible  | 
| cost for the construction, renovation, and  | 
| rehabilitation of all
low and very low-income housing  | 
| units, as defined in Section 3 of the Illinois
 | 
| Affordable Housing Act, within the redevelopment  | 
|  | 
| project area.  If the low and
very
low-income units are  | 
| part of a residential redevelopment project that  | 
| includes
units not affordable to low and very  | 
| low-income households, only the low and
very  | 
| low-income units shall be eligible for benefits under  | 
| this subparagraph (F) of
paragraph (11).
The standards  | 
| for maintaining the occupancy
by low-income households  | 
| and very low-income households,
as
defined in Section 3  | 
| of the Illinois Affordable Housing Act,
of those units  | 
| constructed with eligible costs made available under  | 
| the
provisions of
this subparagraph (F) of paragraph  | 
| (11)
shall be
established by guidelines adopted by the  | 
| municipality.  The
responsibility for annually  | 
| documenting the initial occupancy of
the units by  | 
| low-income households and very low-income households,  | 
| as defined
in
Section 3
of the Illinois Affordable  | 
| Housing Act, shall be that of the then current
owner of  | 
| the property.
For ownership units, the guidelines will  | 
| provide, at a minimum, for a
reasonable recapture of  | 
| funds, or other appropriate methods designed to
 | 
| preserve the original affordability of the ownership  | 
| units.  For rental units,
the guidelines will provide,  | 
| at a minimum, for the affordability of rent to low
and  | 
| very low-income households.  As units become available,  | 
| they shall be
rented to income-eligible tenants.
The  | 
| municipality may modify these
guidelines from time to  | 
|  | 
| time; the guidelines, however, shall be in effect
for  | 
| as long as tax increment revenue is being used to pay  | 
| for costs
associated with the units or for the  | 
| retirement of bonds issued to finance
the units or for  | 
| the life of the redevelopment project area, whichever  | 
| is
later;.
 | 
|         (11.5) If the redevelopment project area is located  | 
| within a municipality
with a population of more than  | 
| 100,000, the cost of day care services for
children of  | 
| employees from
low-income
families working for businesses  | 
| located within the redevelopment project area
and all or a
 | 
| portion of the cost of operation of day care centers  | 
| established by
redevelopment project
area businesses to  | 
| serve employees from low-income families working in
 | 
| businesses
located in the redevelopment project area.  For  | 
| the purposes of this paragraph,
"low-income families"  | 
| means families whose annual income does not exceed 80% of
 | 
| the
municipal, county, or regional median income, adjusted  | 
| for family size, as the
annual
income and municipal,  | 
| county, or regional median income are determined from
time  | 
| to
time by the United States Department of Housing and  | 
| Urban Development.
 | 
|     (12) Unless explicitly stated herein the cost of  | 
| construction of new
privately-owned buildings shall not be an  | 
| eligible redevelopment project cost.
 | 
|     (13) After November 1, 1999 (the effective date of Public  | 
|  | 
| Act
91-478), none of
the
redevelopment project costs enumerated  | 
| in this subsection shall be eligible
redevelopment project  | 
| costs if those costs would provide direct financial
support to  | 
| a
retail entity initiating operations in the
redevelopment  | 
| project area while
terminating operations at another Illinois  | 
| location within 10 miles of the
redevelopment project area but  | 
| outside the boundaries of the redevelopment
project area  | 
| municipality.  For
purposes of this paragraph, termination  | 
| means a
closing of a retail operation that is directly related  | 
| to the opening of the
same operation or like retail entity  | 
| owned or operated by more than 50% of the
original ownership in  | 
| a redevelopment project area, but
it does not mean
closing an  | 
| operation for reasons beyond the control of the
retail entity,  | 
| as
documented by the retail entity, subject to a reasonable  | 
| finding by the
municipality that the current location contained  | 
| inadequate space, had become
economically obsolete, or was no  | 
| longer a viable location for the retailer or
serviceman.
 | 
|     (14) No cost shall be a redevelopment project cost in a  | 
| redevelopment project area if used to demolish, remove, or  | 
| substantially modify a historic resource, after August 26, 2008  | 
| (the effective date of Public Act 95-934), unless no prudent  | 
| and feasible alternative exists. "Historic resource" for the  | 
| purpose of this paragraph item (14)  means (i) a place or  | 
| structure that is included or eligible for inclusion on the  | 
| National Register of Historic Places or (ii) a contributing  | 
| structure in a district on the National Register of Historic  | 
|  | 
| Places. This paragraph item (14) does not apply to a place or  | 
| structure for which demolition, removal, or modification is  | 
| subject to review by the preservation agency of a Certified  | 
| Local Government designated as such by the National Park  | 
| Service of the United States Department of the Interior. | 
|     If a special service area has been established pursuant to
 | 
| the Special Service Area Tax Act or Special Service Area Tax  | 
| Law, then any
tax increment revenues derived
from the tax  | 
| imposed pursuant to the Special Service Area Tax Act or Special
 | 
| Service Area Tax Law may
be used within the redevelopment  | 
| project area for the purposes permitted by
that Act or Law as  | 
| well as the purposes permitted by this Act.
 | 
|     (q-1) For redevelopment project areas created pursuant to  | 
| subsection (p-1), redevelopment project costs are limited to  | 
| those costs in paragraph (q) that are related to the existing  | 
| or proposed Regional Transportation Authority Suburban Transit  | 
| Access Route (STAR Line) station.  | 
|     (q-2) For a redevelopment project area located within a  | 
| transit facility improvement area established pursuant to  | 
| Section 11-74.4-3.3, redevelopment project costs means those  | 
| costs described in subsection (q) that are related to the  | 
| construction, reconstruction, rehabilitation, remodeling, or  | 
| repair of any existing or proposed transit facility.  | 
|     (r) "State Sales Tax Boundary" means the redevelopment  | 
| project area or
the amended redevelopment project area  | 
| boundaries which are determined
pursuant to subsection (9) of  | 
|  | 
| Section 11-74.4-8a of this
Act.  The Department of Revenue shall  | 
| certify pursuant to subsection (9) of
Section 11-74.4-8a the  | 
| appropriate boundaries eligible for the
determination of State  | 
| Sales Tax Increment.
 | 
|     (s) "State Sales Tax Increment" means an amount equal to  | 
| the increase
in the aggregate amount of taxes paid by retailers  | 
| and servicemen, other
than retailers and servicemen subject to  | 
| the Public Utilities Act,
on transactions at places of business  | 
| located within a State Sales Tax
Boundary pursuant to the  | 
| Retailers' Occupation Tax Act, the Use Tax Act,
the Service Use  | 
| Tax Act, and the Service Occupation Tax Act, except such
 | 
| portion of such increase that is paid into the State and Local  | 
| Sales Tax
Reform Fund, the Local  Government  Distributive  Fund,  | 
| the  Local
Government Tax Fund and the County and Mass Transit  | 
| District Fund, for as
long as State participation exists, over  | 
| and above the Initial Sales Tax
Amounts, Adjusted Initial Sales  | 
| Tax Amounts or the Revised Initial Sales
Tax Amounts for such  | 
| taxes as certified by the Department of Revenue and
paid under  | 
| those Acts by retailers and servicemen on transactions at  | 
| places
of business located within the State Sales Tax Boundary  | 
| during the base
year which shall be the calendar year  | 
| immediately prior to the year in
which the municipality adopted  | 
| tax increment allocation financing, less
3.0% of such amounts  | 
| generated under the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act, Use
Tax Act  | 
| and Service Use Tax Act and the Service Occupation Tax Act,  | 
| which
sum shall be appropriated to the Department of Revenue to  | 
|  | 
| cover its costs
of administering and enforcing this Section.  | 
| For purposes of computing the
aggregate amount of such taxes  | 
| for base years occurring prior to 1985, the
Department of  | 
| Revenue shall compute the Initial Sales Tax Amount for such
 | 
| taxes and deduct therefrom an amount equal to 4% of the  | 
| aggregate amount of
taxes per year for each year the base year  | 
| is prior to 1985, but not to
exceed a total deduction of 12%.   | 
| The amount so determined shall be known
as the "Adjusted  | 
| Initial Sales Tax Amount". For purposes of determining the
 | 
| State Sales Tax Increment the Department of Revenue shall for  | 
| each period
subtract from the tax amounts received from  | 
| retailers and servicemen on
transactions located in the State  | 
| Sales Tax Boundary, the certified Initial
Sales Tax Amounts,  | 
| Adjusted Initial Sales Tax Amounts or Revised Initial
Sales Tax  | 
| Amounts for the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act, the Use Tax Act,
 | 
| the Service Use Tax Act and the Service Occupation Tax Act.  For  | 
| the State
Fiscal Year 1989 this calculation shall be made by  | 
| utilizing the calendar
year 1987 to determine the tax amounts  | 
| received. For the State Fiscal Year
1990, this calculation  | 
| shall be made by utilizing the period from January
1, 1988,  | 
| until September 30, 1988, to determine the tax amounts received
 | 
| from retailers and servicemen, which shall have deducted  | 
| therefrom
nine-twelfths of the certified Initial Sales Tax  | 
| Amounts, Adjusted Initial
Sales Tax Amounts or the Revised  | 
| Initial Sales Tax Amounts as appropriate.
For the State Fiscal  | 
| Year 1991, this calculation shall be made by utilizing
the  | 
|  | 
| period from October 1, 1988, until June 30, 1989, to determine  | 
| the tax
amounts received from retailers and servicemen, which  | 
| shall have
deducted therefrom nine-twelfths of the certified  | 
| Initial State Sales Tax
Amounts, Adjusted Initial Sales Tax  | 
| Amounts or the Revised Initial Sales
Tax Amounts as  | 
| appropriate. For every State Fiscal Year thereafter, the
 | 
| applicable period shall be the 12 months beginning July 1 and  | 
| ending on
June 30, to determine the tax amounts received which  | 
| shall have deducted
therefrom the certified Initial Sales Tax  | 
| Amounts, Adjusted Initial Sales
Tax Amounts or the Revised  | 
| Initial Sales Tax Amounts.  Municipalities
intending to receive  | 
| a distribution of State Sales Tax Increment must
report a list  | 
| of retailers to the Department of Revenue by October 31, 1988
 | 
| and by July 31, of each year thereafter.
 | 
|     (t) "Taxing districts" means counties, townships, cities  | 
| and incorporated
towns and villages, school, road, park,  | 
| sanitary, mosquito abatement, forest
preserve, public health,  | 
| fire protection, river conservancy, tuberculosis
sanitarium  | 
| and any other municipal corporations or districts with the  | 
| power
to levy taxes.
 | 
|     (u) "Taxing districts' capital costs" means those costs of  | 
| taxing districts
for capital improvements that are found by the  | 
| municipal corporate authorities
to be necessary and directly  | 
| result from the redevelopment project.
 | 
|     (v) As used in subsection (a) of Section 11-74.4-3 of this
 | 
| Act, "vacant
land" means any  parcel or combination of parcels  | 
|  | 
| of real property without
industrial, commercial, and  | 
| residential buildings which has not been used
for commercial  | 
| agricultural purposes within 5 years prior to the
designation  | 
| of the redevelopment project area, unless the parcel
is  | 
| included in an industrial park conservation area or the parcel  | 
| has
been subdivided; provided that if the parcel was part of a  | 
| larger tract that
has been divided into 3 or more smaller  | 
| tracts that were accepted for
recording during the period from  | 
| 1950 to 1990, then the parcel shall be deemed
to have been  | 
| subdivided, and all proceedings and actions of the municipality
 | 
| taken in that connection with respect to any previously  | 
| approved or designated
redevelopment project area or amended  | 
| redevelopment project area are hereby
validated and hereby  | 
| declared to be legally sufficient for all purposes of this
Act.
 | 
| For purposes of this Section and only for land subject to
the  | 
| subdivision requirements of the Plat Act, land is subdivided  | 
| when the
original plat of
the proposed Redevelopment Project  | 
| Area or relevant portion thereof has
been
properly certified,  | 
| acknowledged, approved, and recorded or filed in accordance
 | 
| with the Plat Act and a preliminary plat, if any, for any  | 
| subsequent phases of
the
proposed Redevelopment Project Area or  | 
| relevant portion thereof has been
properly approved and filed  | 
| in accordance with the applicable ordinance of the
 | 
| municipality.
 | 
|     (w) "Annual Total Increment" means the sum of each  | 
| municipality's
annual Net Sales Tax Increment and each  | 
|  | 
| municipality's annual Net Utility
Tax Increment.  The ratio of  | 
| the Annual Total Increment of each
municipality to the Annual  | 
| Total Increment for all municipalities, as most
recently  | 
| calculated by the Department, shall determine the proportional
 | 
| shares of the Illinois Tax Increment Fund to be distributed to  | 
| each
municipality.
 | 
|     (x) "LEED certified" means any certification level of  | 
| construction elements by a qualified Leadership in Energy and  | 
| Environmental Design Accredited Professional as determined by  | 
| the U.S. Green Building Council. | 
|     (y)  "Green Globes certified" means any certification level  | 
| of construction elements by a qualified Green Globes  | 
| Professional as determined by the Green Building Initiative. | 
| (Source: P.A. 99-792, eff. 8-12-16; revised 10-31-16.)
 
 | 
|     (65 ILCS 5/11-74.4-8)
  (from Ch. 24, par. 11-74.4-8)
 | 
|     Sec. 11-74.4-8. Tax increment allocation financing.  A  | 
| municipality may
not adopt tax increment financing in a
 | 
| redevelopment
project area after the effective date of this  | 
| amendatory Act of 1997 that will
encompass an area that is  | 
| currently included in an enterprise zone created
under the  | 
| Illinois Enterprise Zone Act unless that municipality,  | 
| pursuant to
Section 5.4 of the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act,  | 
| amends the enterprise zone
designating ordinance to limit the  | 
| eligibility for tax abatements as provided
in Section 5.4.1 of  | 
| the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act.
A municipality, at the time a  | 
|  | 
| redevelopment project area
is designated, may adopt tax  | 
| increment allocation financing by passing an
ordinance  | 
| providing that the ad valorem taxes, if any, arising from the
 | 
| levies upon taxable real property in such redevelopment project
 | 
| area by taxing districts and tax rates determined in the manner  | 
| provided
in paragraph (c) of Section 11-74.4-9 each year after  | 
| the effective
date of the ordinance until redevelopment project  | 
| costs and all municipal
obligations financing redevelopment  | 
| project costs incurred under this Division
have been paid shall  | 
| be divided as follows, provided, however, that with respect to  | 
| any redevelopment project area located within a transit  | 
| facility improvement area established pursuant to Section  | 
| 11-74.4-3.3 in a municipality with a population of 1,000,000 or  | 
| more, ad valorem taxes, if any, arising from the levies upon  | 
| taxable real property in such redevelopment project area shall  | 
| be allocated as specifically provided in this Section:
 | 
|         (a) That portion of taxes levied upon each taxable lot,  | 
| block, tract or
parcel of real property which is  | 
| attributable to the lower of the current
equalized assessed  | 
| value or the initial equalized assessed
value of each such  | 
| taxable lot, block, tract or parcel of real property
in the  | 
| redevelopment project area shall be allocated to and when  | 
| collected
shall be paid by the county collector to the  | 
| respective affected taxing
districts in the manner  | 
| required by law in the absence of the adoption of
tax  | 
| increment allocation financing.
 | 
|  | 
|         (b) Except from a tax levied by a township to retire  | 
| bonds issued to satisfy
court-ordered damages, that  | 
| portion, if any, of such taxes which is
attributable to the
 | 
| increase in the current equalized assessed valuation of  | 
| each taxable lot,
block, tract or parcel of real property  | 
| in the redevelopment project area
over and above the  | 
| initial equalized assessed value of each property in the
 | 
| project area shall be allocated to and when collected shall  | 
| be paid to the
municipal treasurer who shall deposit said  | 
| taxes into a special fund called
the special tax allocation  | 
| fund of the municipality for the purpose of
paying  | 
| redevelopment project costs and obligations incurred in  | 
| the payment
thereof. In any county with a population of  | 
| 3,000,000 or more that has adopted
a procedure for  | 
| collecting taxes that provides for one or more of the
 | 
| installments of the taxes to be billed and collected on an  | 
| estimated basis,
the municipal treasurer shall be paid for  | 
| deposit in the special tax
allocation fund of the  | 
| municipality, from the taxes collected from
estimated  | 
| bills issued for property in the redevelopment project  | 
| area, the
difference between the amount actually collected  | 
| from each taxable lot,
block, tract, or parcel of real  | 
| property within the redevelopment project
area and an  | 
| amount determined by multiplying the rate at which taxes  | 
| were
last extended against the taxable lot, block, track,  | 
| or parcel of real
property in the manner provided in  | 
|  | 
| subsection (c) of Section 11-74.4-9 by
the initial  | 
| equalized assessed value of the property divided by the  | 
| number
of installments in which real estate taxes are  | 
| billed and collected within
the county; provided that the  | 
| payments on or before December 31,
1999 to a municipal  | 
| treasurer shall be made only if each of the following
 | 
| conditions are met:
 | 
|         (1) The total equalized assessed value of the  | 
| redevelopment project
area as last determined was not  | 
| less than 175% of the total initial
equalized assessed  | 
| value.
 | 
|         (2) Not more than 50% of the total equalized assessed  | 
| value of the
redevelopment project area as last  | 
| determined is attributable to a piece of
property  | 
| assigned a single real estate index number.
 | 
|         (3) The municipal clerk has certified to the county  | 
| clerk that the
municipality has issued its obligations  | 
| to which there has been pledged
the incremental  | 
| property taxes of the redevelopment project area or  | 
| taxes
levied and collected on any or all property in  | 
| the municipality or
the full faith and credit of the  | 
| municipality to pay or secure payment for
all or a  | 
| portion of the redevelopment project costs. The  | 
| certification
shall be filed annually no later than  | 
| September 1 for the estimated taxes
to be distributed  | 
| in the following year; however, for the year 1992 the
 | 
|  | 
| certification shall be made at any time on or before  | 
| March 31, 1992.
 | 
|         (4) The municipality has not requested that the total  | 
| initial
equalized assessed value of real property be  | 
| adjusted as provided in
subsection (b) of Section  | 
| 11-74.4-9.
 | 
|         The conditions of paragraphs (1) through (4) do not  | 
| apply after December
31, 1999 to payments to a municipal  | 
| treasurer
made by a county with 3,000,000 or more  | 
| inhabitants that has adopted an
estimated billing  | 
| procedure for collecting taxes.
If a county that has  | 
| adopted the estimated billing
procedure makes an erroneous  | 
| overpayment of tax revenue to the municipal
treasurer, then  | 
| the county may seek a refund of that overpayment.
The  | 
| county shall send the municipal treasurer a notice of  | 
| liability for the
overpayment on or before the mailing date  | 
| of the next real estate tax bill
within the county.  The  | 
| refund shall be limited to the amount of the
overpayment.
 | 
|         It is the intent of this Division that after the  | 
| effective date of this
amendatory Act of 1988 a  | 
| municipality's own ad valorem
tax arising from levies on  | 
| taxable real property be included in the
determination of  | 
| incremental revenue in the manner provided in paragraph
(c)  | 
| of Section 11-74.4-9. If the municipality does not extend  | 
| such a tax,
it shall annually deposit in the municipality's  | 
| Special Tax Increment Fund
an amount equal to 10% of the  | 
|  | 
| total contributions to the fund from all
other taxing  | 
| districts in that year.  The annual 10% deposit required by
 | 
| this paragraph shall be limited to the actual amount of  | 
| municipally
produced incremental tax revenues available to  | 
| the municipality from
taxpayers located in the  | 
| redevelopment project area in that year if:
(a) the plan  | 
| for the area restricts the use of the property primarily to
 | 
| industrial purposes, (b) the municipality establishing the  | 
| redevelopment
project area is a home-rule community with a  | 
| 1990 population of between
25,000 and 50,000, (c) the  | 
| municipality is wholly located within a county
with a 1990  | 
| population of over 750,000 and (d) the redevelopment  | 
| project
area was established by the municipality prior to  | 
| June 1, 1990.  This
payment shall be in lieu of a  | 
| contribution of ad valorem taxes on real
property. If no  | 
| such payment is made, any redevelopment project area of the
 | 
| municipality shall be dissolved.
 | 
|         If a municipality has adopted tax increment allocation  | 
| financing by ordinance
and the County Clerk thereafter  | 
| certifies the "total initial equalized assessed
value as  | 
| adjusted" of the taxable real property within such  | 
| redevelopment
project area in the manner provided in  | 
| paragraph (b) of Section 11-74.4-9,
each year after the  | 
| date of the certification of the total initial equalized
 | 
| assessed value as adjusted until redevelopment project  | 
| costs and all
municipal obligations financing  | 
|  | 
| redevelopment project costs have been paid
the ad valorem  | 
| taxes, if any, arising from the levies upon the taxable  | 
| real
property in such redevelopment project area by taxing  | 
| districts and tax
rates determined in the manner provided  | 
| in paragraph (c) of Section
11-74.4-9 shall be divided as  | 
| follows, provided, however, that with respect to any  | 
| redevelopment project area located within a transit  | 
| facility improvement area established pursuant to Section  | 
| 11-74.4-3.3 in a municipality with a population of  | 
| 1,000,000 or more, ad valorem taxes, if any, arising from  | 
| the levies upon the taxable real property in such  | 
| redevelopment project area shall be allocated as  | 
| specifically provided in this Section:
 | 
|         (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable  | 
| lot, block, tract
or parcel of real property which is  | 
| attributable to the lower of the
current equalized  | 
| assessed value or "current equalized assessed value as
 | 
| adjusted" or the initial equalized assessed value of  | 
| each such taxable lot,
block, tract, or parcel of real  | 
| property existing at the time tax increment
financing  | 
| was adopted, minus the total current homestead  | 
| exemptions under Article 15 of the Property
Tax Code in  | 
| the
redevelopment project area shall be allocated to  | 
| and when collected shall be
paid by the county  | 
| collector to the respective affected taxing districts  | 
| in the
manner required by law in the absence of the  | 
|  | 
| adoption of tax increment
allocation financing.
 | 
|         (2) That portion, if any, of such taxes which is  | 
| attributable to the
increase in the current equalized  | 
| assessed valuation of each taxable lot,
block, tract,  | 
| or parcel of real property in the redevelopment project  | 
| area,
over and above the initial equalized assessed  | 
| value of each property
existing at the time tax  | 
| increment financing was adopted, minus the total
 | 
| current homestead exemptions pertaining to each piece  | 
| of property provided
by Article 15 of the Property Tax  | 
| Code
in the redevelopment
project area, shall be  | 
| allocated to and when collected shall be paid to the
 | 
| municipal Treasurer, who shall deposit said taxes into  | 
| a special fund called
the special tax allocation fund  | 
| of the municipality for the purpose of paying
 | 
| redevelopment project costs and obligations incurred  | 
| in the payment thereof.
 | 
|         The municipality may pledge in the ordinance the funds  | 
| in and to be
deposited in the special tax allocation fund  | 
| for the payment of such costs
and obligations.  No part of  | 
| the current equalized assessed valuation of
each property  | 
| in the redevelopment project area attributable to any
 | 
| increase above the total initial equalized assessed value,  | 
| or the total
initial equalized assessed value as adjusted,  | 
| of such properties shall be
used in calculating the general  | 
| State school aid formula, provided for in
Section 18-8 of  | 
|  | 
| the School Code, or the evidence-based funding formula,  | 
| provided for in Section 18-8.15 of the School Code, until  | 
| such time as all redevelopment
project costs have been paid  | 
| as provided for in this Section.
 | 
|         Whenever a municipality issues bonds for the purpose of  | 
| financing
redevelopment project costs, such municipality  | 
| may provide by ordinance for the
appointment of a trustee,  | 
| which may be any trust company within the State,
and for  | 
| the establishment of such funds or accounts to be  | 
| maintained by
such trustee as the municipality shall deem  | 
| necessary to provide for the
security and payment of the  | 
| bonds.  If such municipality provides for
the appointment of  | 
| a trustee, such trustee shall be considered the assignee
of  | 
| any payments assigned by the municipality pursuant to such  | 
| ordinance
and this Section.  Any amounts paid to such  | 
| trustee as assignee shall be
deposited in the funds or  | 
| accounts established pursuant to such trust
agreement, and  | 
| shall be held by such trustee in trust for the benefit of  | 
| the
holders of the bonds, and such holders shall have a  | 
| lien on and a security
interest in such funds or accounts  | 
| so long as the bonds remain outstanding and
unpaid. Upon  | 
| retirement of the bonds, the trustee shall pay over any  | 
| excess
amounts held to the municipality for deposit in the  | 
| special tax allocation
fund.
 | 
|         When such redevelopment projects costs, including  | 
| without limitation all
municipal obligations financing  | 
|  | 
| redevelopment project costs incurred under
this Division,  | 
| have been paid, all surplus funds then remaining in the
 | 
| special tax allocation fund shall be distributed
by being  | 
| paid by the
municipal treasurer to the Department of  | 
| Revenue, the municipality and the
county collector; first  | 
| to the Department of Revenue and the municipality
in direct  | 
| proportion to the tax incremental revenue received from the  | 
| State
and the municipality, but not to exceed the total  | 
| incremental revenue received
from the State or the  | 
| municipality less any annual surplus distribution
of  | 
| incremental revenue previously made; with any remaining  | 
| funds to be paid
to the County Collector who shall  | 
| immediately thereafter pay said funds to
the taxing  | 
| districts in the redevelopment project area in the same  | 
| manner
and proportion as the most recent distribution by  | 
| the county collector to
the affected districts of real  | 
| property taxes from real property in the
redevelopment  | 
| project area.
 | 
|         Upon the payment of all redevelopment project costs,  | 
| the retirement of
obligations, the distribution of any  | 
| excess monies pursuant to this
Section, and final closing  | 
| of the books and records of the redevelopment
project
area,  | 
| the municipality shall adopt an ordinance dissolving the  | 
| special
tax allocation fund for the redevelopment project  | 
| area and terminating the
designation of the redevelopment  | 
| project area as a redevelopment project
area.
Title to real  | 
|  | 
| or personal property and public improvements
acquired
by or  | 
| for
the
municipality as a result of the redevelopment  | 
| project and plan shall vest in
the
municipality when  | 
| acquired and shall continue to be held by the municipality
 | 
| after the redevelopment project area has been terminated.
 | 
| Municipalities shall notify affected taxing districts  | 
| prior to
November 1 if the redevelopment project area is to  | 
| be terminated by December 31
of
that same year.  If a  | 
| municipality extends estimated dates of completion of a
 | 
| redevelopment project and retirement of obligations to  | 
| finance a
redevelopment project, as allowed by this  | 
| amendatory Act of 1993, that
extension shall not extend the  | 
| property tax increment allocation financing
authorized by  | 
| this Section.  Thereafter the rates of the taxing districts
 | 
| shall be extended and taxes levied, collected and  | 
| distributed in the manner
applicable in the absence of the  | 
| adoption of tax increment allocation
financing.
 | 
|         If a municipality with a population of 1,000,000 or  | 
| more has adopted by ordinance tax increment allocation  | 
| financing for a redevelopment project area located in a  | 
| transit facility improvement area established pursuant to  | 
| Section 11-74.4-3.3, for each year after the effective date  | 
| of the ordinance until redevelopment project costs and all  | 
| municipal obligations financing redevelopment project  | 
| costs have been paid, the ad valorem taxes, if any, arising  | 
| from the levies upon the taxable real property in that  | 
|  | 
| redevelopment project area by taxing districts and tax  | 
| rates determined in the manner provided in paragraph (c) of  | 
| Section 11-74.4-9 shall be divided as follows: | 
|             (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each  | 
| taxable lot, block, tract or parcel of real property  | 
| which is attributable to the lower of (i) the current  | 
| equalized assessed value or "current equalized  | 
| assessed value as adjusted" or (ii) the initial  | 
| equalized assessed value of each such taxable lot,  | 
| block, tract, or parcel of real property existing at  | 
| the time tax increment financing was adopted, minus the  | 
| total current homestead exemptions under Article 15 of  | 
| the Property Tax Code in the redevelopment project area  | 
| shall be allocated to and when collected shall be paid  | 
| by the county collector to the respective affected  | 
| taxing districts in the manner required by law in the  | 
| absence of the adoption of tax increment allocation  | 
| financing. | 
|             (2) That portion, if any, of such taxes which is  | 
| attributable to the increase in the current equalized  | 
| assessed valuation of each taxable lot, block, tract,  | 
| or parcel of real property in the redevelopment project  | 
| area, over and above the initial equalized assessed  | 
| value of each property existing at the time tax  | 
| increment financing was adopted, minus the total  | 
| current homestead exemptions pertaining to each piece  | 
|  | 
| of property provided by Article 15 of the Property Tax  | 
| Code in the redevelopment project area, shall be  | 
| allocated to and when collected shall be paid by the  | 
| county collector as follows: | 
|                 (A) First, that portion which would be payable  | 
| to a school district whose boundaries are  | 
| coterminous with such municipality in the absence  | 
| of the adoption of tax increment allocation  | 
| financing, shall be paid to such school district in  | 
| the manner required by law in the absence of the  | 
| adoption of tax increment allocation financing;  | 
| then | 
|                 (B) 80% of the remaining portion shall be paid  | 
| to the municipal Treasurer, who shall deposit said  | 
| taxes into a special fund called the special tax  | 
| allocation fund of the municipality for the  | 
| purpose of paying redevelopment project costs and  | 
| obligations incurred in the payment thereof; and  | 
| then | 
|                 (C) 20% of the remaining portion shall be paid  | 
| to the respective affected taxing districts, other  | 
| than the school district described in clause (a)  | 
| above, in the manner required by law in the absence  | 
| of the adoption of tax increment allocation  | 
| financing.  | 
|     Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving  | 
|  | 
| property in such
redevelopment project areas from being  | 
| assessed as provided in the Property
Tax Code or as relieving  | 
| owners of such property from paying a uniform rate of
taxes, as  | 
| required by Section 4 of Article IX of the Illinois  | 
| Constitution.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13; 99-792, eff. 8-12-16.)
 
 | 
|     (65 ILCS 5/11-74.6-35)
 | 
|     Sec. 11-74.6-35. Ordinance for tax increment allocation  | 
| financing. 
 | 
|     (a) A municipality, at the time a redevelopment project  | 
| area
is designated, may adopt tax increment allocation  | 
| financing by passing an
ordinance providing that the ad valorem  | 
| taxes, if any, arising from the
levies upon taxable real  | 
| property within the redevelopment project
area by taxing  | 
| districts and tax rates determined in the manner provided
in  | 
| subsection (b) of Section 11-74.6-40 each year after the  | 
| effective
date of the ordinance until redevelopment project  | 
| costs and all municipal
obligations financing redevelopment  | 
| project costs incurred under this Act
have been paid shall be  | 
| divided as follows:
 | 
|         (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable  | 
| lot, block,
tract or parcel of real property that is  | 
| attributable to the lower of the
current equalized assessed  | 
| value or the initial equalized assessed value or the
 | 
| updated initial equalized assessed value of
each taxable  | 
|  | 
| lot, block, tract or parcel of real property in the
 | 
| redevelopment project area shall be allocated to and when  | 
| collected shall
be paid by the county collector to the  | 
| respective affected taxing districts
in the manner  | 
| required by law without regard to the adoption of tax
 | 
| increment allocation financing.
 | 
|         (2) That portion, if any, of those taxes that is  | 
| attributable to the
increase in the current equalized  | 
| assessed value of each taxable lot,
block, tract or parcel  | 
| of real property in the redevelopment project area,
over  | 
| and above the initial equalized assessed value or the  | 
| updated initial
equalized assessed value of each property  | 
| in the
project area, shall be allocated to and when  | 
| collected shall be paid by the
county collector to the  | 
| municipal treasurer who shall deposit that portion
of those  | 
| taxes into a special fund called the special tax allocation  | 
| fund
of the municipality for the purpose of paying  | 
| redevelopment project costs
and obligations incurred in  | 
| the payment of those costs and obligations.
In any county  | 
| with a population of 3,000,000 or more that has adopted
a  | 
| procedure for collecting taxes that provides for one or  | 
| more of the
installments of the taxes to be billed and  | 
| collected on an estimated basis,
the municipal treasurer  | 
| shall be paid for deposit in the special tax
allocation  | 
| fund of the municipality, from the taxes collected from
 | 
| estimated bills issued for property in the redevelopment  | 
|  | 
| project area, the
difference between the amount actually  | 
| collected from each taxable lot,
block, tract, or parcel of  | 
| real property within the redevelopment project
area and an  | 
| amount determined by multiplying the rate at which taxes  | 
| were
last extended against the taxable lot, block, track,  | 
| or parcel of real
property in the manner provided in  | 
| subsection (b) of Section 11-74.6-40 by
the initial  | 
| equalized assessed value or the updated initial equalized  | 
| assessed
value of the property divided by the number
of  | 
| installments in which real estate taxes are billed and  | 
| collected within
the county, provided that the payments on  | 
| or before December 31, 1999 to a
municipal treasurer shall  | 
| be made only if each of the following conditions
are met:
 | 
|             (A) The total equalized assessed value of the  | 
| redevelopment project
area as last determined was not  | 
| less than 175% of the total initial
equalized assessed  | 
| value.
 | 
|             (B) Not more than 50% of the total equalized  | 
| assessed value of the
redevelopment project area as  | 
| last determined is attributable to a piece of
property  | 
| assigned a single real estate index number.
 | 
|             (C) The municipal clerk has certified to the county  | 
| clerk that the
municipality has issued its obligations  | 
| to which there has been pledged
the incremental  | 
| property taxes of the redevelopment project area or  | 
| taxes
levied and collected on any or all property in  | 
|  | 
| the municipality or
the full faith and credit of the  | 
| municipality to pay or secure payment for
all or a  | 
| portion of the redevelopment project costs. The  | 
| certification
shall be filed annually no later than  | 
| September 1 for the estimated taxes
to be distributed  | 
| in the following year.
 | 
|     The conditions of paragraphs (A) through (C) do not apply  | 
| after December
31, 1999 to payments to a municipal treasurer
 | 
| made by a county with 3,000,000 or more inhabitants that has  | 
| adopted an
estimated billing procedure for collecting taxes.
If  | 
| a county that has adopted the estimated billing
procedure makes  | 
| an erroneous overpayment of tax revenue to the municipal
 | 
| treasurer, then the county may seek a refund of that  | 
| overpayment.
The county shall send the municipal treasurer a  | 
| notice of liability for the
overpayment on or before the  | 
| mailing date of the next real estate tax bill
within the  | 
| county.  The refund shall be limited to the amount of the
 | 
| overpayment.
 | 
|     (b) It is the intent of this Act that a municipality's own  | 
| ad valorem
tax arising from levies on taxable real property be  | 
| included in the
determination of incremental revenue in the  | 
| manner provided in paragraph
(b) of Section 11-74.6-40.
 | 
|     (c) If a municipality has adopted tax increment allocation  | 
| financing for a
redevelopment project area by
ordinance and the  | 
| county clerk thereafter certifies the total initial
equalized  | 
| assessed value or the total updated initial equalized
assessed  | 
|  | 
| value of the taxable real property within such redevelopment
 | 
| project area in the manner provided in paragraph (a) or (b) of  | 
| Section
11-74.6-40, each year after the date of the  | 
| certification of the total
initial equalized assessed value or  | 
| the total updated initial
equalized assessed value until  | 
| redevelopment project costs and all
municipal obligations  | 
| financing redevelopment project costs have been paid,
the ad  | 
| valorem taxes, if any, arising from the levies upon the taxable  | 
| real
property in the redevelopment project area by taxing  | 
| districts and tax
rates determined in the manner provided in  | 
| paragraph (b) of Section
11-74.6-40 shall be divided as  | 
| follows:
 | 
|         (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable  | 
| lot, block, tract
or parcel of real property that is  | 
| attributable to the lower of the
current equalized assessed  | 
| value or the initial equalized assessed value, or
the  | 
| updated initial equalized assessed value of each parcel if  | 
| the updated
initial equalized assessed value of that parcel  | 
| has been certified in
accordance with Section 11-74.6-40,  | 
| whichever has been most
recently certified, of each taxable  | 
| lot, block, tract, or parcel of real
property existing at  | 
| the time tax increment allocation financing was
adopted in  | 
| the redevelopment project area, shall be allocated to and  | 
| when
collected shall be paid by the county collector to the  | 
| respective affected
taxing districts in the manner  | 
| required by law without regard to the adoption
of tax  | 
|  | 
| increment allocation financing.
 | 
|         (2) That portion, if any, of those taxes that is  | 
| attributable to the
increase in the current equalized  | 
| assessed value of each taxable lot,
block, tract, or parcel  | 
| of real property in the redevelopment project area,
over  | 
| and above the initial equalized assessed value of each  | 
| property
existing at the time tax increment allocation  | 
| financing was adopted
in the redevelopment project area, or
 | 
| the updated initial equalized assessed value of each parcel  | 
| if the updated
initial equalized assessed value of that  | 
| parcel has been certified in
accordance with Section  | 
| 11-74.6-40, shall be allocated to and when collected
shall  | 
| be paid to the municipal treasurer, who shall deposit those  | 
| taxes
into a special fund called the special tax allocation  | 
| fund of the
municipality for the purpose of paying  | 
| redevelopment project costs and
obligations incurred in  | 
| the payment thereof.
 | 
|     (d) The municipality may pledge in the ordinance the funds  | 
| in and to be
deposited in the special tax allocation fund for  | 
| the payment of
redevelopment project costs and obligations.  No  | 
| part of the current
equalized assessed value of each property  | 
| in the redevelopment project
area attributable to any increase  | 
| above the total initial equalized
assessed value
or the total  | 
| initial updated equalized assessed value of the property,
shall  | 
| be used in calculating the general General State aid formula  | 
| School Aid Formula, provided
for in Section 18-8 of the School  | 
|  | 
| Code, or the evidence-based funding formula, provided for in  | 
| Section 18-8.15 of the School Code, until all redevelopment  | 
| project
costs have been paid as provided for in this Section.
 | 
|     Whenever a municipality issues bonds for the purpose of  | 
| financing
redevelopment project costs, that municipality may  | 
| provide by ordinance for the
appointment of a trustee, which  | 
| may be any trust company within the State,
and for the  | 
| establishment of any funds or accounts to be maintained by
that  | 
| trustee, as the municipality deems necessary to provide for the
 | 
| security and payment of the bonds.  If the municipality provides  | 
| for
the appointment of a trustee, the trustee shall be  | 
| considered the assignee
of any payments assigned by the  | 
| municipality under that ordinance
and this Section.  Any amounts  | 
| paid to the trustee as
assignee shall be deposited into the  | 
| funds or accounts established
under the trust agreement, and  | 
| shall be held by the trustee in trust for the
benefit of the  | 
| holders of the bonds.  The holders of those bonds shall have a
 | 
| lien on and a security interest in those funds or accounts  | 
| while the
bonds remain outstanding and unpaid. Upon retirement  | 
| of the bonds,
the trustee shall pay over any excess amounts  | 
| held to the municipality for
deposit in the special tax  | 
| allocation fund. 
 | 
|     When the redevelopment projects costs, including without  | 
| limitation all
municipal obligations financing redevelopment  | 
| project costs incurred under
this Law, have been paid, all  | 
| surplus funds then remaining in the
special tax allocation fund  | 
|  | 
| shall be distributed by being paid by the
municipal treasurer  | 
| to the municipality and the county collector; first to
the  | 
| municipality in direct proportion to the tax incremental  | 
| revenue
received from the municipality, but not to exceed the  | 
| total incremental
revenue received from the municipality,  | 
| minus any annual surplus
distribution of incremental revenue  | 
| previously made.  Any remaining funds
shall be paid to the  | 
| county collector who shall immediately distribute that
payment  | 
| to the taxing districts in the redevelopment project area in  | 
| the
same manner and proportion as the most recent distribution  | 
| by the county
collector to the affected districts of real  | 
| property taxes from real
property situated in the redevelopment  | 
| project area.
 | 
|     Upon the payment of all redevelopment project costs,  | 
| retirement of
obligations and the distribution of any excess  | 
| moneys under this
Section, the municipality shall adopt an  | 
| ordinance dissolving the special
tax allocation fund for the  | 
| redevelopment project area and terminating the
designation of  | 
| the redevelopment project area as a redevelopment project
area.   | 
| Thereafter the tax levies of taxing districts shall be  | 
| extended,
collected and distributed in the same manner  | 
| applicable
before the adoption of tax increment allocation  | 
| financing.
Municipality shall notify affected taxing districts  | 
| prior to November if the
redevelopment project area is to be  | 
| terminated by December 31 of that same
year.
 | 
|     Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving  | 
|  | 
| property in a
redevelopment project area from being assessed as  | 
| provided in the Property
Tax Code or as relieving owners of  | 
| that property
from paying a uniform rate of taxes, as required  | 
| by Section 4 of Article IX
of the Illinois Constitution.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 91-474, eff. 11-1-99.)
 | 
|     Section 960. The Economic Development Project Area Tax  | 
| Increment Allocation Act of
1995 is amended  by changing Section  | 
| 50 as follows:
 
 | 
|     (65 ILCS 110/50)
 | 
|     Sec. 50. Special tax allocation fund. 
 | 
|     (a) If a county clerk has certified the "total initial  | 
| equalized assessed
value" of the taxable real property within  | 
| an economic development project area
in the manner provided in  | 
| Section 45, each year after the date of the
certification by  | 
| the county clerk of the "total initial equalized assessed
 | 
| value", until economic development project costs and all  | 
| municipal obligations
financing economic development project  | 
| costs have been paid, the ad valorem
taxes, if any, arising  | 
| from the levies upon the taxable real property in the
economic  | 
| development project area by taxing districts and tax rates  | 
| determined
in the manner provided in subsection (b) of Section  | 
| 45 shall be divided as
follows:
 | 
|         (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable
 | 
| lot, block, tract, or parcel of real property that is  | 
|  | 
| attributable to the lower
of the current equalized assessed  | 
| value or the initial equalized assessed value
of each  | 
| taxable lot, block, tract, or parcel of real property  | 
| existing
at the time tax increment financing was adopted  | 
| shall be allocated to (and when
collected shall be paid by  | 
| the county collector to) the respective affected
taxing  | 
| districts in the manner required by law in the absence of  | 
| the adoption
of tax increment allocation financing.
 | 
|         (2) That portion, if any, of the taxes that is  | 
| attributable to the
increase in the current equalized  | 
| assessed valuation of each taxable lot,
block, tract, or
 | 
| parcel of real property in the economic development project  | 
| area, over and
above the initial equalized assessed value  | 
| of each property existing at the
time tax increment  | 
| financing was adopted, shall be allocated to (and when
 | 
| collected shall be paid to) the municipal treasurer, who  | 
| shall deposit the
taxes into a special fund (called the  | 
| special tax allocation fund of the
municipality) for the  | 
| purpose of paying economic development project costs and
 | 
| obligations incurred in the payment of those costs.
 | 
|     (b) The municipality, by an ordinance adopting tax  | 
| increment allocation
financing, may pledge the monies in and to  | 
| be deposited into the special tax
allocation fund for the  | 
| payment of obligations issued under this Act and for
the  | 
| payment of economic development project costs.  No part of the  | 
| current
equalized assessed valuation of each property in the  | 
|  | 
| economic development
project area attributable to any increase  | 
| above the total initial equalized
assessed value of those  | 
| properties shall be used in calculating the general
State  | 
| school aid formula under
Section 18-8 of the School Code or the  | 
| evidence-based funding formula under Section 18-8.15 of the  | 
| School Code, until all economic development projects costs
have  | 
| been paid as provided for in this Section.
 | 
|     (c) When the economic development projects costs,  | 
| including without
limitation all municipal obligations  | 
| financing economic development project
costs incurred under  | 
| this Act, have been paid, all surplus monies then
remaining in  | 
| the special tax allocation fund shall be distributed by being  | 
| paid
by the municipal treasurer to the county collector, who  | 
| shall immediately pay
the monies to the taxing districts having  | 
| taxable property in the economic
development project area in  | 
| the same manner and proportion as the most recent
distribution  | 
| by the county collector to those taxing districts of real  | 
| property
taxes from real property in the economic development  | 
| project area.
 | 
|     (d) Upon the payment of all economic development project  | 
| costs, retirement
of obligations, and distribution of any  | 
| excess monies under this Section and
not later than 23 years  | 
| from the date of the adoption of the ordinance
establishing the  | 
| economic development project area, the municipality shall
 | 
| adopt an ordinance dissolving the special tax allocation fund  | 
| for the economic
development project area and terminating the  | 
|  | 
| designation of the economic
development project area as an  | 
| economic development project area.
Thereafter, the rates of the  | 
| taxing districts shall be extended and taxes shall
be levied,  | 
| collected, and distributed in the manner applicable in the  | 
| absence
of the adoption of tax increment allocation financing.
 | 
|     (e) Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving  | 
| property in the
economic development project areas from being  | 
| assessed as provided in the
Property Tax Code or as relieving  | 
| owners or lessees of that property from
paying a uniform rate  | 
| of taxes as required by Section 4 of Article IX of the
Illinois  | 
| Constitution.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13.)
 | 
|     Section 965. The School Code is amended  by changing  | 
| Sections 1A-8, 1B-5, 1B-6, 1B-7, 1B-8, 1C-1, 1C-2, 1D-1, 1E-20,  | 
| 1F-20, 1F-62, 1H-20, 1H-70, 2-3.25g, 2-3.33, 2-3.51.5, 2-3.66,  | 
| 2-3.66b, 2-3.84, 2-3.109a, 3-14.21, 7-14A, 10-17a, 10-19,  | 
| 10-22.5a, 10-22.20, 10-29, 11E-135, 13A-8, 13B-20.20, 13B-45,  | 
| 13B-50, 13B-50.10, 13B-50.15, 14-7.02b, 14-13.01, 14C-1,  | 
| 14C-12, 17-1, 17-1.2, 17-1.5, 17-2.11, 17-2A, 18-4.3, 18-8.05,  | 
| 18-8.10, 18-9, 18-12, 26-16, 27-6, 27-7, 27-8.1, 27-24.2,  | 
| 27A-9, 27A-11, 29-5, 34-2.3, 34-18, 34-18.30, 34-43.1, and  | 
| 34-53 and by adding Sections 2-3.170, 17-3.6, and 18-8.15 as  | 
| follows:
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1A-8)  (from Ch. 122, par. 1A-8)
 | 
|  | 
|     Sec. 1A-8. Powers of the Board in Assisting Districts  | 
| Deemed in Financial
Difficulties. To promote the financial  | 
| integrity of school districts, the
State Board of Education  | 
| shall be provided the necessary powers to promote
sound  | 
| financial management and continue operation of the public  | 
| schools.
 | 
|     (a) The State Superintendent of Education may require a  | 
| school district, including any district subject to Article 34A  | 
| of this Code, to share financial information relevant to a  | 
| proper investigation of the district's financial condition and  | 
| the delivery of appropriate State financial, technical, and  | 
| consulting services to the district if the district (i) has  | 
| been designated, through the State Board of Education's School  | 
| District Financial Profile System, as on financial warning or  | 
| financial watch status, (ii) has failed to file an annual  | 
| financial report, annual budget, deficit reduction plan, or  | 
| other financial information as required by law, (iii) has been  | 
| identified, through the district's annual audit or other  | 
| financial and management information, as in serious financial  | 
| difficulty in the current or next school year, or (iv) is  | 
| determined to be likely to fail to fully meet any regularly  | 
| scheduled, payroll-period obligations when due or any debt  | 
| service payments when due or both.  In addition to financial,  | 
| technical, and consulting services provided by the State Board  | 
| of Education, at the request of a school district, the State  | 
| Superintendent may provide for an independent financial  | 
|  | 
| consultant to assist the district review its financial  | 
| condition and options.
 | 
|     (b) The State Board of Education, after proper  | 
| investigation of a district's
financial condition, may certify  | 
| that a district, including any district
subject to Article 34A,  | 
| is in financial difficulty
when any of the following conditions  | 
| occur:
 | 
|         (1) The district has issued school or teacher orders  | 
| for wages as permitted in Sections
8-16, 32-7.2 and 34-76  | 
| of this Code.
 | 
|         (2) The district has issued tax anticipation warrants  | 
| or tax
anticipation notes in anticipation of a second  | 
| year's taxes when warrants or
notes in anticipation of  | 
| current year taxes are still outstanding, as
authorized by  | 
| Sections 17-16, 34-23, 34-59 and 34-63 of this Code, or has  | 
| issued short-term debt against 2 future revenue sources,  | 
| such as, but not limited to, tax anticipation warrants and  | 
| general State aid or evidence-based funding Aid  | 
| certificates or tax anticipation warrants and revenue  | 
| anticipation notes.
 | 
|         (3) The district has for 2 consecutive years shown an  | 
| excess
of expenditures and other financing uses over  | 
| revenues and other financing
sources and beginning fund  | 
| balances on its annual financial report for the
aggregate  | 
| totals of the Educational, Operations and Maintenance,
 | 
| Transportation, and Working Cash Funds.
 | 
|  | 
|         (4) The district refuses to provide financial  | 
| information or cooperate with the State Superintendent in  | 
| an investigation of the district's financial condition. | 
|         (5) The district is likely to fail to fully meet any  | 
| regularly scheduled,  payroll-period obligations when due  | 
| or any debt service payments when due or both. 
 | 
|     No school district shall be certified by the State Board of  | 
| Education to be in financial difficulty solely by
reason of any  | 
| of the above circumstances arising as a result of (i) the  | 
| failure
of the county to make any distribution of property tax  | 
| money due the district
at the time such distribution is due or  | 
| (ii) the failure of this State to make timely payments of  | 
| general State aid, evidence-based funding, or any of the  | 
| mandated categoricals; or if the district clearly demonstrates
 | 
| to the satisfaction of the State Board of Education at the time  | 
| of its
determination that such condition no longer exists. If  | 
| the State Board of
Education certifies that a district in a  | 
| city with 500,000 inhabitants or
more is in financial  | 
| difficulty, the State Board shall so notify the
Governor and  | 
| the Mayor of the city in which the district is located.  The
 | 
| State Board of Education may require school districts certified  | 
| in
financial difficulty, except those districts subject to  | 
| Article 34A, to
develop, adopt and submit a financial plan  | 
| within 45 days after
certification of financial difficulty. The  | 
| financial plan shall be
developed according to guidelines  | 
| presented to the district by the State
Board of Education  | 
|  | 
| within 14 days of certification. Such guidelines shall
address  | 
| the specific nature of each district's financial difficulties.  | 
| Any
proposed budget of the district shall be consistent with  | 
| the financial plan
submitted to and
approved by the State Board  | 
| of Education.
 | 
|     A district certified to be in financial difficulty, other  | 
| than a district
subject to Article 34A, shall report to the  | 
| State Board of Education at
such times and in such manner as  | 
| the State Board may direct, concerning the
district's  | 
| compliance with each financial plan. The State Board may review
 | 
| the district's operations, obtain budgetary data and financial  | 
| statements,
require the district to produce reports, and have  | 
| access to any other
information in the possession of the  | 
| district that it deems relevant. The
State Board may issue  | 
| recommendations or directives within its powers to
the district  | 
| to assist in compliance with the financial plan. The district
 | 
| shall produce such budgetary data, financial statements,  | 
| reports and other
information and comply with such directives.  | 
| If the State Board of Education
determines that a district has  | 
| failed to comply with its financial plan, the
State Board of  | 
| Education may rescind approval of the plan and appoint a
 | 
| Financial Oversight Panel for the district as provided in  | 
| Section 1B-4.  This
action shall be taken only after the  | 
| district has been given notice and an
opportunity to appear  | 
| before the State Board of Education to discuss its
failure to  | 
| comply with its financial plan.
 | 
|  | 
|     No bonds, notes, teachers orders, tax anticipation  | 
| warrants or other
evidences of indebtedness shall be issued or  | 
| sold by a school district or
be legally binding upon or  | 
| enforceable against a local board of education
of a district  | 
| certified to be in financial difficulty unless and until the
 | 
| financial plan required under this Section has been approved by  | 
| the State
Board of Education.
 | 
|     Any financial profile compiled and distributed by the State  | 
| Board of Education in Fiscal Year 2009 or any fiscal year  | 
| thereafter
 shall incorporate such adjustments as may be needed  | 
| in the profile scores to reflect the financial effects of the
 | 
| inability or refusal of the State of Illinois to make timely
 | 
| disbursements of any general State aid, evidence-based  | 
| funding, or mandated categorical aid payments due school  | 
| districts or to fully reimburse
school districts for mandated  | 
| categorical programs pursuant to
reimbursement formulas  | 
| provided in this School Code.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 96-668, eff. 8-25-09; 96-1423, eff. 8-3-10;  | 
| 97-429, eff. 8-16-11.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1B-5)  (from Ch. 122, par. 1B-5)
 | 
|     Sec. 1B-5. 
When a petition for emergency financial
 | 
| assistance for a school district is allowed by the State
Board  | 
| under Section 1B-4, the State Superintendent
shall within 10  | 
| days thereafter appoint 3 members
to serve at the State  | 
| Superintendent's pleasure on a
Financial Oversight Panel for  | 
|  | 
| the district.  The State
Superintendent shall designate one of  | 
| the members of the
Panel to serve as its Chairman.  In the event  | 
| of vacancy or
resignation the State Superintendent shall  | 
| appoint a
successor within 10 days of receiving notice thereof.
 | 
|     Members of the Panel shall be selected primarily on the
 | 
| basis of their experience and education in financial
 | 
| management, with consideration given to persons
knowledgeable  | 
| in education finance.  A member of the Panel
may not be a board  | 
| member or employee of the district for
which the Panel is  | 
| constituted, nor may a member have a
direct financial interest  | 
| in that district.
 | 
|     Panel members shall serve without compensation, but may
be  | 
| reimbursed for travel and other necessary expenses
incurred in  | 
| the performance of their official duties by the
State Board.   | 
| The amount reimbursed Panel
members for their expenses shall be  | 
| charged to the school
district as part of any emergency  | 
| financial assistance and
incorporated as a part of the terms  | 
| and conditions for
repayment of such assistance or shall be  | 
| deducted from the district's general
State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding as provided in Section 1B-8.
 | 
|     The first meeting of the Panel shall be held at the
call of  | 
| the Chairman.  The Panel may elect such other
officers as it  | 
| deems appropriate.  The Panel shall prescribe
the times and  | 
| places for its meetings and the manner in
which regular and  | 
| special meetings may be called, and shall
comply with the Open  | 
| Meetings Act.
 | 
|  | 
|     Two members of the Panel shall constitute a quorum, and
the  | 
| affirmative vote of 2 members shall be necessary for any
 | 
| decision or action to be taken by the Panel.
 | 
|     The Panel and the State Superintendent
shall cooperate with  | 
| each other in the exercise of their
respective powers.  The  | 
| Panel shall report not later than
September 1 annually to the  | 
| State Board and the State
Superintendent with respect to its  | 
| activities and the
condition of the school district for the  | 
| previous fiscal
year.
 | 
|     Any Financial Oversight Panel established under this
 | 
| Article shall remain in existence for not less than 3 years
nor  | 
| more than 10 years from the date the State Board grants
the  | 
| petition under Section 1B-4.  If after 3 years the
school  | 
| district has repaid all of its obligations resulting
from  | 
| emergency State financial assistance provided under
this  | 
| Article and has improved its financial situation, the board of
 | 
| education may, not more
frequently than once in any 12 month  | 
| period, petition the
State Board to dissolve the Financial  | 
| Oversight Panel,
terminate the oversight responsibility, and  | 
| remove the
district's certification under Section 1A-8 as a  | 
| district in
financial difficulty.  In acting on such a petition  | 
| the
State Board shall give additional weight to the
 | 
| recommendations of the State Superintendent and the
Financial  | 
| Oversight Panel.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 88-618, eff. 9-9-94.)
 
 | 
|  | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1B-6)  (from Ch. 122, par. 1B-6)
 | 
|     Sec. 1B-6. General powers. The purpose of the Financial  | 
| Oversight Panel
shall be to exercise financial control over the  | 
| board of education, and, when
approved by the State Board and  | 
| the State Superintendent of Education, to
furnish financial  | 
| assistance so that the board can provide public education
 | 
| within the board's jurisdiction while permitting the board to  | 
| meet its
obligations to its creditors and the holders of its  | 
| notes and bonds.
Except as expressly limited by this Article,  | 
| the Panel shall have all
powers necessary to meet its  | 
| responsibilities and to carry out its purposes
and the purposes  | 
| of this Article, including, but not limited to, the following
 | 
| powers:
 | 
|     (a) to sue and be sued;
 | 
|     (b) to provide for its organization and internal
 | 
| management;
 | 
|     (c) to appoint a Financial Administrator to serve as
the  | 
| chief executive officer of the Panel.  The Financial
 | 
| Administrator may be an individual, partnership,
corporation,  | 
| including an accounting firm, or other entity
determined by the  | 
| Panel to be qualified to serve; and to
appoint other officers,  | 
| agents, and employees of the Panel,
define their duties and  | 
| qualifications and fix their
compensation and employee  | 
| benefits;
 | 
|     (d) to approve the local board of education appointments to  | 
| the
positions of treasurer in a Class I county school unit and  | 
|  | 
| in each school
district which forms a part of a Class II county  | 
| school unit but which no
longer is subject to the jurisdiction  | 
| and authority of a township treasurer
or trustees of schools of  | 
| a township because the district has withdrawn
from the  | 
| jurisdiction and authority of the township treasurer and the
 | 
| trustees of schools of the township or because those offices  | 
| have been
abolished as provided in subsection (b) or (c) of  | 
| Section 5-1,
and chief school business official, if such  | 
| official is not the
superintendent of the district.  Either the  | 
| board or the Panel may remove
such treasurer or chief school  | 
| business official;
 | 
|     (e) to approve any and all bonds, notes, teachers
orders,  | 
| tax anticipation warrants, and other evidences of
indebtedness  | 
| prior to issuance or sale by the school
district; and  | 
| notwithstanding any other provision of The School Code, as
now  | 
| or hereafter amended, no bonds, notes, teachers orders, tax
 | 
| anticipation warrants or other evidences of indebtedness shall  | 
| be issued or
sold by the school district or be legally binding  | 
| upon or enforceable
against the local board of education unless  | 
| and until the approval of the
Panel has been received;
 | 
|     (f) to approve all property tax levies of the school
 | 
| district and require adjustments thereto as the Panel deems
 | 
| necessary or advisable;
 | 
|     (g) to require and approve a school district financial  | 
| plan;
 | 
|     (h) to approve and require revisions of the school district  | 
|  | 
| budget;
 | 
|     (i) to approve all contracts and other obligations as
the  | 
| Panel deems necessary and appropriate;
 | 
|     (j) to authorize emergency State financial assistance,
 | 
| including requirements regarding the terms and conditions of
 | 
| repayment of such assistance, and to require the board of
 | 
| education to levy a separate local property tax, subject to
the  | 
| limitations of Section 1B-8, sufficient to repay such
 | 
| assistance consistent with the terms and conditions of
 | 
| repayment and the district's approved financial plan and
 | 
| budget;
 | 
|     (k) to request the regional superintendent to make  | 
| appointments to
fill all vacancies on the local school board as  | 
| provided in Section 10-10;
 | 
|     (l) to recommend dissolution or reorganization of the  | 
| school district
to the General Assembly if in the Panel's  | 
| judgment the
circumstances so require;
 | 
|     (m) to direct a phased reduction in the oversight  | 
| responsibilities of
the Financial Administrator and of the  | 
| Panel as the circumstances permit;
 | 
|     (n) to determine the amount of emergency State
financial  | 
| assistance to be made available to the school
district, and to  | 
| establish an operating budget for the Panel
to be supported by  | 
| funds available from such assistance,
with the assistance and  | 
| the budget required to be approved
by the State Superintendent;
 | 
|     (o) to procure insurance against any loss in such
amounts  | 
|  | 
| and from such insurers as it deems necessary;
 | 
|     (p) to engage the services of consultants for
rendering  | 
| professional and technical assistance and advice
on matters  | 
| within the Panel's power;
 | 
|     (q) to contract for and to accept any gifts, grants or
 | 
| loans of funds or property or financial or other aid in any
 | 
| form from the federal government, State government, unit of
 | 
| local government, school district or any agency or
 | 
| instrumentality thereof, or from any other private or public
 | 
| source, and to comply with the terms and conditions thereof;
 | 
|     (r) to pay the expenses of its operations based on the
 | 
| Panel's budget as approved by the State Superintendent from
 | 
| emergency financial assistance funds available to the
district  | 
| or from deductions from the district's general State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding;
 | 
|     (s) to do any and all things necessary or convenient
to  | 
| carry out its purposes and exercise the powers given to
the  | 
| Panel by this Article; and
 | 
|     (t) to recommend the creation of a school finance authority
 | 
| pursuant to Article 1F of this Code.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 91-357, eff. 7-29-99; 92-855, eff. 12-6-02.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1B-7)  (from Ch. 122, par. 1B-7)
 | 
|     Sec. 1B-7. Financial Administrator; Powers and
Duties.  The  | 
| Financial Administrator appointed by the
Financial Oversight  | 
| Panel shall serve as the Panel's chief
executive officer.  The  | 
|  | 
| Financial Administrator shall
exercise the powers and duties  | 
| required by the Panel,
including but not limited to the  | 
| following:
 | 
|     (a) to provide guidance and recommendations to the
local  | 
| board and officials of the school district in
developing the  | 
| district's financial plan and budget prior to
board action;
 | 
|     (b) to direct the local board to reorganize its
financial  | 
| accounts, budgetary systems, and internal
accounting and  | 
| financial controls, in whatever manner the
Panel deems  | 
| appropriate to achieve greater financial
responsibility and to  | 
| reduce financial inefficiency, and to
provide technical  | 
| assistance to aid the district in
accomplishing the  | 
| reorganization;
 | 
|     (c) to make recommendations to the Financial Oversight
 | 
| Panel concerning the school district's financial plan and
 | 
| budget, and all other matters within the scope of the
Panel's  | 
| authority;
 | 
|     (d) to prepare and recommend to the Panel a proposal
for  | 
| emergency State financial assistance for the district,
 | 
| including recommended terms and conditions of repayment, and
an  | 
| operations budget for the Panel to be funded from the
emergency  | 
| assistance or from deductions from the district's general State
 | 
| aid or evidence-based funding;
 | 
|     (e) to require the local board to prepare and submit
 | 
| preliminary staffing and budgetary analyses annually prior
to  | 
| February 1 in such manner and form as the Financial
 | 
|  | 
| Administrator shall prescribe; and
 | 
|     (f) subject to the direction of the Panel, to do all
other  | 
| things necessary or convenient to carry out its
purposes and  | 
| exercise the powers given to the Panel under
this Article.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 88-618, eff. 9-9-94.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1B-8)  (from Ch. 122, par. 1B-8)
 | 
|     Sec. 1B-8. There is created in the State Treasury a
special  | 
| fund to be known as the School District Emergency
Financial  | 
| Assistance Fund (the "Fund").  The School District Emergency
 | 
| Financial Assistance Fund shall consist of appropriations,  | 
| loan repayments, grants from the
federal government, and  | 
| donations from any public or private source.  Moneys in
the Fund
 | 
| may be appropriated only to the Illinois Finance Authority and
 | 
| the State Board for
those purposes authorized under this  | 
| Article and Articles
 1F and 1H of this Code.
 The appropriation  | 
| may be
allocated and expended by the State Board for  | 
| contractual services to provide technical assistance or  | 
| consultation to school districts to assess their financial  | 
| condition and to Financial Oversight Panels that petition for  | 
| emergency financial assistance grants. The Illinois Finance  | 
| Authority may provide
loans to school districts which are the  | 
| subject of an
approved petition for emergency financial  | 
| assistance under
 Section 1B-4,
 1F-62, or 1H-65 of this Code.  | 
| Neither the State Board of Education nor the Illinois Finance  | 
| Authority may collect any fees for providing these services.   | 
|  | 
|     From the amount allocated to each such school
district  | 
| under this Article the State Board shall identify a sum  | 
| sufficient to
cover all approved costs of the Financial  | 
| Oversight Panel
 established for the respective school  | 
| district.  If the State Board and State
Superintendent of  | 
| Education have not approved emergency financial assistance in
 | 
| conjunction with the appointment of a Financial Oversight  | 
| Panel, the Panel's
 approved costs shall be paid from deductions  | 
| from the district's general State
aid or evidence-based  | 
| funding.
 | 
|     The Financial Oversight Panel may prepare and file
with the  | 
| State Superintendent a proposal for emergency
financial  | 
| assistance for the school district and for its
operations  | 
| budget.  No expenditures from the Fund shall be
authorized by  | 
| the State Superintendent until he or she has approved
the  | 
| request of the Panel, either as submitted or in such
lesser  | 
| amount determined by the State Superintendent.
 | 
|     The maximum amount of an emergency financial assistance  | 
| loan
which may be allocated to any school district under this
 | 
| Article, including moneys necessary for the operations of
the  | 
| Panel, shall not exceed $4,000 times the number of pupils
 | 
| enrolled in the school district during the school year
ending  | 
| June 30 prior to the date of approval by the State
Board of the  | 
| petition for emergency financial assistance, as
certified to  | 
| the local board and the Panel by the State
Superintendent.
An  | 
| emergency financial assistance grant shall not exceed $1,000  | 
|  | 
| times the
number of such pupils.  A district may receive both a  | 
| loan and a grant.
 | 
|     The payment of an emergency State financial assistance  | 
| grant or loan
shall be subject to appropriation by the General  | 
| Assembly. Payment of the emergency State financial assistance  | 
| loan is subject to the applicable provisions of the Illinois  | 
| Finance Authority Act.
Emergency State financial assistance  | 
| allocated and paid to a school
district under this Article may  | 
| be applied to any fund or funds from which
the local board of  | 
| education of that district is authorized to make
expenditures  | 
| by law.
 | 
|     Any emergency financial assistance grant proposed by the
 | 
| Financial Oversight Panel and approved by the State
 | 
| Superintendent may be paid in its entirety during the
initial  | 
| year of the Panel's existence or spread in equal or
declining  | 
| amounts over a period of years not to exceed the
period of the  | 
| Panel's existence. An emergency financial assistance loan  | 
| proposed by the Financial Oversight Panel and approved by the  | 
| Illinois Finance Authority may be paid in its entirety during  | 
| the initial year of the Panel's existence or spread in equal or  | 
| declining amounts over a period of years not to exceed the  | 
| period of the Panel's existence.  All
loans made by the Illinois  | 
| Finance Authority for a
school district shall be required to be  | 
| repaid, with simple interest over
the term of the loan at a  | 
| rate equal to 50% of the one-year Constant Maturity
Treasury  | 
| (CMT) yield as last published by the Board of Governors of the  | 
|  | 
| Federal
Reserve System before the date on which the district's  | 
| loan is
approved
by the Illinois Finance Authority, not later  | 
| than the
date the
Financial Oversight Panel ceases to exist.   | 
| The Panel shall
establish and the Illinois Finance Authority  | 
| shall
approve the terms and conditions, including the schedule,  | 
| of
repayments.  The schedule shall provide for repayments
 | 
| commencing July 1 of each year or upon each fiscal year's  | 
| receipt of moneys from a tax levy for emergency financial  | 
| assistance. Repayment shall be incorporated into the
annual  | 
| budget of the school district and may be made from any fund or  | 
| funds
of the district in which there are moneys available. An  | 
| emergency financial assistance loan to the Panel or district  | 
| shall not be considered part of the calculation of a district's  | 
| debt for purposes of the limitation specified in Section 19-1  | 
| of this Code. Default on repayment is subject to the Illinois  | 
| Grant Funds Recovery Act. When moneys are repaid
as provided  | 
| herein they shall not be made available to the local board for
 | 
| further use as emergency financial assistance under this  | 
| Article at any
time thereafter.  All repayments required to be  | 
| made by a school district
shall be received by the State Board  | 
| and deposited in the School District
Emergency Financial  | 
| Assistance Fund.
 | 
|     In establishing the terms and conditions for the
repayment  | 
| obligation of the school district the Panel shall
annually  | 
| determine whether a separate local property tax levy is
 | 
| required.  The board of any school district with a tax rate
for  | 
|  | 
| educational purposes for the prior year of less than
120% of  | 
| the maximum rate for educational purposes authorized
by Section  | 
| 17-2 shall provide for a separate
tax levy for emergency  | 
| financial assistance repayment
purposes.  Such tax levy shall  | 
| not be subject to referendum approval.  The
amount of the levy  | 
| shall be equal to the
amount necessary to meet the annual  | 
| repayment obligations of
the district as established by the  | 
| Panel, or 20% of the
amount levied for educational purposes for  | 
| the prior year,
whichever is less.  However, no district shall  | 
| be
required to levy the tax if the district's operating tax
 | 
| rate as determined under Section
18-8, or 18-8.05, or 18-8.15  | 
| exceeds 200% of the district's tax rate for educational
 | 
| purposes for the prior year.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 97-429, eff. 8-16-11.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1C-1)
 | 
|     Sec. 1C-1. Purpose. The purpose of this Article is to  | 
| permit greater
flexibility and efficiency in the distribution  | 
| and use of certain State funds
available to
local education  | 
| agencies for the improvement of the quality of educational
 | 
| services pursuant to locally established priorities.
 | 
|     Through fiscal year 2017, this This Article does not apply  | 
| to school districts having a population in excess
of 500,000  | 
| inhabitants.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 88-555, eff. 7-27-94; 89-15, eff. 5-30-95;  | 
| 89-397, eff.
8-20-95; 89-626, eff. 8-9-96.)
 
 | 
|  | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1C-2)
 | 
|     Sec. 1C-2. Block grants. 
 | 
|     (a) For fiscal year 1999, and each fiscal year thereafter,  | 
| the State Board
of Education shall award to school districts  | 
| block grants as described in subsection
 (c). The State Board of  | 
| Education may adopt
rules and regulations necessary to  | 
| implement this Section. In accordance with
Section 2-3.32, all  | 
| state block grants are subject to an audit.  Therefore,
block  | 
| grant receipts and block grant expenditures shall be recorded  | 
| to the
appropriate fund code.
 | 
|     (b) (Blank).
 | 
|     (c) An Early Childhood Education Block Grant shall be  | 
| created by combining
the following programs: Preschool  | 
| Education, Parental Training and Prevention
Initiative.  These  | 
| funds shall be distributed to school districts and other
 | 
| entities on a competitive basis, except that the State Board of  | 
| Education shall award to a school district having a population  | 
| exceeding 500,000 inhabitants 37% of the funds in each fiscal  | 
| year.  Not less than 14% of the Early Childhood Education Block  | 
| Grant allocation of funds
shall be used to
fund programs for  | 
| children ages 0-3.  Beginning in Fiscal Year 2016, at least 25%  | 
| of any additional Early Childhood Education Block Grant funding  | 
| over and above the previous fiscal year's allocation shall be  | 
| used to fund programs for children ages 0-3. Once the  | 
| percentage of Early Childhood Education Block Grant funding  | 
|  | 
| allocated to programs for children ages 0-3 reaches 20% of the  | 
| overall Early Childhood Education Block Grant allocation for a  | 
| full fiscal year, thereafter in subsequent fiscal years the  | 
| percentage of Early Childhood Education Block Grant funding  | 
| allocated to programs for children ages 0-3 each fiscal year  | 
| shall remain at least 20% of the overall Early Childhood  | 
| Education Block Grant allocation. However, if, in a given  | 
| fiscal year, the amount appropriated for the Early Childhood  | 
| Education Block Grant is insufficient to increase the  | 
| percentage of the grant to fund programs for children ages 0-3  | 
| without reducing the amount of the grant for existing providers  | 
| of preschool education programs, then the percentage of the  | 
| grant to fund programs for children ages 0-3 may be held steady  | 
| instead of increased.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-645, eff. 7-1-14; 99-589, eff. 7-21-16.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1D-1)
 | 
|     Sec. 1D-1. Block grant funding. 
 | 
|     (a) For fiscal year 1996 through fiscal year 2017 and each  | 
| fiscal year thereafter, the State Board
of Education shall  | 
| award to a school district having a population exceeding
 | 
| 500,000 inhabitants a general education block grant and an  | 
| educational services
block grant, determined as provided in  | 
| this Section, in lieu of distributing to
the district separate  | 
| State funding for the programs described in subsections
(b) and  | 
| (c).  The provisions of this Section, however, do not apply to  | 
|  | 
| any
federal funds that the district is entitled to receive.  In  | 
| accordance with
Section 2-3.32, all block grants are subject to  | 
| an audit.  Therefore, block
grant receipts and block grant  | 
| expenditures shall be recorded to the
appropriate fund code for  | 
| the designated block grant.
 | 
|     (b) The general education block grant shall include the  | 
| following
programs: REI Initiative, Summer Bridges, Preschool  | 
| At Risk, K-6
Comprehensive Arts, School Improvement Support,  | 
| Urban Education, Scientific
Literacy, Substance Abuse  | 
| Prevention, Second Language Planning, Staff
Development,  | 
| Outcomes and Assessment, K-6 Reading Improvement, 7-12  | 
| Continued
Reading Improvement, Truants'
Optional Education,  | 
| Hispanic Programs, Agriculture Education,
Parental Education,  | 
| Prevention Initiative, Report Cards, and Criminal
Background  | 
| Investigations.  Notwithstanding any other provision of law,  | 
| all
amounts paid under the general education block grant from  | 
| State appropriations
to a school district in a city having a  | 
| population exceeding 500,000
inhabitants shall be appropriated  | 
| and expended by the board of that district
for any of the  | 
| programs included in the block grant or any of the board's
 | 
| lawful purposes.
 | 
|     (c) The educational services block grant shall include the  | 
| following
programs: Regular and Vocational Transportation,  | 
| State Lunch and
Free Breakfast Program, Special Education  | 
| (Personnel,
 Transportation, Orphanage, Private Tuition),  | 
| funding
for children requiring special education services,  | 
|  | 
| Summer School,
Educational Service Centers, and  | 
| Administrator's Academy.  This subsection (c)
does not relieve  | 
| the district of its obligation to provide the services
required  | 
| under a program that is included within the educational  | 
| services block
grant.  It is the intention of the General  | 
| Assembly in enacting the provisions
of this subsection (c) to  | 
| relieve the district of the administrative burdens
that impede  | 
| efficiency and accompany single-program funding.  The General
 | 
| Assembly encourages the board to pursue mandate waivers  | 
| pursuant to Section
2-3.25g. | 
|     The funding program included in the educational services  | 
| block grant
for funding for children requiring special  | 
| education services in each fiscal
year shall be treated in that  | 
| fiscal year as a payment to the school district
in respect of  | 
| services provided or costs incurred in the prior fiscal year,
 | 
| calculated in each case as provided in this Section.  Nothing in  | 
| this Section
shall change the nature of payments for any  | 
| program that, apart from this
Section, would be or, prior to  | 
| adoption or amendment of this Section, was on
the basis of a  | 
| payment in a fiscal year in respect of services provided or
 | 
| costs incurred in the prior fiscal year, calculated in each  | 
| case as provided
in this Section.
 | 
|     (d) For fiscal year 1996 through fiscal year 2017 and each  | 
| fiscal year thereafter, the amount
of the district's block  | 
| grants shall be determined as follows:
(i) with respect to each  | 
| program that is included within each block grant, the
district  | 
|  | 
| shall receive an amount equal to the same percentage of the  | 
| current
fiscal year appropriation made for that program as the  | 
| percentage of the
appropriation received by the district from  | 
| the 1995 fiscal year appropriation
made for that program, and
 | 
| (ii) the total amount that is due the district under the block  | 
| grant shall be
the aggregate of the amounts that the district  | 
| is entitled to receive for the
fiscal year with respect to each  | 
| program that is included within the block
grant that the State  | 
| Board of Education shall award the district under this
Section  | 
| for that fiscal year.  In the case of the Summer Bridges  | 
| program,
the amount of the district's block grant shall be  | 
| equal to 44% of the amount
of the current fiscal year  | 
| appropriation made for that program.
 | 
|     (e) The district is not required to file any application or  | 
| other claim in
order to receive the block grants to which it is  | 
| entitled under this Section.
The State Board of Education shall  | 
| make payments to the district of amounts due
under the  | 
| district's block grants on a schedule determined by the State  | 
| Board
of Education.
 | 
|     (f) A school district to which this Section applies shall  | 
| report to the
State Board of Education on its use of the block  | 
| grants in such form and detail
as the State Board of Education  | 
| may specify. In addition, the report must include the following  | 
| description for the district, which must also be reported to  | 
| the General Assembly: block grant allocation and expenditures  | 
| by program; population and service levels by program; and  | 
|  | 
| administrative expenditures by program. The State Board of  | 
| Education shall ensure that the reporting requirements for the  | 
| district are the same as for all other school districts in this  | 
| State. 
 | 
|     (g) Through fiscal year 2017, this This paragraph provides  | 
| for the treatment of block grants under Article
1C for purposes  | 
| of calculating the amount of block grants for a district under
 | 
| this Section.  Those block grants under Article 1C are, for this
 | 
| purpose, treated as included in the amount of appropriation for  | 
| the various
programs set forth in paragraph (b) above.  The  | 
| appropriation in each current
fiscal year for each block grant  | 
| under Article 1C shall be treated for these
purposes as  | 
| appropriations for the individual program included in that  | 
| block
grant.  The proportion of each block grant so allocated to  | 
| each such program
included in it shall be the proportion which  | 
| the appropriation for that program
was of all appropriations  | 
| for such purposes now in that block grant, in fiscal
1995.
 | 
|     Payments to the school district under this Section with  | 
| respect to each
program for which payments to school districts  | 
| generally, as of the date of
this
amendatory Act of the 92nd  | 
| General Assembly, are on a reimbursement basis
shall continue  | 
| to be made to the district on a reimbursement basis, pursuant
 | 
| to the provisions of this Code governing those programs.
 | 
|     (h) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, any school  | 
| district
receiving a block grant under this Section may  | 
| classify all or a portion of
the funds that it receives in a  | 
|  | 
| particular fiscal year from any block grant
authorized under  | 
| this Code or from general State aid pursuant to Section
18-8.05  | 
| of this Code (other than supplemental general State aid) as
 | 
| funds received in connection with any funding program for which  | 
| it is
entitled to receive funds from the State in that fiscal  | 
| year (including,
without limitation, any funding program  | 
| referred to in subsection (c) of
this Section), regardless of  | 
| the source or timing of the receipt.  The
district may not  | 
| classify more funds as funds received in connection
with the  | 
| funding program than the district is entitled to receive in  | 
| that
fiscal year for that program.  Any classification by a  | 
| district must be made by
a resolution
of its board of  | 
| education.  The resolution must identify the amount of any
block  | 
| grant or general State aid to be classified under this  | 
| subsection (h)
and must specify the funding program to which  | 
| the funds are to be
treated as received in connection  | 
| therewith.  This resolution is
controlling as to the  | 
| classification of funds referenced therein.  A certified
copy of  | 
| the resolution must be sent to the State Superintendent of
 | 
| Education.
The resolution shall still take effect even though a  | 
| copy of the resolution
has not been sent to the State
 | 
| Superintendent of Education in a timely manner.
 No  | 
| classification under this subsection (h) by a district shall
 | 
| affect the total amount or timing of money the district is  | 
| entitled to receive
under this Code.
 No classification under  | 
| this subsection (h) by a district
shall in any way relieve the  | 
|  | 
| district from or affect any
requirements that otherwise would  | 
| apply with respect to the
block grant as provided in this  | 
| Section, including any
accounting of funds by source, reporting  | 
| expenditures by
original source and purpose,
reporting  | 
| requirements, or requirements of provision of
services.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 97-238, eff. 8-2-11; 97-324, eff. 8-12-11;  | 
| 97-813, eff. 7-13-12.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1E-20)
 | 
|     (This Section scheduled to be repealed in accordance with  | 
| 105 ILCS 5/1E-165) | 
|     Sec. 1E-20. Members of Authority; meetings. 
 | 
|     (a) When a petition for a School Finance Authority is  | 
| allowed by the State
Board under Section 1E-15 of this Code,  | 
| the State Superintendent shall within
10 days thereafter  | 
| appoint 5 members to serve on a School Finance Authority for
 | 
| the district. Of the initial members, 2 shall be appointed to  | 
| serve a
term of 2 years and 3 shall be appointed to serve a term  | 
| of 3 years.
Thereafter, each member shall serve for a term of 3  | 
| years and until his or her
successor has been appointed. The  | 
| State Superintendent shall designate one of
the members of the  | 
| Authority to serve as its Chairperson. In the event
of vacancy  | 
| or resignation, the State Superintendent shall, within 10
days  | 
| after receiving notice, appoint a successor to serve out that
 | 
| member's term. The State Superintendent may remove a member for
 | 
| incompetence, malfeasance, neglect of duty, or other just  | 
|  | 
| cause.
 | 
|     Members of the Authority shall be selected primarily on the  | 
| basis
of their experience and education in financial  | 
| management,
with consideration given to persons knowledgeable  | 
| in education finance.
Two members of the Authority shall be  | 
| residents of the school district that the
Authority serves. A  | 
| member of the Authority may not be a member of the
district's  | 
| school board or an
employee of the district
 nor may
a
member  | 
| have a direct financial interest in the district.
 | 
|     Authority members shall serve without compensation, but  | 
| may
be reimbursed by the State Board for travel and other  | 
| necessary
expenses incurred in the performance of their  | 
| official duties.
Unless paid from bonds issued under Section  | 
| 1E-65 of this Code, the amount
reimbursed members for their  | 
| expenses shall be charged
to the school district as part of any  | 
| emergency financial
assistance and incorporated as a part of  | 
| the terms and conditions
for repayment of the assistance or  | 
| shall be deducted from the
district's general State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding as provided in Section 1B-8 of this  | 
| Code.
 | 
|     The Authority may elect such officers as it deems  | 
| appropriate.
 | 
|     (b) The first meeting of the Authority shall be held at the  | 
| call of the
Chairperson.
 The
Authority shall prescribe the  | 
| times and places for its meetings and the manner
in which  | 
| regular and special meetings may be called and shall comply  | 
|  | 
| with the
Open Meetings Act.
 | 
|     Three members of the Authority shall constitute a quorum.
 | 
| When a vote is taken upon any measure before the Authority, a  | 
| quorum
being present, a majority of the votes of the members  | 
| voting on the
measure shall determine the outcome.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 92-547, eff. 6-13-02.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1F-20)
 | 
| (This Section scheduled to be repealed in accordance with 105  | 
| ILCS 5/1F-165) | 
|     Sec. 1F-20. Members of Authority; meetings. 
 | 
|     (a) Upon establishment of a School Finance Authority
under  | 
| Section 1F-15 of this Code, the State Superintendent shall  | 
| within
15 days thereafter appoint 5 members to serve on a  | 
| School Finance Authority for
the district. Of the initial  | 
| members, 2 shall be appointed to serve a
term of 2 years and 3  | 
| shall be appointed to serve a term of 3 years.
Thereafter, each  | 
| member shall serve for a term of 3 years and until his or her
 | 
| successor has been appointed. The State Superintendent shall  | 
| designate one of
the members of the Authority to serve as its  | 
| Chairperson. In the event
of vacancy or resignation, the State  | 
| Superintendent shall, within 10
days after receiving notice,  | 
| appoint a successor to serve out that
member's term. The State  | 
| Superintendent may remove a member for
incompetence,  | 
| malfeasance, neglect of duty, or other just cause.
 | 
|     Members of the Authority shall be selected primarily on the  | 
|  | 
| basis
of their experience and education in financial  | 
| management,
with consideration given to persons knowledgeable  | 
| in education finance.
Two members of the Authority shall be  | 
| residents of the school district that the
Authority serves. A  | 
| member of the Authority may not be a member of the
district's  | 
| school board or an
employee of the district
 nor may
a
member  | 
| have a direct financial interest in the district.
 | 
|     Authority members shall be paid a stipend approved by the  | 
| State Superintendent of not more than $100 per meeting and may
 | 
| be reimbursed by the State Board for travel and other necessary
 | 
| expenses incurred in the performance of their official duties.
 | 
| Unless paid from bonds issued under Section 1F-65 of this Code,  | 
| the amount
reimbursed members for their expenses shall be  | 
| charged
to the school district as part of any emergency  | 
| financial
assistance and incorporated as a part of the terms  | 
| and conditions
for repayment of the assistance or shall be  | 
| deducted from the
district's general State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding as provided in Section 1B-8 of this  | 
| Code.
 | 
|     The Authority may elect such officers as it deems  | 
| appropriate.
 | 
|     (b) The first meeting of the Authority shall be held at the  | 
| call of the
Chairperson.
 The
Authority shall prescribe the  | 
| times and places for its meetings and the manner
in which  | 
| regular and special meetings may be called and shall comply  | 
| with the
Open Meetings Act.
 | 
|  | 
|     Three members of the Authority shall constitute a quorum.
 | 
| When a vote is taken upon any measure before the Authority, a  | 
| quorum
being present, a majority of the votes of the members  | 
| voting on the
measure shall determine the outcome.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 94-234, eff. 7-1-06.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1F-62)
 | 
| (This Section scheduled to be repealed in accordance with 105  | 
| ILCS 5/1F-165) | 
|     Sec. 1F-62. School District Emergency Financial Assistance  | 
| Fund;
grants and loans. | 
|     (a) Moneys in the School District Emergency Financial  | 
| Assistance Fund
established under Section 1B-8 of this Code may  | 
| be allocated and
expended by the State Board as grants to  | 
| provide technical and consulting services to school districts  | 
| to assess their financial condition and by the Illinois Finance  | 
| Authority for emergency financial assistance loans to a School  | 
| Finance
Authority that petitions for
emergency financial
 | 
| assistance.
An emergency financial assistance loan to a School  | 
| Finance Authority or borrowing from
sources other than the  | 
| State shall not be
considered as part of the calculation of a  | 
| district's debt for purposes of
the limitation specified in  | 
| Section 19-1 of this Code. From the amount allocated to each  | 
| School Finance Authority, the State Board shall identify a sum  | 
| sufficient to cover all approved costs of the School Finance  | 
| Authority.  If the State Board and State Superintendent have not  | 
|  | 
| approved emergency financial assistance in conjunction with  | 
| the appointment of a School Finance Authority, the Authority's  | 
| approved costs shall be paid from deductions from the  | 
| district's general State aid or evidence-based funding. | 
|     The School Finance Authority may prepare and file with the  | 
| State
Superintendent a proposal for emergency financial  | 
| assistance for the school district and for its operations  | 
| budget.  No expenditures shall be
authorized by the State  | 
| Superintendent until he or she has approved
the proposal of the  | 
| School Finance Authority, either as submitted or in such lesser  | 
| amount determined by the State Superintendent.
 | 
|     (b) The amount of an emergency financial assistance
loan  | 
| that may be allocated to a School Finance Authority under this  | 
| Article,
including moneys necessary for the operations of the  | 
| School Finance Authority, and borrowing
from sources other than  | 
| the State shall not
exceed, in the aggregate, $4,000 times the  | 
| number of pupils enrolled in the
district
during the school  | 
| year ending June 30 prior to the date of approval by
the State  | 
| Board of the petition for emergency financial assistance, as
 | 
| certified to the school board and the School Finance Authority  | 
| by the State
Superintendent.
However, this limitation does not  | 
| apply to borrowing by the district secured
by
amounts levied by  | 
| the district prior to establishment of the School Finance
 | 
| Authority. An emergency financial assistance grant shall not  | 
| exceed $1,000 times the number of such pupils.  A district may  | 
| receive both a loan and a grant.
 | 
|  | 
|     (c) The payment of a State emergency financial assistance  | 
| grant or loan
shall be subject to appropriation by the General  | 
| Assembly. State
emergency financial assistance allocated and  | 
| paid to a School Finance Authority
under this Article may be  | 
| applied to any fund or funds from which the
School Finance
 | 
| Authority is authorized to make expenditures by
law.
 | 
|     (d) Any State emergency financial assistance proposed by  | 
| the
School Finance Authority and approved by the State  | 
| Superintendent may be paid in its
entirety during the initial  | 
| year of the School Finance Authority's existence or spread in
 | 
| equal or declining amounts over a period of years not to exceed  | 
| the
period of the School Finance  Authority's existence. The  | 
| State Superintendent shall not
approve any loan to the School  | 
| Finance Authority unless the School Finance Authority has been
 | 
| unable to borrow sufficient funds to operate the district.
 | 
|     All loan payments made from the School District Emergency
 | 
| Financial Assistance Fund to a School Finance Authority shall  | 
| be required to be
repaid not later than the date the School  | 
| Finance Authority ceases to exist, with simple
interest over  | 
| the term of the loan at a rate equal to
50% of the one-year  | 
| Constant Maturity Treasury (CMT) yield as last published
by the  | 
| Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System
before the
 | 
| date on which the School Finance Authority's loan is approved  | 
| by the State
Board.
 | 
|     The School Finance Authority shall establish and the  | 
| Illinois Finance Authority shall
approve the terms and  | 
|  | 
| conditions of the loan, including the schedule of
repayments.
 | 
| The schedule shall provide for repayments commencing July 1 of  | 
| each
year or upon each fiscal year's receipt of moneys from a  | 
| tax levy for emergency financial assistance. Repayment shall be  | 
| incorporated into the annual budget of the
district and may be  | 
| made from any fund or funds of the district in
which there are  | 
| moneys available. Default on repayment is subject to the  | 
| Illinois Grant Funds Recovery Act.
When moneys are repaid as  | 
| provided
in this Section, they shall not be made available to  | 
| the School Finance Authority for
further use as emergency  | 
| financial assistance under this Article at any
time thereafter.  | 
| All repayments required to be made by a School Finance  | 
| Authority
shall be received by the State Board and deposited in  | 
| the School District
Emergency Financial Assistance Fund.
 | 
|     In establishing the terms and conditions for the repayment
 | 
| obligation of the School Finance Authority, the School Finance
 | 
| Authority shall annually determine
whether a separate local  | 
| property tax levy is required to meet that obligation.
The  | 
| School Finance Authority
shall provide for a separate tax
levy  | 
| for emergency financial assistance repayment purposes. This  | 
| tax
levy shall not be subject to referendum approval. The  | 
| amount of the levy
shall not exceed the amount necessary to  | 
| meet the annual
emergency financial repayment
obligations of  | 
| the district, including principal and interest, as established
 | 
| by the School Finance Authority.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 94-234, eff. 7-1-06.)
 | 
|  | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1H-20) | 
|     Sec. 1H-20. Members of Panel; meetings. | 
|     (a) Upon establishment of a Financial Oversight Panel under  | 
| Section 1H-15 of this Code, the State Superintendent shall  | 
| within 15 working days thereafter appoint 5 members to serve on  | 
| a Financial Oversight Panel for the district. Members appointed  | 
| to the Panel shall serve at the pleasure of the State  | 
| Superintendent. The State Superintendent shall designate one  | 
| of the members of the Panel to serve as its Chairperson. In the  | 
| event of vacancy or resignation, the State Superintendent  | 
| shall, within 10 days after receiving notice, appoint a  | 
| successor to serve out that member's term. | 
|     (b) Members of the Panel shall be selected primarily on the  | 
| basis of their experience and education in financial  | 
| management, with consideration given to persons knowledgeable  | 
| in education finance. Two members of the Panel shall be  | 
| residents of the school district that the Panel serves. A  | 
| member of the Panel may not be a member of the district's  | 
| school board or an employee of the district nor may a member  | 
| have a direct financial interest in the district. | 
|     (c) Panel members may be reimbursed by the State Board for  | 
| travel and other necessary expenses incurred in the performance  | 
| of their official duties. The amount reimbursed members for  | 
| their expenses shall be charged to the school district as part  | 
| of any emergency financial assistance and incorporated as a  | 
|  | 
| part of the terms and conditions for repayment of the  | 
| assistance or shall be deducted from the district's general  | 
| State aid or evidence-based funding as provided in Section  | 
| 1H-65 of this Code. | 
|     (d) With the exception of the chairperson, who shall be  | 
| designated as provided in subsection (a) of this Section, the  | 
| Panel may elect such officers as it deems appropriate. | 
|     (e) The first meeting of the Panel shall be held at the  | 
| call of the Chairperson. The Panel shall prescribe the times  | 
| and places for its meetings and the manner in which regular and  | 
| special meetings may be called and shall comply with the Open  | 
| Meetings Act. The Panel shall also comply with the Freedom of  | 
| Information Act. | 
|     (f) Three members of the Panel shall constitute a quorum. A  | 
| majority of members present is required to pass a measure.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 97-429, eff. 8-16-11.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/1H-70) | 
|     Sec. 1H-70. Tax anticipation warrants, tax anticipation  | 
| notes, revenue anticipation certificates or notes, general  | 
| State aid or evidence-based funding anticipation certificates,  | 
| and lines of credit. With the approval of the State  | 
| Superintendent and provided that the district is unable to  | 
| secure short-term financing after 3 attempts, a Panel shall  | 
| have the same power as a district to do the following: | 
|         (1)  issue tax anticipation warrants under the  | 
|  | 
| provisions of Section 17-16 of this Code against taxes  | 
| levied by either the school board or the Panel pursuant to  | 
| Section 1H-25 of this Code; | 
|         (2) issue tax anticipation notes under the provisions  | 
| of the Tax Anticipation Note Act against taxes levied by  | 
| either the school board or the Panel pursuant to Section  | 
| 1H-25 of this Code; | 
|         (3) issue revenue anticipation certificates or notes  | 
| under the provisions of the Revenue Anticipation Act; | 
|         (4) issue general State aid or evidence-based funding  | 
| anticipation certificates under the provisions of Section  | 
| 18-18 of this Code; and | 
|         (5) establish and utilize lines of credit under the  | 
| provisions of Section 17-17 of this Code. | 
|     Tax anticipation warrants, tax anticipation notes, revenue  | 
| anticipation certificates or notes, general State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding anticipation certificates, and lines of  | 
| credit are considered borrowing from sources other than the  | 
| State and are subject to Section 1H-65 of this Code. 
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 97-429, eff. 8-16-11.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/2-3.25g)  (from Ch. 122, par. 2-3.25g) | 
|     Sec. 2-3.25g. Waiver or modification of mandates within the  | 
| School
Code and administrative rules and regulations.   | 
|     (a) In this Section: | 
|         "Board" means a school board or the governing board or  | 
|  | 
| administrative district, as the case may be, for a joint  | 
| agreement. | 
|         "Eligible applicant" means a school district, joint  | 
| agreement made up of school districts, or regional  | 
| superintendent of schools on behalf of schools and programs  | 
| operated by the regional office of education.
 | 
|         "Implementation date" has the meaning set forth in  | 
| Section 24A-2.5 of this Code.  | 
|         "State Board" means the State Board of Education.
 | 
|     (b) Notwithstanding any other
provisions of this School  | 
| Code or any other law of this State to the
contrary, eligible  | 
| applicants may petition the State Board of Education for the
 | 
| waiver or modification of the mandates of this School Code or  | 
| of the
administrative rules and regulations promulgated by the  | 
| State Board of
Education.  Waivers or modifications of  | 
| administrative rules and regulations
and modifications of  | 
| mandates of this School Code may be requested when an eligible  | 
| applicant demonstrates that it can address the intent of the  | 
| rule or
mandate in a more effective, efficient, or economical  | 
| manner or when necessary
to stimulate innovation or improve  | 
| student performance.  Waivers of
mandates of
the School Code may  | 
| be requested when the waivers are necessary to stimulate
 | 
| innovation or improve student performance or when the applicant  | 
| demonstrates that it can address the intent of the mandate of  | 
| the School Code in a more effective, efficient, or economical  | 
| manner.  Waivers may not be requested
from laws, rules, and  | 
|  | 
| regulations pertaining to special education, teacher educator  | 
| licensure, teacher tenure and seniority, or Section 5-2.1 of  | 
| this Code or from compliance with the Every Student Succeeds  | 
| Act (Public Law 114-95) No
Child Left Behind Act of 2001  | 
| (Public Law 107-110). Eligible applicants may not seek a waiver  | 
| or seek a modification of a mandate regarding the requirements  | 
| for (i) student performance data to be a significant factor in  | 
| teacher or principal evaluations or (ii) teachers and  | 
| principals to be rated using the 4 categories of "excellent",  | 
| "proficient", "needs improvement", or "unsatisfactory".  On  | 
| September 1, 2014, any previously authorized waiver or  | 
| modification from such requirements shall terminate.  | 
|     (c) Eligible applicants, as a matter of inherent managerial  | 
| policy, and any
Independent Authority established under  | 
| Section 2-3.25f-5 of this Code may submit an
application for a  | 
| waiver or modification authorized under this Section.  Each
 | 
| application must include a written request by the eligible  | 
| applicant or
Independent Authority and must demonstrate that  | 
| the intent of the mandate can
be addressed in a more effective,  | 
| efficient, or economical manner
or be based
upon a specific  | 
| plan for improved student performance and school improvement.
 | 
| Any eligible applicant requesting a waiver or modification for  | 
| the reason that intent
of the mandate can be addressed in a  | 
| more economical manner shall include in
the application a  | 
| fiscal analysis showing current expenditures on the mandate
and  | 
| projected savings resulting from the waiver
or modification.   | 
|  | 
| Applications
and plans developed by eligible applicants must be  | 
| approved by the board or regional superintendent of schools  | 
| applying on behalf of schools or programs operated by the  | 
| regional office of education following a public hearing on the  | 
| application and plan and the
opportunity for the board or  | 
| regional superintendent to hear testimony from staff
directly  | 
| involved in
its implementation, parents, and students. The time  | 
| period for such testimony shall be separate from the time  | 
| period established by the eligible applicant for public comment  | 
| on other matters. If the applicant is a school district or  | 
| joint agreement requesting a waiver or modification of Section  | 
| 27-6 of this Code, the public hearing shall be held on a day  | 
| other than the day on which a regular meeting of the board is  | 
| held. | 
|     (c-5) If the applicant is a school district, then the  | 
| district shall post information that sets forth the time, date,  | 
| place, and general subject matter of the public hearing on its  | 
| Internet website at least 14 days prior to the hearing.  If the  | 
| district is requesting to increase the fee charged for driver  | 
| education authorized pursuant to Section 27-24.2 of this Code,  | 
| the website information shall include the proposed amount of  | 
| the fee the district will request.  All school districts must  | 
| publish a notice of the public hearing at least 7 days prior to  | 
| the hearing in a newspaper of general circulation within the  | 
| school district that sets forth the time, date, place, and  | 
| general subject matter of the hearing.  Districts requesting to  | 
|  | 
| increase the fee charged for driver education shall include in  | 
| the published notice the proposed amount of the fee the  | 
| district will request. If the applicant is a joint agreement or  | 
| regional superintendent, then the joint agreement or regional  | 
| superintendent shall post information that sets forth the time,  | 
| date, place, and general subject matter of the public hearing  | 
| on its Internet website at least 14 days prior to the hearing.   | 
| If the joint agreement or regional superintendent is requesting  | 
| to increase the fee charged for driver education authorized  | 
| pursuant to Section 27-24.2 of this Code, the website  | 
| information shall include the proposed amount of the fee the  | 
| applicant will request.  All joint agreements and regional  | 
| superintendents must publish a notice of the public hearing at  | 
| least 7 days prior to the hearing in a newspaper of general  | 
| circulation in each school district that is a member of the  | 
| joint agreement or that is served by the educational service  | 
| region that sets forth the time, date, place, and general  | 
| subject matter of the hearing, provided that a notice appearing  | 
| in a newspaper generally circulated in more than one school  | 
| district shall be deemed to fulfill this requirement with  | 
| respect to all of the affected districts. Joint agreements or  | 
| regional superintendents requesting to increase the fee  | 
| charged for driver education shall include in the published  | 
| notice the proposed amount of the fee the applicant will  | 
| request. The
eligible applicant must notify in writing the  | 
| affected exclusive collective
bargaining agent and those State  | 
|  | 
| legislators representing the eligible applicant's territory of
 | 
| its
intent to seek approval of a
waiver or
modification and of  | 
| the hearing to be held to take testimony from staff.
The  | 
| affected exclusive collective bargaining agents shall be  | 
| notified of such
public hearing at least 7 days prior to the  | 
| date of the hearing and shall be
allowed to attend
such public  | 
| hearing. The eligible applicant shall attest to compliance with  | 
| all of
the notification and procedural requirements set forth  | 
| in this Section. | 
|     (d) A request for a waiver or modification of  | 
| administrative rules and
regulations or for a modification of  | 
| mandates contained in this School Code
shall be submitted to  | 
| the State Board of Education within 15 days after
approval by  | 
| the board or  regional superintendent of schools.  The  | 
| application as submitted to the
State Board of Education shall  | 
| include a description of the public hearing. Except with  | 
| respect to contracting for adaptive driver education, an  | 
| eligible applicant wishing to request a modification or waiver  | 
| of administrative rules of the State Board of Education  | 
| regarding contracting with a commercial driver training school  | 
| to provide the course of study authorized under Section 27-24.2  | 
| of this Code must provide evidence with its application that  | 
| the commercial driver training school with which it will  | 
| contract holds a license issued by the Secretary of State under  | 
| Article IV of Chapter 6 of the Illinois Vehicle Code and that  | 
| each instructor employed by the commercial driver training  | 
|  | 
| school to provide instruction to students served by the school  | 
| district holds a valid teaching certificate or teaching  | 
| license, as applicable, issued under the requirements of this  | 
| Code and rules of the State Board of Education.  Such evidence  | 
| must include, but need not be limited to, a list of each  | 
| instructor assigned to teach students served by the school  | 
| district, which list shall include the instructor's name,  | 
| personal identification number as required by the State Board  | 
| of Education, birth date, and driver's license number. If the  | 
| modification or waiver is granted, then the eligible applicant  | 
| shall notify the State Board of Education of any changes in the  | 
| personnel providing instruction within 15 calendar days after  | 
| an instructor leaves the program or a new instructor is hired.   | 
| Such notification shall include the instructor's name,  | 
| personal identification number as required by the State Board  | 
| of Education, birth date, and driver's license number.   If a  | 
| school district maintains an Internet website, then the  | 
| district shall post a copy of the final contract between the  | 
| district and the commercial driver training school on the  | 
| district's Internet website. If no Internet website exists,  | 
| then the district shall make available the contract upon  | 
| request. A record of all materials in relation to the  | 
| application for contracting must be maintained by the school  | 
| district and made available to parents and guardians upon  | 
| request. The instructor's date of birth and driver's license  | 
| number and any other personally identifying information as  | 
|  | 
| deemed by the federal Driver's Privacy Protection Act of 1994  | 
| must be redacted from any public materials.
Following receipt  | 
| of the waiver or modification request, the
State Board shall  | 
| have 45 days to review the application and request.  If the
 | 
| State Board fails to disapprove the application within that 45  | 
| day period, the
waiver or modification shall be deemed granted.   | 
| The State Board
may disapprove
any request if it is not based  | 
| upon sound educational practices, endangers the
health or  | 
| safety of students or staff, compromises equal opportunities  | 
| for
learning, or fails to demonstrate that the intent of the  | 
| rule or mandate can be
addressed in a more effective,  | 
| efficient, or economical manner or have improved
student  | 
| performance as a primary goal.  Any request disapproved by the  | 
| State
Board may be appealed to the General Assembly by the  | 
| eligible applicant
as outlined in this Section.  | 
|     A request for a waiver from mandates contained in this  | 
| School Code shall be
submitted to the State Board within 15  | 
| days after approval by the board or regional superintendent of  | 
| schools.
 The application as submitted to the State Board of  | 
| Education
shall include a description of the public hearing.   | 
| The description shall
include, but need not be limited to, the  | 
| means of notice, the number of people
in attendance, the number  | 
| of people who spoke as proponents or opponents of the
waiver, a  | 
| brief description of their comments, and whether there were any
 | 
| written statements submitted.
 The State Board shall review the  | 
| applications and requests for
completeness and shall compile  | 
|  | 
| the requests in reports to be filed with the
General Assembly.  | 
| The State Board shall file
reports outlining the waivers
 | 
| requested by eligible applicants
and appeals by eligible  | 
| applicants of requests
disapproved by the State Board with the  | 
| Senate and the House of
Representatives before each March 1 and
 | 
| October
1. | 
|     The report shall be reviewed by a panel of 4 members  | 
| consisting of: | 
|         (1) the Speaker of the House of Representatives; | 
|         (2) the Minority Leader of the House of  | 
| Representatives; | 
|         (3) the President of the Senate; and | 
|         (4) the Minority Leader of the Senate. | 
| The State Board of Education may provide the panel  | 
| recommendations on waiver requests. The members  of the panel  | 
| shall review the report submitted by the State Board of  | 
| Education and submit to the State Board of Education any notice  | 
| of further consideration to any waiver request within 14 days  | 
| after the member receives the report. If 3 or more of the panel  | 
| members submit a notice of further consideration to any waiver  | 
| request contained within the report, the State Board of  | 
| Education shall submit the waiver request to the General  | 
| Assembly for consideration. If less than 3 panel members submit  | 
| a notice of further consideration to a waiver request, the  | 
| waiver may be approved, denied, or modified by the State Board.   | 
| If the State Board does not act on a waiver request within 10  | 
|  | 
| days, then the waiver request is approved.  If the waiver  | 
| request is denied by the State Board, it shall submit the  | 
| waiver request to the General Assembly for consideration. | 
|     The General Assembly may disapprove any waiver request  | 
| submitted to the General Assembly pursuant to this subsection  | 
| (d) the report of the State Board in whole
or in part within 60  | 
| calendar days after each house of the General Assembly
next
 | 
| convenes after the waiver request is submitted report is filed  | 
| by adoption of a resolution by a record vote
of the majority of  | 
| members elected in each house.  If the General Assembly
fails to  | 
| disapprove any waiver request or appealed request within such  | 
| 60
day period, the waiver or modification shall be deemed  | 
| granted.  Any resolution
adopted by the General Assembly  | 
| disapproving a report of the State Board in
whole or in part  | 
| shall be binding on the State Board. | 
|     (e) An approved waiver or modification (except a waiver  | 
| from or modification to a physical education mandate) may  | 
| remain in effect for a period not to
exceed 5 school years and  | 
| may be renewed upon application by the
eligible applicant.  | 
| However, such waiver or modification may be changed within that
 | 
| 5-year period by a board or regional superintendent of schools  | 
| applying on behalf of schools or programs operated by the  | 
| regional office of education following the procedure as set
 | 
| forth in this Section for the initial waiver or modification  | 
| request.  If
neither the State Board of Education nor the  | 
| General Assembly disapproves, the
change is deemed granted.  | 
|  | 
|     An approved waiver from or modification to a physical  | 
| education mandate may remain in effect for a period not to  | 
| exceed 2 school years and may be renewed no more than 2 times  | 
| upon application by the eligible applicant.  An approved waiver  | 
| from or modification to a physical education mandate may be  | 
| changed within the 2-year period by the board or regional  | 
| superintendent of schools, whichever is applicable, following  | 
| the procedure set forth in this Section for the initial waiver  | 
| or modification request.  If neither the State Board of  | 
| Education nor the General Assembly disapproves, the change is  | 
| deemed granted.
 | 
|     (f) (Blank). | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-513, eff. 1-1-14; 98-739, eff. 7-16-14;  | 
| 98-1155, eff. 1-9-15; 99-78, eff. 7-20-15.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/2-3.33)  (from Ch. 122, par. 2-3.33)
 | 
|     Sec. 2-3.33. Recomputation of claims.  To recompute within  | 
| 3 years from the
final date for filing of a claim any claim for  | 
| general State aid reimbursement to any school
district and one  | 
| year from the final date for filing of a claim for  | 
| evidence-based funding if the claim has been found to be  | 
| incorrect and to adjust subsequent
claims accordingly, and to  | 
| recompute and adjust any such claims within 6 years
from the  | 
| final date for filing when there has been an adverse court or
 | 
| administrative agency decision on
the merits affecting the tax  | 
| revenues of the school district.  However, no such
adjustment  | 
|  | 
| shall be made regarding equalized assessed valuation unless the
 | 
| district's equalized assessed valuation is changed by greater  | 
| than $250,000 or
2%. Any adjustments for claims recomputed for  | 
| the 2016-2017 school year and prior school years shall be  | 
| applied to the apportionment of evidence-based funding in  | 
| Section 18-8.15 of this Code beginning in the 2017-2018 school  | 
| year and thereafter. However, the recomputation of a claim for  | 
| evidence-based funding for a school district shall not require  | 
| the recomputation of claims for all districts, and the State  | 
| Board of Education shall only make recomputations of  | 
| evidence-based funding for those districts where an adjustment  | 
| is required.
 | 
|     Except in the case of an adverse court or administrative  | 
| agency decision,
no recomputation of a
State aid claim shall be  | 
| made pursuant to this Section as a result of a
reduction in the  | 
| assessed valuation of a school district from the assessed
 | 
| valuation of the district reported to the State Board of  | 
| Education by the
Department of Revenue under Section 18-8.05 or  | 
| 18-8.15 of this Code unless the
requirements of Section
16-15  | 
| of the Property Tax Code and Section 2-3.84 of this Code are
 | 
| complied with in all respects.
 | 
|     This paragraph applies to all requests for recomputation of  | 
| a general
State aid or evidence-based funding claim received  | 
| after June 30, 2003. In recomputing a general
State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding claim that was originally calculated  | 
| using an extension
limitation equalized assessed valuation  | 
|  | 
| under paragraph (3) of
subsection (G) of Section 18-8.05 of  | 
| this Code or Section 18-8.15 of this Code, a qualifying  | 
| reduction in
equalized assessed valuation shall be deducted  | 
| from the extension
limitation equalized assessed valuation  | 
| that was used in calculating the
original claim.
 | 
|     From the total amount of general State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding to be provided to
districts,  | 
| adjustments as a result of recomputation under this Section
 | 
| together with adjustments under Section 2-3.84 must not exceed  | 
| $25
million, in the aggregate for all districts under both  | 
| Sections combined,
of the general State aid or evidence-based  | 
| funding appropriation in any fiscal year; if necessary,
amounts  | 
| shall be prorated among districts. If it is necessary to  | 
| prorate
claims under this paragraph, then that portion of each  | 
| prorated claim that is
approved but not paid in the current  | 
| fiscal year may be resubmitted as a
valid claim in the  | 
| following fiscal year.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 93-845, eff. 7-30-04.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/2-3.51.5) | 
|     Sec. 2-3.51.5. School Safety and Educational Improvement  | 
| Block Grant
Program.  To improve the level of education and  | 
| safety of students from
kindergarten through grade 12 in school  | 
| districts and State-recognized, non-public schools.  The State  | 
| Board of
Education is authorized to fund a School Safety and  | 
| Educational Improvement
Block Grant Program.  | 
|  | 
|     (1) For school districts, the program shall provide funding  | 
| for school safety, textbooks and
software, electronic  | 
| textbooks and the technological equipment necessary to gain  | 
| access to and use electronic textbooks, teacher training and  | 
| curriculum development, school improvements, school
report  | 
| cards under Section 10-17a, and criminal history records checks
 | 
| under Sections 10-21.9 and 34-18.5.  For State-recognized,  | 
| non-public schools, the program shall provide funding for  | 
| secular textbooks and software, criminal history records  | 
| checks, and health and safety mandates to the extent that the  | 
| funds are expended for purely secular purposes. A school  | 
| district
or laboratory school as defined in Section 18-8, or  | 
| 18-8.05, or 18-8.15 is not required
to file an application in  | 
| order to receive the categorical funding to which it
is  | 
| entitled under this Section.  Funds for the School Safety and  | 
| Educational
Improvement Block Grant Program shall be  | 
| distributed to school districts and
laboratory schools based on  | 
| the prior year's best 3 months average daily
attendance.  Funds  | 
| for the School Safety and Educational Improvement Block Grant  | 
| Program shall be distributed to State-recognized, non-public  | 
| schools based on the average daily attendance figure for the  | 
| previous school year provided to the State Board of Education.  | 
| The State Board of Education shall develop an application that  | 
| requires State-recognized, non-public schools to submit   | 
| average daily attendance figures. A State-recognized,  | 
| non-public school must submit the application and average daily  | 
|  | 
| attendance figure prior to receiving funds under this Section.  | 
| The State Board of Education shall promulgate rules and
 | 
| regulations necessary for the implementation of this program. | 
|     (2) Distribution of moneys to school districts and  | 
| State-recognized, non-public schools shall be made in 2
 | 
| semi-annual installments, one payment on or before October 30,  | 
| and one
payment prior to April 30, of each fiscal year. | 
|     (3) Grants under the School Safety and Educational  | 
| Improvement Block Grant
Program shall be awarded provided there  | 
| is an appropriation for the program,
and funding levels for  | 
| each district shall be prorated according to the amount
of the  | 
| appropriation. | 
|     (4) The provisions of this Section are in the public  | 
| interest, are for the public benefit, and serve secular public  | 
| purposes.  | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-972, eff. 8-15-14.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/2-3.66)  (from Ch. 122, par. 2-3.66)
 | 
|     Sec. 2-3.66. Truants' alternative and optional education  | 
| programs. To
establish projects to offer modified  | 
| instructional programs or other
services designed to prevent  | 
| students from dropping out of school,
including programs  | 
| pursuant to Section 2-3.41, and to serve as a part time
or full  | 
| time option in lieu of regular school attendance and to award
 | 
| grants to local school districts, educational service regions  | 
| or community
college districts from appropriated funds to  | 
|  | 
| assist districts in
establishing such projects.  The education  | 
| agency may operate its own
program or enter into a contract  | 
| with another not-for-profit entity to
implement the program.   | 
| The projects shall allow dropouts, up to and
including age 21,  | 
| potential dropouts, including truants, uninvolved,
unmotivated  | 
| and disaffected students, as defined by State Board of
 | 
| Education rules and regulations, to enroll, as an alternative  | 
| to regular
school attendance, in an optional education program  | 
| which may be
established by school board policy and is in  | 
| conformance with rules adopted
by the State Board of Education.   | 
| Truants' Alternative and Optional
Education programs funded  | 
| pursuant to this Section shall be
planned by a student, the  | 
| student's parents or legal guardians, unless the
student is 18  | 
| years or older, and school officials and shall culminate in
an  | 
| individualized optional education plan.  Such plan shall focus
 | 
| on academic or vocational skills, or both, and may include, but  | 
| not be
limited to, evening school, summer school, community  | 
| college courses, adult
education, preparation courses for high  | 
| school equivalency testing, vocational training, work  | 
| experience, programs to
enhance self concept and parenting  | 
| courses.  School districts which are
awarded grants pursuant to  | 
| this Section shall be authorized to provide day
care services  | 
| to children of students who are eligible and desire to enroll
 | 
| in programs established and funded under this Section, but only  | 
| if and to
the extent that such day care is necessary to enable  | 
| those eligible
students to attend and participate in the  | 
|  | 
| programs and courses which are
conducted pursuant to this  | 
| Section.
School districts and regional offices of education may  | 
| claim general State
aid under Section 18-8.05 or evidence-based  | 
| funding under Section 18-8.15 for students enrolled in truants'  | 
| alternative and
optional education programs, provided that  | 
| such students are receiving services
that are supplemental to a  | 
| program leading to a high school diploma and are
otherwise  | 
| eligible to be claimed for general State aid under Section  | 
| 18-8.05 or evidence-based funding under Section 18-8.15, as  | 
| applicable.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-718, eff. 1-1-15.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/2-3.66b) | 
|     Sec. 2-3.66b. IHOPE Program. | 
|     (a)  There is established the Illinois Hope and Opportunity  | 
| Pathways through Education (IHOPE) Program.  The State Board of  | 
| Education shall implement and administer the IHOPE Program.  The  | 
| goal of the IHOPE Program is to develop a comprehensive system  | 
| in this State to re-enroll significant numbers of high school  | 
| dropouts in programs that will enable them to earn their high  | 
| school diploma. | 
|     (b)  The IHOPE Program shall award grants, subject to  | 
| appropriation for this purpose, to educational service regions  | 
| and a school district organized under Article 34 of this Code  | 
| from appropriated funds to assist in establishing  | 
| instructional programs and other services designed to  | 
|  | 
| re-enroll high school dropouts. From any funds appropriated for  | 
| the IHOPE Program, the State Board of Education may use up to  | 
| 5% for administrative costs, including the performance of a  | 
| program evaluation and the hiring of staff to implement and  | 
| administer the program.  | 
|     The IHOPE Program shall provide incentive grant funds for  | 
| regional offices of education and a school district organized  | 
| under Article 34 of this Code to develop partnerships with  | 
| school districts, public community colleges, and community  | 
| groups to build comprehensive plans to re-enroll high school  | 
| dropouts in their regions or districts. | 
|     Programs funded through the IHOPE Program shall allow high  | 
| school dropouts, up to and including age 21 notwithstanding  | 
| Section 26-2 of this Code, to re-enroll in an educational  | 
| program in conformance with rules adopted by the State Board of  | 
| Education. Programs may include without limitation  | 
| comprehensive year-round programming, evening school, summer  | 
| school, community college courses, adult education, vocational  | 
| training, work experience, programs to enhance self-concept,  | 
| and parenting courses.  Any student in the IHOPE Program who  | 
| wishes to earn a high school diploma must meet the  | 
| prerequisites to receiving a high school diploma specified in  | 
| Section 27-22 of this Code and any other graduation  | 
| requirements of the student's district of residence.  Any  | 
| student who successfully completes the requirements for his or  | 
| her graduation shall receive a diploma identifying the student  | 
|  | 
| as graduating from his or her district of residence.  | 
|     (c)  In order to be eligible for funding under the IHOPE  | 
| Program, an interested regional office of education or a school  | 
| district organized under Article 34 of this Code shall develop  | 
| an IHOPE Plan to be approved by the State Board of Education.   | 
| The State Board of Education shall develop rules for the IHOPE  | 
| Program that shall set forth the requirements for the  | 
| development of the IHOPE Plan.  Each Plan shall involve school  | 
| districts, public community colleges, and key community  | 
| programs that work with high school dropouts located in an  | 
| educational service region or the City of Chicago before the  | 
| Plan is sent to the State Board for approval.  No funds may be  | 
| distributed to a regional office of education or a school  | 
| district organized under Article 34 of this Code until the  | 
| State Board has approved the Plan. | 
|     (d)  A regional office of education or a school district  | 
| organized under Article 34 of this Code may operate its own  | 
| program funded by the IHOPE Program or enter into a contract  | 
| with other not-for-profit entities, including school  | 
| districts, public community colleges, and not-for-profit  | 
| community-based organizations, to operate a program.  | 
|     A regional office of education or a school district  | 
| organized under Article 34 of this Code that receives an IHOPE  | 
| grant from the State Board of Education may provide funds under  | 
| a sub-grant, as specified in the IHOPE Plan, to other  | 
| not-for-profit entities to provide services according to the  | 
|  | 
| IHOPE Plan that was developed.  These other entities may include  | 
| school districts, public community colleges, or not-for-profit  | 
| community-based organizations or a cooperative partnership  | 
| among these entities. | 
|     (e)  In order to distribute funding based upon the need to  | 
| ensure delivery of programs that will have the greatest impact,  | 
| IHOPE Program funding must be distributed based upon the  | 
| proportion of dropouts in the educational service region or  | 
| school district, in the case of a school district organized  | 
| under Article 34 of this Code, to the total number of dropouts  | 
| in this State.  This formula shall employ the dropout data  | 
| provided by school districts to the State Board of Education.  | 
|     A regional office of education or a school district  | 
| organized under Article 34 of this Code may claim State aid  | 
| under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code for students  | 
| enrolled in a program funded by the IHOPE Program, provided  | 
| that the State Board of Education has approved the IHOPE Plan  | 
| and that these students are receiving services that are meeting  | 
| the requirements of Section 27-22 of this Code for receipt of a  | 
| high school diploma and are otherwise eligible to be claimed  | 
| for general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of this Code or  | 
| evidence-based funding under Section 18-8.15 of this Code,  | 
| including provisions related to the minimum number of days of  | 
| pupil attendance pursuant to Section 10-19 of this Code and the  | 
| minimum number of daily hours of school work and any exceptions  | 
| thereto as defined by the State Board of Education in rules.  | 
|  | 
|     (f)  IHOPE categories of programming may include the  | 
| following: | 
|         (1)  Full-time programs that are comprehensive,  | 
| year-round programs. | 
|         (2)  Part-time programs combining work and study  | 
| scheduled at various times that are flexible to the needs  | 
| of students. | 
|         (3)  Online programs and courses in which students take  | 
| courses and complete on-site, supervised tests that  | 
| measure the student's mastery of a specific course needed  | 
| for graduation. Students may take courses online and earn  | 
| credit or students may prepare to take supervised tests for  | 
| specific courses for credit leading to receipt of a high  | 
| school diploma. | 
|         (4)  Dual enrollment in which students attend high  | 
| school classes in combination with community college  | 
| classes or students attend community college classes while  | 
| simultaneously earning high school credit and eventually a  | 
| high school diploma.  | 
|     (g)  In order to have successful comprehensive programs  | 
| re-enrolling and graduating low-skilled high school dropouts,  | 
| programs funded through the IHOPE Program shall include all of  | 
| the following components: | 
|         (1)  Small programs (70 to 100 students) at a separate  | 
| school site with a distinct identity.  Programs may be  | 
| larger with specific need and justification, keeping in  | 
|  | 
| mind that it is crucial to keep programs small to be  | 
| effective. | 
|         (2)  Specific performance-based goals and outcomes and  | 
| measures of enrollment, attendance, skills, credits,  | 
| graduation, and the transition to college, training, and  | 
| employment. | 
|         (3)  Strong, experienced leadership and teaching staff  | 
| who are provided with ongoing professional development. | 
|         (4)  Voluntary enrollment. | 
|         (5)  High standards for student learning, integrating  | 
| work experience, and education, including during the  | 
| school year and after school, and summer school programs  | 
| that link internships, work, and learning. | 
|         (6)  Comprehensive programs providing extensive support  | 
| services. | 
|         (7)  Small teams of students supported by full-time paid  | 
| mentors who work to retain and help those students  | 
| graduate. | 
|         (8)  A comprehensive technology learning center with  | 
| Internet access and broad-based curriculum focusing on  | 
| academic and career subject areas. | 
|         (9)  Learning opportunities that incorporate action  | 
| into study. | 
|     (h)  Programs funded through the IHOPE Program must report  | 
| data to the State Board of Education as requested.  This  | 
| information shall include, but is not limited to, student  | 
|  | 
| enrollment figures, attendance information, course completion  | 
| data, graduation information, and post-graduation information,  | 
| as available.  | 
|     (i)  Rules must be developed by the State Board of Education  | 
| to set forth the fund distribution process to regional offices  | 
| of education and a school district organized under Article 34  | 
| of this Code, the planning and the conditions upon which an  | 
| IHOPE Plan would be approved by State Board, and other rules to  | 
| develop the IHOPE Program. 
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 96-106, eff. 7-30-09.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/2-3.84)  (from Ch. 122, par. 2-3.84)
 | 
|     Sec. 2-3.84. In calculating the amount of State aid to be  | 
| apportioned
to the various school districts in this State, the  | 
| State Board of Education
shall incorporate and deduct the total  | 
| aggregate adjustments to assessments
made by
the State Property  | 
| Tax Appeal Board or Cook County Board of Appeals, as
reported  | 
| pursuant to Section 16-15 of the Property Tax Code or Section
 | 
| 129.1 of the Revenue Act of 1939 by the Department of Revenue,  | 
| from the
equalized assessed valuation that is otherwise to be  | 
| utilized in
the initial calculation.
 | 
|     From the total amount of general State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding to be provided to
districts,  | 
| adjustments under this Section together with adjustments as a
 | 
| result of recomputation under Section 2-3.33 must not exceed  | 
| $25
million, in the aggregate for all districts under both  | 
|  | 
| Sections combined,
of the general State aid or evidence-based  | 
| funding appropriation in any fiscal year; if necessary,
amounts  | 
| shall be prorated among districts. If it is necessary to  | 
| prorate
claims under this paragraph, then that portion of each  | 
| prorated claim that is
approved but not paid in the current  | 
| fiscal year may be resubmitted as a
valid claim in the  | 
| following fiscal year.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 93-845, eff. 7-30-04.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/2-3.109a)
 | 
|     Sec. 2-3.109a. Laboratory schools grant eligibility. A  | 
| laboratory school
as defined in Section 18-8 or 18-8.15 may  | 
| apply for and be eligible to receive, subject to
the same  | 
| restrictions applicable to school districts, any grant  | 
| administered by
the State Board of Education that is available  | 
| for school districts.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 90-566, eff. 1-2-98.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/2-3.170 new) | 
|     Sec. 2-3.170. Property tax relief pool grants. | 
|     (a) As used in this Section, | 
|     "Property tax multiplier" equals one minus the square of  | 
| the school district's Local Capacity Percentage, as defined in  | 
| Section 18-8.15 of this Code. | 
|     "State Board" means the State Board of Education. | 
|     "Unit equivalent tax rate" means the Adjusted Operating Tax  | 
|  | 
| Rate, as defined in Section 18-8.15 of this Code, multiplied by  | 
| a factor of 1 for unit school districts, 13/9 for elementary  | 
| school districts, and 13/4 for high school districts.  | 
|     (b) Subject to appropriation, the State Board shall provide  | 
| grants to eligible school districts that provide tax relief to  | 
| the school district's residents, up to a limit of 1% of the  | 
| school district's equalized assessed value, as provided in this  | 
| Section. | 
|     (c) By August 1 of each year, the State Board shall publish  | 
| an estimated threshold unit equivalent tax rate. School  | 
| districts whose adjusted operating tax rate, as defined in this  | 
| Section, is greater than the estimated threshold unit  | 
| equivalent tax rate are eligible for relief under this Section.  | 
| This estimated tax rate shall be based on the most recent  | 
| available data provided by school districts pursuant to Section  | 
| 18-8.15 of this Code. The State Board shall estimate this  | 
| property tax rate based on the amount appropriated to the grant  | 
| program and the assumption that a set of school districts,  | 
| based on criteria established by the State Board, will apply  | 
| for grants under this Section. The criteria shall be based on  | 
| reasonable assumptions about when school districts will apply  | 
| for the grant. | 
|     (d) School districts seeking grants under this Section  | 
| shall apply to the State Board by October 1 of each year. All  | 
| applications to the State Board for grants shall include the  | 
| amount of the grant requested. | 
|  | 
|     (e) By December 1 of each year, based on the most recent  | 
| available data provided by school districts pursuant to Section  | 
| 18-8.15 of this Code, the State Board shall calculate the unit  | 
| equivalent tax rate, based on the applications received by the  | 
| State Board, above which the appropriations are sufficient to  | 
| provide relief and publish a list of the school districts  | 
| eligible for relief. | 
|     (f) The State Board shall publish a final list of grant  | 
| recipients and provide payment of the grants by January 15 of  | 
| each year. | 
|     (g) If payment from the State Board is received by the  | 
| school district on time, the school district shall reduce its  | 
| property tax levy in an amount equal to the grant received  | 
| under this Section. | 
|     (h)   The total grant to a school district under this Section  | 
| shall be calculated based on the total amount of reduction in  | 
| the school district's aggregate extension, up to a limit of 1%  | 
| of a district's equalized assessed value for a unit school  | 
| district, 0.69% for an elementary school district, and 0.31%  | 
| for a high school district, multiplied by the property tax  | 
| multiplier or the amount that the unit equivalent tax rate is  | 
| greater than the rate determined by the State Board, whichever  | 
| is less. | 
|     (i)   If the State Board does not expend all appropriations  | 
| allocated pursuant to this Section, then any remaining funds  | 
| shall be allocated pursuant to Section 18-8.15 of this Code. | 
|  | 
|     (j) The State Board shall prioritize payments under Section  | 
| 18-8.15 of this Code over payments under this Section, if  | 
| necessary. | 
|     (k) Any grants received by a school district shall be  | 
| included in future calculations of that school district's Base  | 
| Funding Minimum under Section 18-8.15 of this Code. | 
|     (l)   In the tax year following receipt of a Property Tax  | 
| Pool Relief Grant, the aggregate levy of any school district  | 
| receiving a grant under this Section, for purposes of the  | 
| Property Tax Extension Limitation Law, shall include the tax  | 
| relief the school district provided in the previous taxable  | 
| year under this Section.
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/3-14.21)  (from Ch. 122, par. 3-14.21)
 | 
|     Sec. 3-14.21. Inspection of schools. 
 | 
|     (a) The regional superintendent shall inspect and survey  | 
| all
public
schools under his or her supervision and notify the  | 
| board of education, or the
trustees of schools in a district  | 
| with trustees, in writing before July 30,
whether or not the  | 
| several schools in their district have been kept as required
by  | 
| law, using forms provided by the State Board of Education which  | 
| are based on
the Health/Life Safety Code for Public Schools  | 
| adopted under Section 2-3.12.  The regional
superintendent  | 
| shall report his or her findings to the State Board of
 | 
| Education on
forms provided by the State Board of Education.
 | 
|     (b) If the regional superintendent determines that a school  | 
|  | 
| board has
failed in a timely manner to correct urgent items  | 
| identified in a previous
life-safety report completed under  | 
| Section 2-3.12 or as otherwise previously
ordered by the  | 
| regional superintendent, the regional superintendent shall  | 
| order
the school board to adopt and submit to the regional  | 
| superintendent a plan for
the immediate correction of the  | 
| building violations.  This plan shall be
adopted following a  | 
| public hearing that is conducted by the school board on the
 | 
| violations and the plan and that is preceded by at least 7  | 
| days' prior notice
of the hearing published in
a newspaper of  | 
| general circulation within the school district.  If the regional
 | 
| superintendent determines in the next annual inspection that  | 
| the plan has not
been completed and that the violations have  | 
| not been corrected, the regional
superintendent shall submit a  | 
| report to the State Board of Education with a
recommendation  | 
| that the State Board withhold from payments of general State  | 
| aid or evidence-based funding
due to the district an amount  | 
| necessary to correct the outstanding violations.
The State  | 
| Board, upon notice to the school board
and to the regional  | 
| superintendent, shall consider the report at a meeting of
the  | 
| State Board, and may order that a sufficient amount of general  | 
| State aid or evidence-based funding be
withheld from payments  | 
| due to the district to correct the violations.  This
amount  | 
| shall be paid to the regional superintendent who shall contract  | 
| on
behalf of the school board for the correction of the  | 
| outstanding violations.
 | 
|  | 
|     (c)  The Office of the State Fire Marshal or a qualified  | 
| fire official, as defined in Section 2-3.12 of this Code, to  | 
| whom the State Fire Marshal has delegated his or her authority  | 
| shall conduct an annual fire safety inspection of each school  | 
| building in this State.  The State Fire Marshal or the fire  | 
| official shall coordinate its inspections with the regional  | 
| superintendent. The inspection shall be based on the fire  | 
| safety code authorized in Section 2-3.12 of this Code.  Any  | 
| violations shall be reported in writing to the regional  | 
| superintendent and shall reference the specific code sections  | 
| where a discrepancy has been identified within 15 days after  | 
| the inspection has been conducted.  The regional superintendent  | 
| shall address  those violations that are not corrected in a  | 
| timely manner pursuant to subsection (b) of this Section.  The  | 
| inspection must be at no cost to the school district.
 | 
|     (d) If a municipality or, in the case of an unincorporated  | 
| area, a county or, if applicable, a fire protection district  | 
| wishes to perform new construction inspections under the  | 
| jurisdiction of a regional superintendent, then the entity must  | 
| register this wish with the regional superintendent. These  | 
| inspections must be based on the building code authorized in  | 
| Section 2-3.12 of this Code. The inspections must be at no cost  | 
| to the school district.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 96-734, eff. 8-25-09.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/7-14A)  (from Ch. 122, par. 7-14A)
 | 
|  | 
|     Sec. 7-14A. Annexation compensation. There shall be no  | 
| accounting
made after a mere change in boundaries when no new  | 
| district is created, except that those districts whose  | 
| enrollment increases by 90% or more as a result of annexing  | 
| territory detached from another district pursuant to this  | 
| Article are eligible for supplementary State aid payments in  | 
| accordance with Section 11E-135  of this Code.  Eligible annexing  | 
| districts shall apply to the State Board of Education for  | 
| supplementary State aid payments by submitting enrollment  | 
| figures for the year immediately preceding and the year  | 
| immediately following the effective date of the boundary change  | 
| for both the district gaining territory and the district losing  | 
| territory.  Copies of any intergovernmental agreements between  | 
| the district gaining territory and the district losing  | 
| territory detailing any transfer of fund balances and staff  | 
| must also be submitted. In all instances of changes in  | 
| boundaries,
 the district losing territory shall
not count the  | 
| average daily attendance of pupils living in the territory
 | 
| during the year preceding the effective date of the boundary  | 
| change in its
claim for reimbursement under Section 18-8.05 or  | 
| 18-8.15 of this Code for the school year following
the  | 
| effective date of the change in boundaries and the district  | 
| receiving
the territory shall count the average daily  | 
| attendance of pupils living in
the territory during the year  | 
| preceding the effective date of the boundary
change in its  | 
| claim for reimbursement under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of  | 
|  | 
| this Code for the school
year following the effective date of  | 
| the change in boundaries. The changes to this Section made by  | 
| this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly are intended  | 
| to be retroactive and applicable to any annexation taking  | 
| effect on or after July 1, 2004.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 99-657, eff. 7-28-16.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/10-17a)  (from Ch. 122, par. 10-17a)
 | 
|     Sec. 10-17a. State, school district, and school report  | 
| cards. 
 | 
|     (1) By October 31, 2013 and October 31 of each subsequent  | 
| school year, the State Board of Education, through the State  | 
| Superintendent of Education, shall prepare a State report card,  | 
| school district report cards, and school report cards, and  | 
| shall by the most economic means provide to each school
 | 
| district in this State, including special charter districts and  | 
| districts
subject to the provisions of Article 34, the report  | 
| cards for the school district and each of its schools.   | 
|     (2) In addition to any information required by federal law,  | 
| the State Superintendent shall determine the indicators and  | 
| presentation of the school report card, which must include, at  | 
| a minimum, the most current data possessed by the State Board  | 
| of Education related to the following: | 
|         (A)  school characteristics and student demographics,  | 
| including average class size, average teaching experience,   | 
| student racial/ethnic breakdown, and the percentage of  | 
|  | 
| students classified as low-income; the percentage of  | 
| students classified as English learners; the percentage of  | 
| students who have individualized education plans or 504  | 
| plans that provide for special education services;  the  | 
| percentage of students who annually transferred in or out  | 
| of the school district; the per-pupil operating  | 
| expenditure of the school district; and the per-pupil State  | 
| average operating expenditure  for the district type  | 
| (elementary, high school, or unit); | 
|         (B)  curriculum information, including, where  | 
| applicable, Advanced Placement, International  | 
| Baccalaureate or equivalent courses, dual enrollment  | 
| courses, foreign language classes, school personnel  | 
| resources (including Career Technical Education teachers),  | 
| before and after school programs, extracurricular  | 
| activities, subjects in which elective classes are  | 
| offered, health and wellness initiatives (including the  | 
| average number of days of Physical Education per week per  | 
| student), approved programs of study, awards received,  | 
| community partnerships, and special programs such as  | 
| programming for the gifted and talented, students with  | 
| disabilities, and work-study students; | 
|         (C) student outcomes, including, where applicable, the  | 
| percentage of students deemed proficient on assessments of  | 
| State standards, the percentage of students in the eighth  | 
| grade who pass Algebra, the percentage of students enrolled  | 
|  | 
| in post-secondary institutions (including colleges,  | 
| universities, community colleges, trade/vocational  | 
| schools, and training programs leading to career  | 
| certification within 2 semesters of high school  | 
| graduation), the percentage of students graduating from  | 
| high school who are college and career ready, and the  | 
| percentage of graduates enrolled in community colleges,  | 
| colleges, and universities who are in one or more courses  | 
| that the community college, college, or university  | 
| identifies as a developmental course;  | 
|         (D)  student progress, including, where applicable, the  | 
| percentage of students in the ninth grade who have earned 5  | 
| credits or more without failing more than one core class, a  | 
| measure of students entering kindergarten ready to learn, a  | 
| measure of growth, and the percentage of students who enter  | 
| high school on track for college and career readiness; | 
|         (E)  the school environment, including, where  | 
| applicable, the percentage of students with less than 10  | 
| absences in a school year, the percentage of teachers with  | 
| less than 10 absences in a school year for reasons other  | 
| than professional development, leaves taken pursuant to  | 
| the federal Family Medical Leave Act of 1993, long-term  | 
| disability, or parental leaves, the 3-year average of the  | 
| percentage of teachers returning to the school from the  | 
| previous year, the number of different principals at the  | 
| school in the last 6 years, 2 or more indicators from any  | 
|  | 
| school climate survey selected or approved by the State and  | 
| administered pursuant to Section 2-3.153 of this Code, with  | 
| the same or similar indicators included on school report  | 
| cards for all surveys selected or approved by the State  | 
| pursuant to Section 2-3.153 of this Code, and the combined  | 
| percentage of teachers rated as proficient or excellent in  | 
| their most recent evaluation; and | 
|         (F) a school district's and its individual schools'  | 
| balanced accountability measure, in accordance with  | 
| Section 2-3.25a of this Code; . | 
|         (G) a school district's Final Percent of Adequacy, as  | 
| defined in paragraph (4) of subsection (f) of Section  | 
| 18-8.15 of this Code; | 
|         (H) a school district's Local Capacity Target, as  | 
| defined in paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of Section  | 
| 18-8.15 of this Code, displayed as a percentage amount; and | 
|         (I) a school district's Real Receipts, as defined in  | 
| paragraph (1) of subsection (d) of Section 18-8.15 of this  | 
| Code, divided by a school district's Adequacy Target, as  | 
| defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (b) of Section  | 
| 18-8.15 of this Code, displayed as a percentage amount.  | 
|     The school report card shall also provide
information that  | 
| allows for comparing the current outcome, progress, and  | 
| environment data to the State average, to the school data from  | 
| the past 5 years, and to the outcomes, progress, and  | 
| environment of similar schools based on the type of school and  | 
|  | 
| enrollment of low-income students, special education students,  | 
| and English learners.
 | 
|     (3)  At the discretion of the State Superintendent, the  | 
| school district report card shall include a subset of the  | 
| information identified in paragraphs (A) through (E) of  | 
| subsection (2) of this Section, as well as information relating  | 
| to the operating expense per pupil and other finances of the  | 
| school district, and the State report card shall include a  | 
| subset of the information identified in paragraphs (A) through  | 
| (E) of subsection (2) of this Section.  | 
|     (4) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this  | 
| Section, in consultation with key education stakeholders, the  | 
| State Superintendent shall at any time have the discretion to  | 
| amend or update any and all metrics on the school, district, or  | 
| State report card.  | 
|     (5) Annually, no more than 30 calendar days after receipt  | 
| of the school district and school report cards from the State  | 
| Superintendent of Education, each school district, including  | 
| special charter districts and districts subject to the  | 
| provisions of Article 34, shall present such report
cards at a  | 
| regular school board meeting subject to
applicable notice  | 
| requirements, post the report cards
 on the
school district's  | 
| Internet web site, if the district maintains an Internet web
 | 
| site, make the report cards
 available
to a newspaper of general  | 
| circulation serving the district, and, upon
request, send the  | 
| report cards
home to a parent (unless the district does not  | 
|  | 
| maintain an Internet web site,
in which case
the report card  | 
| shall be sent home to parents without request).  If the
district  | 
| posts the report card on its Internet web
site, the district
 | 
| shall send a
written notice home to parents stating (i) that  | 
| the report card is available on
the web site,
(ii) the address  | 
| of the web site, (iii) that a printed copy of the report card
 | 
| will be sent to
parents upon request, and (iv) the telephone  | 
| number that parents may
call to
request a printed copy of the  | 
| report card.
 | 
|     (6) Nothing contained in this amendatory Act of the 98th  | 
| General Assembly repeals, supersedes, invalidates, or  | 
| nullifies final decisions in lawsuits pending on the effective  | 
| date of this amendatory Act of the 98th General Assembly in  | 
| Illinois courts involving the interpretation of Public Act  | 
| 97-8.  | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13; 98-648, eff. 7-1-14; 99-30,  | 
| eff. 7-10-15; 99-193, eff. 7-30-15; 99-642, eff. 7-28-16.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/10-19)  (from Ch. 122, par. 10-19)
 | 
|     Sec. 10-19. Length of school term  -  experimental programs.  | 
| Each school
board shall annually prepare a calendar for the  | 
| school term, specifying
the opening and closing dates and  | 
| providing a minimum term of at least 185
days to insure 176  | 
| days of actual pupil attendance, computable under Section
 | 
| 18-8.05 or 18-8.15, except that for the 1980-1981 school year  | 
| only 175 days
of actual
pupil attendance shall be required  | 
|  | 
| because of the closing of schools pursuant
to Section 24-2 on  | 
| January 29, 1981 upon the appointment by the President
of that  | 
| day as a day of thanksgiving for the freedom of the Americans  | 
| who
had been held hostage in Iran. Any days allowed by law for  | 
| teachers' institutes
 but not used as such or used as parental  | 
| institutes as provided
in Section 10-22.18d shall increase the  | 
| minimum term by the school days not
so used.  Except as provided  | 
| in Section 10-19.1, the board may not extend
the school term  | 
| beyond such closing date unless that extension of term is
 | 
| necessary to provide the minimum number of computable days.  In  | 
| case of
such necessary extension school employees
shall be paid  | 
| for such additional time on the basis of their regular
 | 
| contracts.  A school board may specify a closing date earlier  | 
| than that
set on the annual calendar when the schools of the  | 
| district have
provided the minimum number of computable days  | 
| under this Section.
Nothing in this Section prevents the board  | 
| from employing
superintendents of schools, principals and  | 
| other nonteaching personnel
for a period of 12 months, or in  | 
| the case of superintendents for a
period in accordance with  | 
| Section 10-23.8, or prevents the board from
employing other  | 
| personnel before or after the regular school term with
payment  | 
| of salary proportionate to that received for comparable work
 | 
| during the school term.
 | 
|     A school board may make such changes in its calendar for  | 
| the school term
as may be required by any changes in the legal  | 
| school holidays prescribed
in Section 24-2.  A school board may  | 
|  | 
| make changes in its calendar for the
school term as may be  | 
| necessary to reflect the utilization of teachers'
institute  | 
| days as parental institute days as provided in Section  | 
| 10-22.18d.
 | 
|     The calendar for the school term and any changes must be  | 
| submitted to and approved by the regional superintendent of  | 
| schools before the calendar or changes may take effect.
 | 
|     With the prior approval of the State Board of Education and  | 
| subject
to review by the State Board of Education every 3  | 
| years, any school
board may, by resolution of its board and in  | 
| agreement with affected
exclusive collective bargaining  | 
| agents, establish experimental
educational programs, including  | 
| but not limited to programs for e-learning days as authorized  | 
| under Section 10-20.56 of this Code,
self-directed learning, or  | 
| outside of formal class periods, which programs
when so  | 
| approved shall be considered to comply with the requirements of
 | 
| this Section as respects numbers of days of actual pupil  | 
| attendance and
with the other requirements of this Act as  | 
| respects courses of instruction.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-756, eff. 7-16-14; 99-194, eff. 7-30-15.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/10-22.5a)  (from Ch. 122, par. 10-22.5a)
 | 
|     Sec. 10-22.5a. Attendance by dependents of United States  | 
| military personnel, foreign exchange students, and certain
 | 
| nonresident pupils. | 
|     (a) To enter into written agreements with cultural exchange  | 
|  | 
| organizations,
or with nationally recognized eleemosynary  | 
| institutions that promote excellence
in the arts, mathematics,  | 
| or science. The written agreements may provide
for tuition free  | 
| attendance at the local district school by foreign exchange
 | 
| students, or by nonresident pupils of eleemosynary  | 
| institutions. The local
board of education, as part of the  | 
| agreement, may require that the cultural
exchange program or  | 
| the eleemosynary institutions provide services to the
district  | 
| in exchange for the waiver of nonresident tuition.
 | 
|     To enter into written agreements with adjacent school  | 
| districts to provide
for tuition free attendance by a student  | 
| of the adjacent district when
requested for the student's  | 
| health and safety by the student or parent and both
districts  | 
| determine that the student's health or safety will be served by  | 
| such
attendance. Districts shall not be required to enter into  | 
| such agreements nor
be
required to alter existing  | 
| transportation services due to the attendance of
such  | 
| non-resident pupils.
 | 
|     (a-5) If, at the time of enrollment, a dependent of United  | 
| States military personnel is housed in temporary housing  | 
| located outside of a school district, but will be living within  | 
| the district within 60 days after the time of initial  | 
| enrollment, the dependent must be allowed to enroll, subject to  | 
| the requirements of this subsection (a-5), and must not be  | 
| charged tuition. Any United States military personnel  | 
| attempting to enroll a dependent under this subsection (a-5)  | 
|  | 
| shall provide proof that the dependent will be living within  | 
| the district within 60 days after the time of initial  | 
| enrollment. Proof of residency may include, but is not limited  | 
| to, postmarked mail addressed to the military personnel and  | 
| sent to an address located within the district, a lease  | 
| agreement for occupancy of a residence located within the  | 
| district, or proof of ownership of a residence located within  | 
| the district.
 | 
|     (b) Nonresident pupils and foreign exchange students  | 
| attending school on a
tuition free basis under such agreements  | 
| and nonresident dependents of United States military personnel  | 
| attending school on a tuition free basis may be counted for the  | 
| purposes
of determining the apportionment of State aid provided  | 
| under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15
of this Code. No organization
 | 
| or institution participating in agreements authorized under  | 
| this Section
may exclude any individual for participation in  | 
| its program on account
of the person's race, color, sex,  | 
| religion or nationality.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-739, eff. 7-16-14.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/10-22.20)  (from Ch. 122, par. 10-22.20)
 | 
|     Sec. 10-22.20. Classes for adults and youths whose  | 
| schooling has
been interrupted; conditions for State  | 
| reimbursement; use of child
care facilities. | 
|     (a) To establish special classes for the instruction (1)
of  | 
| persons of age 21 years or over and (2) of persons less than  | 
|  | 
| age 21
and not otherwise in attendance in public school, for  | 
| the purpose of
providing adults in the community and youths  | 
| whose schooling has been
interrupted with such additional basic  | 
| education, vocational skill
training, and other instruction as  | 
| may be necessary to increase their
qualifications for  | 
| employment or other means of self-support and their
ability to  | 
| meet their responsibilities as citizens, including courses of
 | 
| instruction regularly accepted for graduation from elementary  | 
| or high
schools and for Americanization and high school  | 
| equivalency testing review classes.
 | 
|     The board shall pay the necessary expenses of such classes  | 
| out of
school funds of the district, including costs of student  | 
| transportation
and such facilities or provision for child-care  | 
| as may be necessary in
the judgment of the board to permit  | 
| maximum utilization of the courses
by students with children,  | 
| and other special needs of the students
directly related to  | 
| such instruction.  The expenses thus incurred shall
be subject  | 
| to State reimbursement, as provided in this Section.  The
board  | 
| may make a tuition charge for persons taking instruction who  | 
| are
not subject to State reimbursement, such tuition charge not  | 
| to exceed
the per capita cost of such classes.
 | 
|     The cost of such instruction, including the additional  | 
| expenses herein
authorized, incurred for recipients of  | 
| financial aid under the Illinois
Public Aid Code, or for  | 
| persons for whom education and training aid has been
authorized  | 
| under Section 9-8 of that Code, shall be assumed in its  | 
|  | 
| entirety
from funds appropriated by the State to the Illinois  | 
| Community College
Board.
 | 
|     (b) The
Illinois Community College Board shall establish
 | 
| the standards for the
courses of instruction reimbursed
under  | 
| this Section.  The Illinois Community College Board shall  | 
| supervise the
administration of the programs.  The Illinois  | 
| Community College Board shall
determine the cost
of instruction  | 
| in accordance with standards established by the Illinois
 | 
| Community College Board, including therein
other incidental  | 
| costs as herein authorized, which shall serve as the basis of
 | 
| State reimbursement in accordance with the provisions of  this  | 
| Section. In the
approval of programs and the determination of  | 
| the cost of instruction, the
Illinois Community College Board  | 
| shall provide
for the maximum utilization of federal
funds for  | 
| such programs.
The Illinois Community College Board shall also  | 
| provide for:
 | 
|         (1) the development of an index of need for program  | 
| planning and for area
funding allocations, as defined by  | 
| the Illinois Community College Board;
 | 
|         (2) the method for calculating hours of instruction, as  | 
| defined by the
Illinois Community College Board, claimable
 | 
| for reimbursement and a method to phase in
the calculation  | 
| and for adjusting the calculations in cases where the  | 
| services
of a program are interrupted due to circumstances  | 
| beyond the control of the
program provider;
 | 
|         (3) a plan for the reallocation of funds to increase  | 
|  | 
| the amount allocated
for grants based upon program  | 
| performance as set forth in subsection (d) below;
and
 | 
|         (4) the development of standards for determining  | 
| grants based upon
performance as set forth in subsection  | 
| (d) below and a plan for the phased-in
implementation of  | 
| those standards.
 | 
|     For instruction provided by school districts and community  | 
| college
districts beginning July 1, 1996 and thereafter,  | 
| reimbursement
provided by
the Illinois Community College Board  | 
| for
classes authorized by this Section
shall be provided from
 | 
| funds appropriated for the reimbursement criteria set forth in  | 
| subsection (c)
below.
 | 
|     (c) Upon the annual approval of the Illinois Community  | 
| College Board, reimbursement
shall be first provided for  | 
| transportation, child care services, and other
special needs of  | 
| the students directly related to instruction and then from the
 | 
| funds remaining
an amount equal to the product of the total  | 
| credit hours or units
of instruction approved by the Illinois  | 
| Community College Board, multiplied by the
following:
 | 
|         (1) For adult basic education, the maximum  | 
| reimbursement per
credit hour
or per unit of instruction  | 
| shall be equal to (i) through fiscal year 2017, the general  | 
| state aid per pupil
foundation level established in  | 
| subsection (B) of Section 18-8.05, divided by
60, or (ii)  | 
| in fiscal year 2018 and thereafter, the prior fiscal year  | 
| reimbursement level multiplied by the Consumer Price Index  | 
|  | 
| for All Urban Consumers for all items published by the  | 
| United States Department of Labor;
 | 
|         (2) The maximum reimbursement per credit hour or per  | 
| unit of
instruction
in subparagraph (1) above shall be  | 
| weighted for students enrolled in classes
defined as  | 
| vocational skills and
approved
by the Illinois Community  | 
| College Board by
1.25;
 | 
|         (3) The maximum reimbursement per credit hour or per  | 
| unit of
instruction
in subparagraph (1) above shall be  | 
| multiplied by .90 for students enrolled in
classes defined  | 
| as adult
secondary
education programs and approved by the  | 
| Illinois Community College Board;
 | 
|         (4) (Blank); and
 | 
|         (5)  Funding
for program years after 1999-2000 shall be  | 
| determined by the Illinois
Community College Board.
 | 
|     (d) Upon its annual approval, the Illinois Community  | 
| College Board
shall provide grants to eligible programs for  | 
| supplemental
activities to improve or expand services under the  | 
| Adult Education Act.
Eligible programs shall be determined  | 
| based upon performance outcomes of
students in the programs as  | 
| set by the Illinois Community College Board.
 | 
|     (e) Reimbursement under this Section shall not exceed
the  | 
| actual costs of the approved program.
 | 
|     If the amount appropriated to the Illinois Community  | 
| College Board for
reimbursement under this Section is less than  | 
| the amount required under
this Act, the apportionment shall
be  | 
|  | 
| proportionately reduced.
 | 
|     School districts and community college districts may  | 
| assess students up
to $3.00 per credit hour, for classes other  | 
| than Adult Basic Education level
programs, if needed to meet  | 
| program costs.
 | 
|     (f) An education plan shall be established for each adult  | 
| or youth
whose
schooling has been interrupted and who is  | 
| participating in the
instructional programs provided under  | 
| this Section.
 | 
|     Each school board and community college shall keep an  | 
| accurate and
detailed account of the
students assigned to and  | 
| receiving instruction under this Section who
are subject to  | 
| State reimbursement and shall submit reports of services
 | 
| provided commencing with fiscal year 1997 as required by the  | 
| Illinois
Community College Board.
 | 
|     For classes authorized under this Section, a credit hour or  | 
| unit of
instruction is equal to 15 hours of direct instruction  | 
| for students
enrolled in approved adult education programs at  | 
| midterm and making
satisfactory progress, in accordance with  | 
| standards established by the Illinois Community College Board.
 | 
|     (g) Upon proof submitted to the Illinois
Department of  | 
| Human Services of the payment of all claims submitted under
 | 
| this Section, that Department shall apply for federal funds  | 
| made
available therefor and any federal funds so received shall
 | 
| be paid into the General Revenue Fund in the State Treasury.
 | 
|     School districts or community colleges providing classes  | 
|  | 
| under this Section
shall submit applications to the Illinois  | 
| Community College Board for
preapproval in accordance with the  | 
| standards established by the Illinois
Community College Board.   | 
| Payments shall be made by the Illinois Community
College Board  | 
| based upon approved programs.  Interim expenditure reports may
 | 
| be required by the Illinois Community College Board.  Final
 | 
| claims for the school year shall be submitted to the regional  | 
| superintendents
for transmittal to the Illinois Community  | 
| College Board.  Final adjusted
payments shall be made by  | 
| September
30.
 | 
|     If a school district or community college district fails to  | 
| provide, or
is providing unsatisfactory or insufficient  | 
| classes under this Section,
the Illinois Community College  | 
| Board may enter
into agreements with public or
private  | 
| educational or other agencies other than the public schools for
 | 
| the establishment of such classes.
 | 
|     (h) If a school district or community college district  | 
| establishes
child-care
facilities for the children of  | 
| participants in classes established under
this Section, it may  | 
| extend the use of these facilities to students who
have  | 
| obtained employment and to other persons in the community whose
 | 
| children require care and supervision while the parent or other  | 
| person in
charge of the children is employed or otherwise  | 
| absent from the home during
all or part of the day.  It may make  | 
| the facilities available before and
after as well as during  | 
| regular school hours to school age and preschool
age children  | 
|  | 
| who may benefit thereby, including children who require care
 | 
| and supervision pending the return of their parent or other  | 
| person in
charge of their care from employment or other  | 
| activity requiring absence
from the home.
 | 
|     The Illinois Community College Board shall
pay to the board  | 
| the cost of care
in the facilities for any child who is a  | 
| recipient of financial aid
under the Illinois Public Aid Code. 
 | 
|     The board may charge for care of children for whom it  | 
| cannot make
claim under the provisions of this Section.  The  | 
| charge shall not exceed
per capita cost, and to the extent  | 
| feasible, shall be fixed at a level
which will permit  | 
| utilization by employed parents of low or moderate
income.  It  | 
| may also permit any other State or local governmental agency
or  | 
| private agency providing care for children to purchase care.
 | 
|     After July 1, 1970 when the provisions of Section 10-20.20  | 
| become
operative in the district, children in a child-care  | 
| facility shall be
transferred to the kindergarten established  | 
| under that Section for such
portion of the day as may be  | 
| required for the kindergarten program, and
only the prorated  | 
| costs of care and training provided in the Center for
the  | 
| remaining period shall be charged to the Illinois Department of
 | 
| Human Services or other persons or agencies paying for such  | 
| care.
 | 
|     (i) The provisions of this Section shall also apply to  | 
| school
districts having a population exceeding 500,000.
 | 
|     (j) In addition to claiming reimbursement under this  | 
|  | 
| Section, a school
district may claim general State aid under  | 
| Section 18-8.05 or evidence-based funding under Section  | 
| 18-8.15 for any student
under age 21 who is enrolled in courses  | 
| accepted for graduation from elementary
or high school and who  | 
| otherwise meets the requirements of Section 18-8.05 or  18-8.15,  | 
| as applicable.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-718, eff. 1-1-15.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/10-29) | 
|     Sec. 10-29. Remote educational programs. | 
|     (a)  For purposes of this Section, "remote educational  | 
| program" means an educational program delivered to students in  | 
| the home or other location outside of a school building that  | 
| meets all of the following criteria: | 
|         (1)  A student may participate in the program only after  | 
| the school district, pursuant to adopted school board  | 
| policy, and a person authorized to enroll the student under  | 
| Section 10-20.12b of this Code determine that a remote  | 
| educational program will best serve the student's  | 
| individual learning needs. The adopted school board policy  | 
| shall include, but not be limited to, all of the following: | 
|             (A)  Criteria for determining that a remote  | 
| educational program will best serve a student's  | 
| individual learning needs. The criteria must include  | 
| consideration of, at a minimum, a student's prior  | 
| attendance, disciplinary record, and academic history. | 
|  | 
|             (B)  Any limitations on the number of students or  | 
| grade levels that may participate in a remote  | 
| educational program. | 
|             (C)  A description of the process that the school  | 
| district will use to approve participation in the  | 
| remote educational program. The process must include  | 
| without limitation a requirement that, for any student  | 
| who qualifies to receive services pursuant to the  | 
| federal Individuals with Disabilities Education  | 
| Improvement Act of 2004, the student's participation  | 
| in a remote educational program receive prior approval   | 
| from the student's individualized education program  | 
| team. | 
|             (D) A description of the process the school  | 
| district will use to develop and approve a written  | 
| remote educational plan that meets the requirements of  | 
| subdivision (5) of this subsection (a). | 
|             (E)  A description of the system the school district  | 
| will establish to calculate the number of clock hours a  | 
| student is participating in instruction in accordance  | 
| with the remote educational program. | 
|             (F)  A description of the process for renewing a  | 
| remote educational program at the expiration of its  | 
| term. | 
|             (G)  Such other terms and provisions as the school  | 
| district deems necessary to provide for the  | 
|  | 
| establishment and delivery of a remote educational  | 
| program. | 
|         (2) The school district has determined that the remote  | 
| educational program's curriculum is aligned to State  | 
| learning standards and that the program offers instruction  | 
| and educational experiences consistent with those given to  | 
| students at the same grade level in the district. | 
|         (3)  The remote educational program is delivered by  | 
| instructors that meet the following qualifications: | 
|             (A)  they are certificated under Article 21 of this  | 
| Code; | 
|             (B) they meet applicable highly qualified criteria  | 
| under the federal No Child Left Behind Act of 2001; and | 
|             (C) they have responsibility for all of the  | 
| following elements of the program: planning  | 
| instruction, diagnosing learning needs, prescribing  | 
| content delivery through class activities, assessing  | 
| learning, reporting outcomes to administrators and  | 
| parents and guardians, and evaluating the effects of  | 
| instruction. | 
|         (4)  During the period of time from and including the  | 
| opening date to the
closing date of the regular school term  | 
| of the school district established pursuant to Section  | 
| 10-19 of this Code, participation in a remote educational  | 
| program may be claimed for general State aid purposes under  | 
| Section 18-8.05 of this Code or evidence-based funding  | 
|  | 
| purposes under Section 18-8.15 of this Code on any calendar  | 
| day, notwithstanding whether the day is a day of pupil  | 
| attendance or institute day on the school district's  | 
| calendar or any other provision of law restricting  | 
| instruction on that day.  If the district holds year-round  | 
| classes in some buildings, the district
shall classify each  | 
| student's participation in a remote educational program as  | 
| either on a year-round or a non-year-round schedule for  | 
| purposes of claiming general State aid or evidence-based  | 
| funding. Outside of the regular school term of the  | 
| district, the remote educational program may be offered as  | 
| part of any summer school program authorized by this Code. | 
|         (5)  Each student participating in a remote educational  | 
| program must have a written remote educational plan that  | 
| has been approved by the school district and a person  | 
| authorized to enroll the student under Section 10-20.12b of  | 
| this Code. The school district and a person authorized to  | 
| enroll the student under Section 10-20.12b of this Code  | 
| must approve any amendment to a remote educational plan.   | 
| The remote educational plan must include, but is not  | 
| limited to, all of the following: | 
|             (A) Specific achievement goals for the student  | 
| aligned to State learning standards. | 
|             (B) A description of all assessments that will be  | 
| used to measure student progress, which description  | 
| shall indicate the assessments that will be  | 
|  | 
| administered at an attendance center within the school  | 
| district. | 
|             (C) A description of the progress reports that will  | 
| be provided to the school district and the person or  | 
| persons authorized to enroll the student under Section  | 
| 10-20.12b of this Code. | 
|             (D) Expectations, processes, and schedules for  | 
| interaction between a teacher and student. | 
|             (E) A description of the specific responsibilities  | 
| of the student's family and the school district with  | 
| respect to equipment, materials, phone and Internet  | 
| service, and any other requirements applicable to the  | 
| home or other location outside of a school building  | 
| necessary for the delivery of the remote educational  | 
| program. | 
|             (F) If applicable, a description of how the remote  | 
| educational program will be delivered in a manner  | 
| consistent with the student's individualized education  | 
| program required by Section 614(d) of the federal  | 
| Individuals with Disabilities Education Improvement  | 
| Act of 2004 or plan to ensure compliance with Section  | 
| 504 of the federal Rehabilitation Act of 1973. | 
|             (G) A description of the procedures and  | 
| opportunities for participation in academic and  | 
| extra-curricular activities and programs within the  | 
| school district. | 
|  | 
|             (H) The identification of a parent, guardian, or  | 
| other responsible adult who will provide direct  | 
| supervision of the program.  The plan must include an  | 
| acknowledgment by the parent, guardian, or other  | 
| responsible adult that he or she may engage only in  | 
| non-teaching duties not requiring instructional  | 
| judgment or the evaluation of a student.  The plan shall  | 
| designate the parent, guardian, or other responsible  | 
| adult as non-teaching personnel or volunteer personnel  | 
| under subsection (a) of Section 10-22.34 of this Code. | 
|             (I) The identification of a school district  | 
| administrator who will oversee the remote educational  | 
| program on behalf of the school district and who may be  | 
| contacted by the student's parents with respect to any  | 
| issues or concerns with the program. | 
|             (J) The term of the student's participation in the  | 
| remote educational program, which may not extend for  | 
| longer than 12 months, unless the term is renewed by  | 
| the district in accordance with subdivision (7) of this  | 
| subsection (a). | 
|             (K) A description of the specific location or  | 
| locations in which the program will be delivered.  If  | 
| the remote educational program is to be delivered to a  | 
| student in any location other than the student's home,  | 
| the plan must include a written determination by the  | 
| school district that the location will provide a  | 
|  | 
| learning environment appropriate for the delivery of  | 
| the program. The location or locations in which the  | 
| program will be delivered shall be deemed a long  | 
| distance teaching reception area under subsection (a)  | 
| of Section 10-22.34 of this Code. | 
|             (L) Certification by the school district that the  | 
| plan meets all other requirements of this Section. | 
|         (6)  Students participating in a remote educational  | 
| program must be enrolled in a school district attendance  | 
| center pursuant to the school district's enrollment policy  | 
| or policies.  A student participating in a remote  | 
| educational program must be tested as part of all  | 
| assessments administered by the school district pursuant  | 
| to Section 2-3.64a-5 of this Code at the attendance center  | 
| in which the student is enrolled and in accordance with the  | 
| attendance center's assessment policies and schedule.  The  | 
| student must be included within all accountability  | 
| determinations for the school district and attendance  | 
| center under State and federal law. | 
|         (7)  The term of a student's participation in a remote  | 
| educational program may not extend for longer than 12  | 
| months, unless the term is renewed by the school district.   | 
| The district may only renew a student's participation in a  | 
| remote educational program following an evaluation of the  | 
| student's progress in the program, a determination that the  | 
| student's continuation in the program will best serve the  | 
|  | 
| student's individual learning needs, and an amendment to  | 
| the student's written remote educational plan addressing  | 
| any changes for the upcoming term of the program.  | 
|     For purposes of this Section, a remote educational program  | 
| does not include instruction delivered to students through an  | 
| e-learning program approved under Section 10-20.56 of this  | 
| Code.  | 
|     (b)  A school district may, by resolution of its school  | 
| board, establish a remote educational program. | 
|     (c)  Clock hours of instruction by students in a remote  | 
| educational program meeting the requirements of this Section  | 
| may be claimed by the school district and shall be counted as  | 
| school work for general State aid purposes in accordance with  | 
| and subject to the limitations of Section 18-8.05 of this Code  | 
| or evidence-based funding purposes in accordance with and  | 
| subject to the limitations of Section 18-8.15 of this Code. | 
|     (d)  The impact of remote educational programs on wages,  | 
| hours, and terms and conditions of employment of educational  | 
| employees within the school district shall be subject to local  | 
| collective bargaining agreements. | 
|     (e)  The use of a home or other location outside of a school  | 
| building for a remote educational program shall not cause the  | 
| home or other location to be deemed a public school facility.  | 
|     (f)  A remote educational program may be used, but is not  | 
| required, for instruction delivered to a student in the home or  | 
| other location outside of a school building that is not claimed  | 
|  | 
| for general State aid purposes under Section 18-8.05 of this  | 
| Code or evidence-based funding purposes under Section 18-8.15  | 
| of this Code. | 
|     (g) School districts that, pursuant to this Section, adopt  | 
| a policy for a remote educational program must submit to the  | 
| State Board of Education a copy of the policy and any  | 
| amendments thereto, as well as data on student participation in  | 
| a format specified by the State Board of Education.   The State  | 
| Board of Education may perform or contract with an outside  | 
| entity to perform an evaluation of remote educational programs  | 
| in this State. | 
|     (h) The State Board of Education may adopt any rules  | 
| necessary to ensure compliance by remote educational programs  | 
| with the requirements of this Section and other applicable  | 
| legal requirements. 
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-972, eff. 8-15-14; 99-193, eff. 7-30-15;  | 
| 99-194, eff. 7-30-15; 99-642, eff. 7-28-16.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/11E-135) | 
|     Sec. 11E-135. Incentives. For districts reorganizing under  | 
| this Article and for a district or districts that annex all of  | 
| the territory of one or more entire other school districts in  | 
| accordance with Article 7 of this Code, the following payments  | 
| shall be made from appropriations made for these purposes: | 
|     (a)(1) For a combined school district, as defined in  | 
| Section 11E-20 of this Code, or for a unit district, as defined  | 
|  | 
| in Section 11E-25 of this Code, for its first year of  | 
| existence, the general State aid and supplemental general State  | 
| aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code or the  | 
| evidence-based funding calculated under Section 18-8.15 of  | 
| this Code, as applicable, shall be computed for the new  | 
| district and for the previously existing districts for which  | 
| property is totally included within the new district. If the  | 
| computation on the basis of the previously existing districts  | 
| is greater, a supplementary payment equal to the difference  | 
| shall be made for the first 4 years of existence of the new  | 
| district. | 
|     (2) For a school district that annexes all of the territory  | 
| of one or more entire other school districts as defined in  | 
| Article 7 of this Code, for the first year during which the  | 
| change of boundaries attributable to the annexation becomes  | 
| effective for all purposes, as determined under Section 7-9 of  | 
| this Code, the general State aid and supplemental general State  | 
| aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code or the  | 
| evidence-based funding calculated under Section 18-8.15 of  | 
| this Code, as applicable, shall be computed for the annexing  | 
| district as constituted after the annexation and for the  | 
| annexing and each annexed district as constituted prior to the  | 
| annexation; and if the computation on the basis of the annexing  | 
| and annexed districts as constituted prior to the annexation is  | 
| greater, then a supplementary payment equal to the difference  | 
| shall be made for the first 4 years of existence of the  | 
|  | 
| annexing school district as constituted upon the  annexation. | 
|     (3) For 2 or more school districts that  annex all of the  | 
| territory of one or more entire other school districts, as  | 
| defined in Article 7 of this Code, for the first year during  | 
| which the change of boundaries attributable to the  annexation  | 
| becomes effective for all purposes, as determined under Section  | 
| 7-9 of this Code, the general State aid and supplemental  | 
| general State aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code  | 
| or the evidence-based funding calculated under Section 18-8.15  | 
| of this Code, as applicable, shall be computed for each  | 
| annexing district as constituted after the annexation and for  | 
| each annexing and annexed district as constituted prior to the  | 
| annexation; and if the aggregate of the general State aid and  | 
| supplemental general State aid or evidence-based funding, as  | 
| applicable, as so computed for the annexing districts as  | 
| constituted after the annexation is less than the aggregate of  | 
| the general State aid and supplemental general State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding, as applicable, as so computed for the  | 
| annexing and annexed districts, as constituted prior to the  | 
| annexation, then a supplementary payment equal to the  | 
| difference shall be made and allocated between or among the  | 
| annexing districts, as constituted upon the annexation, for the  | 
| first 4 years of their existence. The total difference payment  | 
| shall be allocated between or among the annexing districts in  | 
| the same ratio as the pupil enrollment from that portion of the  | 
| annexed district or districts that is annexed to each annexing  | 
|  | 
| district bears to the total pupil enrollment from the entire  | 
| annexed district or districts, as such pupil enrollment is  | 
| determined for the school year last ending prior to the date  | 
| when the change of boundaries attributable to the annexation  | 
| becomes effective for all purposes. The amount of the total  | 
| difference payment and the amount thereof to be allocated to  | 
| the annexing districts shall be computed by the State Board of  | 
| Education on the basis of pupil enrollment and other data that  | 
| shall be certified to the State Board of Education, on forms  | 
| that  it shall provide for that purpose, by the regional  | 
| superintendent of schools for each educational service region  | 
| in which the annexing and annexed districts are located. | 
|     (4) For a school district conversion, as defined in Section  | 
| 11E-15 of this Code, or a multi-unit conversion, as defined in  | 
| subsection (b) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, if in their  | 
| first year of existence the newly created elementary districts  | 
| and the newly created high school district, from a school  | 
| district conversion, or the newly created elementary district  | 
| or districts and newly created combined high school - unit  | 
| district, from a multi-unit conversion, qualify for less  | 
| general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of this Code or  | 
| evidence-based funding under Section 18-8.15 of this Code than  | 
| would have been payable under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15, as  | 
| applicable,  for that same year to the previously existing  | 
| districts, then a supplementary payment equal to that  | 
| difference shall be made for the first 4 years of existence of  | 
|  | 
| the newly created districts. The aggregate amount of each  | 
| supplementary payment shall be allocated among the newly  | 
| created districts in the proportion that the deemed pupil  | 
| enrollment in each district during its first year of existence  | 
| bears to the actual aggregate pupil enrollment in all of the   | 
| districts during their first year of existence. For purposes of  | 
| each allocation: | 
|         (A) the deemed pupil enrollment of the newly created  | 
| high school district from a school district conversion  | 
| shall be an amount equal to its actual pupil enrollment for  | 
| its first year of existence multiplied by 1.25; | 
|         (B) the deemed pupil enrollment of each newly created  | 
| elementary district from a school district conversion  | 
| shall be an amount equal to its actual pupil enrollment for  | 
| its first year of existence reduced by an amount equal to  | 
| the product obtained when the amount by which the newly  | 
| created high school district's deemed pupil enrollment  | 
| exceeds its actual pupil enrollment for its first year of  | 
| existence is multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of  | 
| which is the actual pupil enrollment of the newly created  | 
| elementary district for its first year of existence and the  | 
| denominator of which is the actual aggregate pupil  | 
| enrollment of all of the newly created elementary districts  | 
| for their first year of existence; | 
|         (C)  the deemed high school pupil enrollment of the  | 
| newly created combined high school - unit district from a  | 
|  | 
| multi-unit conversion shall be an amount equal to its  | 
| actual grades 9 through 12 pupil enrollment for its first  | 
| year of existence multiplied by 1.25; and | 
|         (D)  the deemed elementary pupil enrollment of each  | 
| newly created district from a multi-unit conversion shall  | 
| be an amount equal to each district's actual grade K  | 
| through 8 pupil enrollment for its first year of existence,  | 
| reduced by an amount equal to the product obtained when the  | 
| amount by which the newly created combined high school -  | 
| unit district's deemed high school pupil enrollment  | 
| exceeds its actual grade 9 through 12 pupil enrollment for  | 
| its first year of existence is multiplied by a fraction,  | 
| the numerator of which is the actual grade K through 8  | 
| pupil enrollment of each newly created district for its  | 
| first year of existence and the denominator of which is the  | 
| actual aggregate grade K through 8 pupil enrollment of all  | 
| such newly created districts for their first year of  | 
| existence. | 
|     
The aggregate amount of each supplementary payment under  | 
| this subdivision (4) and the amount thereof to be allocated to  | 
| the newly created districts shall be computed by the State  | 
| Board of Education on the basis of pupil enrollment and other  | 
| data, which shall be certified to the State Board of Education,  | 
| on forms that it shall provide for that purpose, by the  | 
| regional superintendent of schools for each educational  | 
| service region in which the newly created districts are  | 
|  | 
| located.
 | 
|     (5) For a partial elementary unit district, as defined in  | 
| subsection (a) or (c) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, if, in  | 
| the first year of existence, the newly created partial  | 
| elementary unit district qualifies for less general State aid  | 
| and supplemental general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of  | 
| this Code or less evidence-based funding under Section 18-8.15  | 
| of this Code, as applicable, than would have been payable under  | 
| those Sections that Section for that same year to the  | 
| previously existing districts that formed the partial  | 
| elementary unit district, then a supplementary payment equal to  | 
| that difference shall be made to the partial elementary unit  | 
| district for the first 4 years of existence of that newly  | 
| created district. | 
|     (6) For an elementary opt-in, as described  in subsection  | 
| (d) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the general State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding difference shall be computed in  | 
| accordance with paragraph (5) of this subsection (a)  as if the  | 
| elementary opt-in  was included in an optional elementary unit  | 
| district at the optional elementary unit district's original  | 
| effective date.  If the calculation in this paragraph  (6) is  | 
| less than that calculated in paragraph (5) of this subsection  | 
| (a)  at the optional elementary unit district's original  | 
| effective date, then no adjustments may  be made.  If the  | 
| calculation in this paragraph  (6) is more than that calculated  | 
| in paragraph (5) of this subsection (a)  at the optional  | 
|  | 
| elementary unit district's original effective date, then the  | 
| excess must  be paid as follows: | 
|         (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| one year after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess  | 
| shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in  | 
| each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the  | 
| elementary opt-in. | 
|         (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 2 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess  | 
| shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in  | 
| each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the  | 
| elementary opt-in. | 
|         (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 3 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess  | 
| shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in  | 
| each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the  | 
| elementary opt-in. | 
|         (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 4 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 25% of the calculated excess  | 
| shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in  | 
| each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the  | 
| elementary opt-in. | 
|  | 
|         (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 5 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit  | 
| district is not eligible for any additional incentives due  | 
| to the elementary opt-in. | 
|     (6.5) For a school district that annexes territory detached  | 
| from another school district whereby the enrollment of the  | 
| annexing district increases by 90% or more as a result of the  | 
| annexation, for the first year during which the change of  | 
| boundaries attributable to the annexation becomes effective  | 
| for all purposes as determined under Section 7-9 of this Code,  | 
| the general State aid and supplemental general State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding, as applicable, calculated under this  | 
| Section shall be computed for the district gaining territory  | 
| and the district losing territory as constituted after the  | 
| annexation and for the same districts as constituted prior to  | 
| the annexation; and if the aggregate of the general State aid  | 
| and supplemental general State aid or evidence-based funding,  | 
| as applicable, as so computed for the district gaining  | 
| territory and the district losing territory as constituted  | 
| after the annexation is less than the aggregate of the general  | 
| State aid and supplemental general State aid or evidence-based  | 
| funding, as applicable, as so computed for the district gaining  | 
| territory and the district losing territory as constituted  | 
| prior to the annexation, then a supplementary payment shall be  | 
| made to the annexing district for the first 4 years of  | 
|  | 
| existence after the annexation, equal to the difference  | 
| multiplied by the ratio of student enrollment in the territory  | 
| detached to the total student enrollment in the district losing  | 
| territory for the year prior to the effective date of the  | 
| annexation.  The amount of the total difference and the  | 
| proportion paid to the annexing district shall be computed by  | 
| the State Board of Education on the basis of pupil enrollment  | 
| and other data that must be submitted to the State Board of  | 
| Education in accordance with Section 7-14A of this Code.  The  | 
| changes to this Section made by Public Act 95-707
 are intended  | 
| to be retroactive and applicable to any annexation taking  | 
| effect on or after July 1, 2004. For annexations that are  | 
| eligible for payments under this paragraph (6.5) and that are  | 
| effective on or after July 1, 2004, but before January 11, 2008  | 
| (the effective date of Public Act 95-707), the first required  | 
| yearly payment under this paragraph (6.5) shall be paid in the  | 
| fiscal year of January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public  | 
| Act 95-707).  Subsequent required yearly payments shall be paid  | 
| in subsequent fiscal years until the payment obligation under  | 
| this paragraph (6.5) is complete. | 
|     (7) Claims for financial assistance under this subsection  | 
| (a) may  not be recomputed except as expressly provided under  | 
| Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code. | 
|     (8) Any supplementary payment made under this subsection  | 
| (a) must  be treated as separate from all other payments made  | 
| pursuant to Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code. | 
|  | 
|     (b)(1) After the formation of a combined school district,  | 
| as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code, or a unit district,  | 
| as defined in Section 11E-25 of this Code, a computation shall  | 
| be made to determine the difference between the salaries  | 
| effective in each of the previously existing districts on June  | 
| 30, prior to the creation of the new district. For the first 4  | 
| years after the formation of the new district, a supplementary  | 
| State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the new district equal  | 
| to the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by  | 
| each of the certificated members of the new district, while  | 
| employed in one of the previously existing districts during the  | 
| year immediately preceding the formation of the new district,  | 
| and the sum of the salaries those certificated members would  | 
| have been paid during the year immediately prior to the  | 
| formation of the new district if placed on the salary schedule  | 
| of the previously existing district with the highest salary  | 
| schedule. | 
|     (2) After the territory of one or more school districts is  | 
| annexed by one or more other school districts as defined in  | 
| Article 7 of this Code, a computation shall be made to  | 
| determine the difference between the salaries effective in each  | 
| annexed district and in the annexing district or districts as  | 
| they were each  constituted on June 30 preceding the date when  | 
| the change of boundaries attributable to the annexation became  | 
| effective for all purposes, as determined under Section 7-9  of  | 
| this Code. For the first 4 years after the annexation, a  | 
|  | 
| supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to each  | 
| annexing district as constituted after the annexation equal to  | 
| the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by each  | 
| of the certificated members of the  annexing district as  | 
| constituted after the annexation, while employed in an annexed  | 
| or annexing district during the year immediately preceding the  | 
| annexation, and the sum of the salaries those certificated  | 
| members would have been paid during the immediately preceding  | 
| year if placed on the salary schedule of whichever of the  | 
| annexing or annexed districts had the highest salary schedule  | 
| during the immediately preceding year. | 
|     (3) For each new high school district formed under a school  | 
| district conversion, as defined in Section 11E-15 of this Code,  | 
| the State shall make a supplementary payment for 4 years equal  | 
| to the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by  | 
| each certified member of the new high school district, while  | 
| employed in one of the previously existing districts, and the  | 
| sum of the salaries those certified members would have been  | 
| paid if placed on the salary schedule of the previously  | 
| existing district with the highest salary schedule. | 
|     (4) For each newly created partial elementary unit  | 
| district, the State shall make a supplementary payment for 4  | 
| years equal to the difference between the sum of the salaries  | 
| earned by each certified member of the newly created partial  | 
| elementary unit district, while employed in one of the  | 
| previously existing districts that formed the partial  | 
|  | 
| elementary unit district, and the sum of the salaries those  | 
| certified members would have been paid if placed on the salary  | 
| schedule of the previously existing district with the highest  | 
| salary schedule.  The salary schedules used in the calculation  | 
| shall be those in effect in the previously existing districts  | 
| for the school year prior to the creation of the new partial  | 
| elementary unit district. | 
|     (5) For an elementary district opt-in, as described in  | 
| subsection (d) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the salary  | 
| difference incentive shall be computed in accordance with  | 
| paragraph  (4) of this subsection (b) as if the opted-in  | 
| elementary district was included in the optional elementary  | 
| unit district at the optional elementary unit district's  | 
| original effective date.  If the calculation in this paragraph   | 
| (5) is less than that calculated in paragraph  (4) of this  | 
| subsection (b)  at the optional elementary unit district's  | 
| original effective date, then no adjustments may be made.  If  | 
| the calculation in this paragraph  (5) is more than that  | 
| calculated in paragraph  (4) of this subsection (b)  at the  | 
| optional elementary unit district's original effective date,  | 
| then the excess must  be paid as follows: | 
|         (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| one year after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess  | 
| shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in  | 
| each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the  | 
|  | 
| elementary opt-in. | 
|         (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 2 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess  | 
| shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in  | 
| each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the  | 
| elementary opt-in. | 
|         (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 3 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess  | 
| shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in  | 
| each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the  | 
| elementary opt-in. | 
|         (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 4 years after the effective date for the partial elementary  | 
| unit district, 25% of the calculated excess shall be paid  | 
| to the optional elementary unit district in each of the  | 
| first 4 years after the effective date of the elementary  | 
| opt-in. | 
|         (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 5 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit  | 
| district is not eligible for any additional incentives due  | 
| to the elementary opt-in. | 
|     (5.5) After the formation of a cooperative high school by 2  | 
| or more school districts under Section 10-22.22c of this Code,  | 
|  | 
| a computation shall be made to determine the difference between  | 
| the salaries effective in each of the previously existing high  | 
| schools on June 30 prior to the formation of the cooperative  | 
| high school. For the first 4 years after the formation of the  | 
| cooperative high school, a supplementary State aid  | 
| reimbursement shall be paid to the cooperative high school  | 
| equal to the difference between the sum of the salaries earned  | 
| by each of the certificated members of the cooperative high  | 
| school while employed in one of the previously existing high  | 
| schools during the year immediately preceding the formation of  | 
| the cooperative high school and the sum of the salaries those  | 
| certificated members would have been paid during the year  | 
| immediately prior to the formation of the cooperative high  | 
| school if placed on the salary schedule of the previously  | 
| existing high school with the highest salary schedule. | 
|     (5.10) After the annexation of territory detached from
 | 
| another school district whereby the enrollment of the annexing
 | 
| district increases by 90% or more as a result of the
 | 
| annexation, a computation shall be made to determine the
 | 
| difference between the salaries effective in the district
 | 
| gaining territory and the district losing territory as they
 | 
| each were constituted on June 30 preceding the date when the
 | 
| change of boundaries attributable to the annexation became
 | 
| effective for all purposes as determined under Section 7-9 of
 | 
| this Code. For the first 4 years after the annexation, a
 | 
| supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the
 | 
|  | 
| annexing district equal to the difference between the sum of
 | 
| the salaries earned by each of the certificated members of the
 | 
| annexing district as constituted after the annexation while
 | 
| employed in the district gaining territory or the district
 | 
| losing territory during the year immediately preceding the
 | 
| annexation and the sum of the salaries those certificated
 | 
| members would have been paid during such immediately preceding
 | 
| year if placed on the salary schedule of whichever of the
 | 
| district gaining territory or district losing territory had the
 | 
| highest salary schedule during the immediately preceding year.
 | 
| To be eligible for supplementary State aid reimbursement under
 | 
| this Section, the intergovernmental agreement to be submitted
 | 
| pursuant to Section 7-14A of this Code must show that staff
 | 
| members were transferred from the control of the district
 | 
| losing territory to the control of the district gaining
 | 
| territory in the annexation. The changes to this Section made
 | 
| by Public Act 95-707
 are
intended to be retroactive and  | 
| applicable to any annexation
taking effect on or after July 1,  | 
| 2004. For annexations that are eligible for payments under this  | 
| paragraph (5.10) and that are effective on or after July 1,  | 
| 2004, but before January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public  | 
| Act 95-707), the first required yearly payment under this  | 
| paragraph (5.10) shall be paid in the fiscal year of January  | 
| 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public Act 95-707).  Subsequent  | 
| required yearly payments shall be paid in subsequent fiscal  | 
| years until the payment obligation under this paragraph (5.10)  | 
|  | 
| is complete.
 | 
|     (5.15)
 After the deactivation of a school facility in  | 
| accordance with Section 10-22.22b of this Code, a computation  | 
| shall be made to determine the difference between the salaries  | 
| effective in the sending school district and each receiving  | 
| school district on June 30 prior to the deactivation of the  | 
| school facility. For the lesser of the first 4 years after the  | 
| deactivation of the school facility or the length of the  | 
| deactivation agreement, including any renewals of the original  | 
| deactivation agreement, a supplementary State aid  | 
| reimbursement shall be paid to each receiving district equal to  | 
| the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by each  | 
| of the certificated members transferred to that receiving  | 
| district as a result of the deactivation while employed in the  | 
| sending district during the year immediately preceding the  | 
| deactivation and the sum of the salaries those certificated  | 
| members would have been paid during the year immediately  | 
| preceding the deactivation if placed on the salary schedule of  | 
| the sending or receiving district with the highest salary  | 
| schedule.  | 
|     (6) The supplementary State aid reimbursement under this  | 
| subsection (b) shall be treated as separate from all other  | 
| payments made pursuant to Section 18-8.05 of this Code. In the  | 
| case of the formation of a new district or cooperative high  | 
| school or a deactivation, reimbursement shall begin during the  | 
| first year of operation of the new district or cooperative high  | 
|  | 
| school or the first year of the deactivation,  and in the case  | 
| of an annexation of the territory of one or more school  | 
| districts by one or more other school districts or the  | 
| annexation of territory detached from a school district whereby
 | 
| the enrollment of the annexing district increases by 90% or
 | 
| more as a result of the annexation, reimbursement shall begin  | 
| during the first year when the change in boundaries  | 
| attributable to the  annexation becomes effective for all  | 
| purposes as determined pursuant to Section 7-9 of this Code,  | 
| except that for an annexation of territory detached from a  | 
| school district that is effective on or after July 1, 2004, but  | 
| before January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public Act  | 
| 95-707), whereby the enrollment of the annexing district  | 
| increases by 90% or more as a result of the annexation,  | 
| reimbursement shall begin during the fiscal year of January 11,  | 
| 2008 (the effective date of Public Act 95-707). Each year that  | 
| the new, annexing, or receiving district or cooperative high  | 
| school, as the case may be, is entitled to receive  | 
| reimbursement, the number of eligible certified members who are  | 
| employed on October 1 in the district or cooperative high  | 
| school shall be certified to the State Board of Education on  | 
| prescribed forms by October 15 and payment shall be made on or  | 
| before November 15 of that year. | 
|     (c)(1) For the first year after the formation of a combined  | 
| school district, as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code or a  | 
| unit district, as defined in Section 11E-25 of this Code, a  | 
|  | 
| computation shall be made totaling each previously existing  | 
| district's audited fund balances in the educational fund,  | 
| working cash fund, operations and maintenance fund, and  | 
| transportation fund for the year ending June 30 prior to the  | 
| referendum for the creation of the new district. The new  | 
| district shall be paid supplementary State aid equal to the sum  | 
| of the differences between the deficit of the previously  | 
| existing district with the smallest deficit and the deficits of  | 
| each of the other previously existing districts. | 
|     (2) For the first year after the annexation of all of the  | 
| territory of one or more entire school districts by another  | 
| school district, as defined in Article 7 of this Code,  | 
| computations shall be made, for the year ending June 30 prior  | 
| to the date that the change of boundaries attributable to the  | 
| annexation is allowed by the affirmative decision issued by the  | 
| regional board of school trustees under Section 7-6 of this  | 
| Code, notwithstanding any effort to seek administrative review  | 
| of the  decision, totaling the annexing district's and totaling  | 
| each annexed district's audited fund balances in their  | 
| respective educational, working cash, operations and  | 
| maintenance, and transportation funds. The annexing district  | 
| as constituted after the annexation shall be paid supplementary  | 
| State aid equal to the sum of the differences between the  | 
| deficit of whichever of the annexing or annexed districts as  | 
| constituted prior to the annexation had the smallest deficit  | 
| and the deficits of each of the other districts as constituted  | 
|  | 
| prior to the  annexation. | 
|     (3) For the first year after the annexation of all of the  | 
| territory of one or more entire school districts by 2 or more  | 
| other school districts, as defined by Article 7 of this Code,  | 
| computations shall be made, for the year ending June 30 prior  | 
| to the date that the change of boundaries attributable to the  | 
| annexation is allowed by the affirmative decision of the  | 
| regional board of school trustees under Section 7-6 of this  | 
| Code, notwithstanding any action for administrative review of  | 
| the decision, totaling each annexing and annexed district's  | 
| audited fund balances in their respective educational, working  | 
| cash, operations and maintenance, and transportation funds.  | 
| The annexing districts as constituted after the annexation  | 
| shall be paid supplementary State aid, allocated as provided in  | 
| this paragraph (3), in an aggregate amount equal to the sum of  | 
| the differences between the deficit of whichever of the  | 
| annexing or annexed districts as constituted prior to the  | 
| annexation had the smallest deficit and the deficits of each of  | 
| the other districts as constituted prior to the annexation. The  | 
| aggregate amount of the supplementary State aid payable under  | 
| this paragraph (3)  shall be allocated between or among the  | 
| annexing districts as follows: | 
|         (A) the regional superintendent of schools for each  | 
| educational service region in which an annexed district is  | 
| located prior to the annexation shall certify to the State  | 
| Board of Education, on forms that it shall provide for that  | 
|  | 
| purpose, the value of all taxable property in each annexed  | 
| district, as last equalized or assessed by the Department  | 
| of Revenue prior to the annexation, and the equalized  | 
| assessed value of each part of the annexed district that  | 
| was annexed to or included as a part of an annexing  | 
| district; | 
|         (B) using equalized assessed values as certified by the  | 
| regional superintendent of schools under clause (A) of this  | 
| paragraph (3), the combined audited fund balance deficit of  | 
| each annexed district as determined under this Section  | 
| shall be apportioned between or among the annexing  | 
| districts in the same ratio as the equalized assessed value  | 
| of that part of the annexed district that was annexed to or  | 
| included as a part of an annexing district bears to the  | 
| total equalized assessed value of the  annexed district; and | 
|         (C) the aggregate supplementary State aid payment  | 
| under this paragraph (3)  shall be allocated between or  | 
| among, and shall be paid to, the annexing districts in the  | 
| same ratio as the sum of the combined audited fund balance  | 
| deficit of each annexing district as constituted prior to  | 
| the annexation, plus all combined audited fund balance  | 
| deficit amounts apportioned to that annexing district  | 
| under clause (B) of this subsection, bears to the aggregate  | 
| of the combined audited fund balance deficits of all of the  | 
| annexing and annexed districts as constituted prior to the  | 
| annexation. | 
|  | 
|     (4) For the new elementary districts and new high school  | 
| district formed through a school district conversion, as  | 
| defined in  Section 11E-15 of this Code or the new elementary  | 
| district or districts and new combined high school - unit  | 
| district formed through a multi-unit conversion, as defined in  | 
| subsection (b) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, a computation  | 
| shall be made totaling each previously existing district's  | 
| audited fund balances in the educational fund, working cash  | 
| fund, operations and maintenance fund, and transportation fund  | 
| for the year ending June 30 prior to the referendum  | 
| establishing the new districts. In the first year of the new  | 
| districts, the State shall make a one-time supplementary  | 
| payment equal to the sum of the differences between the deficit  | 
| of the previously existing district with the smallest deficit  | 
| and the deficits of each of the other previously existing  | 
| districts. A district with a combined balance among the 4 funds  | 
| that is positive shall be considered to have a deficit of zero.  | 
| The supplementary payment shall be allocated among the newly  | 
| formed high school and elementary districts in the manner  | 
| provided by the petition for the formation of the districts, in  | 
| the form in which the petition is approved by the regional  | 
| superintendent of schools  or State Superintendent of Education   | 
| under Section 11E-50 of this Code. | 
|     (5) For each newly created partial elementary unit  | 
| district, as defined in subsection (a) or (c) of Section 11E-30  | 
| of this Code, a computation shall be made totaling the audited  | 
|  | 
| fund balances of each previously existing district that formed  | 
| the new partial elementary unit district in the educational  | 
| fund, working cash fund, operations and maintenance fund, and  | 
| transportation fund for the year ending June 30 prior to the  | 
| referendum for the formation of the partial elementary unit  | 
| district. In the first year of the new partial elementary unit  | 
| district, the State shall make a one-time supplementary payment  | 
| to the new district equal to the sum of the differences between  | 
| the deficit of the previously existing district with the  | 
| smallest deficit and the deficits of each of the other  | 
| previously existing districts. A district with a combined  | 
| balance among the 4 funds that is positive shall be considered  | 
| to have a deficit of zero. | 
|     (6) For an elementary opt-in as defined in subsection (d)  | 
| of  Section 11E-30 of this Code, the deficit fund balance  | 
| incentive shall be computed in accordance with paragraph (5) of  | 
| this subsection  (c) as if the opted-in elementary was included  | 
| in the optional elementary unit district at the optional  | 
| elementary unit district's original effective date.  If the  | 
| calculation in this paragraph  (6) is less than that calculated  | 
| in paragraph  (5) of this subsection (c)  at the optional  | 
| elementary unit district's original effective date, then no  | 
| adjustments may be made.  If the calculation in this paragraph   | 
| (6) is more than that calculated in paragraph  (5) of this  | 
| subsection (c)  at the optional elementary unit district's  | 
| original effective date, then the excess must  be paid as  | 
|  | 
| follows: | 
|         (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| one year after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess  | 
| shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in  | 
| the first year after the effective date of the elementary  | 
| opt-in. | 
|         (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 2 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess  | 
| shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in  | 
| the first year after the effective date of the elementary  | 
| opt-in. | 
|         (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 3 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess  | 
| shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in  | 
| the first year after the effective date of the elementary  | 
| opt-in. | 
|         (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 4 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 25% of the calculated excess  | 
| shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in  | 
| the first year after the effective date of the elementary  | 
| opt-in. | 
|         (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
|  | 
| 5 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit  | 
| district is not eligible for any additional incentives due  | 
| to the elementary opt-in. | 
|     (6.5) For the first year after the annexation of territory
 | 
| detached from another school district whereby the enrollment of
 | 
| the annexing district increases by 90% or more as a result of
 | 
| the annexation, a computation shall be made totaling the
 | 
| audited fund balances of the district gaining territory and the
 | 
| audited fund balances of the district losing territory in the
 | 
| educational fund, working cash fund, operations and
 | 
| maintenance fund, and transportation fund for the year ending
 | 
| June 30 prior to the date that the change of boundaries
 | 
| attributable to the annexation is allowed by the affirmative
 | 
| decision of the regional board of school trustees under Section
 | 
| 7-6 of this Code, notwithstanding any action for administrative
 | 
| review of the decision. The annexing district as constituted
 | 
| after the annexation shall be paid supplementary State aid
 | 
| equal to the difference between the deficit of whichever
 | 
| district included in this calculation as constituted prior to
 | 
| the annexation had the smallest deficit and the deficit of each
 | 
| other district included in this calculation as constituted
 | 
| prior to the annexation, multiplied by the ratio of equalized
 | 
| assessed value of the territory detached to the total equalized
 | 
| assessed value of the district losing territory. The regional
 | 
| superintendent of schools for the educational service region in
 | 
|  | 
| which a district losing territory is located prior to the
 | 
| annexation shall certify to the State Board of Education the
 | 
| value of all taxable property in the district losing territory
 | 
| and the value of all taxable property in the territory being
 | 
| detached, as last equalized or assessed by the Department of
 | 
| Revenue prior to the annexation. To be eligible for
 | 
| supplementary State aid reimbursement under this Section, the
 | 
| intergovernmental agreement to be submitted pursuant to
 | 
| Section 7-14A of this Code must show that fund balances were
 | 
| transferred from the district losing territory to the district
 | 
| gaining territory in the annexation. The changes to this
 | 
| Section made by Public Act 95-707
 are intended to be  | 
| retroactive and applicable to any
annexation taking effect on  | 
| or after July 1, 2004. For annexations that are eligible for  | 
| payments under this paragraph (6.5) and that are effective on  | 
| or after July 1, 2004, but before January 11, 2008 (the  | 
| effective date of Public Act 95-707), the required payment  | 
| under this paragraph (6.5) shall be paid in the fiscal year of  | 
| January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public Act 95-707).
 | 
|     (7) For purposes of any calculation required under  | 
| paragraph  (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), (6), or (6.5) of this  | 
| subsection (c), a district with a combined fund balance that is  | 
| positive shall be considered to have a deficit of zero. For  | 
| purposes of determining each district's audited fund balances  | 
| in its educational fund, working cash fund, operations and  | 
| maintenance fund, and transportation fund for the specified  | 
|  | 
| year ending June 30, as provided in paragraphs (1), (2), (3),  | 
| (4), (5), (6), and (6.5) of this subsection (c), the balance of  | 
| each fund shall be deemed decreased by an amount equal to the  | 
| amount of the annual property tax theretofore levied in the   | 
| fund by the district for collection and payment to the district  | 
| during the calendar year in which the June 30 fell, but only to  | 
| the extent that the tax so levied in the fund actually was  | 
| received by the district on or before or comprised a part of  | 
| the fund on such June 30. For purposes of determining each  | 
| district's audited fund balances, a calculation shall be made  | 
| for each fund to determine the average for the 3 years prior to  | 
| the specified year ending June 30, as provided in paragraphs  | 
| (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), (6), and (6.5) of this subsection (c),   | 
| of the district's expenditures in the categories "purchased  | 
| services", "supplies and materials", and "capital outlay", as  | 
| those categories are defined in rules of the State Board of  | 
| Education. If this 3-year average is less than the district's  | 
| expenditures in these categories for the specified year ending  | 
| June 30, as provided in paragraphs (1), (2), (3), (4), (5),  | 
| (6), and (6.5) of this subsection (c), then the 3-year average  | 
| shall be used in calculating the amounts payable under this  | 
| Section in place of the amounts shown in these categories for  | 
| the specified year ending June 30, as provided in paragraphs  | 
| (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), (6), and (6.5) of this subsection (c).  | 
| Any deficit because of State aid not yet received may  not be  | 
| considered in determining the June 30 deficits. The same basis  | 
|  | 
| of accounting shall be used by all previously existing  | 
| districts and by all annexing or annexed districts, as  | 
| constituted prior to the annexation, in making any computation  | 
| required under paragraphs  (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), (6), and  | 
| (6.5) of this subsection (c). | 
|     (8) The supplementary State aid payments under this  | 
| subsection (c) shall be treated as separate from all other  | 
| payments made pursuant to Section 18-8.05 of this Code. | 
|     (d)(1) Following the formation of a combined school  | 
| district, as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code, a new unit  | 
| district, as defined in Section 11E-25 of this Code, a new  | 
| elementary district or districts and a new high school district  | 
| formed through a school district conversion, as defined in  | 
| Section  11E-15 of this Code, a new partial elementary unit  | 
| district, as defined in Section 11E-30 of this Code, or a new  | 
| elementary district or districts formed through a multi-unit  | 
| conversion, as defined in subsection (b) of Section 11E-30 of  | 
| this Code, or the annexation of all of the territory of one or  | 
| more entire school districts by one or more other school  | 
| districts, as defined in Article 7 of this Code, a  | 
| supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid for the  | 
| number of school years determined under the following table to  | 
| each new or annexing district equal to the sum of $4,000 for  | 
| each certified employee who is employed by the district on a  | 
| full-time basis for the regular term of the school year:
 | 
|  | 
|  | 
| | Reorganized District's Rank | 
Reorganized District's Rank | 
 
|
 | by type of district (unit, | 
in Average Daily Attendance | 
 
|
 | high school, elementary) | 
By Quintile | 
 
|
 | in Equalized Assessed Value | 
 | 
 | 
 | 
 
|
 | Per Pupil by Quintile | 
 | 
 | 
 | 
 
|
 |  | 
 | 
 | 
3rd, 4th, | 
 
|
 |  | 
1st | 
2nd | 
or 5th | 
 
|
 |  | 
Quintile | 
Quintile | 
Quintile | 
 
|
 |     1st Quintile | 
1 year | 
1 year | 
1 year | 
 
|
 |     2nd Quintile | 
1 year | 
2 years | 
2 years | 
 
|
 |     3rd Quintile | 
2 years | 
3 years | 
3 years | 
 
|
 |     4th Quintile | 
2 years | 
3 years | 
3 years | 
 
|
 |     5th Quintile | 
2 years | 
3 years | 
3 years | 
 
 | 
 | The State Board of Education shall make a one-time calculation  | 
| of a reorganized district's quintile ranks. The average daily  | 
| attendance used in this calculation shall be the best 3 months'  | 
| average daily attendance for the district's first year. The  | 
| equalized assessed value per pupil shall be the district's real  | 
| property equalized assessed value used in calculating the  | 
| district's first-year general State aid claim, under Section  | 
| 18-8.05 of this Code, or first-year evidence-based funding  | 
| claim, under Section 18-8.15 of this Code, as applicable,  | 
| divided by the best 3 months' average daily attendance. | 
|     No annexing or resulting school district shall be entitled  | 
| to supplementary State aid under this subsection (d) unless the  | 
|  | 
| district acquires at least 30% of the average daily attendance  | 
| of the district from which the territory is being detached or  | 
| divided. | 
|     If a district results from multiple reorganizations that  | 
| would otherwise qualify the district for multiple payments  | 
| under this subsection (d) in any year, then the district shall  | 
| receive a single payment only for that year based solely on the  | 
| most recent reorganization. | 
|     (2) For an elementary opt-in, as defined in subsection (d)  | 
| of  Section 11E-30 of this Code, the full-time certified staff  | 
| incentive shall be computed in accordance with paragraph (1) of  | 
| this subsection (d), equal to the sum of $4,000 for each  | 
| certified employee of the elementary district that opts-in who  | 
| is employed by the optional elementary unit district on a  | 
| full-time basis for the regular term of the school year. The  | 
| calculation from this paragraph  (2) must  be paid as follows: | 
|         (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| one year after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 100% of the amount calculated in  | 
| this paragraph  (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary  | 
| unit district for the number of years calculated in  | 
| paragraph  (1) of this subsection (d)  at the optional  | 
| elementary unit district's original effective date,  | 
| starting in the second year after the effective date of the  | 
| elementary opt-in. | 
|         (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
|  | 
| 2 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 75% of the amount calculated in  | 
| this paragraph  (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary  | 
| unit district for the number of years calculated in  | 
| paragraph  (1) of this subsection (d)  at the optional  | 
| elementary unit district's original effective date,  | 
| starting in the second year after the effective date of the  | 
| elementary opt-in. | 
|         (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 3 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 50% of the amount calculated in  | 
| this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary  | 
| unit district for the number of years calculated in  | 
| paragraph  (1) of this subsection (d)  at the optional  | 
| elementary unit district's original effective date,  | 
| starting in the second year after the effective date of the  | 
| elementary opt-in. | 
|         (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 4 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, 25% of the amount calculated in  | 
| this paragraph  (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary  | 
| unit district for the number of years calculated in  | 
| paragraph  (1) of this subsection (d)  at the optional  | 
| elementary unit district's original effective date,  | 
| starting in the second year after the effective date of the  | 
| elementary opt-in. | 
|  | 
|         (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is  | 
| 5 years after the effective date for the optional  | 
| elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit  | 
| district is not eligible for any additional incentives due  | 
| to the elementary opt-in. | 
|     (2.5) Following the formation of a cooperative high school  | 
| by 2 or more school districts under Section 10-22.22c of this  | 
| Code, a supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid for  | 
| 3 school years to the cooperative high school equal to the sum  | 
| of $4,000 for each certified employee who is employed by the  | 
| cooperative high school on a full-time basis for the regular  | 
| term of any such school year.  If a cooperative high school  | 
| results from multiple agreements that would otherwise qualify  | 
| the cooperative high school for multiple payments under this  | 
| Section in any year, the cooperative high school shall receive  | 
| a single payment for that year based solely on the most recent  | 
| agreement. | 
|     (2.10) Following the annexation of territory detached from
 | 
| another school district whereby the enrollment of the annexing
 | 
| district increases 90% or more as a result of the annexation, a
 | 
| supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the
 | 
| annexing district equal to the sum of $4,000 for each certified
 | 
| employee who is employed by the annexing district on a
 | 
| full-time basis and shall be calculated in accordance with
 | 
| subsection (a) of this Section. To be eligible for
 | 
| supplementary State aid reimbursement under this Section, the
 | 
|  | 
| intergovernmental agreement to be submitted pursuant to
 | 
| Section 7-14A of this Code must show that certified staff
 | 
| members were transferred from the control of the district
 | 
| losing territory to the control of the district gaining
 | 
| territory in the annexation. The changes to this Section made
 | 
| by Public Act 95-707
 are
intended to be retroactive and  | 
| applicable to any annexation
taking effect on or after July 1,  | 
| 2004. For annexations that are eligible for payments under this  | 
| paragraph (2.10) and that are effective on or after July 1,  | 
| 2004, but before January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public  | 
| Act 95-707), the first required yearly payment under this  | 
| paragraph (2.10) shall be paid in the second fiscal year after  | 
| January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public Act 95-707).  Any  | 
| subsequent required yearly payments shall be paid in subsequent  | 
| fiscal years until the payment obligation under this paragraph  | 
| (2.10) is complete.
 | 
|     (2.15)
 Following the deactivation of a school facility in  | 
| accordance with Section 10-22.22b of this Code, a supplementary  | 
| State aid reimbursement shall be paid for the lesser of 3  | 
| school years or the length of the deactivation agreement,  | 
| including any renewals of the original deactivation agreement,  | 
| to each receiving school district equal to the sum of $4,000  | 
| for each certified employee who is employed by that receiving  | 
| district on a full-time basis for the regular term of any such  | 
| school year who was originally transferred to the control of  | 
| that receiving district as a result of the deactivation.  | 
|  | 
| Receiving districts are eligible for payments under this  | 
| paragraph (2.15)
 based on the certified employees transferred  | 
| to that receiving district as a result of the deactivation and  | 
| are not required to receive at least 30% of the deactivating  | 
| district's average daily attendance as required under  | 
| paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) to be eligible for  | 
| payments.  | 
|     (3) The supplementary State aid reimbursement payable  | 
| under this subsection (d) shall be separate from and in  | 
| addition to all other payments made to the district pursuant to  | 
| any other Section of this Article. | 
|     (4) During May of each school year for which a  | 
| supplementary State aid reimbursement is to be paid to a new,  | 
| annexing, or receiving school district or cooperative high  | 
| school pursuant to this subsection (d), the school board or  | 
| governing board shall certify to the State Board of Education,  | 
| on forms furnished to the school board or governing board by  | 
| the State Board of Education for purposes of this subsection  | 
| (d), the number of certified employees for which the district  | 
| or cooperative high school is entitled to reimbursement under  | 
| this Section, together with the names, certificate numbers, and  | 
| positions held by the  certified employees. | 
|     (5) Upon certification by the State Board of Education to  | 
| the State Comptroller of the amount of the supplementary State  | 
| aid reimbursement to which a school district or cooperative  | 
| high school is entitled under this subsection (d), the State  | 
|  | 
| Comptroller shall draw his or her  warrant upon the State  | 
| Treasurer for the payment thereof to the school district or  | 
| cooperative high school and shall promptly transmit the payment  | 
| to the school district or cooperative high school through the  | 
| appropriate school treasurer.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 95-331, eff. 8-21-07; 95-707, eff. 1-11-08;  | 
| 95-903, eff. 8-25-08; 96-328, eff. 8-11-09.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/13A-8)
 | 
|     Sec. 13A-8. Funding. 
 | 
|     (a) The State of Illinois shall provide funding for
the
 | 
| alternative school programs within each educational service  | 
| region and within
the Chicago public school system by line item  | 
| appropriation made to the State
Board of Education for that  | 
| purpose.  This money, when appropriated, shall be
provided to  | 
| the regional superintendent and to the Chicago Board of  | 
| Education,
who shall establish a budget, including salaries,  | 
| for their
alternative school programs.
Each program shall  | 
| receive funding in the amount of $30,000 plus an amount
based  | 
| on the ratio of the region's or Chicago's best 3 months'  | 
| average daily
attendance in grades pre-kindergarten through 12  | 
| to the statewide totals of
these amounts.  For purposes of this  | 
| calculation, the best 3 months' average
daily attendance for  | 
| each region or Chicago shall be calculated by adding to
the  | 
| best 3 months' average
daily
attendance the number of  | 
| low-income students identified in the most
recently available  | 
|  | 
| federal census multiplied by one-half times the percentage
of  | 
| the
region's or Chicago's low-income students
to the State's  | 
| total low-income students.
The State Board of Education shall  | 
| retain
up to 1.1% of the appropriation to be used to provide  | 
| technical assistance,
professional development, and  | 
| evaluations for the programs.
 | 
|     (a-5) Notwithstanding any other provisions of this  | 
| Section, for the
1998-1999
fiscal year, the total amount  | 
| distributed
under subsection (a) for an alternative school  | 
| program shall be not less than
the total amount that was  | 
| distributed under that subsection for that
alternative school  | 
| program for the 1997-1998 fiscal year.  If an alternative
school  | 
| program is to receive a total distribution under subsection (a)  | 
| for the
1998-1999 fiscal year that is less than the total
 | 
| distribution that the program received under that subsection  | 
| for the 1997-1998
fiscal year, that alternative school program  | 
| shall also receive, from a
separate appropriation made for  | 
| purposes of this subsection (a-5), a
supplementary
payment  | 
| equal to the amount by which its total distribution under
 | 
| subsection (a) for the 1997-1998 fiscal year exceeds the amount  | 
| of the total
distribution that the alternative school program  | 
| receives under that
subsection for the 1998-1999 fiscal year.
 | 
| If the amount appropriated
for supplementary payments to  | 
| alternative school programs under this subsection
(a-5)
is  | 
| insufficient for that purpose, those supplementary payments  | 
| shall be
prorated among the alternative school programs  | 
|  | 
| entitled to receive those
supplementary payments according to  | 
| the aggregate amount of the appropriation
made for purposes of  | 
| this subsection (a-5).
 | 
|     (b) An alternative school program shall be entitled to  | 
| receive general
State aid as calculated in subsection (K) of
 | 
| Section 18-8.05 or evidence-based funding as calculated in   | 
| subsection (g) of Section 18-8.15 upon filing a claim as
 | 
| provided therein.  Any time that a student who is enrolled in an  | 
| alternative
school program spends in work-based learning,  | 
| community service, or a similar
alternative educational  | 
| setting shall be included in determining the student's
minimum  | 
| number of clock hours of daily school work that constitute a  | 
| day of
attendance for purposes of calculating general State aid  | 
| or evidence-based funding.
 | 
|     (c) An alternative school program may receive additional  | 
| funding from its
school districts in such amount as may be  | 
| agreed upon by the parties and
necessary
to support the  | 
| program.  In addition, an alternative school program is
 | 
| authorized to accept and expend gifts, legacies, and grants,  | 
| including but not
limited to federal grants, from any source  | 
| for purposes directly related to the
conduct and operation of  | 
| the program.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 89-383, eff. 8-18-95; 89-629, eff. 8-9-96;  | 
| 89-636, eff. 8-9-96;
90-14, eff. 7-1-97; 90-283, eff. 7-31-97;  | 
| 90-802, eff. 12-15-98.)
 
 | 
|  | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/13B-20.20)
 | 
|     Sec. 13B-20.20. Enrollment in other programs. High school  | 
| equivalency testing
preparation programs are not eligible for  | 
| funding under this Article.  A
student
may enroll in a program  | 
| approved under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code, as
 | 
| appropriate, or
attend both the alternative learning  | 
| opportunities program and the regular
school program to enhance  | 
| student performance and facilitate on-time
graduation.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-718, eff. 1-1-15.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/13B-45)
 | 
|     Sec. 13B-45. Days and hours of attendance. An alternative  | 
| learning
opportunities program
shall provide students with at  | 
| least the minimum number of days of pupil
attendance required  | 
| under Section 10-19 of this Code and the minimum number of
 | 
| daily hours of school work required under Section 18-8.05 or  | 
| 18-8.15 of this Code,
provided that the State Board may approve  | 
| exceptions to these
requirements if the program meets all of  | 
| the following conditions:
 | 
|         (1) The district plan submitted under Section  | 
| 13B-25.15 of this Code
establishes that a program providing  | 
| the required minimum number of days of
attendance or daily  | 
| hours of school work would not serve the needs of the
 | 
| program's students.
 | 
|         (2) Each day of attendance shall provide no fewer than  | 
| 3 clock hours of
school work, as defined under paragraph  | 
|  | 
| (1) of subsection (F) of Section
18-8.05 of this Code.
 | 
|         (3) Each day of attendance that provides fewer than 5  | 
| clock hours of
school
work shall also provide supplementary  | 
| services, including without limitation
work-based  | 
| learning, student assistance programs, counseling, case  | 
| management,
health and fitness programs, or life-skills or  | 
| conflict resolution training,
in order to provide a total  | 
| daily program to the student of 5 clock hours.  A
program  | 
| may claim general State aid or evidence-based funding for  | 
| up to 2 hours of the time each day that
a student is  | 
| receiving
supplementary services.
 | 
|         (4) Each program shall provide no fewer than 174 days  | 
| of actual pupil
attendance during the school term; however,  | 
| approved evening programs that meet
the requirements of  | 
| Section 13B-45 of this Code may offer less than 174 days
of  | 
| actual pupil attendance during the school term.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 92-42, eff. 1-1-02.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/13B-50)
 | 
|     Sec. 13B-50. Eligibility to receive general State aid or  | 
| evidence-based funding. In order to
receive general State aid  | 
| or evidence-based funding,
alternative learning opportunities  | 
| programs must meet the requirements for
claiming general State
 | 
| aid as specified in Section 18-8.05 of this Code or  | 
| evidence-based funding as specified in Section 18-8.15 of this  | 
| Code, as applicable, with the exception of the
length of the  | 
|  | 
| instructional
day, which may be less than 5 hours of school  | 
| work if the program meets the
criteria set forth under
Sections  | 
| 13B-50.5 and 13B-50.10 of this Code and if the program is  | 
| approved by
the State Board.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 92-42, eff. 1-1-02.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/13B-50.10)
 | 
|     Sec. 13B-50.10. Additional criteria for general State aid  | 
| or evidence-based funding. In order to
claim general State aid  | 
| or evidence-based funding,
an alternative learning  | 
| opportunities program must meet the following
criteria:
 | 
|     (1) Teacher professional development plans should include  | 
| education in the
instruction
of at-risk students.
 | 
|     (2) Facilities must meet the health, life, and safety  | 
| requirements in this
Code.
 | 
|     (3) The program must comply with all other State and  | 
| federal laws
applicable to
education providers.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 92-42, eff. 1-1-02.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/13B-50.15)
 | 
|     Sec. 13B-50.15. Level of funding. Approved alternative  | 
| learning
opportunities programs are
entitled to claim general  | 
| State aid or evidence-based funding, subject to Sections  | 
| 13B-50, 13B-50.5, and
13B-50.10 of this
Code.  Approved programs  | 
| operated by regional offices of education are entitled
to  | 
| receive general
State aid at the foundation level of support.  A  | 
|  | 
| school district or consortium
must ensure that an
approved  | 
| program receives supplemental general State aid,  | 
| transportation
reimbursements, and
special education  | 
| resources, if appropriate, for students enrolled in the
 | 
| program.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 92-42, eff. 1-1-02.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/14-7.02b)
 | 
|     Sec. 14-7.02b. Funding for children requiring special  | 
| education services.
Payments to school districts for children  | 
| requiring
special education services documented in their  | 
| individualized education
program regardless of the program  | 
| from which these services are received,
excluding children  | 
| claimed under Sections 14-7.02 and 14-7.03 of this Code,
shall
 | 
| be made in accordance with this Section.  Funds received under  | 
| this Section
may be used only for the provision of special  | 
| educational facilities and
services as defined in Section  | 
| 14-1.08 of this Code.
 | 
|     The appropriation for fiscal year 2005 through fiscal year  | 
| 2017 and thereafter shall be based upon
the IDEA child count of  | 
| all students in the State, excluding students
claimed under  | 
| Sections 14-7.02 and 14-7.03 of this Code, on December 1 of the
 | 
| fiscal year 2
years
preceding, multiplied by 17.5% of the  | 
| general State aid
foundation level of support established for  | 
| that fiscal year under Section
18-8.05 of
this Code.
 | 
|     Beginning with fiscal year 2005 and through fiscal year  | 
|  | 
| 2007, individual school districts
shall not receive payments  | 
| under this Section totaling less than they received
under the
 | 
| funding authorized under Section 14-7.02a of this Code
during  | 
| fiscal year 2004, pursuant to the provisions of Section  | 
| 14-7.02a as they
were in effect before the effective date of  | 
| this amendatory Act of the 93rd
General Assembly. This base  | 
| level funding shall be computed first.
 | 
|     Beginning with fiscal   year 2008 through fiscal year 2017  | 
| and each fiscal year thereafter, individual school districts  | 
| must not receive payments under this Section totaling less than  | 
| they received in fiscal year 2007. This funding shall be  | 
| computed last and shall be a separate calculation from any  | 
| other calculation set forth in this Section.  This amount is  | 
| exempt from the requirements of Section 1D-1 of this Code.
 | 
|     Through fiscal year 2017, an An amount equal to 85% of the  | 
| funds remaining in the appropriation shall be allocated to  | 
| school districts based upon the
district's average daily  | 
| attendance reported for purposes of Section
18-8.05 of this  | 
| Code for the preceding school year.  Fifteen percent of the
 | 
| funds
remaining in the appropriation
shall be allocated to  | 
| school districts based upon the district's low income
eligible  | 
| pupil count used in the calculation of general State aid under  | 
| Section
18-8.05 of this Code for the same fiscal year.  One  | 
| hundred percent of the
funds
computed and allocated to  | 
| districts under this Section shall be distributed and
paid to  | 
| school districts.
 | 
|  | 
|     For individual
students with disabilities whose program  | 
| costs exceed 4 times the
district's per capita tuition rate
as  | 
| calculated under Section 10-20.12a of this Code, the costs in  | 
| excess
of 4 times the district's per capita tuition rate shall  | 
| be paid by the State
Board of Education from unexpended IDEA  | 
| discretionary funds originally
designated for room and board  | 
| reimbursement pursuant to Section
14-8.01 of this Code. The  | 
| amount of tuition for these children shall be
determined by the  | 
| actual cost of maintaining classes for these children,
using  | 
| the per
capita cost formula set forth in Section 14-7.01 of  | 
| this Code, with the
program and cost being pre-approved by the  | 
| State Superintendent of
Education. Reimbursement for  | 
| individual students with disabilities whose program costs  | 
| exceed 4 times the district's per capita tuition rate shall be  | 
| claimed beginning with costs encumbered for the 2004-2005  | 
| school year and thereafter.
 | 
|     The State Board of Education shall prepare vouchers equal  | 
| to one-fourth the
amount allocated to districts, for  | 
| transmittal
to the State Comptroller on the 30th day of  | 
| September, December, and March,
respectively, and the final  | 
| voucher, no later than June 20. The Comptroller
shall make  | 
| payments pursuant to this Section to school districts as soon  | 
| as possible after receipt of vouchers. If the money
 | 
| appropriated from the General Assembly for such purposes for  | 
| any year is
insufficient, it shall be apportioned on the basis  | 
| of the payments due to
school districts.
 | 
|  | 
|     Nothing in this Section shall be construed to decrease or  | 
| increase the
percentage of all special education funds that are  | 
| allocated annually
under Article 1D of this Code
or to alter  | 
| the requirement that a
school district provide special  | 
| education services.
 | 
|     Nothing in this amendatory Act of the 93rd General Assembly  | 
| shall
eliminate any reimbursement obligation owed as of the  | 
| effective date of this
amendatory Act of the 93rd General  | 
| Assembly to a school district with in excess
of 500,000  | 
| inhabitants.
 | 
|     Except for reimbursement for individual students with  | 
| disabilities whose program costs exceed 4 times the district's  | 
| per capita tuition rate, no funding shall be provided to school  | 
| districts under this Section after fiscal year 2017. | 
|     In fiscal year 2018 and each fiscal year thereafter, all  | 
| funding received by a school district from the State pursuant  | 
| to Section 18–8.15 of this Code that is attributable to  | 
| students requiring special education services must be used for  | 
| special education services authorized under this Code. | 
| (Source: P.A. 93-1022, eff. 8-24-08; 95-705, eff. 1-8-08.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/14-13.01)  (from Ch. 122, par. 14-13.01)
 | 
|     Sec. 14-13.01. Reimbursement payable by State; amounts for  | 
| personnel and transportation.  | 
|     (a) Through fiscal year 2017, for For staff working on  | 
| behalf of children who have not been identified as eligible for  | 
|  | 
| special
education and for eligible children with physical
 | 
| disabilities, including all
eligible children whose placement  | 
| has been determined under Section 14-8.02 in
hospital or home  | 
| instruction, 1/2 of the teacher's salary but not more than
 | 
| $1,000 annually per child or $9,000 per teacher, whichever is  | 
| less. | 
|     (a-5) A child qualifies for home or hospital instruction if  | 
| it is anticipated that, due to a medical condition, the child  | 
| will be unable to attend school, and instead must be instructed  | 
| at home or in the hospital, for a period of 2 or more  | 
| consecutive weeks or on an ongoing intermittent basis.  For  | 
| purposes of this Section, "ongoing intermittent basis" means  | 
| that the child's medical condition is of such a nature or  | 
| severity that it is anticipated that the child will be absent  | 
| from school due to the medical condition for periods of at  | 
| least 2 days at a time multiple times during the school year  | 
| totaling at least 10 days or more of absences.  There shall be  | 
| no requirement that a child be absent from school a minimum  | 
| number of days before the child qualifies for home or hospital  | 
| instruction. In order to establish eligibility for home or  | 
| hospital services, a student's parent or guardian must submit  | 
| to the child's school district of residence a written statement  | 
| from a physician licensed to practice medicine in all of its  | 
| branches stating the existence of such medical condition, the  | 
| impact on the child's ability to participate in education, and  | 
| the anticipated duration or nature of the child's absence from  | 
|  | 
| school. Home or hospital instruction may commence upon receipt  | 
| of  a written physician's statement in accordance with this  | 
| Section, but instruction shall commence not later than 5 school  | 
| days after the school district receives the physician's  | 
| statement.  Special education and related services required by  | 
| the  child's IEP or services and accommodations required by the  | 
| child's federal Section 504 plan must be implemented as part of  | 
| the child's home or hospital instruction, unless the IEP team  | 
| or federal Section 504 plan team determines that modifications  | 
| are necessary  during the home or hospital instruction due to  | 
| the child's condition. | 
|     (a-10) Through fiscal year 2017, eligible  Eligible  | 
| children
to be included in any reimbursement under this  | 
| paragraph must regularly
receive a minimum of one hour of  | 
| instruction each school day, or in lieu
thereof of a minimum of  | 
| 5 hours of instruction in each school week in
order to qualify  | 
| for full reimbursement under this Section.  If the
attending  | 
| physician for such a child has certified that the child should
 | 
| not receive as many as 5 hours of instruction in a school week,  | 
| however,
reimbursement under this paragraph on account of that  | 
| child shall be
computed proportionate to the actual hours of  | 
| instruction per week for
that child divided by 5. | 
|     (a-15) The State Board of Education shall establish rules  | 
| governing the required qualifications of staff providing home  | 
| or hospital instruction. 
 | 
|     (b) For children described in Section 14-1.02, 80% of the  | 
|  | 
| cost of
transportation approved as a related service in the  | 
| Individualized Education Program for each student
in order to  | 
| take advantage of special educational facilities.
 | 
| Transportation costs shall be determined in the same fashion as  | 
| provided
in Section 29-5 of this Code.  For purposes of this  | 
| subsection (b), the dates for
processing claims specified in  | 
| Section 29-5 shall apply.
 | 
|     (c) Through fiscal year 2017, for For each qualified  | 
| worker, the annual sum of
 $9,000.
 | 
|     (d) Through fiscal year 2017, for For one full time  | 
| qualified director of the special education
program of each  | 
| school district which maintains a fully approved program
of  | 
| special education the annual sum of $9,000.  Districts  | 
| participating in a joint agreement special
education program  | 
| shall not receive such reimbursement if reimbursement is made
 | 
| for a director of the joint agreement program.
 | 
|     (e) (Blank).
 | 
|     (f) (Blank).
 | 
|     (g) Through fiscal year 2017, for For readers, working with  | 
| blind or partially seeing children 1/2
of their salary but not  | 
| more than $400 annually per child.  Readers may
be employed to  | 
| assist such children and shall not be required to be
certified  | 
| but prior to employment shall meet standards set up by the
 | 
| State Board of Education.
 | 
|     (h) Through fiscal year 2017, for For non-certified  | 
| employees, as defined by rules promulgated by the State Board  | 
|  | 
| of Education, who deliver services to students with IEPs, 1/2  | 
| of the salary paid or
 $3,500 per employee, whichever is less.
 | 
|     (i) The State Board of Education shall set standards and  | 
| prescribe rules
for determining the allocation of  | 
| reimbursement under this section on
less than a full time basis  | 
| and for less than a school year.
 | 
|     When any school district eligible for reimbursement under  | 
| this
Section operates a school or program approved by the State
 | 
| Superintendent of Education for a number of days in excess of  | 
| the
adopted school calendar but not to exceed 235 school days,  | 
| such
reimbursement shall be increased by 1/180 of the amount or  | 
| rate paid
hereunder for each day such school is operated in  | 
| excess of 180 days per
calendar year.
 | 
|     Notwithstanding any other provision of law, any school  | 
| district receiving
a payment under this Section or under  | 
| Section 14-7.02, 14-7.02b, or
29-5 of this Code may classify  | 
| all or a portion of the funds that it receives
in a particular  | 
| fiscal year or from evidence-based funding general State aid  | 
| pursuant to Section 18-8.15
18-8.05 of this Code as
funds  | 
| received in connection with any funding program for which it is
 | 
| entitled to receive funds from the State in that fiscal year  | 
| (including,
without limitation, any funding program referenced  | 
| in this Section),
regardless of the source or timing of the  | 
| receipt.  The district may not
classify more funds as funds  | 
| received in connection with the funding
program than the  | 
| district is entitled to receive in that fiscal year for that
 | 
|  | 
| program.  Any
classification by a district must be made by a  | 
| resolution of its board of
education.  The resolution must  | 
| identify the amount of any payments or evidence-based funding
 | 
| general State aid to be classified under this paragraph and  | 
| must specify
the funding program to which the funds are to be  | 
| treated as received in
connection therewith.  This resolution is  | 
| controlling as to the
classification of funds referenced  | 
| therein.  A certified copy of the
resolution must be sent to the  | 
| State Superintendent of Education.
The resolution shall still  | 
| take effect even though a copy of the resolution has
not been  | 
| sent to the State
Superintendent of Education in a timely  | 
| manner.
 No
classification under this paragraph by a district  | 
| shall affect the total amount
or timing of money the district  | 
| is entitled to receive under this Code.
 No classification under  | 
| this paragraph by a district shall
in any way relieve the  | 
| district from or affect any
requirements that otherwise would  | 
| apply with respect to
that funding program, including any
 | 
| accounting of funds by source, reporting expenditures by
 | 
| original source and purpose,
reporting requirements,
or  | 
| requirements of providing services.
 | 
|     No funding shall be provided to school districts under this  | 
| Section after fiscal year 2017.  In fiscal year 2018 and each  | 
| fiscal year thereafter, all funding received by a school  | 
| district from the State pursuant to Section 18-8.15 of this  | 
| Code that is attributable to personnel reimbursements for  | 
| special education pupils must be used for special education  | 
|  | 
| services authorized under this Code.  | 
| (Source: P.A. 96-257, eff. 8-11-09; 97-123, eff. 7-14-11.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/14C-1)  (from Ch. 122, par. 14C-1) | 
|     Sec. 14C-1. The General Assembly finds that there are large  | 
| numbers of children in
this State who come from environments  | 
| where the primary language is other
than English. Experience  | 
| has shown that public school classes in which
instruction is  | 
| given only in English are often inadequate for the education
of  | 
| children whose native tongue is another language. The General  | 
| Assembly
believes that a program of transitional bilingual  | 
| education can meet the
needs of these children and facilitate  | 
| their integration into the regular
public school curriculum.  | 
| Therefore, pursuant to the policy of this State
to ensure equal  | 
| educational opportunity to every child, and in recognition
of  | 
| the educational needs of English learners, it is the purpose of  | 
| this Act to provide for the establishment of
transitional  | 
| bilingual education programs in the public schools, to
provide  | 
| supplemental financial assistance through fiscal year 2017 to  | 
| help local school districts
meet the extra costs of such  | 
| programs, and to allow this State through the State Board of  | 
| Education to directly or indirectly provide technical  | 
| assistance and professional development to support  | 
| transitional bilingual education or a transitional program of  | 
| instruction programs statewide through contractual services by  | 
| a not-for-profit entity for technical assistance, professional  | 
|  | 
| development, and other support to school districts and  | 
| educators for services for English learner pupils. In no case  | 
| may aggregate funding for contractual services by a  | 
| not-for-profit entity for support to school districts and  | 
| educators for services for English learner pupils be less than  | 
| the aggregate amount expended for such purposes in Fiscal Year  | 
| 2017.  Not-for-profit entities providing support to school  | 
| districts and educators for services for English learner pupils  | 
| must have experience providing those services in a school  | 
| district having a population exceeding 500,000; one or more  | 
| school districts in any of the counties of Lake, McHenry,  | 
| DuPage, Kane, and Will; and one or more school districts  | 
| elsewhere in this State. Funding for not-for-profit entities  | 
| providing support to school districts and educators for  | 
| services for English learner pupils may be increased subject to  | 
| an agreement with the State Board of Education. Funding for  | 
| not-for-profit entities providing support to school districts  | 
| and educators for services for English learner pupils shall  | 
| come from funds allocated pursuant to Section 18-8.15 of this  | 
| Code. | 
| (Source: P.A. 99-30, eff. 7-10-15.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/14C-12)  (from Ch. 122, par. 14C-12)
 | 
|     Sec. 14C-12. Account of expenditures; Cost report;  | 
| Reimbursement. 
Each
school district with at least one English  | 
| learner shall keep an accurate, detailed and separate account  | 
|  | 
| of
all monies paid out by it for the programs in transitional  | 
| bilingual education
required or permitted by this Article,  | 
| including transportation costs, and
shall annually report  | 
| thereon for the school year ending June 30 indicating
the  | 
| average per pupil expenditure. Through fiscal year 2017, each   | 
| Each school district shall be reimbursed
for the amount by  | 
| which such costs exceed the average per pupil expenditure
by  | 
| such school district for the education of children of  | 
| comparable age
who are not in any special education program. No  | 
| funding shall be provided to school districts under this  | 
| Section after fiscal year 2017. In fiscal year 2018 and each  | 
| fiscal year thereafter, all funding received by a school  | 
| district from the State pursuant to Section 18-8.15 of this  | 
| Code that is attributable to instructions, supports, and  | 
| interventions for English learner pupils must be used for  | 
| programs and services authorized under this Article. At least  | 
| 60% of transitional bilingual education funding received from  | 
| the State must be used for the instructional costs of programs  | 
| and services authorized under this Article transitional  | 
| bilingual education. 
 | 
|     Applications for preapproval for reimbursement for costs  | 
| of transitional
bilingual education programs must be submitted  | 
| to the State Superintendent of
Education at least 60 days  | 
| before a transitional bilingual education program
is started,  | 
| unless a justifiable exception is granted by the State
 | 
| Superintendent of Education.
Applications shall set forth a  | 
|  | 
| plan for transitional
bilingual education established and  | 
| maintained in accordance with this Article.
 | 
|     Through fiscal year 2017, reimbursement Reimbursement  | 
| claims for transitional bilingual education programs shall
be  | 
| made as follows:
 | 
|     Each school district shall claim reimbursement on a current  | 
| basis for the
first 3 quarters of the fiscal year and file a  | 
| final adjusted
claim
for the school year ended June 30  | 
| preceding computed in accordance with rules
prescribed by the  | 
| State Superintendent's Office.
  The State Superintendent
of
 | 
| Education before approving any such claims shall
determine  | 
| their accuracy and whether
they are based upon services and  | 
| facilities provided under approved programs.
Upon approval he  | 
| shall transmit to the Comptroller
the
vouchers showing the  | 
| amounts due for
school
district reimbursement claims.  Upon  | 
| receipt of the
final adjusted
claims the State Superintendent  | 
| of Education shall make a final
determination of the
accuracy  | 
| of such claims.  If the money appropriated by the General  | 
| Assembly
for such purpose for any year is insufficient, it  | 
| shall be apportioned on
the basis of the claims approved.
 | 
|     Failure on the part of the school district to prepare and  | 
| certify the final
adjusted claims due under this Section may  | 
| constitute a forfeiture
by the school district of its right to  | 
| be reimbursed by the State under this
Section.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 96-1170, eff. 1-1-11.)
 
 | 
|  | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/17-1)  (from Ch. 122, par. 17-1)
 | 
|     Sec. 17-1. Annual Budget. The board of education of each  | 
| school
district under 500,000 inhabitants shall, within or  | 
| before the first
quarter of each fiscal year, adopt and file  | 
| with the State Board of Education an annual balanced budget  | 
| which it deems
necessary to defray all necessary expenses and  | 
| liabilities of the
district, and in such annual budget shall  | 
| specify the objects and
purposes of each item and amount needed  | 
| for each object or purpose.
 | 
|     The budget shall be entered upon a School District Budget  | 
| form prepared
and provided by the State Board of Education and  | 
| therein shall contain
a statement of the cash on hand at the
 | 
| beginning of the fiscal year, an estimate of the cash expected  | 
| to be
received during such fiscal year from all sources, an  | 
| estimate of the
expenditures contemplated for such fiscal year,  | 
| and a statement of the
estimated cash expected to be on hand at  | 
| the end of such year.  The
estimate of taxes to be received may  | 
| be based upon the amount of actual
cash receipts that may  | 
| reasonably be expected by the district during
such fiscal year,  | 
| estimated from the experience of the district in prior
years  | 
| and with due regard for other circumstances that may  | 
| substantially
affect such receipts.  Nothing in this Section  | 
| shall be construed as
requiring any district to change or  | 
| preventing any district from
changing from a cash basis of  | 
| financing to a surplus or deficit basis of
financing; or as  | 
| requiring any district to change or preventing any
district  | 
|  | 
| from changing its system of accounting. The budget shall  | 
| conform to the requirements adopted by the State Board of  | 
| Education pursuant to Section 2-3.28 of this Code. 
 | 
|     To the extent that a school district's budget is not  | 
| balanced, the district shall also adopt and file with the State  | 
| Board of Education a deficit reduction plan to balance the  | 
| district's budget within 3 years.  The deficit reduction plan  | 
| must be filed at the same time as the budget, but the State  | 
| Superintendent of Education may extend this deadline if the  | 
| situation warrants.
 | 
|     If, as the result of an audit performed in compliance with  | 
| Section 3-7 of this Code, the resulting Annual Financial Report  | 
| required to be submitted pursuant to Section 3-15.1 of this  | 
| Code reflects a deficit as defined for purposes of the  | 
| preceding paragraph, then the district shall, within 30 days  | 
| after acceptance of such audit report, submit a deficit  | 
| reduction plan.  | 
|     The board of education of each district shall fix a fiscal  | 
| year
therefor.  If the beginning of the fiscal year of a  | 
| district is
subsequent to the time that the tax levy due to be  | 
| made in such
fiscal year shall be
made, then such annual budget  | 
| shall be adopted prior to the time such
tax levy shall be made.
  | 
| The failure by a board of education of any district to adopt an  | 
| annual
budget, or to comply in any respect with the provisions  | 
| of this Section, shall
not affect the validity of any tax levy  | 
| of the district otherwise in
conformity with the law.  With  | 
|  | 
| respect to taxes levied either before, on, or
after the  | 
| effective date of this amendatory Act of the 91st General  | 
| Assembly,
(i) a tax levy is made
for the fiscal year in which  | 
| the levy is due to be made regardless of which
fiscal year the  | 
| proceeds of the levy are expended or are intended to be
 | 
| expended, and (ii) except as otherwise provided by law, a board  | 
| of education's
adoption of
an annual budget in conformity with  | 
| this Section is not a prerequisite to the
adoption of a valid  | 
| tax levy and is not a limit on the amount of the levy.
 | 
|     Such budget shall be prepared in tentative form by some  | 
| person or
persons designated by the board, and in such  | 
| tentative form shall be
made conveniently available to public  | 
| inspection for at least 30 days
prior to final action thereon.   | 
| At least 1 public hearing shall be held
as to such budget prior  | 
| to final action thereon.  Notice of availability
for public  | 
| inspection and of such public hearing shall be given by
 | 
| publication in a newspaper published in such district, at least  | 
| 30 days
prior to the time of such hearing.  If there is no  | 
| newspaper published
in such district, notice of such public  | 
| hearing shall be given by
posting notices thereof in 5 of the  | 
| most public places in such district.
It shall be the duty of  | 
| the secretary of such board to make such
tentative budget  | 
| available to public inspection, and to arrange for such
public  | 
| hearing.  The board may from time to time make transfers between
 | 
| the various items in any fund not exceeding in the aggregate  | 
| 10% of the
total of such fund as set forth in the budget. The  | 
|  | 
| board may from time
to time amend such budget by the same  | 
| procedure as is herein provided
for its original adoption.
 | 
|     Beginning July 1, 1976, the board of education, or regional
 | 
| superintendent, or governing board responsible for the  | 
| administration of
a joint agreement shall, by September 1 of  | 
| each
fiscal year thereafter, adopt an annual budget for the  | 
| joint agreement
in the same manner and subject to the same  | 
| requirements as are provided
in this Section.
 | 
|     The State Board of Education shall exercise powers and  | 
| duties
relating to budgets as provided in Section 2-3.27 of  | 
| this Code and shall require school districts to submit their  | 
| annual budgets, deficit reduction plans, and other financial  | 
| information, including revenue and expenditure reports and  | 
| borrowing and interfund transfer plans, in such form and within  | 
| the timelines designated by the State Board of Education.
 | 
|     By fiscal year 1982 all school districts shall use the  | 
| Program Budget
Accounting System.
 | 
|     In the case of a school district receiving emergency State  | 
| financial
assistance under Article 1B, the school board shall  | 
| also be subject to the
requirements
established under Article  | 
| 1B with respect to the annual budget.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 97-429, eff. 8-16-11.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/17-1.2)
 | 
|     Sec. 17-1.2. Post annual budget on web site. If a school  | 
| district
has an Internet web site, the school district shall  | 
|  | 
| post its current annual
budget,
itemized by receipts and  | 
| expenditures, on the district's Internet web site. The budget  | 
| shall include information conforming to the rules adopted by  | 
| the State Board of Education pursuant to Section 2-3.28 of this  | 
| Code.
The school district shall notify the parents or guardians  | 
| of its students
that the budget has been posted on the  | 
| district's web site and what
the web site's address is.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 92-438, eff. 1-1-02.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/17-1.5)
 | 
|     Sec. 17-1.5. Limitation of administrative costs. 
 | 
|     (a) It is the purpose of this Section to establish  | 
| limitations on the growth
of administrative expenditures in  | 
| order to maximize the proportion of school
district resources  | 
| available for the instructional program, building
maintenance,  | 
| and safety services for the students of each district.
 | 
|     (b) Definitions.  For the purposes of this Section:
 | 
|     "Administrative expenditures" mean the annual expenditures  | 
| of
school districts properly attributable to expenditure  | 
| functions defined by the
rules of the State Board of Education  | 
| as: 2320 (Executive Administration Services);
2330 (Special  | 
| Area Administration Services); 2490 (Other Support Services -
 | 
| School Administration); 2510 (Direction of Business Support  | 
| Services); 2570
(Internal Services); and 2610 (Direction of  | 
| Central
Support Services); provided, however, that  | 
| "administrative expenditures" shall
not include early  | 
|  | 
| retirement or other pension system obligations required by
 | 
| State law.
 | 
|     "School district" means all school districts having a  | 
| population of less than
500,000.
 | 
|     (c) For the 1998-99 school year and each school year  | 
| thereafter, each school
district shall undertake budgetary and  | 
| expenditure control actions so that the
increase in  | 
| administrative expenditures for that school year over the prior
 | 
| school year does not exceed 5%.
School districts with  | 
| administrative expenditures per pupil
in the 25th
percentile  | 
| and below for all districts of the same type,
as defined by the  | 
| State Board of Education,
may waive the limitation imposed  | 
| under this Section for any year following a
public hearing and  | 
| with the
affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the members  | 
| of the school board of
the
district. Any district waiving the  | 
| limitation shall notify the State Board
within 45 days of such  | 
| action.
 | 
|     (d) School districts shall file with the State Board of  | 
| Education by
November 15, 1998 and
by each November 15th  | 
| thereafter a one-page report that lists
(i) the actual
 | 
| administrative expenditures for
the
prior year from the  | 
| district's audited Annual Financial Report, and (ii) the
 | 
| projected administrative expenditures for the current year  | 
| from the budget adopted by the school board
pursuant to Section  | 
| 17-1 of this Code.
 | 
|     If a school district that is ineligible to waive the  | 
|  | 
| limitation imposed by
subsection (c) of this Section by board  | 
| action exceeds the limitation
solely because of circumstances  | 
| beyond
the control of the district and the district has  | 
| exhausted all available and
reasonable remedies to comply with  | 
| the limitation, the district may request a
waiver pursuant to  | 
| Section 2-3.25g.  The waiver application shall specify the
 | 
| amount,
nature, and reason for the relief requested, as well as  | 
| all remedies the
district has exhausted to comply with the  | 
| limitation.
 Any emergency relief so requested shall apply only  | 
| to the specific
school year for which the request is made.  The  | 
| State Board of Education shall
analyze all such waivers  | 
| submitted and shall recommend that the General
Assembly  | 
| disapprove any such waiver requested that is not due solely to
 | 
| circumstances beyond the control of the district and for which  | 
| the district has
not exhausted all available and reasonable  | 
| remedies to comply with the
limitation.  The State  | 
| Superintendent shall have
no authority to impose any sanctions  | 
| pursuant to this Section for any
expenditures for which a  | 
| waiver has been requested until such waiver has been
reviewed  | 
| by the General Assembly.
 | 
|     If the report and information required
under this
 | 
| subsection (d) are not provided by the school district in a  | 
| timely
manner, or are subsequently determined by
the State  | 
| Superintendent of Education
to be incomplete or inaccurate, the  | 
| State Superintendent shall notify the
district in writing of  | 
| reporting deficiencies.  The school district shall,
within 60  | 
|  | 
| days of the notice, address the reporting deficiencies  | 
| identified. 
 | 
|     (e) If the State Superintendent determines that a school  | 
| district has failed
to comply with the administrative  | 
| expenditure limitation imposed in subsection
(c) of this  | 
| Section,
the
State Superintendent shall notify the district of  | 
| the violation and direct the
district to undertake corrective  | 
| action to bring the district's budget into
compliance with the  | 
| administrative expenditure limitation.  The district shall,
 | 
| within 60 days of the notice, provide adequate assurance to the  | 
| State
Superintendent that appropriate corrective actions have  | 
| been or will be taken.
If the district fails to provide  | 
| adequate assurance or fails to undertake the
necessary  | 
| corrective actions, the State Superintendent may impose  | 
| progressive
sanctions against the district that may culminate  | 
| in withholding
all
subsequent payments of general State aid due  | 
| the district under Section
18-8.05 of
this Code or  | 
| evidence-based funding due the district under Section 18-8.15  | 
| of this Code
until the assurance is provided or the corrective  | 
| actions taken.
 | 
|     (f) The State Superintendent shall publish a list each year  | 
| of the school
districts that violate the limitation imposed by  | 
| subsection (c) of this
Section and a list of the districts that  | 
| waive the limitation by board
action as provided in subsection  | 
| (c) of this Section. 
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 90-548, eff. 1-1-98; 90-653, eff. 7-29-98.)
 | 
|  | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/17-2.11)  (from Ch. 122, par. 17-2.11) | 
|     Sec. 17-2.11. School board power to levy a tax or to borrow  | 
| money and
issue bonds for fire prevention, safety, energy  | 
| conservation,
accessibility, school security, and specified  | 
| repair purposes. | 
|     (a) Whenever, as a
result of any lawful order of any  | 
| agency,
other than a school board, having authority to enforce  | 
| any school building code
applicable to any facility that houses  | 
| students, or any law or regulation for
the protection and  | 
| safety of the environment, pursuant to the Environmental
 | 
| Protection Act, any school district having a population of less  | 
| than 500,000
inhabitants is required to alter or reconstruct  | 
| any school building or
permanent, fixed equipment; the district  | 
| may, by proper resolution, levy a tax for the purpose of making  | 
| such alteration or reconstruction, based on a survey report by  | 
| an architect or engineer licensed in this State, upon all of  | 
| the taxable property of the district at the value as assessed  | 
| by the Department of Revenue and at a rate not to exceed 0.05%  | 
| per year for a period sufficient to finance such alteration or  | 
| reconstruction, upon the following conditions: | 
|         (1) When there are not sufficient funds available in  | 
| the operations and maintenance fund of the school district,  | 
| the school facility occupation tax fund of the district, or  | 
| the fire prevention and safety fund of the district, as  | 
| determined by the district on the basis of rules adopted by  | 
|  | 
| the State Board of Education, to make such alteration or  | 
| reconstruction or to purchase and install such permanent,  | 
| fixed equipment so ordered or determined as necessary.  | 
| Appropriate school district records must be made available  | 
| to the State Superintendent of Education, upon request, to  | 
| confirm this insufficiency. | 
|         (2) When a certified estimate of an architect or  | 
| engineer licensed in this State stating the estimated  | 
| amount necessary to make the alteration or reconstruction  | 
| or to purchase and install the equipment so ordered has  | 
| been secured by the school district, and the estimate has  | 
| been approved by the regional superintendent of schools  | 
| having jurisdiction over the district and the State  | 
| Superintendent of Education.  Approval must not be granted  | 
| for any work that has already started without the prior  | 
| express authorization of the State Superintendent of  | 
| Education. If the estimate is not approved or is denied  | 
| approval by the regional superintendent of schools within 3  | 
| months after the date on which it is submitted to him or  | 
| her, the school board of the district may submit the  | 
| estimate directly to the State Superintendent of Education  | 
| for approval or denial. | 
|     In the case of an emergency situation, where the estimated  | 
| cost to effectuate emergency repairs is less than the amount  | 
| specified in Section 10-20.21 of this Code, the school district  | 
| may proceed with such repairs prior to approval by the State  | 
|  | 
| Superintendent of Education, but shall comply with the  | 
| provisions of subdivision (2) of this subsection (a) as soon  | 
| thereafter as may be as well as Section 10-20.21 of this Code.  | 
| If the estimated cost to effectuate emergency repairs is  | 
| greater than the amount specified in Section 10-20.21 of this  | 
| Code, then the school district shall proceed in conformity with  | 
| Section 10-20.21 of this Code and with rules established by the  | 
| State Board of Education to address such situations. The rules  | 
| adopted by the State Board of Education to deal with these  | 
| situations shall stipulate that emergency situations must be  | 
| expedited and given priority consideration. For purposes of  | 
| this paragraph, an emergency is a situation that presents an  | 
| imminent and continuing threat to the health and safety of  | 
| students or other occupants of a facility, requires complete or  | 
| partial evacuation of a building or part of a building, or  | 
| consumes one or more of the 5 emergency days built into the  | 
| adopted calendar of the school or schools or would otherwise be  | 
| expected to cause such school or schools to fall short of the  | 
| minimum school calendar requirements.  | 
|     (b)  Whenever any such district determines that
it is  | 
| necessary for energy conservation purposes that any school  | 
| building
or permanent, fixed equipment should be altered or  | 
| reconstructed and
that such alterations or reconstruction will  | 
| be made with funds not necessary
for the completion of approved  | 
| and recommended projects contained in any safety
survey report  | 
| or amendments thereto authorized by Section 2-3.12 of this Act;  | 
|  | 
| the district may levy a tax or issue bonds as provided in  | 
| subsection (a) of this Section. | 
|     (c)  Whenever
 any such district determines that it is  | 
| necessary for accessibility purposes and to comply with the  | 
| school building
code that any
school building or equipment  | 
| should be altered or reconstructed and that such
alterations or  | 
| reconstruction will be made with
funds not necessary for the  | 
| completion of approved and recommended projects
contained in  | 
| any safety survey report or amendments thereto authorized under
 | 
| Section 2-3.12 of this Act, the district may levy a tax or  | 
| issue bonds as provided in subsection (a) of this Section. | 
|     (d) Whenever any such district determines that it is
 | 
| necessary for school
security purposes and the related  | 
| protection and safety of pupils and school
personnel that any  | 
| school building or property should be altered or
reconstructed  | 
| or that security systems and equipment (including but not  | 
| limited
to intercom, early detection and warning, access  | 
| control and television
monitoring systems) should be purchased  | 
| and installed, and that such
alterations, reconstruction or  | 
| purchase and installation of equipment will be
made with funds  | 
| not necessary for the completion of approved and recommended
 | 
| projects contained in any safety survey report or amendment  | 
| thereto authorized
by Section 2-3.12 of this Act and will deter  | 
| and prevent unauthorized entry or
activities upon school  | 
| property by unknown or dangerous persons, assure early
 | 
| detection and advance warning of any such actual or attempted  | 
|  | 
| unauthorized
entry or activities and help assure the continued  | 
| safety of pupils and school
staff if any such unauthorized  | 
| entry or activity is attempted or occurs;
the district may levy  | 
| a tax or issue bonds as provided in subsection (a) of this  | 
| Section. | 
|     (e)  If a school district does not need funds for other fire  | 
| prevention and
safety projects, including the completion of  | 
| approved and recommended projects
contained in any safety  | 
| survey report or amendments thereto authorized by
Section  | 
| 2-3.12 of this Act, and it is determined after a public hearing  | 
| (which
is preceded by at least one published notice (i)  | 
| occurring at least 7 days
prior to the hearing in a newspaper  | 
| of general circulation within the school
district and (ii)  | 
| setting forth the time, date, place, and general subject
matter  | 
| of the hearing) that there is a
substantial, immediate, and  | 
| otherwise unavoidable threat to the health, safety,
or welfare  | 
| of pupils due to disrepair of school sidewalks, playgrounds,  | 
| parking
lots, or school bus turnarounds and repairs must be  | 
| made; then the district may levy a tax or issue bonds as  | 
| provided in subsection (a) of this Section. | 
|     (f) For purposes of this Section a school district may  | 
| replace a school
building or build additions to replace  | 
| portions of a building when it is
determined that the  | 
| effectuation of the recommendations for the existing
building  | 
| will cost more than the replacement costs.  Such determination  | 
| shall
be based on a comparison of estimated costs made by an  | 
|  | 
| architect or engineer
licensed in the State of Illinois.  The  | 
| new building or addition shall be
equivalent in area (square  | 
| feet) and comparable in purpose and grades served
and may be on  | 
| the same site or another site.  Such replacement may only be  | 
| done
upon order of the regional superintendent of schools and  | 
| the approval of the
State Superintendent of Education. | 
|     (g) The filing of a certified copy of the resolution  | 
| levying the tax when
accompanied by the certificates of the  | 
| regional superintendent of schools and
State Superintendent of  | 
| Education shall be the authority of the county clerk to
extend  | 
| such tax. | 
|     (h) The county clerk of the county in which any school  | 
| district levying a
tax under the authority of this Section is  | 
| located, in reducing raised
levies, shall not consider any such  | 
| tax as a part of the general levy
for school purposes and shall  | 
| not include the same in the limitation of
any other tax rate  | 
| which may be extended. | 
|     Such tax shall be levied and collected in like manner as  | 
| all other
taxes of school districts, subject to the provisions  | 
| contained in this Section. | 
|     (i) The tax rate limit specified in this Section may be  | 
| increased to .10%
upon the approval of a proposition to effect  | 
| such increase by a majority
of the electors voting on that  | 
| proposition at a regular scheduled election.
Such proposition  | 
| may be initiated by resolution of the school board and
shall be  | 
| certified by the secretary to the proper election authorities  | 
|  | 
| for
submission in accordance with the general election law. | 
|     (j) When taxes are levied by any school district for fire  | 
| prevention,
safety, energy conservation, and school security  | 
| purposes as specified in this
Section, and the purposes for  | 
| which the taxes have been
levied are accomplished and paid in  | 
| full, and there remain funds on hand in
the Fire Prevention and  | 
| Safety Fund from the proceeds of the taxes levied,
including  | 
| interest earnings thereon, the school board by resolution shall  | 
| use
such excess and other board restricted funds, excluding  | 
| bond proceeds and
earnings from such proceeds, as follows: | 
|         (1) for other authorized fire prevention,
safety,  | 
| energy conservation, required safety inspections, school  | 
| security purposes, sampling for lead in drinking water in  | 
| schools, and for repair and mitigation due to lead levels  | 
| in the drinking water supply;
or | 
|         (2) for transfer to the Operations and Maintenance Fund
 | 
| for the purpose of abating an equal amount of operations  | 
| and maintenance
purposes taxes. | 
| Notwithstanding subdivision (2) of this subsection (j) and  | 
| subsection (k) of this Section, through June 30, 2020 2019, the  | 
| school board
may, by proper resolution following a public  | 
| hearing set by the
school board or the president of the school  | 
| board (that is
preceded (i) by at least one published notice  | 
| over the name of
the clerk or secretary of the board, occurring  | 
| at least 7 days
and not more than 30 days prior to the hearing,  | 
| in a newspaper
of general circulation within the school  | 
|  | 
| district and (ii) by
posted notice over the name of the clerk  | 
| or secretary of the
board, at least 48 hours before the  | 
| hearing, at the principal
office of the school board or at the  | 
| building where the hearing
is to be held if a principal office  | 
| does not exist, with both
notices setting forth the time, date,  | 
| place, and subject matter
of the hearing), transfer surplus  | 
| life safety taxes and interest earnings thereon to the  | 
| Operations and Maintenance Fund for building repair work.  | 
|     (k)  If any transfer is made to the Operation and  | 
| Maintenance
Fund, the secretary of the school board shall  | 
| within 30 days notify
the county clerk of the amount of that  | 
| transfer and direct the clerk to
abate the taxes to be extended  | 
| for the purposes of operations and
maintenance authorized under  | 
| Section 17-2 of this Act by an amount equal
to such transfer. | 
|     (l) If the proceeds from the tax levy authorized by this
 | 
| Section are insufficient to complete the work approved under  | 
| this
Section, the school board is authorized to sell bonds  | 
| without referendum
under the provisions of this Section in an  | 
| amount that, when added to the
proceeds of the tax levy  | 
| authorized by this Section, will allow completion
of the  | 
| approved work. | 
|     (m) Any bonds issued pursuant to this Section shall bear  | 
| interest at a rate not to exceed the maximum rate
authorized by  | 
| law at the time of the making of the contract, shall mature
 | 
| within 20 years from date, and shall be signed by the president  | 
| of the school
board and the treasurer of the school district. | 
|  | 
|     (n) In order to authorize and issue such bonds, the school  | 
| board shall adopt
a resolution fixing the amount of bonds, the  | 
| date thereof, the maturities
thereof, rates of interest  | 
| thereof, place of payment and denomination,
which shall be in  | 
| denominations of not less than $100 and not more than
$5,000,  | 
| and provide for the levy and collection of a direct annual tax  | 
| upon
all the taxable property in the school district sufficient  | 
| to pay the
principal and interest on such bonds to maturity.   | 
| Upon the filing in the
office of the county clerk of the county  | 
| in which the school district is
located of a certified copy of  | 
| the resolution, it is the duty of the
county clerk to extend  | 
| the tax therefor in addition to and in excess of all
other  | 
| taxes heretofore or hereafter authorized to be
levied by such  | 
| school district. | 
|     (o) After the time such bonds are issued as provided for by  | 
| this Section, if
additional alterations or reconstructions are  | 
| required to be made because
of surveys conducted by an  | 
| architect or engineer licensed in the State of
Illinois, the  | 
| district may levy a tax at a rate not to exceed .05% per year
 | 
| upon all the taxable property of the district or issue  | 
| additional bonds,
whichever action shall be the most feasible. | 
|     (p) This Section is cumulative and constitutes complete  | 
| authority for the
issuance of bonds as provided in this Section  | 
| notwithstanding any other
statute or law to the contrary. | 
|     (q) With respect to instruments for the payment of money  | 
| issued under this
Section either before, on, or after the  | 
|  | 
| effective date of Public Act 86-004
(June 6, 1989), it is, and  | 
| always has been, the intention of the General
Assembly (i) that  | 
| the Omnibus Bond Acts are, and always have been,
supplementary  | 
| grants of power to issue instruments in accordance with the
 | 
| Omnibus Bond Acts, regardless of any provision of this Act that  | 
| may appear
to be or to have been more restrictive than those  | 
| Acts, (ii) that the
provisions of this Section are not a  | 
| limitation on the supplementary
authority granted by the  | 
| Omnibus Bond Acts, and (iii) that instruments
issued under this  | 
| Section within the supplementary authority granted by the
 | 
| Omnibus Bond Acts are not invalid because of any provision of  | 
| this Act that
may appear to be or to have been more restrictive  | 
| than those Acts. | 
|     (r) When the purposes for which the bonds are issued have  | 
| been accomplished
and paid for in full and there remain funds  | 
| on hand from the proceeds of
the bond sale and interest  | 
| earnings therefrom, the board shall, by
resolution, use such  | 
| excess funds in accordance with the provisions of
Section  | 
| 10-22.14 of this Act. | 
|     (s) Whenever any tax is levied or bonds issued for fire  | 
| prevention, safety,
energy conservation, and school security  | 
| purposes, such proceeds shall be
deposited and accounted for  | 
| separately within the Fire Prevention and Safety
Fund. | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-26, eff. 6-21-13; 98-1066, eff. 8-26-14;  | 
| 99-143, eff. 7-27-15; 99-713, eff. 8-5-16; 99-922, eff.  | 
| 1-17-17.)
 
 | 
|  | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/17-2A)  (from Ch. 122, par. 17-2A)
 | 
|     Sec. 17-2A. Interfund transfers.  | 
|     (a) The school board of any district having a population of  | 
| less than
500,000 inhabitants may, by proper resolution  | 
| following a public hearing
set by the school board or the  | 
| president of the school board
(that is preceded (i) by at least  | 
| one published notice over the name of
the clerk
or secretary of  | 
| the board, occurring at least 7 days and not more than 30
days
 | 
| prior to the hearing, in a newspaper of general circulation  | 
| within the
school
district and (ii) by posted notice over the  | 
| name of the clerk or secretary of
the board, at least 48 hours  | 
| before the hearing, at the principal office of the
school board  | 
| or at the building where the hearing is to be held if a  | 
| principal
office does not exist, with both notices setting  | 
| forth the time, date, place,
and subject matter of the
 | 
| hearing), transfer money from (1) the Educational Fund to the  | 
| Operations
and
Maintenance Fund or the Transportation Fund, (2)  | 
| the Operations and
Maintenance Fund to the Educational Fund or  | 
| the Transportation Fund, (3) the
Transportation Fund to the  | 
| Educational Fund or the Operations and Maintenance
Fund, or (4)  | 
| the Tort Immunity Fund to the Operations and Maintenance Fund  | 
| of said
district,
provided that, except during the period from  | 
| July 1, 2003 through June 30, 2020 2019, such transfer is made  | 
| solely for the purpose of meeting one-time,
non-recurring  | 
| expenses.  Except during the period from July 1, 2003 through
 | 
|  | 
| June 30, 2020 2019 and except as otherwise provided in  | 
| subsection (b) of this Section, any other permanent interfund  | 
| transfers authorized
by any provision or judicial  | 
| interpretation of this Code for which the
transferee fund is  | 
| not precisely and specifically set forth in the provision of
 | 
| this Code authorizing such transfer shall be made to the fund  | 
| of the school
district most in need of the funds being  | 
| transferred, as determined by
resolution of the school board. | 
|     (b) (Blank).
 | 
|     (c) Notwithstanding subsection (a) of this Section or any  | 
| other provision of this Code to the contrary, the school board  | 
| of any school district (i) that is subject to the Property Tax  | 
| Extension Limitation Law, (ii) that is an elementary district  | 
| servicing students in grades K through 8, (iii) whose territory  | 
| is in one county, (iv) that is eligible for Section 7002  | 
| Federal Impact Aid, and (v) that has no more than $81,000 in  | 
| funds remaining from refinancing bonds that were refinanced a  | 
| minimum of 5 years prior to January 20, 2017 (the effective  | 
| date of Public Act 99-926) this amendatory Act of the 99th  | 
| General Assembly may make a one-time transfer of the funds  | 
| remaining from the refinancing bonds to the Operations and  | 
| Maintenance Fund of the district by proper resolution following  | 
| a public hearing set by the school board or the president of  | 
| the school board, with notice as provided in subsection (a) of  | 
| this Section, so long as the district meets the qualifications  | 
| set forth in this subsection (c) on January 20, 2017 (the  | 
|  | 
| effective date of Public Act 99-926) this amendatory Act of the  | 
| 99th General Assembly.  | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-26, eff. 6-21-13; 98-131, eff. 1-1-14; 99-713,  | 
| eff. 8-5-16; 99-922, eff. 1-17-17; 99-926, eff. 1-20-17;  | 
| revised 1-23-17.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/17-3.6 new) | 
|     Sec. 17-3.6. Educational purposes tax rate for school  | 
| districts subject to Property Tax Extension Limitation Law.   | 
| Notwithstanding the provisions, requirements, or limitations  | 
| of this Code or any other law, any tax levied for educational  | 
| purposes by a school district subject to the Property Tax  | 
| Extension Limitation Law for the 2016 levy year or any  | 
| subsequent levy year may be extended at a rate exceeding the  | 
| rate established for educational purposes by referendum or this  | 
| Code, provided that the rate does not cause the school district  | 
| to exceed the limiting rate applicable to the school district  | 
| under the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law for that levy  | 
| year.
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/18-4.3)  (from Ch. 122, par. 18-4.3)
 | 
|     Sec. 18-4.3. Summer school grants. Through fiscal year  | 
| 2017, grants Grants shall be determined for
pupil attendance in  | 
| summer schools conducted under Sections 10-22.33A
and 34-18 and  | 
| approved under Section 2-3.25 in the following manner.
 | 
|     The amount of grant for each accredited summer school  | 
|  | 
| attendance pupil shall
be obtained by dividing the total amount  | 
| of apportionments determined under Section 18-8.05 by the
 | 
| actual
number of pupils in average daily attendance used for  | 
| such
apportionments.  The number of credited summer school  | 
| attendance pupils
shall be determined (a) by counting clock  | 
| hours of class instruction by
pupils enrolled in grades 1  | 
| through 12 in approved courses conducted at
least 60 clock  | 
| hours in summer sessions; (b) by dividing such total of
clock  | 
| hours of class instruction by 4 to produce days of credited  | 
| pupil
attendance; (c) by dividing such days of credited pupil  | 
| attendance by
the actual number of days in the regular term as  | 
| used in computation in
the general apportionment in Section  | 
| 18-8.05; and (d) by
multiplying by
1.25.
 | 
|     The amount of the grant for a summer school program  | 
| approved by the
State Superintendent of Education for children  | 
| with
disabilities, as defined
in Sections 14-1.02 through  | 
| 14-1.07, shall be determined in the manner
contained above  | 
| except that average daily membership shall be utilized
in lieu  | 
| of average daily attendance.
 | 
|     In the case of an apportionment based on summer school  | 
| attendance or
membership pupils, the claim therefor shall be  | 
| presented as a separate
claim for the particular school year in   | 
| which such summer school
session ends.  On or before November 1  | 
| of each year the
superintendent of each eligible school  | 
| district shall certify to
the State Superintendent of Education  | 
| the claim
of the district for the summer
session just ended.   | 
|  | 
| Failure on the part of the school board to so
certify shall  | 
| constitute a forfeiture of its right to such payment.   The State  | 
| Superintendent of Education shall transmit to the
Comptroller  | 
| no later than December 15th of each year
vouchers for payment  | 
| of amounts due school districts for
summer school.  The State  | 
| Superintendent of Education shall direct the
Comptroller to  | 
| draw his warrants for payments thereof by the 30th
day of  | 
| December.   If the money appropriated by the
General Assembly for  | 
| such purpose for any year is insufficient, it shall
be  | 
| apportioned on the basis of claims approved.
 | 
|     However, notwithstanding the foregoing provisions, for  | 
| each fiscal year the
money appropriated by the General
Assembly  | 
| for the purposes of this Section shall only be used for grants
 | 
| for approved summer school programs for those children with
 | 
| disabilities served pursuant to Section 14-7.02 or 14-7.02b of  | 
| this
Code.  | 
|     No funding shall be provided to school districts under this  | 
| Section after fiscal year 2017. In fiscal year 2018 and each  | 
| fiscal year thereafter, all funding received by a school  | 
| district from the State pursuant to Section 18–8.15 of this  | 
| Code that is attributable to summer school for special  | 
| education pupils must be used for special education services  | 
| authorized under this Code. 
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 93-1022, eff. 8-24-04.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/18-8.05)
 | 
|  | 
|     Sec. 18-8.05. Basis for apportionment of general State  | 
| financial aid and
supplemental general State aid to the common  | 
| schools for the 1998-1999 through the 2016-2017 and
subsequent  | 
| school years.
 
 | 
| (A) General Provisions. | 
|     (1) The provisions of this Section relating to the  | 
| calculation and apportionment of general State financial aid  | 
| and supplemental general State aid apply to the 1998-1999  | 
| through the 2016-2017 and subsequent
school years.  The system  | 
| of general State financial aid provided for in this
Section
is  | 
| designed to assure that, through a combination of State  | 
| financial aid and
required local resources, the financial  | 
| support provided each pupil in Average
Daily Attendance equals  | 
| or exceeds a
prescribed per pupil Foundation Level.  This  | 
| formula approach imputes a level
of per pupil Available Local  | 
| Resources and provides for the basis to calculate
a per pupil  | 
| level of general State financial aid that, when added to  | 
| Available
Local Resources, equals or exceeds the Foundation  | 
| Level.  The
amount of per pupil general State financial aid for  | 
| school districts, in
general, varies in inverse
relation to  | 
| Available Local Resources.  Per pupil amounts are based upon
 | 
| each school district's Average Daily Attendance as that term is  | 
| defined in this
Section. | 
|     (2) In addition to general State financial aid, school  | 
| districts with
specified levels or concentrations of pupils  | 
|  | 
| from low income households are
eligible to receive supplemental  | 
| general State financial aid grants as provided
pursuant to  | 
| subsection (H).
The supplemental State aid grants provided for  | 
| school districts under
subsection (H) shall be appropriated for  | 
| distribution to school districts as
part of the same line item  | 
| in which the general State financial aid of school
districts is  | 
| appropriated under this Section. | 
|     (3) To receive financial assistance under this Section,  | 
| school districts
are required to file claims with the State  | 
| Board of Education, subject to the
following requirements: | 
|         (a) Any school district which fails for any given  | 
| school year to maintain
school as required by law, or to  | 
| maintain a recognized school is not
eligible to file for  | 
| such school year any claim upon the Common School
Fund.  In  | 
| case of nonrecognition of one or more attendance centers in  | 
| a
school district otherwise operating recognized schools,  | 
| the claim of the
district shall be reduced in the  | 
| proportion which the Average Daily
Attendance in the  | 
| attendance center or centers bear to the Average Daily
 | 
| Attendance in the school district.  A "recognized school"  | 
| means any
public school which meets the standards as  | 
| established for recognition
by the State Board of  | 
| Education.  A school district or attendance center
not  | 
| having recognition status at the end of a school term is  | 
| entitled to
receive State aid payments due upon a legal  | 
| claim which was filed while
it was recognized. | 
|  | 
|         (b) School district claims filed under this Section are  | 
| subject to
Sections 18-9 and 18-12, except as otherwise  | 
| provided in this
Section. | 
|         (c) If a school district operates a full year school  | 
| under Section
10-19.1, the general State aid to the school  | 
| district shall be determined
by the State Board of  | 
| Education in accordance with this Section as near as
may be  | 
| applicable. | 
|         (d) (Blank). | 
|     (4) Except as provided in subsections (H) and (L), the  | 
| board of any district
receiving any of the grants provided for  | 
| in this Section may apply those funds
to any fund so received  | 
| for which that board is authorized to make expenditures
by law. | 
|     School districts are not required to exert a minimum  | 
| Operating Tax Rate in
order to qualify for assistance under  | 
| this Section. | 
|     (5) As used in this Section the following terms, when  | 
| capitalized, shall
have the meaning ascribed herein: | 
|         (a) "Average Daily Attendance":  A count of pupil  | 
| attendance in school,
averaged as provided for in  | 
| subsection (C) and utilized in deriving per pupil
financial  | 
| support levels. | 
|         (b) "Available Local Resources":  A computation of  | 
| local financial
support, calculated on the basis of Average  | 
| Daily Attendance and derived as
provided pursuant to  | 
| subsection (D). | 
|  | 
|         (c) "Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes":   | 
| Funds paid to local
school districts pursuant to "An Act in  | 
| relation to the abolition of ad valorem
personal property  | 
| tax and the replacement of revenues lost thereby, and
 | 
| amending and repealing certain Acts and parts of Acts in  | 
| connection therewith",
certified August 14, 1979, as  | 
| amended (Public Act 81-1st S.S.-1). | 
|         (d) "Foundation Level":  A prescribed level of per pupil  | 
| financial support
as provided for in subsection (B). | 
|         (e) "Operating Tax Rate":  All school district property  | 
| taxes extended for
all purposes, except Bond and
Interest,  | 
| Summer School, Rent, Capital Improvement, and Vocational  | 
| Education
Building purposes.
 
 | 
| (B) Foundation Level. | 
|     (1) The Foundation Level is a figure established by the  | 
| State representing
the minimum level of per pupil financial  | 
| support that should be available to
provide for the basic  | 
| education of each pupil in
Average Daily Attendance.  As set  | 
| forth in this Section, each school district
is assumed to exert
 | 
| a sufficient local taxing effort such that, in combination with  | 
| the aggregate
of general State
financial aid provided the  | 
| district, an aggregate of State and local resources
are  | 
| available to meet
the basic education needs of pupils in the  | 
| district. | 
|     (2) For the 1998-1999 school year, the Foundation Level of  | 
|  | 
| support is
$4,225.  For the 1999-2000 school year, the  | 
| Foundation Level of support is
$4,325.  For the 2000-2001 school  | 
| year, the Foundation Level of support is
$4,425. For the  | 
| 2001-2002 school year and 2002-2003 school year, the
Foundation  | 
| Level of support is $4,560. For the 2003-2004 school year, the  | 
| Foundation Level of support is $4,810. For the 2004-2005 school  | 
| year, the Foundation Level of support is $4,964.
For the  | 
| 2005-2006 school year,
the Foundation Level of support is  | 
| $5,164. For the 2006-2007 school year,  the Foundation Level of  | 
| support is $5,334. For the 2007-2008 school year, the  | 
| Foundation Level of support is $5,734. For the 2008-2009 school  | 
| year, the Foundation Level of support is $5,959. | 
|     (3) For the 2009-2010 school year and each school year  | 
| thereafter,
the Foundation Level of support is $6,119 or such  | 
| greater amount as
may be established by law by the General  | 
| Assembly.
 
 | 
| (C) Average Daily Attendance. | 
|     (1) For purposes of calculating general State aid pursuant  | 
| to subsection
(E), an Average Daily Attendance figure shall be  | 
| utilized.  The Average Daily
Attendance figure for formula
 | 
| calculation purposes shall be the monthly average of the actual  | 
| number of
pupils in attendance of
each school district, as  | 
| further averaged for the best 3 months of pupil
attendance for  | 
| each
school district.  In compiling the figures for the number  | 
| of pupils in
attendance, school districts
and the State Board  | 
|  | 
| of Education shall, for purposes of general State aid
funding,  | 
| conform
attendance figures to the requirements of subsection  | 
| (F). | 
|     (2) The Average Daily Attendance figures utilized in  | 
| subsection (E) shall be
the requisite attendance data for the  | 
| school year immediately preceding
the
school year for which  | 
| general State aid is being calculated
or the average of the  | 
| attendance data for the 3 preceding school
years, whichever is  | 
| greater.  The Average Daily Attendance figures
utilized in  | 
| subsection (H) shall be the requisite attendance data for the
 | 
| school year immediately preceding the school year for which  | 
| general
State aid is being calculated.
 
 | 
| (D) Available Local Resources. | 
|     (1) For purposes of calculating general State aid pursuant  | 
| to subsection
(E), a representation of Available Local  | 
| Resources per pupil, as that term is
defined and determined in  | 
| this subsection, shall be utilized.  Available Local
Resources  | 
| per pupil shall include a calculated
dollar amount representing  | 
| local school district revenues from local property
taxes and  | 
| from
Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes, expressed  | 
| on the basis of pupils
in Average
Daily Attendance. Calculation  | 
| of Available Local Resources shall exclude any tax amnesty  | 
| funds received as a result of Public Act 93-26. | 
|     (2) In determining a school district's revenue from local  | 
| property taxes,
the State Board of Education shall utilize the  | 
|  | 
| equalized assessed valuation of
all taxable property of each  | 
| school
district as of September 30 of the previous year.  The  | 
| equalized assessed
valuation utilized shall
be obtained and  | 
| determined as provided in subsection (G). | 
|     (3) For school districts maintaining grades kindergarten  | 
| through 12, local
property tax
revenues per pupil shall be  | 
| calculated as the product of the applicable
equalized assessed
 | 
| valuation for the district multiplied by 3.00%, and divided by  | 
| the district's
Average Daily
Attendance figure.  For school  | 
| districts maintaining grades kindergarten
through 8, local
 | 
| property tax revenues per pupil shall be calculated as the  | 
| product of the
applicable equalized
assessed valuation for the  | 
| district multiplied by 2.30%, and divided by the
district's  | 
| Average
Daily Attendance figure.  For school districts  | 
| maintaining grades 9 through 12,
local property
tax revenues  | 
| per pupil shall be the applicable equalized assessed valuation  | 
| of
the district
multiplied by 1.05%, and divided by the  | 
| district's Average Daily
Attendance
figure. | 
|     For partial elementary unit districts created pursuant to  | 
| Article 11E of this Code, local property tax revenues per pupil  | 
| shall be calculated as the product of the equalized assessed  | 
| valuation for property within the partial elementary unit  | 
| district for elementary purposes, as defined in Article 11E of  | 
| this Code, multiplied by 2.06% and divided by the district's  | 
| Average Daily Attendance figure, plus the product of the  | 
| equalized assessed valuation for property within the partial  | 
|  | 
| elementary unit district for high school purposes, as defined  | 
| in Article 11E of this Code, multiplied by 0.94% and divided by  | 
| the district's Average Daily Attendance figure.
 | 
|     (4) The Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes paid  | 
| to each school
district during the calendar year one year  | 
| before the calendar year in which a
school year begins, divided  | 
| by the Average Daily Attendance figure for that
district, shall  | 
| be added to the local property tax revenues per pupil as
 | 
| derived by the application of the immediately preceding  | 
| paragraph (3).  The sum
of these per pupil figures for each  | 
| school district shall constitute Available
Local Resources as  | 
| that term is utilized in subsection (E) in the calculation
of  | 
| general State aid.
 
 | 
| (E) Computation of General State Aid. | 
|     (1) For each school year, the amount of general State aid  | 
| allotted to a
school district shall be computed by the State  | 
| Board of Education as provided
in this subsection. | 
|     (2) For any school district for which Available Local  | 
| Resources per pupil
is less than the product of 0.93 times the  | 
| Foundation Level, general State aid
for that district shall be  | 
| calculated as an amount equal to the Foundation
Level minus  | 
| Available Local Resources, multiplied by the Average Daily
 | 
| Attendance of the school district. | 
|     (3) For any school district for which Available Local  | 
| Resources per pupil
is equal to or greater than the product of  | 
|  | 
| 0.93 times the Foundation Level and
less than the product of  | 
| 1.75 times the Foundation Level, the general State aid
per  | 
| pupil shall be a decimal proportion of the Foundation Level  | 
| derived using a
linear algorithm.  Under this linear algorithm,  | 
| the calculated general State
aid per pupil shall decline in  | 
| direct linear fashion from 0.07 times the
Foundation Level for  | 
| a school district with Available Local Resources equal to
the  | 
| product of 0.93 times the Foundation Level, to 0.05 times the  | 
| Foundation
Level for a school district with Available Local  | 
| Resources equal to the product
of 1.75 times the Foundation  | 
| Level.  The allocation of general
State aid for school districts  | 
| subject to this paragraph 3 shall be the
calculated general  | 
| State aid
per pupil figure multiplied by the Average Daily  | 
| Attendance of the school
district. | 
|     (4) For any school district for which Available Local  | 
| Resources per pupil
equals or exceeds the product of 1.75 times  | 
| the Foundation Level, the general
State aid for the school  | 
| district shall be calculated as the product of $218
multiplied  | 
| by the Average Daily Attendance of the school
district. | 
|     (5) The amount of general State aid allocated to a school  | 
| district for
the 1999-2000 school year meeting the requirements  | 
| set forth in paragraph (4)
of subsection
(G) shall be increased  | 
| by an amount equal to the general State aid that
would have  | 
| been received by the district for the 1998-1999 school year by
 | 
| utilizing the Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed  | 
| Valuation as calculated
in paragraph (4) of subsection (G) less  | 
|  | 
| the general State aid allotted for the
1998-1999
school year.   | 
| This amount shall be deemed a one time increase, and shall not
 | 
| affect any future general State aid allocations.
 
 | 
| (F) Compilation of Average Daily Attendance. | 
|     (1) Each school district shall, by July 1 of each year,  | 
| submit to the State
Board of Education, on forms prescribed by  | 
| the State Board of Education,
attendance figures for the school  | 
| year that began in the preceding calendar
year.  The attendance  | 
| information so transmitted shall identify the average
daily  | 
| attendance figures for each month of the school year.  Beginning  | 
| with
the general State aid claim form for the 2002-2003 school
 | 
| year, districts shall calculate Average Daily Attendance as  | 
| provided in
subdivisions (a), (b), and (c) of this paragraph  | 
| (1). | 
|         (a) In districts that do not hold year-round classes,
 | 
| days of attendance in August shall be added to the month of  | 
| September and any
days of attendance in June shall be added  | 
| to the month of May. | 
|         (b) In districts in which all buildings hold year-round  | 
| classes,
days of attendance in July and August shall be  | 
| added to the month
of September and any days of attendance  | 
| in June shall be added to
the month of May. | 
|         (c) In districts in which some buildings, but not all,  | 
| hold
year-round classes, for the non-year-round buildings,  | 
| days of
attendance in August shall be added to the month of  | 
|  | 
| September
and any days of attendance in June shall be added  | 
| to the month of
May. The average daily attendance for the  | 
| year-round buildings
shall be computed as provided in  | 
| subdivision (b) of this paragraph
(1). To calculate the  | 
| Average Daily Attendance for the district, the
average  | 
| daily attendance for the year-round buildings shall be
 | 
| multiplied by the days in session for the non-year-round  | 
| buildings
for each month and added to the monthly  | 
| attendance of the
non-year-round buildings. | 
|     Except as otherwise provided in this Section, days of
 | 
| attendance by pupils shall be counted only for sessions of not  | 
| less than
5 clock hours of school work per day under direct  | 
| supervision of: (i)
teachers, or (ii) non-teaching personnel or  | 
| volunteer personnel when engaging
in non-teaching duties and  | 
| supervising in those instances specified in
subsection (a) of  | 
| Section 10-22.34 and paragraph 10 of Section 34-18, with
pupils  | 
| of legal school age and in kindergarten and grades 1 through  | 
| 12. Days of attendance by pupils through verified participation  | 
| in an e-learning program approved by the State Board of  | 
| Education under Section 10-20.56 of the Code shall be  | 
| considered as full days of attendance for purposes of this  | 
| Section. | 
|     Days of attendance by tuition pupils shall be accredited  | 
| only to the
districts that pay the tuition to a recognized  | 
| school. | 
|     (2) Days of attendance by pupils of less than 5 clock hours  | 
|  | 
| of school
shall be subject to the following provisions in the  | 
| compilation of Average
Daily Attendance. | 
|         (a) Pupils regularly enrolled in a public school for  | 
| only a part of
the school day may be counted on the basis  | 
| of 1/6 day for every class hour
of instruction of 40  | 
| minutes or more attended pursuant to such enrollment,
 | 
| unless a pupil is
enrolled in a block-schedule format of 80  | 
| minutes or more of instruction,
in which case the pupil may  | 
| be counted on the basis of the proportion of
minutes of  | 
| school work completed each day to the minimum number of
 | 
| minutes that school work is required to be held that day. | 
|         (b) (Blank). | 
|         (c) A session of 4 or more clock hours may be counted  | 
| as a day of
attendance upon certification by the regional  | 
| superintendent, and
approved by the State Superintendent  | 
| of Education to the extent that the
district has been  | 
| forced to use daily multiple sessions. | 
|         (d) A session of 3 or more clock hours may be counted  | 
| as a day of
attendance (1) when the remainder of the school  | 
| day or at least
2 hours in the evening of that day is  | 
| utilized for an
in-service training program for teachers,  | 
| up to a maximum of 5 days per
school year, provided a  | 
| district conducts an in-service
training program for  | 
| teachers in accordance with Section 10-22.39 of this Code;  | 
| or, in lieu of 4 such days, 2 full days may
be used, in  | 
| which event each such day
may be counted as a day required  | 
|  | 
| for a legal school calendar pursuant to Section 10-19 of  | 
| this Code; (1.5) when, of the 5 days allowed under item  | 
| (1), a maximum of 4 days are used for parent-teacher  | 
| conferences, or, in lieu of 4 such days, 2 full days are  | 
| used, in which case each such day may be counted as a  | 
| calendar day required under Section 10-19 of this Code,  | 
| provided that the full-day, parent-teacher conference  | 
| consists of (i) a minimum of 5 clock hours of  | 
| parent-teacher conferences, (ii) both a minimum of 2 clock  | 
| hours of parent-teacher conferences held in the evening  | 
| following a full day of student attendance, as specified in  | 
| subsection (F)(1)(c), and a minimum of 3 clock hours of  | 
| parent-teacher conferences held on the day immediately  | 
| following evening parent-teacher conferences, or (iii)  | 
| multiple parent-teacher conferences held in the evenings  | 
| following full days of student attendance, as specified in  | 
| subsection (F)(1)(c), in which the time used for the  | 
| parent-teacher conferences is equivalent to a minimum of 5  | 
| clock hours; and (2) when days in
addition to
those  | 
| provided in items (1) and (1.5) are scheduled by a school  | 
| pursuant to its school
improvement plan adopted under  | 
| Article 34 or its revised or amended school
improvement  | 
| plan adopted under Article 2, provided that (i) such  | 
| sessions of
3 or more clock hours are scheduled to occur at  | 
| regular intervals, (ii) the
remainder of the school days in  | 
| which such sessions occur are utilized
for in-service  | 
|  | 
| training programs or other staff development activities  | 
| for
teachers, and (iii) a sufficient number of minutes of  | 
| school work under the
direct supervision of teachers are  | 
| added to the school days between such
regularly scheduled  | 
| sessions to accumulate not less than the number of minutes
 | 
| by which such sessions of 3 or more clock hours fall short  | 
| of 5 clock hours.
Any full days used for the purposes of  | 
| this paragraph shall not be considered
for
computing  | 
| average daily attendance.  Days scheduled for in-service  | 
| training
programs, staff development activities, or  | 
| parent-teacher conferences may be
scheduled separately for  | 
| different
grade levels and different attendance centers of  | 
| the district. | 
|         (e) A session of not less than one clock hour of  | 
| teaching
hospitalized or homebound pupils on-site or by  | 
| telephone to the classroom may
be counted as 1/2 day of  | 
| attendance, however these pupils must receive 4 or
more  | 
| clock hours of instruction to be counted for a full day of  | 
| attendance. | 
|         (f) A session of at least 4 clock hours may be counted  | 
| as a day of
attendance for first grade pupils, and pupils  | 
| in full day kindergartens,
and a session of 2 or more hours  | 
| may be counted as 1/2 day of attendance by
pupils in  | 
| kindergartens which provide only 1/2 day of attendance. | 
|         (g) For children with disabilities who are below the  | 
| age of 6 years and
who
cannot attend 2 or more clock hours  | 
|  | 
| because of their disability or
immaturity, a session of not  | 
| less than one clock hour may be counted as 1/2 day
of  | 
| attendance; however for such children whose educational  | 
| needs so require
a session of 4 or more clock hours may be  | 
| counted as a full day of attendance. | 
|         (h) A recognized kindergarten which provides for only  | 
| 1/2 day of
attendance by each pupil shall not have more  | 
| than 1/2 day of attendance
counted in any one day.  However,  | 
| kindergartens may count 2 1/2 days
of
attendance in any 5  | 
| consecutive school days.  When a pupil attends such a
 | 
| kindergarten for 2 half days on any one school day, the  | 
| pupil shall have
the following day as a day absent from  | 
| school, unless the school district
obtains permission in  | 
| writing from the State Superintendent of Education.
 | 
| Attendance at kindergartens which provide for a full day of  | 
| attendance by
each pupil shall be counted the same as  | 
| attendance by first grade pupils.
Only the first year of  | 
| attendance in one kindergarten shall be counted,
except in  | 
| case of children who entered the kindergarten in their  | 
| fifth year
whose educational development requires a second  | 
| year of kindergarten as
determined under the rules and  | 
| regulations of the State Board of Education. | 
|         (i) On the days when the assessment that includes a  | 
| college and career ready determination is
administered  | 
| under subsection (c) of Section 2-3.64a-5 of this Code, the  | 
| day
of attendance for a pupil whose school
day must be  | 
|  | 
| shortened to accommodate required testing procedures may
 | 
| be less than 5 clock hours and shall be counted towards the  | 
| 176 days of actual pupil attendance required under Section  | 
| 10-19 of this Code, provided that a sufficient number of  | 
| minutes
of school work in excess of 5 clock hours are first  | 
| completed on other school
days to compensate for the loss  | 
| of school work on the examination days. | 
|         (j)  Pupils enrolled in a remote educational program  | 
| established under Section 10-29 of this Code may be counted  | 
| on the basis of one-fifth day of attendance for every clock  | 
| hour of instruction attended in the remote educational  | 
| program, provided that, in any month, the school district  | 
| may not claim for a student enrolled in a remote  | 
| educational program more days of attendance than the  | 
| maximum number of days of attendance the district can claim  | 
| (i) for students enrolled in a building holding year-round  | 
| classes if the student is classified as participating in  | 
| the remote educational program on a year-round schedule or  | 
| (ii) for students enrolled in a building not holding  | 
| year-round classes if the student is not classified as  | 
| participating in the remote educational program on a  | 
| year-round schedule. 
 
 | 
| (G) Equalized Assessed Valuation Data. | 
|     (1) For purposes of the calculation of Available Local  | 
| Resources required
pursuant to subsection (D), the
State Board  | 
|  | 
| of Education shall secure from the Department of
Revenue the  | 
| value as equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue of
 | 
| all taxable property of every school district, together with  | 
| (i) the applicable
tax rate used in extending taxes for the  | 
| funds of the district as of
September 30 of the previous year
 | 
| and (ii) the limiting rate for all school
districts subject to  | 
| property tax extension limitations as imposed under the
 | 
| Property Tax Extension Limitation Law.
 | 
|     The Department of Revenue shall add to the equalized  | 
| assessed value of all
taxable
property of each school district  | 
| situated entirely or partially within a county
that is or was  | 
| subject to the
provisions of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the  | 
| Property Tax Code (a)
an amount equal to the total amount by  | 
| which the
homestead exemption allowed under Section 15-176 or  | 
| 15-177 of the Property Tax Code for
real
property situated in  | 
| that school district exceeds the total amount that would
have  | 
| been
allowed in that school district if the maximum reduction  | 
| under Section 15-176
was
(i) $4,500 in Cook County or $3,500 in  | 
| all other counties in tax year 2003 or (ii) $5,000 in all  | 
| counties in tax year 2004 and thereafter and (b) an amount  | 
| equal to the aggregate amount for the taxable year of all  | 
| additional exemptions under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax  | 
| Code for owners with a household income of $30,000 or less. The  | 
| county clerk of any county that is or was subject to the  | 
| provisions of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code  | 
| shall
annually calculate and certify to the Department of  | 
|  | 
| Revenue for each school
district all
homestead exemption  | 
| amounts under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code  | 
| and all amounts of additional exemptions under Section 15-175  | 
| of the Property Tax Code for owners with a household income of  | 
| $30,000 or less. It is the intent of this paragraph that if the  | 
| general homestead exemption for a parcel of property is  | 
| determined under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax  | 
| Code rather than Section 15-175, then the calculation of  | 
| Available Local Resources shall not be affected by the  | 
| difference, if any, between the amount of the general homestead  | 
| exemption allowed for that parcel of property under Section  | 
| 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code and the amount that  | 
| would have been allowed had the general homestead exemption for  | 
| that parcel of property been determined under Section 15-175 of  | 
| the Property Tax Code. It is further the intent of this  | 
| paragraph that if additional exemptions are allowed under  | 
| Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with a  | 
| household income of less than $30,000, then the calculation of  | 
| Available Local Resources shall not be affected by the  | 
| difference, if any, because of those additional exemptions. | 
|     This equalized assessed valuation, as adjusted further by  | 
| the requirements of
this subsection, shall be utilized in the  | 
| calculation of Available Local
Resources. | 
|     (2) The equalized assessed valuation in paragraph (1) shall  | 
| be adjusted, as
applicable, in the following manner: | 
|         (a) For the purposes of calculating State aid under  | 
|  | 
| this Section,
with respect to any part of a school district  | 
| within a redevelopment
project area in respect to which a  | 
| municipality has adopted tax
increment allocation  | 
| financing pursuant to the Tax Increment Allocation
 | 
| Redevelopment Act, Sections 11-74.4-1 through 11-74.4-11  | 
| of the Illinois
Municipal Code or the Industrial Jobs  | 
| Recovery Law, Sections 11-74.6-1 through
11-74.6-50 of the  | 
| Illinois Municipal Code, no part of the current equalized
 | 
| assessed valuation of real property located in any such  | 
| project area which is
attributable to an increase above the  | 
| total initial equalized assessed
valuation of such  | 
| property shall be used as part of the equalized assessed
 | 
| valuation of the district, until such time as all
 | 
| redevelopment project costs have been paid, as provided in  | 
| Section 11-74.4-8
of the Tax Increment Allocation  | 
| Redevelopment Act or in Section 11-74.6-35 of
the  | 
| Industrial Jobs Recovery Law.  For the purpose of
the  | 
| equalized assessed valuation of the
district, the total  | 
| initial equalized assessed valuation or the current
 | 
| equalized assessed valuation, whichever is lower, shall be  | 
| used until
such time as all redevelopment project costs  | 
| have been paid. | 
|         (b) The real property equalized assessed valuation for  | 
| a school district
shall be adjusted by subtracting from the  | 
| real property
value as equalized or assessed by the  | 
| Department of Revenue for the
district an amount computed  | 
|  | 
| by dividing the amount of any abatement of
taxes under  | 
| Section 18-170 of the Property Tax Code by 3.00% for a  | 
| district
maintaining grades kindergarten through 12, by  | 
| 2.30% for a district
maintaining grades kindergarten  | 
| through 8, or by 1.05% for a
district
maintaining grades 9  | 
| through 12 and adjusted by an amount computed by dividing
 | 
| the amount of any abatement of taxes under subsection (a)  | 
| of Section 18-165 of
the Property Tax Code by the same  | 
| percentage rates for district type as
specified in this  | 
| subparagraph (b). | 
|     (3) For the 1999-2000 school year and each school year  | 
| thereafter, if a
school district meets all of the criteria of  | 
| this subsection (G)(3), the school
district's Available Local  | 
| Resources shall be calculated under subsection (D)
using the  | 
| district's Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation  | 
| as
calculated under this
subsection (G)(3). | 
|     For purposes of this subsection (G)(3) the following terms  | 
| shall have
the following meanings: | 
|         "Budget Year":  The school year for which general State  | 
| aid is calculated
and
awarded under subsection (E). | 
|         "Base Tax Year": The property tax levy year used to  | 
| calculate the Budget
Year
allocation of general State aid. | 
|         "Preceding Tax Year": The property tax levy year  | 
| immediately preceding the
Base Tax Year. | 
|         "Base Tax Year's Tax Extension": The product of the  | 
| equalized assessed
valuation utilized by the County Clerk  | 
|  | 
| in the Base Tax Year multiplied by the
limiting rate as  | 
| calculated by the County Clerk and defined in the Property  | 
| Tax
Extension Limitation Law. | 
|         "Preceding Tax Year's Tax Extension": The product of  | 
| the equalized assessed
valuation utilized by the County  | 
| Clerk in the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by
the Operating  | 
| Tax Rate as defined in subsection (A). | 
|         "Extension Limitation Ratio": A numerical ratio,  | 
| certified by the
County Clerk, in which the numerator is  | 
| the Base Tax Year's Tax
Extension and the denominator is  | 
| the Preceding Tax Year's Tax Extension. | 
|         "Operating Tax Rate": The operating tax rate as defined  | 
| in subsection (A). | 
|     If a school district is subject to property tax extension  | 
| limitations as
imposed under
the Property Tax Extension  | 
| Limitation Law, the State Board of Education shall
calculate  | 
| the Extension
Limitation
Equalized Assessed Valuation of that  | 
| district.  For the 1999-2000 school
year, the
Extension  | 
| Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation of a school district as
 | 
| calculated by the State Board of Education shall be equal to  | 
| the product of the
district's 1996 Equalized Assessed Valuation  | 
| and the district's Extension
Limitation Ratio. Except as  | 
| otherwise provided in this paragraph for a school district that  | 
| has approved or does approve an increase in its limiting rate,  | 
| for  the 2000-2001 school year and each school year
thereafter,
 | 
| the Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation of a  | 
|  | 
| school district as
calculated by the State Board of Education  | 
| shall be equal to the product of
the Equalized Assessed  | 
| Valuation last used in the calculation of general State
aid and  | 
| the
district's Extension Limitation Ratio. If the Extension  | 
| Limitation
Equalized
Assessed Valuation of a school district as  | 
| calculated under
this subsection (G)(3) is less than the  | 
| district's equalized assessed valuation
as calculated pursuant  | 
| to subsections (G)(1) and (G)(2), then for purposes of
 | 
| calculating the district's general State aid for the Budget  | 
| Year pursuant to
subsection (E), that Extension
Limitation  | 
| Equalized Assessed Valuation shall be utilized to calculate the
 | 
| district's Available Local Resources
under subsection (D). For  | 
| the 2009-2010 school year and each school year thereafter, if a  | 
| school district has approved or does approve an increase in its  | 
| limiting rate, pursuant to Section 18-190 of the Property Tax  | 
| Code, affecting the Base Tax Year, the Extension Limitation  | 
| Equalized Assessed Valuation of the school district, as  | 
| calculated by the State Board of Education, shall be equal to  | 
| the product of the Equalized Assessed Valuation last used in  | 
| the calculation of general State aid times  an amount equal to  | 
| one plus the percentage increase, if any, in the Consumer Price  | 
| Index for all Urban Consumers for all items published by the  | 
| United States Department of Labor for the 12-month calendar  | 
| year preceding the Base Tax Year, plus the Equalized Assessed  | 
| Valuation of new property, annexed property, and recovered tax  | 
| increment value and minus the Equalized Assessed Valuation of  | 
|  | 
| disconnected property. New property and recovered tax  | 
| increment value shall have the meanings set forth in the  | 
| Property Tax Extension Limitation Law. | 
|     Partial elementary unit districts created in accordance  | 
| with Article 11E of this Code shall not be eligible for the  | 
| adjustment in this subsection (G)(3) until the fifth year  | 
| following the effective date of the reorganization.
 | 
|     (3.5)  For the 2010-2011 school year and each school year  | 
| thereafter, if a school district's boundaries span multiple  | 
| counties, then the Department of Revenue shall send to the  | 
| State Board of Education, for the purpose of calculating  | 
| general State aid, the limiting rate and individual rates by  | 
| purpose for the county that contains the majority of the school  | 
| district's Equalized Assessed Valuation. | 
|     (4) For the purposes of calculating general State aid for  | 
| the 1999-2000
school year only, if a school district  | 
| experienced a triennial reassessment on
the equalized assessed  | 
| valuation used in calculating its general State
financial aid  | 
| apportionment for the 1998-1999 school year, the State Board of
 | 
| Education shall calculate the Extension Limitation Equalized  | 
| Assessed Valuation
that would have been used to calculate the  | 
| district's 1998-1999 general State
aid.  This amount shall equal  | 
| the product of the equalized assessed valuation
used to
 | 
| calculate general State aid for the 1997-1998 school year and  | 
| the district's
Extension Limitation Ratio.  If the Extension  | 
| Limitation Equalized Assessed
Valuation of the school district  | 
|  | 
| as calculated under this paragraph (4) is
less than the  | 
| district's equalized assessed valuation utilized in  | 
| calculating
the
district's 1998-1999 general State aid  | 
| allocation, then for purposes of
calculating the district's  | 
| general State aid pursuant to paragraph (5) of
subsection (E),
 | 
| that Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation shall  | 
| be utilized to
calculate the district's Available Local  | 
| Resources. | 
|     (5) For school districts having a majority of their  | 
| equalized assessed
valuation in any county except Cook, DuPage,  | 
| Kane, Lake, McHenry, or Will, if
the amount of general State  | 
| aid allocated to the school district for the
1999-2000 school  | 
| year under the provisions of subsection (E), (H), and (J) of
 | 
| this Section is less than the amount of general State aid  | 
| allocated to the
district for the 1998-1999 school year under  | 
| these subsections, then the
general
State aid of the district  | 
| for the 1999-2000 school year only shall be increased
by the  | 
| difference between these amounts.  The total payments made under  | 
| this
paragraph (5) shall not exceed $14,000,000.  Claims shall  | 
| be prorated if they
exceed $14,000,000.
 
 | 
| (H) Supplemental General State Aid. | 
|     (1) In addition to the general State aid a school district  | 
| is allotted
pursuant to subsection (E), qualifying school  | 
| districts shall receive a grant,
paid in conjunction with a  | 
| district's payments of general State aid, for
supplemental  | 
|  | 
| general State aid based upon the concentration level of  | 
| children
from low-income households within the school  | 
| district.
Supplemental State aid grants provided for school  | 
| districts under this
subsection shall be appropriated for  | 
| distribution to school districts as part
of the same line item  | 
| in which the general State financial aid of school
districts is  | 
| appropriated under this Section.
 | 
|     (1.5) This paragraph (1.5) applies only to those school  | 
| years
preceding the 2003-2004 school year.
For purposes of this
 | 
| subsection (H), the term "Low-Income Concentration Level"  | 
| shall be the
low-income
eligible pupil count from the most  | 
| recently available federal census divided by
the Average Daily  | 
| Attendance of the school district.
If, however, (i) the  | 
| percentage decrease from the 2 most recent federal
censuses
in  | 
| the low-income eligible pupil count of a high school district  | 
| with fewer
than 400 students exceeds by 75% or more the  | 
| percentage change in the total
low-income eligible pupil count  | 
| of contiguous elementary school districts,
whose boundaries  | 
| are coterminous with the high school district,
or (ii) a high  | 
| school district within 2 counties and serving 5 elementary
 | 
| school
districts, whose boundaries are coterminous with the  | 
| high school
district, has a percentage decrease from the 2 most  | 
| recent federal
censuses in the low-income eligible pupil count  | 
| and there is a percentage
increase in the total low-income  | 
| eligible pupil count of a majority of the
elementary school  | 
| districts in excess of 50% from the 2 most recent
federal  | 
|  | 
| censuses, then
the
high school district's low-income eligible  | 
| pupil count from the earlier federal
census
shall be the number  | 
| used as the low-income eligible pupil count for the high
school  | 
| district, for purposes of this subsection (H).
 The changes made  | 
| to this paragraph (1) by Public Act 92-28 shall apply to
 | 
| supplemental general State aid
grants for school years  | 
| preceding the 2003-2004 school year that are paid
in fiscal  | 
| year 1999 or thereafter
 and to
any State aid payments made in  | 
| fiscal year 1994 through fiscal year
1998 pursuant to  | 
| subsection 1(n) of Section 18-8 of this Code (which was
 | 
| repealed on July 1, 1998), and any high school district that is  | 
| affected by
Public Act 92-28 is
entitled to a
recomputation of  | 
| its supplemental general State aid grant or State aid
paid in  | 
| any of those fiscal years.  This recomputation shall not be
 | 
| affected by any other funding. | 
|     (1.10) This paragraph (1.10) applies to the 2003-2004  | 
| school year
and each school year thereafter through the  | 
| 2016-2017 school year. For purposes of this subsection (H), the
 | 
| term "Low-Income Concentration Level" shall, for each fiscal  | 
| year, be the
low-income eligible
pupil count
as of July 1 of  | 
| the immediately preceding fiscal year
(as determined by the  | 
| Department of Human Services based
on the number of pupils
who  | 
| are eligible for at least one of the following
low income  | 
| programs: Medicaid, the Children's Health Insurance Program,  | 
| TANF, or Food Stamps,
excluding pupils who are eligible for  | 
| services provided by the Department
of Children and Family  | 
|  | 
| Services,
averaged over
the 2 immediately preceding fiscal  | 
| years for fiscal year 2004 and over the 3
immediately preceding  | 
| fiscal years for each fiscal year thereafter)
divided by the  | 
| Average Daily Attendance of the school district. | 
|     (2) Supplemental general State aid pursuant to this  | 
| subsection (H) shall
be
provided as follows for the 1998-1999,  | 
| 1999-2000, and 2000-2001 school years
only: | 
|         (a) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration Level of at
least 20% and less than 35%, the  | 
| grant for any school year
shall be $800
multiplied by the  | 
| low income eligible pupil count. | 
|         (b) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration Level of at
least 35% and less than 50%, the  | 
| grant for the 1998-1999 school year shall be
$1,100  | 
| multiplied by the low income eligible pupil count. | 
|         (c) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration Level of at
least 50% and less than 60%, the  | 
| grant for the 1998-99 school year shall be
$1,500  | 
| multiplied by the low income eligible pupil count. | 
|         (d) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration Level of 60%
or more, the grant for the  | 
| 1998-99 school year shall be $1,900 multiplied by
the low  | 
| income eligible pupil count. | 
|         (e) For the 1999-2000 school year, the per pupil amount  | 
| specified in
subparagraphs (b), (c), and (d) immediately  | 
| above shall be increased to $1,243,
$1,600, and $2,000,  | 
|  | 
| respectively. | 
|         (f) For the 2000-2001 school year, the per pupil  | 
| amounts specified in
subparagraphs (b), (c), and (d)  | 
| immediately above shall be
$1,273, $1,640, and $2,050,  | 
| respectively. | 
|     (2.5) Supplemental general State aid pursuant to this  | 
| subsection (H)
shall be provided as follows for the 2002-2003  | 
| school year: | 
|         (a) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration Level of less
than 10%, the grant for each  | 
| school year shall be $355 multiplied by the low
income  | 
| eligible pupil count. | 
|         (b) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration
Level of at least 10% and less than 20%, the  | 
| grant for each school year shall
be $675
multiplied by the  | 
| low income eligible pupil
count. | 
|         (c) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration
Level of at least 20% and less than 35%, the  | 
| grant for each school year shall
be $1,330
multiplied by  | 
| the low income eligible pupil
count. | 
|         (d) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration
Level of at least 35% and less than 50%, the  | 
| grant for each school year shall
be $1,362
multiplied by  | 
| the low income eligible pupil
count. | 
|         (e) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration
Level of at least 50% and less than 60%, the  | 
|  | 
| grant for each school year shall
be $1,680
multiplied by  | 
| the low income eligible pupil
count. | 
|         (f) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration
Level of 60% or more, the grant for each  | 
| school year shall be $2,080
multiplied by the low income  | 
| eligible pupil count. | 
|     (2.10) Except as otherwise provided, supplemental general  | 
| State aid
pursuant to this subsection
(H) shall be provided as  | 
| follows for the 2003-2004 school year and each
school year  | 
| thereafter: | 
|         (a) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration
Level of 15% or less, the grant for each  | 
| school year
shall be $355 multiplied by the low income  | 
| eligible pupil count. | 
|         (b) For any school district with a Low Income  | 
| Concentration
Level greater than 15%, the grant for each  | 
| school year shall be
$294.25 added to the product of $2,700  | 
| and the square of the Low
Income Concentration Level, all  | 
| multiplied by the low income
eligible pupil count. | 
|     For the 2003-2004 school year and each school year  | 
| thereafter through the 2008-2009 school year only, the grant  | 
| shall be no less than the
grant
for
the 2002-2003 school year.  | 
| For the 2009-2010 school year only, the grant shall
be no
less  | 
| than the grant for the 2002-2003 school year multiplied by  | 
| 0.66. For the 2010-2011
school year only, the grant shall be no  | 
| less than the grant for the 2002-2003
school year
multiplied by  | 
|  | 
| 0.33. Notwithstanding the provisions of this paragraph to the  | 
| contrary, if for any school year supplemental general State aid  | 
| grants are prorated as provided in paragraph (1) of this  | 
| subsection (H), then the grants under this paragraph shall be  | 
| prorated.
 | 
|     For the 2003-2004 school year only, the grant shall be no  | 
| greater
than the grant received during the 2002-2003 school  | 
| year added to the
product of 0.25 multiplied by the difference  | 
| between the grant amount
calculated under subsection (a) or (b)  | 
| of this paragraph (2.10), whichever
is applicable, and the  | 
| grant received during the 2002-2003 school year.
For the  | 
| 2004-2005 school year only, the grant shall be no greater than
 | 
| the grant received during the 2002-2003 school year added to  | 
| the
product of 0.50 multiplied by the difference between the  | 
| grant amount
calculated under subsection (a) or (b) of this  | 
| paragraph (2.10), whichever
is applicable, and the grant  | 
| received during the 2002-2003 school year.
For the 2005-2006  | 
| school year only, the grant shall be no greater than
the grant  | 
| received during the 2002-2003 school year added to the
product  | 
| of 0.75 multiplied by the difference between the grant amount
 | 
| calculated under subsection (a) or (b) of this paragraph  | 
| (2.10), whichever
is applicable, and the grant received during  | 
| the 2002-2003
school year. | 
|     (3) School districts with an Average Daily Attendance of  | 
| more than 1,000
and less than 50,000 that qualify for  | 
| supplemental general State aid pursuant
to this subsection  | 
|  | 
| shall submit a plan to the State Board of Education prior to
 | 
| October 30 of each year for the use of the funds resulting from  | 
| this grant of
supplemental general State aid for the  | 
| improvement of
instruction in which priority is given to  | 
| meeting the education needs of
disadvantaged children.  Such  | 
| plan shall be submitted in accordance with
rules and  | 
| regulations promulgated by the State Board of Education. | 
|     (4) School districts with an Average Daily Attendance of  | 
| 50,000 or more
that qualify for supplemental general State aid  | 
| pursuant to this subsection
shall be required to distribute  | 
| from funds available pursuant to this Section,
no less than  | 
| $261,000,000 in accordance with the following requirements: | 
|         (a) The required amounts shall be distributed to the  | 
| attendance centers
within the district in proportion to the  | 
| number of pupils enrolled at each
attendance center who are  | 
| eligible to receive free or reduced-price lunches or
 | 
| breakfasts under the federal Child Nutrition Act of 1966  | 
| and under the National
School Lunch Act during the  | 
| immediately preceding school year. | 
|         (b) The distribution of these portions of supplemental  | 
| and general State
aid among attendance centers according to  | 
| these requirements shall not be
compensated for or  | 
| contravened by adjustments of the total of other funds
 | 
| appropriated to any attendance centers, and the Board of  | 
| Education shall
utilize funding from one or several sources  | 
| in order to fully implement this
provision annually prior  | 
|  | 
| to the opening of school. | 
|         (c) Each attendance center shall be provided by the
 | 
| school district a distribution of noncategorical funds and  | 
| other
categorical funds to which an attendance center is  | 
| entitled under law in
order that the general State aid and  | 
| supplemental general State aid provided
by application of  | 
| this subsection supplements rather than supplants the
 | 
| noncategorical funds and other categorical funds provided  | 
| by the school
district to the attendance centers. | 
|         (d) Any funds made available under this subsection that  | 
| by reason of the
provisions of this subsection are not
 | 
| required to be allocated and provided to attendance centers  | 
| may be used and
appropriated by the board of the district  | 
| for any lawful school purpose. | 
|         (e) Funds received by an attendance center
pursuant to  | 
| this
subsection shall be used
by the attendance center at  | 
| the discretion
of the principal and local school council  | 
| for programs to improve educational
opportunities at  | 
| qualifying schools through the following programs and
 | 
| services: early childhood education, reduced class size or  | 
| improved adult to
student classroom ratio, enrichment  | 
| programs, remedial assistance, attendance
improvement, and  | 
| other educationally beneficial expenditures which
 | 
| supplement
the regular and basic programs as determined by  | 
| the State Board of Education.
Funds provided shall not be  | 
| expended for any political or lobbying purposes
as defined  | 
|  | 
| by board rule. | 
|         (f) Each district subject to the provisions of this  | 
| subdivision (H)(4)
shall submit an
acceptable plan to meet  | 
| the educational needs of disadvantaged children, in
 | 
| compliance with the requirements of this paragraph, to the  | 
| State Board of
Education prior to July 15 of each year.  | 
| This plan shall be consistent with the
decisions of local  | 
| school councils concerning the school expenditure plans
 | 
| developed in accordance with part 4 of Section 34-2.3.  The  | 
| State Board shall
approve or reject the plan within 60 days  | 
| after its submission.  If the plan is
rejected, the district  | 
| shall give written notice of intent to modify the plan
 | 
| within 15 days of the notification of rejection and then  | 
| submit a modified plan
within 30 days after the date of the  | 
| written notice of intent to modify.
Districts may amend  | 
| approved plans pursuant to rules promulgated by the State
 | 
| Board of Education. | 
|         Upon notification by the State Board of Education that  | 
| the district has
not submitted a plan prior to July 15 or a  | 
| modified plan within the time
period specified herein, the
 | 
| State aid funds affected by that plan or modified plan  | 
| shall be withheld by the
State Board of Education until a  | 
| plan or modified plan is submitted. | 
|         If the district fails to distribute State aid to  | 
| attendance centers in
accordance with an approved plan, the  | 
| plan for the following year shall
allocate funds, in  | 
|  | 
| addition to the funds otherwise required by this
 | 
| subsection, to those attendance centers which were  | 
| underfunded during the
previous year in amounts equal to  | 
| such underfunding. | 
|         For purposes of determining compliance with this  | 
| subsection in relation
to the requirements of attendance  | 
| center funding, each district subject to the
provisions of  | 
| this
subsection shall submit as a separate document by  | 
| December 1 of each year a
report of expenditure data for  | 
| the prior year in addition to any
modification of its  | 
| current plan.  If it is determined that there has been
a  | 
| failure to comply with the expenditure provisions of this  | 
| subsection
regarding contravention or supplanting, the  | 
| State Superintendent of
Education shall, within 60 days of  | 
| receipt of the report, notify the
district and any affected  | 
| local school council.  The district shall within
45 days of  | 
| receipt of that notification inform the State  | 
| Superintendent of
Education of the remedial or corrective  | 
| action to be taken, whether  by
amendment of the current  | 
| plan, if feasible, or by adjustment in the plan
for the  | 
| following year.  Failure to provide the expenditure report  | 
| or the
notification of remedial or corrective action in a  | 
| timely manner shall
result in a withholding of the affected  | 
| funds. | 
|         The State Board of Education shall promulgate rules and  | 
| regulations
to implement the provisions of this  | 
|  | 
| subsection.  No funds shall be released
under this  | 
| subdivision (H)(4) to any district that has not submitted a  | 
| plan
that has been approved by the State Board of  | 
| Education.
 
 | 
| (I) (Blank).
 
 | 
| (J) (Blank).
 
 | 
| (K) Grants to Laboratory and Alternative Schools. | 
|     In calculating the amount to be paid to the governing board  | 
| of a public
university that operates a laboratory school under  | 
| this Section or to any
alternative school that is operated by a  | 
| regional superintendent of schools,
the State
Board of  | 
| Education shall require by rule such reporting requirements as  | 
| it
deems necessary. | 
|     As used in this Section, "laboratory school" means a public  | 
| school which is
created and operated by a public university and  | 
| approved by the State Board of
Education.  The governing board  | 
| of a public university which receives funds
from the State  | 
| Board under this subsection (K) or subsection (g) of Section  | 
| 18-8.15 of this Code may not increase the number of
students  | 
| enrolled in its laboratory
school from a single district, if  | 
| that district is already sending 50 or more
students, except  | 
| under a mutual agreement between the school board of a
 | 
| student's district of residence and the university which  | 
|  | 
| operates the
laboratory school.  A laboratory school may not  | 
| have more than 1,000 students,
excluding students with  | 
| disabilities in a special education program. | 
|     As used in this Section, "alternative school" means a  | 
| public school which is
created and operated by a Regional  | 
| Superintendent of Schools and approved by
the State Board of  | 
| Education.  Such alternative schools may offer courses of
 | 
| instruction for which credit is given in regular school  | 
| programs, courses to
prepare students for the high school  | 
| equivalency testing program or vocational
and occupational  | 
| training.   A regional superintendent of schools may contract
 | 
| with a school district or a public community college district  | 
| to operate an
alternative school.  An alternative school serving  | 
| more than one educational
service region may be established by  | 
| the regional superintendents of schools
of the affected  | 
| educational service regions.  An alternative school
serving  | 
| more than one educational service region may be operated under  | 
| such
terms as the regional superintendents of schools of those  | 
| educational service
regions may agree. | 
|     Each laboratory and alternative school shall file, on forms  | 
| provided by the
State Superintendent of Education, an annual  | 
| State aid claim which states the
Average Daily Attendance of  | 
| the school's students by month.  The best 3 months'
Average  | 
| Daily Attendance shall be computed for each school.
The general  | 
| State aid entitlement shall be computed by multiplying the
 | 
| applicable Average Daily Attendance by the Foundation Level as  | 
|  | 
| determined under
this Section.
 
 | 
| (L) Payments, Additional Grants in Aid and Other Requirements. | 
|     (1) For a school district operating under the financial  | 
| supervision
of an Authority created under Article 34A, the  | 
| general State aid otherwise
payable to that district under this  | 
| Section, but not the supplemental general
State aid, shall be  | 
| reduced by an amount equal to the budget for
the operations of  | 
| the Authority as certified by the Authority to the State
Board  | 
| of Education, and an amount equal to such reduction shall be  | 
| paid
to the Authority created for such district for its  | 
| operating expenses in
the manner provided in Section 18-11.  The  | 
| remainder
of general State school aid for any such district  | 
| shall be paid in accordance
with Article 34A when that Article  | 
| provides for a disposition other than that
provided by this  | 
| Article. | 
|     (2) (Blank). | 
|     (3) Summer school.  Summer school payments shall be made as  | 
| provided in
Section 18-4.3.
 
 | 
| (M) (Blank). Education Funding Advisory Board. | 
|     The Education Funding Advisory
Board, hereinafter in this  | 
| subsection (M) referred to as the "Board", is hereby
created.  | 
| The Board
shall consist of 5 members who are appointed by the  | 
| Governor, by and with the
advice and consent of the Senate. The  | 
| members appointed shall include
representatives of education,  | 
|  | 
| business, and the general public. One of the
members so  | 
| appointed shall be
designated by the Governor at the time the  | 
| appointment is made as the
chairperson of the
Board.
The  | 
| initial members of the Board may
be appointed any time after  | 
| the effective date of this amendatory Act of
1997.  The regular  | 
| term of each member of the
Board shall be for 4 years from the  | 
| third Monday of January of the
year in which the term of the  | 
| member's appointment is to commence, except that
of the 5  | 
| initial members appointed to serve on the
Board, the member who  | 
| is appointed as the chairperson shall serve for
a term that  | 
| commences on the date of his or her appointment and expires on  | 
| the
third Monday of January, 2002, and the remaining 4 members,  | 
| by lots drawn at
the first meeting of the Board that is
held
 | 
| after all 5 members are appointed, shall determine 2 of their  | 
| number to serve
for terms that commence on the date of their
 | 
| respective appointments and expire on the third
Monday of  | 
| January, 2001,
and 2 of their number to serve for terms that  | 
| commence
on the date of their respective appointments and  | 
| expire on the third Monday
of January, 2000.  All members  | 
| appointed to serve on the
Board shall serve until their  | 
| respective successors are
appointed and confirmed.  Vacancies  | 
| shall be filled in the same manner as
original appointments.  If  | 
| a vacancy in membership occurs at a time when the
Senate is not  | 
| in session, the Governor shall make a temporary appointment  | 
| until
the next meeting of the Senate, when he or she shall  | 
| appoint, by and with the
advice and consent of the Senate, a  | 
|  | 
| person to fill that membership for the
unexpired term.  If the  | 
| Senate is not in session when the initial appointments
are  | 
| made, those appointments shall
be made as in the case of  | 
| vacancies. | 
|     The Education Funding Advisory Board shall be deemed  | 
| established,
and the initial
members appointed by the Governor  | 
| to serve as members of the
Board shall take office,
on the date  | 
| that the
Governor makes his or her appointment of the fifth  | 
| initial member of the
Board, whether those initial members are  | 
| then serving
pursuant to appointment and confirmation or  | 
| pursuant to temporary appointments
that are made by the  | 
| Governor as in the case of vacancies. | 
|     The State Board of Education shall provide such staff  | 
| assistance to the
Education Funding Advisory Board as is  | 
| reasonably required for the proper
performance by the Board of  | 
| its responsibilities. | 
|     For school years after the 2000-2001 school year, the  | 
| Education
Funding Advisory Board, in consultation with the  | 
| State Board of Education,
shall make recommendations as  | 
| provided in this subsection (M) to the General
Assembly for the  | 
| foundation level under subdivision (B)(3) of this Section and
 | 
| for the
supplemental general State aid grant level under  | 
| subsection (H) of this Section
for districts with high  | 
| concentrations of children from poverty.  The
recommended  | 
| foundation level shall be determined based on a methodology  | 
| which
incorporates the basic education expenditures of  | 
|  | 
| low-spending schools
exhibiting high academic performance.  The  | 
| Education Funding Advisory Board
shall make such  | 
| recommendations to the General Assembly on January 1 of odd
 | 
| numbered years, beginning January 1, 2001.
 
 | 
| (N) (Blank).
 
 | 
| (O) References. | 
|     (1) References in other laws to the various subdivisions of
 | 
| Section 18-8 as that Section existed before its repeal and  | 
| replacement by this
Section 18-8.05 shall be deemed to refer to  | 
| the corresponding provisions of
this Section 18-8.05, to the  | 
| extent that those references remain applicable. | 
|     (2) References in other laws to State Chapter 1 funds shall  | 
| be deemed to
refer to the supplemental general State aid  | 
| provided under subsection (H) of
this Section.
 | 
| (P)  Public Act 93-838 and Public Act 93-808 make inconsistent  | 
| changes to this Section. Under Section 6 of the Statute on  | 
| Statutes there is an irreconcilable conflict between Public Act  | 
| 93-808 and Public Act 93-838.  Public Act 93-838, being the last  | 
| acted upon, is controlling.  The text of Public Act 93-838 is  | 
| the law regardless of the text of Public Act 93-808.
 | 
| (Q) State Fiscal Year 2015 Payments. | 
|     For payments made for State fiscal year 2015, the State  | 
|  | 
| Board of Education shall,  for each school district, calculate  | 
| that district's pro-rata share of a minimum sum of $13,600,000  | 
| or additional amounts as needed from the total net General  | 
| State Aid funding as calculated under this Section that shall  | 
| be deemed attributable to the provision of special educational  | 
| facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this  | 
| Code, in a manner that ensures compliance with maintenance of  | 
| State financial support requirements under the federal  | 
| Individuals with Disabilities Education Act.  Each school  | 
| district must use such funds only for the provision of special  | 
| educational facilities and services, as defined in Section  | 
| 14-1.08 of this Code, and must comply with any expenditure  | 
| verification procedures adopted by the State Board of  | 
| Education. 
 | 
| (R) State Fiscal Year 2016 Payments.  | 
|     For payments made for State fiscal year 2016, the State  | 
| Board of Education shall, for each school district, calculate  | 
| that district's pro rata share of a minimum sum of $1 or  | 
| additional amounts as needed from the total net General State  | 
| Aid funding as calculated under this Section that shall be  | 
| deemed attributable to the provision of special educational  | 
| facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this  | 
| Code, in a manner that ensures compliance with maintenance of  | 
| State financial support requirements under the federal  | 
| Individuals with Disabilities Education Act. Each school  | 
|  | 
| district must use such funds only for the provision of special  | 
| educational facilities and services, as defined in Section  | 
| 14-1.08 of this Code, and must comply with any expenditure  | 
| verification procedures adopted by the State Board of  | 
| Education.  | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-972, eff. 8-15-14; 99-2, eff. 3-26-15; 99-194,  | 
| eff. 7-30-15; 99-523, eff. 6-30-16.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/18-8.10) | 
|     Sec. 18-8.10. Fast growth grants.
 | 
|     (a)  If there has been an increase in a school district's  | 
| student population over the most recent 2 school years of (i)  | 
| over 1.5% in a district with over 10,000 pupils in average  | 
| daily attendance (as defined in Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of  | 
| this Code) or (ii) over 7.5% in any other district, then the  | 
| district is eligible for a grant under this Section, subject to  | 
| appropriation. | 
|     (b)  The State Board of Education shall determine a per  | 
| pupil grant amount for each school district.  The total grant  | 
| amount for a district for any given school year shall equal the  | 
| per pupil grant amount multiplied by the difference between the  | 
| number of pupils in average daily attendance for the 2 most  | 
| recent school years. | 
|     (c)  Funds for grants under this Section must be  | 
| appropriated to the State Board of Education in a separate line  | 
| item for this purpose.  If the amount appropriated in any fiscal  | 
|  | 
| year is insufficient to pay all grants for a school year, then  | 
| the amount appropriated shall be prorated among eligible  | 
| districts.  As soon as possible after funds have been  | 
| appropriated to the State Board of Education, the State Board  | 
| of Education shall distribute the grants to eligible districts. | 
|     (d)  If a school district intentionally reports incorrect  | 
| average daily attendance numbers to receive a grant under this  | 
| Section, then the district shall be denied State aid in the  | 
| same manner as State aid is denied for intentional incorrect  | 
| reporting of average daily attendance numbers under Section  | 
| 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 93-1042, eff. 10-8-04.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/18-8.15 new) | 
|     Sec. 18-8.15. Evidence-based funding for student success  | 
| for the 2017-2018 and subsequent school years.  | 
|     (a) General provisions.  | 
|         (1)  The purpose of this Section is to ensure that, by  | 
| June 30, 2027 and beyond, this State has a kindergarten  | 
| through grade 12 public education system with the capacity  | 
| to ensure the educational development of all persons to the  | 
| limits of their capacities in accordance with Section 1 of  | 
| Article X of the Constitution of the State of Illinois. To  | 
| accomplish that objective, this Section creates a method of  | 
| funding public education that is evidence-based; is  | 
| sufficient to ensure every student receives a meaningful  | 
|  | 
| opportunity to learn irrespective of race, ethnicity,  | 
| sexual orientation, gender, or community-income level; and  | 
| is sustainable and predictable. When fully funded under  | 
| this Section, every school shall have the resources, based  | 
| on what the evidence indicates is needed, to:  | 
|             (A) provide all students with a high quality  | 
| education that offers the academic, enrichment, social  | 
| and emotional support, technical, and career-focused  | 
| programs that will allow them to become competitive  | 
| workers, responsible parents, productive citizens of  | 
| this State, and active members of our national  | 
| democracy; | 
|             (B) ensure all students receive the education they  | 
| need to graduate from high school with the skills  | 
| required to pursue post-secondary education and  | 
| training for a rewarding career; | 
|             (C) reduce, with a goal of eliminating, the  | 
| achievement gap between at-risk and non-at-risk  | 
| students by raising the performance of at-risk  | 
| students and not by reducing standards; and | 
|             (D) ensure this State satisfies its obligation to  | 
| assume the primary responsibility to fund public  | 
| education and simultaneously relieve the  | 
| disproportionate burden placed on local property taxes  | 
| to fund schools.  | 
|         (2) The evidence-based funding formula under this  | 
|  | 
| Section shall be applied to all Organizational Units in  | 
| this State. The evidence-based funding formula outlined in  | 
| this Act is based on the formula outlined in Senate Bill 1  | 
| of the 100th General Assembly, as passed by both  | 
| legislative chambers.  As further defined and described in  | 
| this Section, there are 4 major components of the  | 
| evidence-based funding model:  | 
|             (A) First, the model calculates a unique adequacy  | 
| target for each Organizational Unit in this State that  | 
| considers the costs to implement research-based  | 
| activities, the unit's student demographics, and  | 
| regional wage difference. | 
|             (B) Second, the model calculates each  | 
| Organizational Unit's local capacity, or the amount  | 
| each Organizational Unit is assumed to contribute  | 
| towards its adequacy target from local resources. | 
|             (C) Third, the model calculates how much funding  | 
| the State currently contributes to the Organizational  | 
| Unit, and adds that to the unit's local capacity to  | 
| determine the unit's overall current adequacy of  | 
| funding. | 
|             (D) Finally, the model's distribution method  | 
| allocates new State funding to those Organizational  | 
| Units that are least well-funded, considering both  | 
| local capacity and State funding, in relation to their  | 
| adequacy target.  | 
|  | 
|         (3) An Organizational Unit receiving any funding under  | 
| this Section may apply those funds to any fund so received  | 
| for which that Organizational Unit is authorized to make  | 
| expenditures by law. | 
|         (4) As used in this Section, the following terms shall  | 
| have the meanings ascribed in this paragraph (4):  | 
|         "Adequacy Target" is defined in paragraph (1) of  | 
| subsection (b) of this Section. | 
|         "Adjusted EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of  | 
| subsection (d) of this Section.  | 
|         "Adjusted Local Capacity Target" is defined in  | 
| paragraph (3) of subsection (c) of this Section. | 
|         "Adjusted Operating Tax Rate" means a tax rate for all  | 
| Organizational Units, for which the State Superintendent  | 
| shall calculate and subtract for the Operating Tax Rate a  | 
| transportation rate based on total expenses for  | 
| transportation services under this Code, as reported on the  | 
| most recent Annual Financial Report in Pupil  | 
| Transportation Services, function 2550 in both the  | 
| Education and Transportation funds and functions 4110 and  | 
| 4120 in the Transportation fund, less any corresponding  | 
| fiscal year State of Illinois scheduled payments excluding  | 
| net adjustments for prior years for regular, vocational, or  | 
| special education transportation reimbursement pursuant to  | 
| Section 29-5 or subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this  | 
| Code divided by the Adjusted EAV. If an Organizational  | 
|  | 
| Unit's corresponding fiscal year State of Illinois  | 
| scheduled payments excluding net adjustments for prior  | 
| years for regular, vocational, or special education  | 
| transportation reimbursement pursuant to Section 29-5 or  | 
| subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this Code exceed the  | 
| total transportation expenses, as defined in this  | 
| paragraph, no transportation rate shall be subtracted from  | 
| the Operating Tax Rate.  | 
|         "Allocation Rate" is defined in paragraph (3) of  | 
| subsection (g) of this Section. | 
|         "Alternative School" means a public school that is  | 
| created and operated by a regional superintendent of  | 
| schools and approved by the State Board. | 
|         "Applicable Tax Rate" is defined in paragraph (1) of  | 
| subsection (d) of this Section. | 
|         "Assessment" means any of those benchmark, progress  | 
| monitoring, formative, diagnostic, and other assessments,  | 
| in addition to the State accountability assessment, that  | 
| assist teachers' needs in understanding the skills and  | 
| meeting the needs of the students they serve. | 
|         "Assistant principal" means a school administrator  | 
| duly endorsed to be employed as an assistant principal in  | 
| this State. | 
|         "At-risk student" means a student who is at risk of not  | 
| meeting the Illinois Learning Standards or not graduating  | 
| from elementary or high school and who demonstrates a need  | 
|  | 
| for vocational support or social services beyond that  | 
| provided by the regular school program. All students  | 
| included in an Organizational Unit's Low-Income Count, as  | 
| well as all English learner and disabled students attending  | 
| the Organizational Unit, shall be considered at-risk  | 
| students under this Section. | 
|         "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" means, for an  | 
| Organizational Unit in a given school year, the greater of  | 
| the average number of students (grades K through 12)  | 
| reported to the State Board as enrolled in the  | 
| Organizational Unit on October 1 and March 1, plus the  | 
| special education pre-kindergarten students with services  | 
| of at least more than 2 hours a day as reported to the  | 
| State Board on December 1, in the immediately preceding  | 
| school year or the average number of students (grades K  | 
| through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the  | 
| Organizational Unit on October 1 and March 1, plus the  | 
| special education pre-kindergarten students with services  | 
| of
at least more than 2 hours a day as reported to the  | 
| State Board on December 1, for each of the immediately  | 
| preceding 3 school years. For the purposes of this  | 
| definition, "enrolled in the Organizational Unit" means  | 
| the number of students reported to the State Board who are  | 
| enrolled in schools within the Organizational Unit that the  | 
| student attends or would attend if not placed or  | 
| transferred to another school or program to receive needed  | 
|  | 
| services.  For the purposes of calculating "ASE", all  | 
| students, grades K through 12, excluding those attending  | 
| kindergarten for a half day, shall be counted as 1.0. All  | 
| students attending kindergarten for a half day shall be  | 
| counted as 0.5, unless in 2017  by June 15 or by March 1 in  | 
| subsequent years, the school district reports to the State  | 
| Board of Education the intent to implement full-day  | 
| kindergarten district-wide for all students, then all  | 
| students attending kindergarten shall be counted as 1.0.  | 
| Special education pre-kindergarten students shall be  | 
| counted as 0.5 each. If the State Board does not collect or  | 
| has not collected both an October 1 and March 1 enrollment  | 
| count by grade or a December 1 collection of special  | 
| education pre-kindergarten students as of the effective  | 
| date of this amendatory Act of the 100th General Assembly,  | 
| it shall establish such collection for all future years.  | 
| For any year where a count by grade level was collected  | 
| only once, that count shall be used as the single count  | 
| available for computing a 3-year average ASE. School  | 
| districts shall submit the data for the ASE calculation to  | 
| the State Board within 45 days of the dates required in  | 
| this Section for submission of enrollment data in order for  | 
| it to be included in the ASE calculation. | 
|         "Base Funding Guarantee" is defined in paragraph (10)  | 
| of subsection (g) of this Section.  | 
|         "Base Funding Minimum" is defined in subsection (e) of  | 
|  | 
| this Section. | 
|         "Base Tax Year" means the property tax levy year used  | 
| to calculate the Budget Year allocation of primary State  | 
| aid. | 
|         "Base Tax Year's Extension" means the product of the  | 
| equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county clerk  | 
| in the Base Tax Year multiplied by the limiting rate as  | 
| calculated by the county clerk and defined in PTELL. | 
|         "Bilingual Education Allocation" means the amount of  | 
| an Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target  | 
| attributable to bilingual education divided by the  | 
| Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target, the product  | 
| of which shall be multiplied by the amount of new funding  | 
| received pursuant to this Section.  An Organizational  | 
| Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable to bilingual  | 
| education shall include all additional investments in  | 
| English learner students' adequacy elements. | 
|         "Budget Year" means the school year for which primary  | 
| State aid is calculated and awarded under this Section.  | 
|         "Central office" means individual administrators and  | 
| support service personnel charged with managing the  | 
| instructional programs, business and operations, and  | 
| security of the Organizational Unit. | 
|         "Comparable Wage Index" or "CWI" means a regional cost  | 
| differentiation metric that measures systemic, regional  | 
| variations in the salaries of college graduates who are not  | 
|  | 
| educators. The CWI utilized for this Section shall, for the  | 
| first 3 years of Evidence-Based Funding implementation, be  | 
| the CWI initially developed by the National Center for  | 
| Education Statistics, as most recently updated by Texas A &  | 
| M University.  In the fourth and subsequent years of  | 
| Evidence-Based Funding implementation, the State  | 
| Superintendent shall re-determine the CWI using a similar  | 
| methodology to that identified in the Texas A & M  | 
| University study, with adjustments made no less frequently  | 
| than once every 5 years. | 
|         "Computer technology and equipment" means computers  | 
| servers, notebooks, network equipment, copiers, printers,  | 
| instructional software, security software, curriculum  | 
| management courseware, and other similar materials and  | 
| equipment.  | 
|         "Core subject" means mathematics; science; reading,  | 
| English, writing, and language arts; history and social  | 
| studies; world languages; and subjects taught as Advanced  | 
| Placement in high schools. | 
|         "Core teacher" means a regular classroom teacher in  | 
| elementary schools and teachers of a core subject in middle  | 
| and high schools. | 
|         "Core Intervention teacher (tutor)" means a licensed  | 
| teacher providing one-on-one or small group tutoring to  | 
| students struggling to meet proficiency in core subjects. | 
|         "CPPRT" means corporate personal property replacement  | 
|  | 
| tax funds paid to an Organizational Unit during the  | 
| calendar year one year before the calendar year in which a  | 
| school year begins, pursuant to "An Act in relation to the  | 
| abolition of ad valorem personal property tax and the  | 
| replacement of revenues lost thereby, and amending and  | 
| repealing certain Acts and parts of Acts in connection  | 
| therewith", certified August 14, 1979, as amended (Public  | 
| Act 81-1st S.S.-1). | 
|         "EAV" means equalized assessed valuation as defined in  | 
| paragraph (2) of subsection (d) of this Section and  | 
| calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of subsection  | 
| (d) of this Section. | 
|         "ECI" means the Bureau of Labor Statistics' national  | 
| employment cost index for civilian workers in educational  | 
| services in elementary and secondary schools on a  | 
| cumulative basis for the 12-month calendar year preceding  | 
| the fiscal year of the Evidence-Based Funding calculation. | 
|         "EIS Data" means the employment information system  | 
| data maintained by the State Board on educators within  | 
| Organizational Units. | 
|         "Employee benefits" means health, dental, and vision  | 
| insurance offered to employees of an Organizational Unit,  | 
| the costs associated with statutorily required payment of  | 
| the normal cost of the Organizational Unit's teacher  | 
| pensions, Social Security employer contributions, and  | 
| Illinois Municipal Retirement Fund employer contributions. | 
|  | 
|         "English learner" or "EL" means a child included in the  | 
| definition of "English learners" under Section 14C-2 of  | 
| this Code participating in a program of transitional  | 
| bilingual education or a transitional program of  | 
| instruction meeting the requirements and program  | 
| application procedures of Article 14C of this Code.  For the  | 
| purposes of collecting the number of EL students enrolled,  | 
| the same collection and calculation methodology as defined  | 
| above for "ASE" shall apply to English learners. | 
|         "Essential Elements" means those elements, resources,  | 
| and educational programs that have been identified through  | 
| academic research as necessary to improve student success,  | 
| improve academic performance, close achievement gaps, and  | 
| provide for other per student costs related to the delivery  | 
| and leadership of the Organizational Unit, as well as the  | 
| maintenance and operations of the unit, and which are  | 
| specified in paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this  | 
| Section. | 
|         "Evidence-Based Funding" means State funding provided  | 
| to an Organizational Unit pursuant to this Section. | 
|         "Extended day" means academic and enrichment programs  | 
| provided to students outside the regular school day before  | 
| and after school or during non-instructional times during  | 
| the school day. | 
|         "Extension Limitation Ratio" means a numerical ratio  | 
| in which the numerator is the Base Tax Year's Extension and  | 
|  | 
| the denominator is the Preceding Tax Year's Extension. | 
|         "Final Percent of Adequacy" is defined in paragraph (4)  | 
| of subsection (f) of this Section. | 
|         "Final Resources" is defined in paragraph (3) of  | 
| subsection (f) of this Section. | 
|         "Full-time equivalent" or "FTE" means the full-time  | 
| equivalency compensation for staffing the relevant  | 
| position at an Organizational Unit. | 
|         "Funding Gap" is defined in paragraph (1) of subsection  | 
| (g). | 
|         "Guidance counselor" means a licensed guidance  | 
| counselor who provides guidance and counseling support for  | 
| students within an Organizational Unit. | 
|         "Hybrid District" means a partial elementary unit  | 
| district created pursuant to Article 11E of this Code. | 
|         "Instructional assistant" means a core or special  | 
| education, non-licensed employee who assists a teacher in  | 
| the classroom and provides academic support to students.  | 
|         "Instructional facilitator" means a qualified teacher  | 
| or licensed teacher leader who facilitates and coaches  | 
| continuous improvement in classroom instruction; provides  | 
| instructional support to teachers in the elements of  | 
| research-based instruction or demonstrates the alignment  | 
| of instruction with curriculum standards and assessment  | 
| tools; develops or coordinates instructional programs or  | 
| strategies; develops and implements training; chooses  | 
|  | 
| standards-based instructional materials; provides teachers  | 
| with an understanding of current research; serves as a  | 
| mentor, site coach, curriculum specialist, or lead  | 
| teacher; or otherwise works with fellow teachers, in  | 
| collaboration, to use data to improve instructional  | 
| practice or develop model lessons. | 
|         "Instructional materials" means relevant instructional  | 
| materials for student instruction, including, but not  | 
| limited to, textbooks, consumable workbooks, laboratory  | 
| equipment, library books, and other similar materials. | 
|         "Laboratory School" means a public school that is  | 
| created and operated by a public university and approved by  | 
| the State Board. | 
|         "Librarian" means a teacher with an endorsement as a  | 
| library information specialist or another individual whose  | 
| primary responsibility is overseeing library resources  | 
| within an Organizational Unit. | 
|         "Local Capacity" is defined in paragraph (1) of  | 
| subsection (c) of this Section. | 
|         "Local Capacity Percentage" is defined in subparagraph  | 
| (A) of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section. | 
|         "Local Capacity Ratio" is defined in subparagraph (B)  | 
| of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section. | 
|         "Local Capacity Target" is defined in paragraph (2) of  | 
| subsection (c) of this Section. | 
|         "Low-Income Count" means, for an Organizational Unit  | 
|  | 
| in a fiscal year, the higher of the average number of  | 
| students for the prior school year or the immediately  | 
| preceding 3 school years who, as of July 1 of the  | 
| immediately preceding fiscal year (as determined by the  | 
| Department of Human Services), are eligible for at least  | 
| one of the following low income programs: Medicaid, the  | 
| Children's Health Insurance Program, TANF, or the  | 
| Supplemental Nutrition Assistance Program, excluding  | 
| pupils who are eligible for services provided by the  | 
| Department of Children and Family Services. Until such time  | 
| that grade level low-income populations become available,  | 
| grade level low-income populations shall be determined by  | 
| applying the low-income percentage to total student  | 
| enrollments by grade level.  The low-income percentage is  | 
| determined by dividing the Low-Income Count by the Average  | 
| Student Enrollment. | 
|         "Maintenance and operations" means custodial services,  | 
| facility and ground maintenance, facility operations,  | 
| facility security, routine facility repairs, and other  | 
| similar services and functions. | 
|         "Minimum Funding Level" is defined in paragraph (9) of  | 
| subsection (g) of this Section. | 
|         "New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds" means, for any  | 
| given fiscal year, all State funds appropriated under  | 
| Section 2-3.170 of the School Code.  | 
|         "New State Funds" means, for a given school year, all  | 
|  | 
| State funds appropriated for Evidence-Based Funding in  | 
| excess of the amount needed to fund the Base Funding  | 
| Minimum for all Organizational Units in that school year. | 
|         "Net State Contribution Target" means, for a given  | 
| school year, the amount of State funds that would be  | 
| necessary to fully meet the Adequacy Target of an  | 
| Operational Unit minus the Preliminary Resources available  | 
| to each unit. | 
|         "Nurse" means an individual licensed as a certified  | 
| school nurse, in accordance with the rules established for  | 
| nursing services by the State Board, who is an employee of  | 
| and is available to provide health care-related services  | 
| for students of an Organizational Unit. | 
|         "Operating Tax Rate" means the rate utilized in the  | 
| previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes,  | 
| except, Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital  | 
| Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes.  | 
| For Hybrid Districts, the Operating Tax Rate shall be the  | 
| combined elementary and high school rates utilized in the  | 
| previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes,  | 
| except, Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital  | 
| Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes.  | 
|         "Organizational Unit" means a Laboratory School, an  | 
| Alternative School, or any public school district that is  | 
| recognized as such by the State Board and that contains  | 
| elementary schools typically serving kindergarten through  | 
|  | 
| 5th grades, middle schools typically serving 6th through  | 
| 8th grades, or high schools typically serving 9th through  | 
| 12th grades. The General Assembly acknowledges that the  | 
| actual grade levels served by a particular Organizational  | 
| Unit may vary slightly from what is typical. | 
|         "Organizational Unit CWI" is determined by calculating  | 
| the CWI in the region and original county in which an  | 
| Organizational Unit's primary administrative office is  | 
| located as set forth in this paragraph, provided that if  | 
| the Organizational Unit CWI as calculated in accordance  | 
| with this paragraph is less than 0.9, the Organizational  | 
| Unit CWI shall be increased to 0.9.  Each county's current  | 
| CWI value shall be adjusted based on the CWI value of that  | 
| county's neighboring Illinois counties, to create a  | 
| "weighted adjusted index value". This shall be calculated  | 
| by summing the CWI values of all of a county's adjacent  | 
| Illinois counties and dividing by the number of adjacent  | 
| Illinois counties, then taking the weighted value of the  | 
| original county's CWI value and the adjacent Illinois  | 
| county average. To calculate this weighted value, if the  | 
| number of adjacent Illinois counties is greater than 2, the  | 
| original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.25 and  | 
| the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at  | 
| 0.75. If the number of adjacent Illinois counties is 2, the  | 
| original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.33 and  | 
| the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at  | 
|  | 
| 0.66. The greater of the county's current CWI value and its  | 
| weighted adjusted index value shall be used as the  | 
| Organizational Unit CWI. | 
|         "Preceding Tax Year" means the property tax levy year  | 
| immediately preceding the Base Tax Year. | 
|         "Preceding Tax Year's Extension" means the product of  | 
| the equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county  | 
| clerk in the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by the Operating  | 
| Tax Rate.  | 
|         "Preliminary Percent of Adequacy" is defined in  | 
| paragraph (2) of subsection (f) of this Section. | 
|         "Preliminary Resources" is defined in paragraph (2) of  | 
| subsection (f) of this Section. | 
|         "Principal" means a school administrator duly endorsed  | 
| to be employed as a principal in this State. | 
|         "Professional development" means training programs for  | 
| licensed staff in schools, including, but not limited to,  | 
| programs that assist in implementing new curriculum  | 
| programs, provide data focused or academic assessment data  | 
| training to help staff identify a student's weaknesses and  | 
| strengths, target interventions, improve instruction,  | 
| encompass instructional strategies for English learner,  | 
| gifted, or at-risk students, address inclusivity, cultural  | 
| sensitivity, or implicit bias, or otherwise provide  | 
| professional support for licensed staff. | 
|         "Prototypical" means 450 special education  | 
|  | 
| pre-kindergarten and kindergarten through grade 5 students  | 
| for an elementary school, 450 grade 6 through 8 students  | 
| for a middle school, and 600 grade 9 through 12 students  | 
| for a high school. | 
|         "PTELL" means the Property Tax Extension Limitation  | 
| Law. | 
|         "PTELL EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of subsection  | 
| (d) of this Section. | 
|         "Pupil support staff" means a nurse, psychologist,  | 
| social worker, family liaison personnel, or other staff  | 
| member who provides support to at-risk or struggling  | 
| students. | 
|         "Real Receipts" is defined in paragraph (1) of  | 
| subsection (d) of this Section. | 
|         "Regionalization Factor" means, for a particular  | 
| Organizational Unit, the figure derived by dividing the  | 
| Organizational Unit CWI by the Statewide Weighted CWI. | 
|         "School site staff" means the primary school secretary  | 
| and any additional clerical personnel assigned to a school. | 
|         "Special education" means special educational  | 
| facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of  | 
| this Code. | 
|         "Special Education Allocation" means the amount of an  | 
| Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable  | 
| to special education divided by the Organizational Unit's  | 
| final Adequacy Target, the product of which shall be  | 
|  | 
| multiplied by the amount of new funding received pursuant  | 
| to this Section.  An Organizational Unit's final Adequacy  | 
| Target attributable to special education shall include all  | 
| special education investment adequacy elements.  | 
|         "Specialist teacher" means a teacher who provides  | 
| instruction in subject areas not included in core subjects,  | 
| including, but not limited to, art, music, physical  | 
| education, health, driver education, career-technical  | 
| education, and such other subject areas as may be mandated  | 
| by State law or provided by an Organizational Unit. | 
|         "Specially Funded Unit" means an Alternative School,  | 
| safe school, Department of Juvenile Justice school,  | 
| special education cooperative or entity recognized by the  | 
| State Board as a special education cooperative,  | 
| State-approved charter school, or alternative learning  | 
| opportunities program that received direct funding from  | 
| the State Board during the 2016-2017 school year through  | 
| any of the funding sources included within the calculation  | 
| of the Base Funding Minimum or Glenwood Academy. | 
|         "Supplemental Grant Funding" means supplemental  | 
| general State aid funding received by an Organization Unit  | 
| during the 2016-2017 school year pursuant to subsection (H)  | 
| of Section 18-8.05 of this Code.  | 
|         "State Adequacy Level" is the sum of the Adequacy  | 
| Targets of all Organizational Units. | 
|         "State Board" means the State Board of Education. | 
|  | 
|         "State Superintendent" means the State Superintendent  | 
| of Education. | 
|         "Statewide Weighted CWI" means a figure determined by  | 
| multiplying each Organizational Unit CWI times the ASE for  | 
| that Organizational Unit creating a weighted value,  | 
| summing all Organizational Unit's weighted values, and  | 
| dividing by the total ASE of all Organizational Units,  | 
| thereby creating an average weighted index. | 
|         "Student activities" means non-credit producing  | 
| after-school programs, including, but not limited to,  | 
| clubs, bands, sports, and other activities authorized by  | 
| the school board of the Organizational Unit. | 
|         "Substitute teacher" means an individual teacher or  | 
| teaching assistant who is employed by an Organizational  | 
| Unit and is temporarily serving the Organizational Unit on  | 
| a per diem or per period-assignment basis replacing another  | 
| staff member. | 
|         "Summer school" means academic and enrichment programs  | 
| provided to students during the summer months outside of  | 
| the regular school year. | 
|         "Supervisory aide" means a non-licensed staff member  | 
| who helps in supervising students of an Organizational  | 
| Unit, but does so outside of the classroom, in situations  | 
| such as, but not limited to, monitoring hallways and  | 
| playgrounds, supervising lunchrooms, or supervising  | 
| students when being transported in buses serving the  | 
|  | 
| Organizational Unit. | 
|         "Target Ratio" is defined in paragraph (4) of  | 
| subsection (g). | 
|         "Tier 1", "Tier 2", "Tier 3", and "Tier 4" are defined  | 
| in paragraph (3) of subsection (g). | 
|         "Tier 1 Aggregate Funding", "Tier 2 Aggregate  | 
| Funding", "Tier 3 Aggregate Funding", and "Tier 4 Aggregate  | 
| Funding" are defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (g).  | 
|     (b)  Adequacy Target calculation.  | 
|         (1)  Each Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target is the  | 
| sum of the Organizational Unit's cost of providing  | 
| Essential Elements, as calculated in accordance with this  | 
| subsection (b), with the salary amounts in the Essential  | 
| Elements multiplied by a Regionalization Factor calculated  | 
| pursuant to paragraph (3) of this subsection (b). | 
|         (2)  The Essential Elements are attributable on a pro  | 
| rata basis related to defined subgroups of the ASE of each  | 
| Organizational Unit as specified in this paragraph (2),  | 
| with investments and FTE positions pro rata funded based on  | 
| ASE counts in excess or less than the thresholds set forth  | 
| in this paragraph (2). The method for calculating  | 
| attributable pro rata costs and the defined subgroups  | 
| thereto are as follows:  | 
|             (A) Core class size investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive the funding required  | 
| to support that number of FTE core teacher positions as  | 
|  | 
| is needed to keep the respective class sizes of the  | 
| Organizational Unit to the following maximum numbers: | 
|                 (i) For grades kindergarten through 3, the  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive funding required  | 
| to support one FTE core teacher position for every  | 
| 15 Low-Income Count students in those grades and  | 
| one FTE core teacher position for every 20  | 
| non-Low-Income Count students in those grades. | 
|                 (ii) For grades 4 through 12, the  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive funding required  | 
| to support one FTE core teacher position for every  | 
| 20 Low-Income Count students in those grades and  | 
| one FTE core teacher position for every 25  | 
| non-Low-Income Count students in those grades. | 
|             The number of non-Low-Income Count students in a  | 
| grade shall be determined by subtracting the  | 
| Low-Income students in that grade from the ASE of the  | 
| Organizational Unit for that grade. | 
|             (B) Specialist teacher investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed  | 
| to cover that number of FTE specialist teacher  | 
| positions that correspond to the following  | 
| percentages:  | 
|                 (i) if the Organizational Unit operates an  | 
| elementary or middle school, then 20.00% of the  | 
| number of the Organizational Unit's core teachers,  | 
|  | 
| as determined under subparagraph (A) of this  | 
| paragraph (2); and | 
|                 (ii) if such Organizational Unit operates a  | 
| high school, then 33.33% of the number of the  | 
| Organizational Unit's core teachers.  | 
|             (C) Instructional facilitator investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed  | 
| to cover one FTE instructional facilitator position  | 
| for every 200 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten  | 
| children with disabilities and all kindergarten  | 
| through grade 12 students of the Organizational Unit. | 
|             (D) Core intervention teacher (tutor) investments.  | 
| Each Organizational Unit shall receive the funding  | 
| needed to cover one FTE teacher position for each  | 
| prototypical elementary, middle, and high school. | 
|             (E) Substitute teacher investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed  | 
| to cover substitute teacher costs that is equal to  | 
| 5.70% of the minimum pupil attendance days required  | 
| under Section 10-19 of this Code for all full-time  | 
| equivalent core, specialist, and intervention  | 
| teachers, school nurses, special education teachers  | 
| and instructional assistants, instructional  | 
| facilitators, and summer school and extended-day  | 
| teacher positions, as determined under this paragraph  | 
| (2), at a salary rate of 33.33% of the average salary  | 
|  | 
| for grade K through 12 teachers and 33.33% of the  | 
| average salary of each instructional assistant  | 
| position. | 
|             (F) Core guidance counselor investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed  | 
| to cover one FTE guidance counselor for each 450  | 
| combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with  | 
| disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 5  | 
| students, plus one FTE guidance counselor for each 250  | 
| grades 6 through 8 ASE middle school students, plus one  | 
| FTE guidance counselor for each 250 grades 9 through 12  | 
| ASE high school students. | 
|             (G) Nurse investments. Each Organizational Unit  | 
| shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE nurse  | 
| for each 750 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children  | 
| with disabilities and all kindergarten through grade  | 
| 12 students across all grade levels it serves. | 
|             (H) Supervisory aide investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed  | 
| to cover one FTE for each 225 combined ASE of  | 
| pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all  | 
| kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE for  | 
| each 225 ASE middle school students, plus one FTE for  | 
| each 200 ASE high school students. | 
|             (I) Librarian investments. Each Organizational  | 
| Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE  | 
|  | 
| librarian for each prototypical elementary school,  | 
| middle school, and high school and one FTE aide or  | 
| media technician for every 300 combined ASE of  | 
| pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all  | 
| kindergarten through grade 12 students. | 
|             (J) Principal investments. Each Organizational  | 
| Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE  | 
| principal position for each prototypical elementary  | 
| school, plus one FTE principal position for each  | 
| prototypical middle school, plus one FTE principal  | 
| position for each prototypical high school. | 
|             (K) Assistant principal investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed  | 
| to cover one FTE assistant principal position for each  | 
| prototypical elementary school, plus one FTE assistant  | 
| principal position for each prototypical middle  | 
| school, plus one FTE assistant principal position for  | 
| each prototypical high school. | 
|             (L) School site staff investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed  | 
| for one FTE position for each 225 ASE of  | 
| pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all  | 
| kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE  | 
| position for each 225 ASE middle school students, plus  | 
| one FTE position for each 200 ASE high school students. | 
|             (M) Gifted investments. Each Organizational Unit  | 
|  | 
| shall receive $40 per kindergarten through grade 12  | 
| ASE. | 
|             (N) Professional development investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive $125 per student of  | 
| the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with  | 
| disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12  | 
| students for trainers and other professional  | 
| development-related expenses for supplies and  | 
| materials. | 
|             (O) Instructional material investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive $190 per student of  | 
| the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with  | 
| disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12  | 
| students to cover instructional material costs. | 
|             (P) Assessment investments. Each Organizational  | 
| Unit shall receive $25 per student of the combined ASE  | 
| of pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all  | 
| kindergarten through grade 12 students student to  | 
| cover assessment costs. | 
|             (Q) Computer technology and equipment investments.  | 
| Each Organizational Unit shall receive $285.50 per  | 
| student of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten  | 
| children with disabilities and all kindergarten  | 
| through grade 12 students to cover computer technology  | 
| and equipment costs. For the 2018-2019 school year and  | 
| subsequent school years, Tier 1 and Tier 2  | 
|  | 
| Organizational Units selected by the State Board  | 
| through a request for proposals process shall, upon the  | 
| State Board's approval of an Organizational Unit's  | 
| one-to-one computing technology plan, receive an  | 
| additional $285.50 per student of the combined ASE of  | 
| pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all  | 
| kindergarten through grade 12 students to cover  | 
| computer technology and equipment costs. The State  | 
| Board may establish additional requirements for  | 
| Organizational Unit expenditures of funds received  | 
| pursuant to this subparagraph (Q). It is the intent of  | 
| this amendatory Act of the 100th General Assembly that  | 
| all Tier 1 and Tier 2 districts that apply for the  | 
| technology grant receive the addition to their  | 
| Adequacy Target, subject to compliance with the  | 
| requirements of the State Board. | 
|             (R) Student activities investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive the following  | 
| funding amounts to cover student activities: $100 per  | 
| kindergarten through grade 5 ASE student in elementary  | 
| school, plus $200 per ASE student in middle school,  | 
| plus $675 per ASE student in high school. | 
|             (S) Maintenance and operations investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive $1,038 per student  | 
| of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with  | 
| disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 for  | 
|  | 
| day-to-day maintenance and operations expenditures,  | 
| including salary, supplies, and materials, as well as  | 
| purchased services, but excluding employee benefits.  | 
| The proportion of salary for the application of a  | 
| Regionalization Factor and the calculation of benefits  | 
| is equal to $352.92. | 
|             (T) Central office investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive $742 per student of  | 
| the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with  | 
| disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12  | 
| students to cover central office operations, including  | 
| administrators and classified personnel charged with  | 
| managing the instructional programs, business and  | 
| operations of the school district, and security  | 
| personnel. The proportion of salary for the  | 
| application of a Regionalization Factor and the  | 
| calculation of benefits is equal to $368.48. | 
|             (U) Employee benefit investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive 30% of the total of  | 
| all salary-calculated elements of the Adequacy Target,  | 
| excluding substitute teachers and student activities  | 
| investments, to cover benefit costs. For central  | 
| office and maintenance and operations investments, the  | 
| benefit calculation shall be based upon the salary  | 
| proportion of each investment. If at any time the  | 
| responsibility for funding the employer normal cost of  | 
|  | 
| teacher pensions is assigned to school districts, then  | 
| that amount certified by the Teachers' Retirement  | 
| System of the State of Illinois to be paid by the  | 
| Organizational Unit for the preceding school year  | 
| shall be added to the benefit investment. For any  | 
| fiscal year in which a school district organized under  | 
| Article 34 of this Code is responsible for paying the  | 
| employer normal cost of teacher pensions, then that  | 
| amount of its employer normal cost plus the amount for  | 
| retiree health insurance as certified by the Public  | 
| School Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of  | 
| Chicago to be paid by the school district for the  | 
| preceding school year that is statutorily required to  | 
| cover employer normal costs and the amount for retiree  | 
| health insurance shall be added to the 30% specified in  | 
| this subparagraph (U).  The Public School Teachers'  | 
| Pension and Retirement Fund of Chicago shall submit  | 
| such information as the State Superintendent may  | 
| require for the calculations set forth in this  | 
| subparagraph (U).  | 
|             (V) Additional investments in low-income students.  | 
| In addition to and not in lieu of all other funding  | 
| under this paragraph (2), each Organizational Unit  | 
| shall receive funding based on the average teacher  | 
| salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of: | 
|                 (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor)  | 
|  | 
| position for every 125 Low-Income Count students; | 
|                 (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for  | 
| every 125 Low-Income Count students; | 
|                 (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position  | 
| for every 120 Low-Income Count students; and | 
|                 (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position  | 
| for every 120 Low-Income Count students. | 
|             (W) Additional investments in English learner  | 
| students. In addition to and not in lieu of all other  | 
| funding under this paragraph (2), each Organizational  | 
| Unit shall receive funding based on the average teacher  | 
| salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of:  | 
|                 (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor)  | 
| position for every 125 English learner students; | 
|                 (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for  | 
| every 125 English learner students; | 
|                 (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position  | 
| for every 120 English learner students; | 
|                 (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position  | 
| for every 120 English learner students; and | 
|                 (v) one FTE core teacher position for every 100  | 
| English learner students.  | 
|             (X) Special education investments. Each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall receive funding based on the  | 
| average teacher salary for grades K through 12 to cover  | 
| special education as follows:  | 
|  | 
|                 (i) one FTE teacher position for every 141  | 
| combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with  | 
| disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12  | 
| students; | 
|                 (ii) one FTE instructional assistant for every  | 
| 141 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with  | 
| disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12  | 
| students; and | 
|                 (iii) one FTE psychologist position for every  | 
| 1,000 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children  | 
| with disabilities and all kindergarten through  | 
| grade 12 students.  | 
|         (3) For calculating the salaries included within the  | 
| Essential Elements, the State Superintendent shall  | 
| annually calculate average salaries to the nearest dollar  | 
| using the employment information system data maintained by  | 
| the State Board, limited to public schools only and  | 
| excluding special education and vocational cooperatives,  | 
| schools operated by the Department of Juvenile Justice, and  | 
| charter schools, for the following positions:  | 
|             (A) Teacher for grades K through 8. | 
|             (B) Teacher for grades 9 through 12. | 
|             (C) Teacher for grades K through 12. | 
|             (D) Guidance counselor for grades K through 8. | 
|             (E) Guidance counselor for grades 9 through 12. | 
|             (F) Guidance counselor for grades K through 12. | 
|  | 
|             (G) Social worker. | 
|             (H) Psychologist. | 
|             (I) Librarian. | 
|             (J) Nurse. | 
|             (K) Principal. | 
|             (L) Assistant principal.  | 
|         For the purposes of this paragraph (3), "teacher"  | 
| includes core teachers, specialist and elective teachers,  | 
| instructional facilitators, tutors, special education  | 
| teachers, pupil support staff teachers, English learner  | 
| teachers, extended-day teachers, and summer school  | 
| teachers. Where specific grade data is not required for the  | 
| Essential Elements, the average salary for corresponding  | 
| positions shall apply.  For substitute teachers, the  | 
| average teacher salary for grades K through 12 shall apply.  | 
|         For calculating the salaries included within the  | 
| Essential Elements for positions not included within EIS  | 
| Data, the following salaries shall be used in the first  | 
| year of implementation of Evidence-Based Funding:  | 
|             (i) school site staff,  $30,000; and | 
|             (ii) non-instructional assistant, instructional  | 
| assistant, library aide, library media tech, or  | 
| supervisory aide:  $25,000.  | 
|         In the second and subsequent years of implementation of  | 
| Evidence-Based Funding, the amounts in items (i) and (ii)  | 
| of this paragraph (3) shall annually increase by the ECI.  | 
|  | 
|         The salary amounts for the Essential Elements  | 
| determined pursuant to subparagraphs (A) through (L), (S)  | 
| and (T), and (V) through (X) of paragraph (2) of subsection  | 
| (b) of this Section shall be multiplied by a  | 
| Regionalization Factor.  | 
|     (c) Local capacity calculation.  | 
|         (1) Each Organizational Unit's Local Capacity  | 
| represents an amount of funding it is assumed to contribute  | 
| toward its Adequacy Target for purposes of the  | 
| Evidence-Based Funding formula calculation. "Local  | 
| Capacity" means either (i) the Organizational Unit's Local  | 
| Capacity Target as calculated in accordance with paragraph  | 
| (2) of this subsection (c) if its Real Receipts are equal  | 
| to or less than its Local Capacity Target or (ii) the  | 
| Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity, as  | 
| calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of this  | 
| subsection (c) if Real Receipts are more than its Local  | 
| Capacity Target. | 
|         (2) "Local Capacity Target" means, for an  | 
| Organizational Unit, that dollar amount that is obtained by  | 
| multiplying its Adequacy Target by its Local Capacity  | 
| Ratio.  | 
|             (A) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity  | 
| Percentage is the conversion of the Organizational  | 
| Unit's Local Capacity Ratio, as such ratio is  | 
| determined in accordance with subparagraph (B) of this  | 
|  | 
| paragraph (2), into a normal curve equivalent score to  | 
| determine each Organizational Unit's relative position  | 
| to all other Organizational Units in this State.  The  | 
| calculation of Local Capacity Percentage is described  | 
| in subparagraph (C) of this paragraph (2). | 
|             (B) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio  | 
| in a given year is the percentage obtained by dividing  | 
| its Adjusted EAV or PTELL EAV, whichever is less, by  | 
| its Adequacy Target, with the resulting ratio further  | 
| adjusted as follows:  | 
|                 (i)  for Organizational Units serving grades  | 
| kindergarten through 12 and Hybrid Districts, no  | 
| further adjustments shall be made; | 
|                 (ii) for Organizational Units serving grades  | 
| kindergarten through 8, the ratio shall be  | 
| multiplied by 9/13; | 
|                 (iii) for Organizational Units serving grades  | 
| 9 through 12, the Local Capacity Ratio shall be  | 
| multiplied by 4/13; and | 
|                 (iv) for an Organizational Unit with a  | 
| different grade configuration than those specified  | 
| in items (i) through (iii) of this subparagraph  | 
| (B), the State Superintendent shall determine a  | 
| comparable adjustment based on the grades served.  | 
|             (C) Local Capacity Percentage converts each  | 
| Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio to a normal  | 
|  | 
| curve equivalent score to determine each  | 
| Organizational Unit's relative position to all other  | 
| Organizational Units in this State. The Local Capacity  | 
| Percentage normal curve equivalent score for each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall be calculated using the  | 
| standard normal distribution of the score in relation  | 
| to the weighted mean and weighted standard deviation  | 
| and Local Capacity Ratios of all Organizational Units.  | 
| If the value assigned to any Organizational Unit is in  | 
| excess of 90%, the value shall be adjusted to 90%.  For  | 
| Laboratory Schools, the Local Capacity Percentage  | 
| shall be set at 10% in
recognition of the absence of  | 
| EAV and resources from the public university that are  | 
| allocated to
the Laboratory School. The weighted mean  | 
| for the Local Capacity Percentage shall be determined  | 
| by multiplying each Organizational Unit's Local  | 
| Capacity Ratio times the ASE for the unit creating a  | 
| weighted value, summing the weighted values of all  | 
| Organizational Units, and dividing by the total ASE of  | 
| all Organizational Units. The weighted standard  | 
| deviation shall be determined by taking the square root  | 
| of the weighted variance of all Organizational Units'  | 
| Local Capacity Ratio, where the variance is calculated  | 
| by squaring the difference between each unit's Local  | 
| Capacity Ratio and the weighted mean, then multiplying  | 
| the variance for each unit times the ASE for the unit  | 
|  | 
| to create a weighted variance for each unit, then  | 
| summing all units' weighted variance and dividing by  | 
| the total ASE of all units. | 
|             (D) For any Organizational Unit, the  | 
| Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity Target  | 
| shall be reduced by either (i) the school board's  | 
| remaining contribution pursuant to paragraph (ii) of  | 
| subsection (b-4) of Section 16-158 of the Illinois  | 
| Pension Code in a given year, or (ii) the board of  | 
| education's remaining contribution pursuant to  | 
| paragraph (iv) of subsection (b) of Section 17-129 of  | 
| the Illinois Pension Code absent the employer normal  | 
| cost portion of the required contribution and amount  | 
| allowed pursuant to subdivision (3) of Section  | 
| 17-142.1 of the Illinois Pension Code in a given year.  | 
| In the preceding sentence, item (i) shall be certified  | 
| to the State Board of Education by the Teachers'  | 
| Retirement System of the State of Illinois and item  | 
| (ii) shall be certified to the State Board of Education  | 
| by the Public School Teachers' Pension and Retirement  | 
| Fund of the City of Chicago.  | 
|         (3) If an Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are more  | 
| than its Local Capacity Target, then its Local Capacity  | 
| shall equal an Adjusted Local Capacity Target as calculated  | 
| in accordance with this paragraph (3).  The Adjusted Local  | 
| Capacity Target is calculated as the sum of the  | 
|  | 
| Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target and its Real  | 
| Receipts Adjustment.  The Real Receipts Adjustment equals  | 
| the Organizational Unit's Real Receipts less its Local  | 
| Capacity Target, with the resulting figure multiplied by  | 
| the Local Capacity Percentage. | 
|         As used in this paragraph (3), "Real Percent of  | 
| Adequacy" means the sum of an Organizational Unit's Real  | 
| Receipts, CPPRT, and Base Funding Minimum, with the  | 
| resulting figure divided by the Organizational Unit's  | 
| Adequacy Target.  | 
|     (d) Calculation of Real Receipts, EAV, and Adjusted EAV for  | 
| purposes of the Local Capacity calculation.  | 
|         (1) An Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are the  | 
| product of its Applicable Tax Rate and its Adjusted EAV.  An  | 
| Organizational Unit's Applicable Tax Rate is its Adjusted  | 
| Operating Tax Rate for property within the Organizational  | 
| Unit. | 
|         (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the  | 
| Equalized Assessed Valuation, or EAV, of all taxable  | 
| property of each Organizational Unit as of September 30 of  | 
| the previous year in accordance with paragraph (3) of this  | 
| subsection (d).  The State Superintendent shall then  | 
| determine the Adjusted EAV of each Organizational Unit in  | 
| accordance with paragraph (4) of this subsection (d), which  | 
| Adjusted EAV figure shall be used for the purposes of  | 
| calculating Local Capacity. | 
|  | 
|         (3) To calculate Real Receipts and EAV, the Department  | 
| of Revenue shall supply to the State Superintendent the  | 
| value as equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue  | 
| of all taxable property of every Organizational Unit,  | 
| together with (i) the applicable tax rate used in extending  | 
| taxes for the funds of the Organizational Unit as of  | 
| September 30 of the previous year and (ii) the limiting  | 
| rate for all Organizational Units subject to property tax  | 
| extension limitations as imposed under PTELL.  | 
|             (A) The Department of Revenue shall add to the  | 
| equalized assessed value of all taxable property of  | 
| each Organizational Unit situated entirely or  | 
| partially within a county that is or was subject to the  | 
| provisions of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property  | 
| Tax Code (i) an amount equal to the total amount by  | 
| which the homestead exemption allowed under Section  | 
| 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code for real  | 
| property situated in that Organizational Unit exceeds  | 
| the total amount that would have been allowed in that  | 
| Organizational Unit if the maximum reduction under  | 
| Section 15-176 was (I) $4,500 in Cook County or $3,500  | 
| in all other counties in tax year 2003 or (II) $5,000  | 
| in all counties in tax year 2004 and thereafter and  | 
| (ii) an amount equal to the aggregate amount for the  | 
| taxable year of all additional exemptions under  | 
| Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with  | 
|  | 
| a household income of $30,000 or less. The county clerk  | 
| of any county that is or was subject to the provisions  | 
| of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code  | 
| shall annually calculate and certify to the Department  | 
| of Revenue for each Organizational Unit all homestead  | 
| exemption amounts under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the  | 
| Property Tax Code and all amounts of additional  | 
| exemptions under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax  | 
| Code for owners with a household income of $30,000 or  | 
| less. It is the intent of this subparagraph (A) that if  | 
| the general homestead exemption for a parcel of  | 
| property is determined under Section 15-176 or 15-177  | 
| of the Property Tax Code rather than Section 15-175,  | 
| then the calculation of EAV shall not be affected by  | 
| the difference, if any, between the amount of the  | 
| general homestead exemption allowed for that parcel of  | 
| property under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property  | 
| Tax Code and the amount that would have been allowed  | 
| had the general homestead exemption for that parcel of  | 
| property been determined under Section 15-175 of the  | 
| Property Tax Code. It is further the intent of this  | 
| subparagraph (A) that if additional exemptions are  | 
| allowed under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code  | 
| for owners with a household income of less than  | 
| $30,000, then the calculation of EAV shall not be  | 
| affected by the difference, if any, because of those  | 
|  | 
| additional exemptions. | 
|             (B) With respect to any part of an Organizational  | 
| Unit within a redevelopment project area in respect to  | 
| which a municipality has adopted tax increment  | 
| allocation financing pursuant to the Tax Increment  | 
| Allocation Redevelopment Act, Division 74.4 of the  | 
| Illinois Municipal Code, or the Industrial Jobs  | 
| Recovery Law, Division 74.6 of the Illinois Municipal  | 
| Code, no part of the current EAV of real property  | 
| located in any such project area which is attributable  | 
| to an increase above the total initial EAV of such  | 
| property shall be used as part of the EAV of the  | 
| Organizational Unit, until such time as all  | 
| redevelopment project costs have been paid, as  | 
| provided in Section 11-74.4-8 of the Tax Increment  | 
| Allocation Redevelopment Act or in Section 11-74.6-35  | 
| of the Industrial Jobs Recovery Law. For the purpose of  | 
| the EAV of the Organizational Unit, the total initial  | 
| EAV or the current EAV, whichever is lower, shall be  | 
| used until such time as all redevelopment project costs  | 
| have been paid. | 
|             (C) For Organizational Units that are Hybrid  | 
| Districts, the State Superintendent shall use the  | 
| lesser of the equalized assessed valuation for  | 
| property within the partial elementary unit district  | 
| for elementary purposes, as defined in Article 11E of  | 
|  | 
| this Code, or the equalized assessed valuation for  | 
| property within the partial elementary unit district  | 
| for high school purposes, as defined in Article 11E of  | 
| this Code.  | 
|         (4) An Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV shall be the  | 
| average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 3 years  | 
| or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if the EAV in  | 
| the immediately preceding year has declined by 10% or more  | 
| compared to the 3-year average. In the event of  | 
| Organizational Unit reorganization, consolidation, or  | 
| annexation, the Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV for the  | 
| first 3 years after such change shall be as follows:   the  | 
| most current EAV shall be used in the first year, the  | 
| average of a 2-year EAV or its EAV in the immediately  | 
| preceding year if the EAV declines by 10% or more compared  | 
| to the 2-year average for the second year, and a 3-year  | 
| average EAV or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if  | 
| the adjusted EAV declines by 10% or more compared to the  | 
| 3-year average for the third year.  | 
|         "PTELL EAV" means a figure calculated by the State  | 
| Board for Organizational Units subject to PTELL as  | 
| described in this paragraph (4) for the purposes of  | 
| calculating an Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio.  | 
| Except as otherwise provided in this paragraph (4), for an  | 
| Organizational Unit that has approved or does approve an  | 
| increase in its limiting rate, the PTELL EAV of an  | 
|  | 
| Organizational Unit shall be equal to the product of the  | 
| equalized assessed valuation last used in the calculation  | 
| of general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of this Code or  | 
| Evidence-Based Funding under this Section and the  | 
| Organizational Unit's Extension Limitation Ratio. If an  | 
| Organizational Unit has approved or does approve an  | 
| increase in its limiting rate, pursuant to Section 18-190  | 
| of the Property Tax Code, affecting the Base Tax Year, the  | 
| PTELL EAV shall be equal to the product of the equalized  | 
| assessed valuation last used in the calculation of general  | 
| State aid under Section 18-8.05 of this Code or  | 
| Evidence-Based Funding under this Section multiplied by an  | 
| amount equal to one plus the percentage increase, if any,  | 
| in the Consumer Price Index for All Urban Consumers for all  | 
| items published by the United States Department of Labor  | 
| for the 12-month calendar year preceding the Base Tax Year,  | 
| plus the equalized assessed valuation of new property,  | 
| annexed property, and recovered tax increment value and  | 
| minus the equalized assessed valuation of disconnected  | 
| property. | 
|         As used in this paragraph (4), "new property" and  | 
| "recovered tax increment value" shall have the meanings set  | 
| forth in the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law. | 
|     (e) Base Funding Minimum calculation.  | 
|         (1) For the 2017-2018 school year, the Base Funding  | 
| Minimum of an Organizational Unit, other than a Specially  | 
|  | 
| Funded Unit, shall be the amount of State funds distributed  | 
| to the Organizational Unit during the 2016-2017 school year  | 
| prior to any adjustments and specified appropriation  | 
| amounts described in this paragraph (1) from the following  | 
| Sections, as calculated by the State Superintendent:   | 
| Section 18-8.05 of this Code (general State aid); Section 5  | 
| of Article 224 of Public Act 99-524 (equity grants);  | 
| Section 14-7.02b of this Code (funding for children  | 
| requiring special education services); Section 14-13.01 of  | 
| this Code (special education facilities and staffing),  | 
| except for reimbursement of the cost of transportation  | 
| pursuant to Section 14-13.01; Section 14C-12 of this Code  | 
| (English learners); and Section 18-4.3 of this Code (summer  | 
| school), based on an appropriation level of $13,121,600.   | 
| For a school district organized under Article 34 of this  | 
| Code, the Base Funding Minimum also includes (i) the funds  | 
| allocated to the school district pursuant to Section 1D-1  | 
| of this Code attributable to funding programs authorized by  | 
| the Sections of this Code listed in the preceding sentence;  | 
| and (ii) the difference between (I) the funds allocated to  | 
| the school district pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code  | 
| attributable to the funding programs authorized by Section  | 
| 14-7.02 (non-public special education reimbursement),  | 
| subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 (special education  | 
| transportation), Section 29-5 (transportation), Section  | 
| 2-3.80 (agricultural education), Section 2-3.66 (truants'  | 
|  | 
| alternative education), Section 2-3.62 (educational  | 
| service centers), and Section 14-7.03 (special education –  | 
| orphanage) of this Code and Section 15 of the Childhood  | 
| Hunger Relief Act (free breakfast program) and (II) the  | 
| school district's actual expenditures for its non-public  | 
| special education, special education transportation,  | 
| transportation programs, agricultural education, truants'  | 
| alternative education, services that would otherwise be  | 
| performed by a regional office of education, special  | 
| education orphanage expenditures, and free breakfast, as  | 
| most recently calculated and reported pursuant to  | 
| subsection (f) of Section 1D-1 of this Code. For Specially  | 
| Funded Units, the Base Funding Minimum shall be the total  | 
| amount of State funds allotted to the Specially Funded Unit  | 
| during the 2016-2017 school year. The Base Funding Minimum  | 
| for Glenwood Academy shall be $625,500. | 
|         (2) For the 2018-2019 and subsequent school years, the  | 
| Base Funding Minimum of Organizational Units and Specially  | 
| Funded Units shall be the sum of (i) the amount of  | 
| Evidence-Based Funding for the prior school year and (ii)  | 
| the Base Funding Minimum for the prior school year.  | 
|     (f) Percent of Adequacy and Final Resources calculation.  | 
|         (1) The Evidence-Based Funding formula establishes a  | 
| Percent of Adequacy for each Organizational Unit in order  | 
| to place such units into tiers for the purposes of the  | 
| funding distribution system described in subsection (g) of  | 
|  | 
| this Section.  Initially, an Organizational Unit's  | 
| Preliminary Resources and Preliminary Percent of Adequacy  | 
| are calculated pursuant to paragraph (2) of this subsection  | 
| (f).  Then, an Organizational Unit's Final Resources and  | 
| Final Percent of Adequacy are calculated to account for the  | 
| Organizational Unit's poverty concentration levels  | 
| pursuant to paragraphs (3) and (4) of this subsection (f). | 
|         (2) An Organizational Unit's Preliminary Resources are  | 
| equal to the sum of its Local Capacity Target, CPPRT, and  | 
| Base Funding Minimum.  An Organizational Unit's Preliminary  | 
| Percent of Adequacy is the lesser of (i) its Preliminary  | 
| Resources divided by its Adequacy Target or (ii) 100%. | 
|         (3) Except for Specially Funded Units, an  | 
| Organizational Unit's Final Resources are equal the sum of  | 
| its Local Capacity, CPPRT, and Adjusted Base Funding  | 
| Minimum.  The Base Funding Minimum of each Specially Funded  | 
| Unit shall serve as its Final Resources, except that the  | 
| Base Funding Minimum for State-approved charter schools  | 
| shall not include any portion of general State aid  | 
| allocated in the prior year based on the per capita tuition  | 
| charge times the charter school enrollment. | 
|         (4) An Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy  | 
| is its Final Resources divided by its Adequacy Target. An  | 
| Organizational Unit's Adjusted Base Funding Minimum is  | 
| equal to its Base Funding Minimum less its Supplemental  | 
| Grant Funding, with the resulting figure added to the  | 
|  | 
| product of its Supplemental Grant Funding and Preliminary  | 
| Percent of Adequacy.  | 
|     (g) Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system.  | 
|         (1) In each school year under the Evidence-Based  | 
| Funding formula, each Organizational Unit receives funding  | 
| equal to the sum of its Base Funding Minimum and the unit's  | 
| allocation of New State Funds determined pursuant to this  | 
| subsection (g).  To allocate New State Funds, the  | 
| Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system first  | 
| places all Organizational Units into one of 4 tiers in  | 
| accordance with paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), based  | 
| on the Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy.  New  | 
| State Funds are allocated to each of the 4 tiers as  | 
| follows:  Tier 1 Aggregate Funding equals 50% of all New  | 
| State Funds,  Tier 2 Aggregate Funding equals 49% of all New  | 
| State Funds, Tier 3 Aggregate Funding equals 0.9% of all  | 
| New State Funds, and Tier 4 Aggregate Funding equals 0.1%  | 
| of all New State Funds.  Each Organizational Unit within  | 
| Tier 1 or Tier 2 receives an allocation of New State Funds  | 
| equal to its tier Funding Gap, as defined in the following  | 
| sentence, multiplied by the tier's Allocation Rate  | 
| determined pursuant to paragraph (4) of this subsection  | 
| (g).  For Tier 1, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap  | 
| equals the tier's Target Ratio, as specified in paragraph  | 
| (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the  | 
| Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting  | 
|  | 
| amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final  | 
| Resources.  For Tier 2, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap  | 
| equals the tier's Target Ratio, as described in paragraph  | 
| (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the  | 
| Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting  | 
| amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final  | 
| Resources and its Tier 1 funding allocation.  To determine  | 
| the Organizational Unit's Funding Gap, the resulting  | 
| amount is then multiplied by a factor equal to one minus  | 
| the Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target  | 
| percentage.   Each Organizational Unit within Tier 3 or Tier  | 
| 4 receives an allocation of New State Funds equal to the  | 
| product of its Adequacy Target and the tier's Allocation  | 
| Rate, as specified in paragraph (4) of this subsection (g). | 
|         (2) To ensure equitable distribution of dollars for all  | 
| Tier 2 Organizational Units, no Tier 2 Organizational Unit  | 
| shall receive fewer dollars per ASE than any Tier 3  | 
| Organizational Unit. Each Tier 2 and Tier 3 Organizational  | 
| Unit shall have its funding allocation divided by its ASE.  | 
| Any Tier 2 Organizational Unit with a funding allocation  | 
| per ASE below the greatest Tier 3 allocation per ASE shall  | 
| get a funding allocation equal to the greatest Tier 3  | 
| funding allocation per ASE multiplied by the  | 
| Organizational Unit's ASE. Each Tier 2 Organizational  | 
| Unit's Tier 2 funding allocation shall be multiplied by the  | 
| percentage calculated by dividing the original Tier 2  | 
|  | 
| Aggregate Funding by the sum of all Tier 2 Organizational  | 
| Unit's Tier 2 funding allocation after adjusting  | 
| districts' funding below Tier 3 levels.  | 
|         (3) Organizational Units are placed into one of 4 tiers  | 
| as follows:  | 
|             (A) Tier 1 consists of all Organizational Units,  | 
| except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of  | 
| Adequacy less than the Tier 1 Target Ratio. The Tier 1  | 
| Target Ratio is the ratio level that allows for Tier 1  | 
| Aggregate Funding to be distributed, with the Tier 1  | 
| Allocation Rate determined pursuant to paragraph (4)  | 
| of this subsection (g). | 
|             (B) Tier 2 consists of all Tier 1 Units and all  | 
| other Organizational Units, except for Specially  | 
| Funded Units, with a Percent of Adequacy of less than  | 
| 0.90. | 
|             (C) Tier 3 consists of all Organizational Units,  | 
| except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of  | 
| Adequacy of at least 0.90 and less than 1.0. | 
|             (D) Tier 4 consists of all Organizational Units  | 
| with a Percent of Adequacy of at least 1.0 and  | 
| Specially Funded Units, excluding Glenwood Academy.  | 
|         (4)  The Allocation Rates for Tiers 1 through 4 is  | 
| determined as follows:  | 
|             (A) The Tier 1 Allocation Rate is 30%. | 
|             (B) The Tier 2 Allocation Rate is the result of the  | 
|  | 
| following equation:  Tier 2 Aggregate Funding, divided  | 
| by the sum of the Funding Gaps for all Tier 2  | 
| Organizational Units, unless the result of such  | 
| equation is higher than 1.0.  If the result of such  | 
| equation is higher than 1.0, then the Tier 2 Allocation  | 
| Rate is 1.0.  | 
|             (C) The Tier 3 Allocation Rate is the result of the  | 
| following equation: Tier 3
Aggregate Funding, divided  | 
| by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 3  | 
| Organizational
Units. | 
|             (D) The Tier 4 Allocation Rate is the result of the  | 
| following equation: Tier 4
Aggregate Funding, divided  | 
| by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 4  | 
| Organizational
Units.  | 
|         (5) A tier's Target Ratio is determined as follows:  | 
|             (A) The Tier 1 Target Ratio is the ratio level that  | 
| allows for Tier 1 Aggregate Funding to be distributed  | 
| with the Tier 1 Allocation Rate. | 
|             (B) The Tier 2 Target Ratio is 0.90. | 
|             (C) The Tier 3 Target Ratio is 1.0. | 
|         (6) If, at any point, the Tier 1 Target Ratio is  | 
| greater than 90%, than all Tier 1 funding shall be  | 
| allocated to Tier 2 and no Tier 1 Organizational Unit's  | 
| funding may be identified. | 
|         (7) In the event that all Tier 2 Organizational Units  | 
| receive funding at the Tier 2 Target Ratio level, any  | 
|  | 
| remaining New State Funds shall be allocated to Tier 3 and  | 
| Tier 4 Organizational Units.  | 
|         (8) If any Specially Funded Units, excluding Glenwood  | 
| Academy, recognized by the State Board  do not qualify for  | 
| direct funding following the implementation of this  | 
| amendatory Act of the 100th General Assembly from any of  | 
| the funding sources included within the definition of Base  | 
| Funding Minimum, the unqualified portion of the Base  | 
| Funding Minimum shall be transferred to one or more  | 
| appropriate Organizational Units as determined by the  | 
| State Superintendent based on the prior year ASE of the  | 
| Organizational Units. | 
|         (9) The Minimum Funding Level is intended to establish  | 
| a target for State funding that will keep pace with  | 
| inflation and continue to advance equity through the  | 
| Evidence-Based Funding formula. The target for State  | 
| funding of New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds is  | 
| $50,000,000 for State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State  | 
| fiscal years. The Minimum Funding Level is equal to  | 
| $350,000,000. In addition to any New State Funds, no more  | 
| than $50,000,000 New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds may be  | 
| counted towards the Minimum Funding Level. If the sum of  | 
| New State Funds and applicable New Property Tax Relief Pool  | 
| Funds are less than the Minimum Funding Level, than funding  | 
| for tiers shall be reduced in the following manner: | 
|             (A) First, Tier 4 funding shall be reduced by an  | 
|  | 
| amount equal to the difference between the Minimum  | 
| Funding Level and New State Funds until such time as  | 
| Tier 4 funding is exhausted. | 
|             (B) Next, Tier 3 funding shall be reduced by an  | 
| amount equal to the difference between the Minimum  | 
| Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in  | 
| Tier 4 funding until such time as Tier 3 funding is  | 
| exhausted. | 
|             (C) Next, Tier 2 funding shall be reduced by an  | 
| amount equal to the difference between the Minimum  | 
| Funding level and new State Funds and the reduction  | 
| Tier 4 and Tier 3. | 
|             (D) Finally, Tier 1 funding shall be reduced by an  | 
| amount equal to the difference between the Minimum  | 
| Funding level and New State Funds and the reduction in  | 
| Tier 2, 3, and 4 funding. In addition, the Allocation  | 
| Rate for Tier 1 shall be reduced to a percentage equal  | 
| to 50%, multiplied by the result of New State Funds  | 
| divided by the Minimum Funding Level. | 
|         (9.5) For State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State  | 
| fiscal years, if New State Funds exceed $300,000,000, then  | 
| any amount in excess of $300,000,000 shall be dedicated for  | 
| purposes of Section 2-3.170 of this Code up to a maximum of  | 
| $50,000,000.  | 
|         (10) In the event of a decrease in the amount of the  | 
| appropriation for this Section in any fiscal year after  | 
|  | 
| implementation of this Section, the Organizational Units  | 
| receiving Tier 1 and Tier 2 funding, as determined under  | 
| paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), shall be held  | 
| harmless by establishing a Base Funding Guarantee equal to  | 
| the per pupil kindergarten through grade 12 funding  | 
| received in accordance with this Section in the prior  | 
| fiscal year. Reductions shall be
made to the Base Funding  | 
| Minimum of Organizational Units in Tier 3 and Tier 4 on a
 | 
| per pupil basis equivalent to the total number of the ASE  | 
| in Tier 3-funded and Tier 4-funded Organizational Units  | 
| divided by the total reduction in State funding. The Base
 | 
| Funding Minimum as reduced shall continue to be applied to  | 
| Tier 3 and Tier 4
Organizational Units and adjusted by the  | 
| relative formula when increases in
appropriations for this  | 
| Section resume. In no event may State funding reductions to
 | 
| Organizational Units in Tier 3 or Tier 4 exceed an amount  | 
| that would be less than the
Base Funding Minimum  | 
| established in the first year of implementation of this
 | 
| Section. If additional reductions are required, all school  | 
| districts shall receive a
reduction by a per pupil amount  | 
| equal to the aggregate additional appropriation
reduction  | 
| divided by the total ASE of all Organizational Units.  | 
|         (11) The State Superintendent shall make minor  | 
| adjustments to the distribution formula set forth in this  | 
| subsection (g) to account for the rounding of percentages  | 
| to the nearest tenth of a percentage and dollar amounts to  | 
|  | 
| the nearest whole dollar.  | 
|     (h) State Superintendent administration of funding and  | 
| district submission requirements.  | 
|         (1) The State Superintendent shall, in accordance with  | 
| appropriations made by the General Assembly, meet the  | 
| funding obligations created under this Section. | 
|         (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the  | 
| Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit and Net State  | 
| Contribution Target for each Organizational Unit under  | 
| this Section. The State Superintendent shall also certify  | 
| the actual amounts of the New State Funds payable for each  | 
| eligible Organizational Unit based on the equitable  | 
| distribution calculation to the unit's treasurer, as soon  | 
| as possible after such amounts are calculated, including  | 
| any applicable adjusted charge-off increase. No  | 
| Evidence-Based Funding shall be distributed within an  | 
| Organizational Unit without the approval of the unit's  | 
| school board. | 
|         (3) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate  | 
| and report to each Organizational Unit the unit's aggregate  | 
| financial adequacy amount, which shall be the sum of the  | 
| Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit. The State  | 
| Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for  | 
| each Organizational Unit the unit's total State funds  | 
| allocated for its students with disabilities. The State  | 
| Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for  | 
|  | 
| each Organizational Unit the amount of funding and  | 
| applicable FTE calculated for each Essential Element of the  | 
| unit's Adequacy Target. | 
|         (4) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate  | 
| and report to each Organizational Unit the amount the unit  | 
| must expend on special education and bilingual education  | 
| pursuant to the unit's Base Funding Minimum, Special  | 
| Education Allocation, and Bilingual Education Allocation. | 
|         (5) Moneys distributed under this Section shall be  | 
| calculated on a school year basis, but paid on a fiscal  | 
| year basis, with payments beginning in August and extending  | 
| through June. Unless otherwise provided, the moneys  | 
| appropriated for each fiscal year shall be distributed in  | 
| 22 equal payments at least 2 times monthly to each  | 
| Organizational Unit. The State Board shall publish a yearly  | 
| distribution schedule at its meeting in June. If moneys  | 
| appropriated for any fiscal year are distributed other than  | 
| monthly, the distribution shall be on the same basis for  | 
| each Organizational Unit. | 
|         (6) Any school district that fails, for any given  | 
| school year, to maintain school as required by law or to  | 
| maintain a recognized school is not eligible to receive  | 
| Evidence-Based Funding.  In case of non-recognition of one  | 
| or more attendance centers in a school district otherwise  | 
| operating recognized schools, the claim of the district  | 
| shall be reduced in the proportion that the enrollment in  | 
|  | 
| the attendance center or centers bears to the enrollment of  | 
| the school district.   "Recognized school" means any public  | 
| school that meets the standards for recognition by the  | 
| State Board.  A school district or attendance center not  | 
| having recognition status at the end of a school term is  | 
| entitled to receive State aid payments due upon a legal  | 
| claim that was filed while it was recognized. | 
|         (7) School district claims filed under this Section are  | 
| subject to Sections 18-9 and 18-12 of this Code, except as  | 
| otherwise provided in this Section. | 
|         (8) Each fiscal year, the State Superintendent shall  | 
| calculate for each Organizational Unit an amount of its  | 
| Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based Funding that shall  | 
| be deemed attributable to the provision of special  | 
| educational facilities and services, as defined in Section  | 
| 14-1.08 of this Code, in a manner that ensures compliance  | 
| with maintenance of State financial support requirements  | 
| under the federal Individuals with Disabilities Education  | 
| Act.  An Organizational Unit must use such funds only for  | 
| the provision of special educational facilities and  | 
| services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this Code, and  | 
| must comply with any expenditure verification procedures  | 
| adopted by the State Board. | 
|         (9) All Organizational Units in this State must submit  | 
| annual spending plans by the end of September of each year  | 
| to the State Board as part of the annual budget process,  | 
|  | 
| which shall describe how each Organizational Unit will  | 
| utilize the Base Minimum Funding and Evidence-Based  | 
| funding it receives from this State under this Section with  | 
| specific identification of the intended utilization of  | 
| Low-Income, English learner, and special education  | 
| resources. Additionally, the annual spending plans of each  | 
| Organizational Unit shall describe how the Organizational  | 
| Unit expects to achieve student growth and how the  | 
| Organizational Unit will achieve State education goals, as  | 
| defined by the State Board. The State Superintendent may,  | 
| from time to time, identify additional requisites for  | 
| Organizational Units to satisfy when compiling the annual  | 
| spending plans required under this subsection (h). The  | 
| format and scope of annual spending plans shall be  | 
| developed by the State Superintendent in conjunction with  | 
| the Professional Review Panel. | 
|         (10) No later than January 1, 2018, the State  | 
| Superintendent shall develop a 5-year strategic plan for  | 
| all Organizational Units to help in planning for adequacy  | 
| funding under this Section. The State Superintendent shall  | 
| submit the plan to the Governor and the General Assembly,  | 
| as provided in Section 3.1 of the General Assembly  | 
| Organization Act. The plan shall include recommendations  | 
| for:  | 
|             (A) a framework for collaborative, professional,  | 
| innovative, and 21st century learning environments  | 
|  | 
| using the Evidence-Based Funding model; | 
|             (B) ways to prepare and support this State's  | 
| educators for successful instructional careers; | 
|             (C) application and enhancement of the current  | 
| financial accountability measures, the approved State  | 
| plan to comply with the federal Every Student Succeeds  | 
| Act,  and the Illinois Balanced Accountability Measures  | 
| in relation to student growth and elements of the  | 
| Evidence-Based Funding model; and | 
|             (D) implementation of an effective school adequacy  | 
| funding system based on projected and recommended  | 
| funding levels from the General Assembly.  | 
|     (i) Professional Review Panel.  | 
|         (1) A Professional Review Panel is created to study and  | 
| review the implementation and effect of the Evidence-Based  | 
| Funding model under this Section and to recommend continual  | 
| recalibration and future study topics and modifications to  | 
| the Evidence-Based Funding model. The Panel shall elect a  | 
| chairperson and vice chairperson by a majority vote of the  | 
| Panel and shall advance recommendations based on a majority  | 
| vote of the Panel. A minority opinion may also accompany  | 
| any recommendation of the majority of the Panel. The Panel  | 
| shall be appointed by the State Superintendent, except as  | 
| otherwise provided in paragraph (2) of this subsection (i)  | 
| and include the following members:  | 
|             (A) Two appointees that represent district  | 
|  | 
| superintendents, recommended by a statewide  | 
| organization that represents district superintendents. | 
|             (B) Two appointees that represent school boards,  | 
| recommended by a statewide organization that  | 
| represents school boards. | 
|             (C) Two appointees from districts that represent  | 
| school business officials, recommended by a statewide  | 
| organization that represents school business  | 
| officials. | 
|             (D) Two appointees that represent school  | 
| principals, recommended by a statewide organization  | 
| that represents school principals. | 
|             (E) Two appointees that represent teachers,  | 
| recommended by a statewide organization that  | 
| represents teachers. | 
|             (F) Two appointees that represent teachers,  | 
| recommended by another statewide organization that  | 
| represents teachers. | 
|             (G) Two appointees that represent regional  | 
| superintendents of schools, recommended by  | 
| organizations that represent regional superintendents. | 
|             (H) Two independent experts selected solely by the  | 
| State Superintendent. | 
|             (I) Two independent experts recommended by public  | 
| universities in this State. | 
|             (J) One member recommended by a statewide  | 
|  | 
| organization that represents parents. | 
|             (K) Two representatives recommended by collective  | 
| impact organizations that represent major metropolitan  | 
| areas or geographic areas in Illinois. | 
|             (L) One member from a statewide organization  | 
| focused on research-based education policy to support  | 
| a school system that prepares all students for college,  | 
| a career, and democratic citizenship.  | 
|             (M) One representative from a school district  | 
| organized under Article 34 of this Code.  | 
|         The State Superintendent shall ensure that the  | 
| membership of the Panel includes representatives from  | 
| school districts and communities reflecting the  | 
| geographic, socio-economic, racial, and ethnic diversity  | 
| of this State.  The State Superintendent shall additionally  | 
| ensure that the membership of the Panel includes  | 
| representatives with expertise in bilingual education and  | 
| special education. Staff from the State Board shall staff  | 
| the Panel.  | 
|         (2) In addition to those Panel members appointed by the  | 
| State Superintendent, 4 members of the General Assembly  | 
| shall be appointed as follows: one member of the House of  | 
| Representatives appointed by the Speaker of the House of  | 
| Representatives, one member of the Senate appointed by the  | 
| President of the Senate, one member of the House of  | 
| Representatives appointed by the Minority Leader of the  | 
|  | 
| House of Representatives, and one member of the Senate  | 
| appointed by the Minority Leader of the Senate. There shall  | 
| be one additional member appointed by the Governor.  All  | 
| members appointed by legislative leaders or the Governor  | 
| shall be non-voting, ex officio members. | 
|         (3) On an annual basis, the State Superintendent  shall  | 
| recalibrate the following per pupil elements of the  | 
| Adequacy Target and applied to the formulas, based on the  | 
| Panel's study of average expenses as reported in the most  | 
| recent annual financial report:  | 
|             (A) gifted under subparagraph (M) of paragraph (2)  | 
| of subsection (b) of this Section; | 
|             (B) instructional materials under subparagraph (O)  | 
| of paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this Section; | 
|             (C) assessment under subparagraph (P) of paragraph  | 
| (2) of subsection (b) of this Section; | 
|             (D) student activities under subparagraph (R) of  | 
| paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this Section; | 
|             (E) maintenance and operations under subparagraph  | 
| (S) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this Section;  | 
| and | 
|             (F) central office under subparagraph (T) of  | 
| paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this Section.  | 
|         (4) On a periodic basis, the Panel shall study all the  | 
| following elements and make recommendations to the State  | 
| Board, the General Assembly, and the Governor for  | 
|  | 
| modification of this Section:  | 
|             (A) The format and scope of annual spending plans  | 
| referenced in paragraph (9) of subsection (h) of this  | 
| Section. | 
|             (B) The Comparable Wage Index under this Section,  | 
| to be studied by the Panel and reestablished by the  | 
| State Superintendent every 5 years. | 
|             (C) Maintenance and operations. Within 5 years  | 
| after the implementation of this Section, the Panel  | 
| shall make recommendations for the further study of  | 
| maintenance and operations costs, including capital  | 
| maintenance costs, and recommend any additional  | 
| reporting data required from Organizational Units. | 
|             (D) "At-risk student" definition. Within 5 years  | 
| after the implementation of this Section, the Panel  | 
| shall make recommendations for the further study and  | 
| determination of an "at-risk student" definition.  | 
| Within 5 years after the implementation of this  | 
| Section, the Panel shall evaluate and make  | 
| recommendations regarding adequate funding for poverty  | 
| concentration under the Evidence-Based Funding model. | 
|             (E) Benefits. Within 5 years after the  | 
| implementation of this Section, the Panel shall make  | 
| recommendations for further study of benefit costs. | 
|             (F) Technology. The per pupil target for  | 
| technology shall be reviewed every 3 years to determine  | 
|  | 
| whether current allocations are sufficient to develop  | 
| 21st century learning in all classrooms in this State  | 
| and supporting a one-to-one technological device  | 
| program in each school. Recommendations shall be made  | 
| no later than 3 years after the implementation of this  | 
| Section. | 
|             (G) Local Capacity Target. Within 3 years after the  | 
| implementation of this Section, the Panel shall make  | 
| recommendations for any additional data desired to  | 
| analyze possible modifications to the Local Capacity  | 
| Target, to be based on measures in addition to solely  | 
| EAV and to be completed within 5 years after  | 
| implementation of this Section. | 
|             (H) Funding for Alternative Schools, Laboratory  | 
| Schools, safe schools, and alternative learning  | 
| opportunities programs. By the beginning of the  | 
| 2021-2022 school year, the Panel shall study and make  | 
| recommendations regarding the funding levels for  | 
| Alternative Schools, Laboratory Schools, safe schools,  | 
| and alternative learning opportunities programs in  | 
| this State. | 
|             (I) Funding for college and career acceleration  | 
| strategies. By the beginning of the 2021-2022 school  | 
| year, the Panel shall study and make recommendations  | 
| regarding funding levels to support college and career  | 
| acceleration strategies in high school that have been  | 
|  | 
| demonstrated to result in improved secondary and  | 
| postsecondary outcomes, including Advanced Placement,  | 
| dual-credit opportunities, and college and career  | 
| pathway systems. | 
|             (J) Special education investments. By the  | 
| beginning of the 2021-2022 school year, the Panel shall  | 
| study and make recommendations on whether and how to  | 
| account for disability types within the special  | 
| education funding category.  | 
|             (K) Early childhood investments. In collaboration  | 
| with the Illinois Early Learning Council, the Panel  | 
| shall include an analysis of what level of Preschool  | 
| for All Children funding would be necessary to serve  | 
| all children ages 0 through 5 years in the  | 
| highest-priority service tier, as specified in  | 
| paragraph (4.5) of subsection (a) of Section 2-3.71 of  | 
| this Code, and an analysis of the potential cost  | 
| savings that that level of Preschool for All Children  | 
| investment would have on the kindergarten through  | 
| grade 12 system. | 
|         (5) Within 5 years after the implementation of this  | 
| Section, the Panel shall complete an evaluative study of  | 
| the entire Evidence-Based Funding model, including an  | 
| assessment of whether or not the formula is achieving State  | 
| goals. The Panel shall report to the State Board, the  | 
| General Assembly, and the Governor on the findings of the  | 
|  | 
| study. | 
|         (6) Within 3 years after the implementation of this  | 
| Section, the Panel shall evaluate and provide  | 
| recommendations to the Governor and the General Assembly on  | 
| the hold-harmless provisions of this Section found in the  | 
| Base Funding Minimum.  | 
|     (j) References. Beginning July 1, 2017, references in other  | 
| laws to general State aid funds or calculations under Section  | 
| 18-8.05 of this Code shall be deemed to be references to  | 
| evidence-based model formula funds or calculations under this  | 
| Section. 
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/18-9)  (from Ch. 122, par. 18-9)
 | 
|     Sec. 18-9. Requirement for special equalization and  | 
| supplementary
State aid. If property comprising an aggregate  | 
| assessed valuation equal to 6% or
more
of the total assessed  | 
| valuation of all taxable property in a school district is
owned  | 
| by a
person or corporation that is the subject of bankruptcy  | 
| proceedings or that has
been
adjudged bankrupt and, as a result  | 
| thereof, has not paid taxes on the
property, then the
district  | 
| may amend its general State aid or evidence-based funding claim  | 
| (i) back to the inception of the
bankruptcy,
not to exceed 6  | 
| years, in which time those taxes were not paid and (ii) for
 | 
| each
succeeding year that those taxes remain unpaid, by adding  | 
| to the claim an
amount
determined by multiplying the assessed  | 
| valuation of the property on which taxes
have not
been paid due  | 
|  | 
| to the bankruptcy by the lesser of the total tax rate for the
 | 
| district for the
tax year for which the taxes are unpaid or the  | 
| applicable rate used in
calculating the
district's general  | 
| State aid under paragraph (3) of subsection (D) of Section
 | 
| 18-8.05 of
this Code or evidence-based funding under Section
 | 
| 18-8.15 of
this Code, as applicable. If at any time a district  | 
| that receives additional State aid under
this Section receives  | 
| tax revenue from the property for the years that taxes were not
 | 
| paid, the
district's next claim for State aid shall be reduced  | 
| in an amount equal to the
taxes paid on
the property, not to  | 
| exceed the additional State aid received under this Section.
 | 
| Claims under this Section shall be filed on forms prescribed by  | 
| the
State
Superintendent of Education, and the State  | 
| Superintendent of Education, upon
receipt of
a claim, shall  | 
| adjust the claim in accordance with the provisions of this  | 
| Section.
Supplementary State aid for each succeeding year under  | 
| this Section
shall be paid
beginning with the first general  | 
| State aid or evidence-based funding claim paid after the  | 
| district has
filed a
completed claim in accordance with this  | 
| Section.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 95-496, eff. 8-28-07.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/18-12)  (from Ch. 122, par. 18-12)
 | 
|     Sec. 18-12. Dates for filing State aid claims. The school  | 
| board of
each school district, a regional office of education,  | 
| a laboratory school, or a State-authorized charter school shall  | 
|  | 
| require teachers, principals, or
superintendents to furnish  | 
| from records kept by them such data as it
needs in preparing  | 
| and certifying to the State Superintendent of Education
 its  | 
| report of claims provided in Section
 18-8.05 of this Code.  The  | 
| claim
shall be based on the latest available equalized assessed  | 
| valuation and tax
rates, as provided in Section 18-8.05 or  | 
| 18-8.15, shall use the average
daily
attendance as determined  | 
| by the method outlined in Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15,
and shall  | 
| be
certified and filed with the State Superintendent of  | 
| Education by June 21
for districts and State-authorized charter  | 
| schools with an
official
school calendar end date before June  | 
| 15 or within 2 weeks following the
official school calendar end  | 
| date for districts, regional offices of education, laboratory  | 
| schools, or State-authorized charter schools with a school year  | 
| end date
of June 15 or later.
Failure to
so file by these  | 
| deadlines constitutes a forfeiture of the right
to
receive  | 
| payment by
the State until such claim is filed.  The
 State  | 
| Superintendent of Education shall voucher
for payment those  | 
| claims to the State Comptroller as provided in Section 18-11.
 | 
|     Except as otherwise provided in this Section, if any school  | 
| district
fails to provide the minimum school term specified
in  | 
| Section 10-19, the State aid claim for that year shall be  | 
| reduced by the
State Superintendent of Education in an amount  | 
| equivalent to 1/176 or .56818% for
each day less than the  | 
| number of days required by this Code.
 | 
|     If
the State Superintendent of Education determines that  | 
|  | 
| the failure
to
provide the minimum school term was occasioned  | 
| by an act or acts of God, or
was occasioned by conditions  | 
| beyond the control of the school district
which posed a  | 
| hazardous threat to the health and safety of pupils, the
State  | 
| aid claim need not be reduced.
 | 
|     If a school district is precluded from providing the  | 
| minimum hours of instruction required for a full day of  | 
| attendance due to an adverse weather condition or a condition  | 
| beyond the control of the school district that poses a  | 
| hazardous threat to the health and safety of students, then the  | 
| partial day of attendance may be counted if (i) the school  | 
| district has provided at least one hour of instruction prior to  | 
| the closure of the school district, (ii) a school building has  | 
| provided at least one hour of instruction prior to the closure  | 
| of the  school building, or (iii) the normal start time of the  | 
| school district is delayed. | 
|     If, prior to providing any instruction, a school district  | 
| must close one or more but not all  school buildings after  | 
| consultation with a local emergency response agency or due to a  | 
| condition beyond the control of the school district, then the  | 
| school district may claim attendance for up to 2 school days  | 
| based on the average attendance of the 3 school days  | 
| immediately preceding the closure of the affected  school  | 
| building or, if approved by the State Board of Education,  | 
| utilize the provisions of an e-learning program for the  | 
| affected school building as prescribed in Section 10-20.56 of  | 
|  | 
| this Code.  The partial or no day of attendance described in  | 
| this Section and the reasons therefore shall be certified  | 
| within a month of the closing or delayed start by the school  | 
| district superintendent to the regional superintendent of  | 
| schools for forwarding to the State Superintendent of Education  | 
| for approval. 
 | 
|     Other than the utilization of any e-learning days as  | 
| prescribed in Section 10-20.56 of this Code, no exception to  | 
| the requirement of providing a minimum school term may
be  | 
| approved by the State Superintendent of Education pursuant to  | 
| this Section
unless a school district has first used all  | 
| emergency days provided for
in its regular calendar.
 | 
|     If the State Superintendent of Education declares that an  | 
| energy
shortage exists during any part of the school year for  | 
| the State or a
designated portion of the State, a district may  | 
| operate the school
attendance centers within the district 4  | 
| days of the week during the
time of the shortage by extending  | 
| each existing school day by one clock
hour of school work, and  | 
| the State aid claim shall not be reduced, nor
shall the  | 
| employees of that district suffer any reduction in salary or
 | 
| benefits as a result thereof. A district may operate all  | 
| attendance
centers on this revised schedule, or may apply the  | 
| schedule to selected
attendance centers, taking into  | 
| consideration such factors as pupil
transportation schedules  | 
| and patterns and sources of energy for
individual attendance  | 
| centers.
 | 
|  | 
|     Electronically submitted State aid claims shall be  | 
| submitted by
duly authorized district individuals over a secure  | 
| network
that is password protected. The electronic submission  | 
| of a State aid
claim must be accompanied with an affirmation  | 
| that all of the provisions
of Sections 18-8.05, 10-22.5, and  | 
| 24-4 of this Code are
met in all respects.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 99-194, eff. 7-30-15; 99-657, eff. 7-28-16.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/26-16) | 
|     Sec. 26-16. Graduation incentives program.
 | 
|     (a)  The General Assembly finds that it is critical to  | 
| provide options for children to succeed in school.  The purpose  | 
| of this Section is to provide incentives for and encourage all  | 
| Illinois students who have experienced or are experiencing  | 
| difficulty in the traditional education system to enroll in  | 
| alternative programs. | 
|     (b)  Any student who is below the age of 20 years is  | 
| eligible to enroll in a graduation incentives program if he or  | 
| she: | 
|         (1)  is considered a dropout pursuant to Section 26-2a  | 
| of this Code; | 
|         (2)  has been suspended or expelled pursuant to Section  | 
| 10-22.6 or 34-19 of
this Code; | 
|         (3)  is pregnant or is a parent; | 
|         (4)  has been assessed as chemically dependent; or | 
|         (5)  is enrolled in a bilingual education or LEP  | 
|  | 
| program. | 
|     (c)  The following programs qualify as graduation  | 
| incentives programs for students meeting the criteria  | 
| established in this Section: | 
|         (1)  Any public elementary or secondary education  | 
| graduation incentives program established by a school  | 
| district or by a regional office of education. | 
|         (2)  Any alternative learning opportunities program  | 
| established pursuant to Article 13B of this Code. | 
|         (3)  Vocational or job training courses approved by the  | 
| State Superintendent of Education that are available  | 
| through the Illinois public community college system.   | 
| Students may apply for reimbursement of 50% of tuition  | 
| costs for one course per semester or a maximum of 3 courses  | 
| per school year.  Subject to available funds, students may  | 
| apply for reimbursement of up to 100% of tuition costs upon  | 
| a showing of employment within 6 months after completion of  | 
| a vocational or job training program. The qualifications  | 
| for reimbursement shall be established by the State  | 
| Superintendent of Education by rule. | 
|         (4)  Job and career programs approved by the State  | 
| Superintendent of Education that are available through  | 
| Illinois-accredited private business and vocational  | 
| schools.  Subject to available funds, pupils may apply for  | 
| reimbursement of up to 100% of tuition costs upon a showing  | 
| of employment within 6 months after completion of a job or  | 
|  | 
| career program.  The State Superintendent of Education  | 
| shall establish, by rule, the qualifications for  | 
| reimbursement, criteria for determining reimbursement  | 
| amounts, and limits on reimbursement. | 
|         (5)  Adult education courses that offer preparation for  | 
| high school equivalency testing. | 
|     (d)  Graduation incentives programs established by school  | 
| districts are entitled to claim general State aid and  | 
| evidence-based funding, subject to Sections 13B-50, 13B-50.5,  | 
| and 13B-50.10 of this Code. Graduation incentives programs  | 
| operated by regional offices of education are entitled to  | 
| receive general State aid and evidence-based funding at the  | 
| foundation level of support per pupil enrolled. A school  | 
| district must ensure that its graduation incentives program  | 
| receives supplemental general State aid, transportation  | 
| reimbursements, and special education resources, if  | 
| appropriate, for students enrolled in the program.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-718, eff. 1-1-15.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/27-6)  (from Ch. 122, par. 27-6)
 | 
|     Sec. 27-6. Courses in physical education required;  special  | 
| activities. 
 | 
|     (a) Pupils enrolled in the public schools and State  | 
| universities engaged in
preparing teachers shall be required to  | 
| engage
daily during the school day, except on block scheduled  | 
| days for those public schools engaged in block scheduling, in  | 
|  | 
| courses of physical education for such
periods as are
 | 
| compatible with the optimum growth and developmental needs of
 | 
| individuals at the various age levels except when appropriate  | 
| excuses
are submitted to the school by a pupil's parent or  | 
| guardian or by a person
licensed under the Medical Practice Act  | 
| of 1987 and except as provided in
subsection (b) of this  | 
| Section. A school board may determine the schedule or frequency  | 
| of physical education courses, provided that a pupil engages in  | 
| a course of physical education for a minimum of 3 days per  | 
| 5-day week. 
 | 
|     Special activities in physical education shall be provided  | 
| for pupils
whose physical or emotional condition, as determined  | 
| by a person licensed
under the Medical Practice Act of 1987,  | 
| prevents their participation in the
courses provided for normal  | 
| children.
 | 
|     (b) A school board is authorized to excuse pupils enrolled
 | 
| in grades 11 and 12 from engaging in physical education courses  | 
| if those
pupils request to be excused for any of the following  | 
| reasons: (1) for
ongoing participation in an interscholastic
 | 
| athletic program; (2) to enroll in academic classes which are  | 
| required for
admission to an institution of higher learning,  | 
| provided that failure to
take such classes will result in the  | 
| pupil being denied admission to the
institution of his or her  | 
| choice; or (3) to enroll in academic classes
which are required  | 
| for graduation from high school, provided that failure to
take  | 
| such classes will result in the pupil being unable to graduate.  | 
|  | 
| A school
board may also excuse pupils in grades 9 through 12  | 
| enrolled in a marching band
program for credit from engaging in  | 
| physical education courses if those pupils
request to be  | 
| excused for ongoing participation in such marching band
 | 
| program. A school board may also, on a case-by-case basis,  | 
| excuse pupils in grades 7 through 12 who participate in an  | 
| interscholastic or extracurricular athletic program from  | 
| engaging in physical education courses. In addition, a pupil
in  | 
| any of grades 3 through 12 who is eligible for special  | 
| education may be excused if the pupil's parent or guardian  | 
| agrees that the pupil
must utilize the time set aside for  | 
| physical education to receive special education support and  | 
| services or, if there is no agreement, the individualized  | 
| education program team for the pupil determines that the pupil  | 
| must utilize the time set aside for physical education to  | 
| receive special education support and services, which  | 
| agreement or determination must be made a part of the  | 
| individualized education program. However, a pupil requiring  | 
| adapted physical education must receive that service in  | 
| accordance with the individualized education program developed  | 
| for the pupil. If requested, a school board is authorized to  | 
| excuse a pupil from engaging in a physical education course if  | 
| the pupil has an individualized educational program under  | 
| Article 14 of this Code, is participating in an adaptive  | 
| athletic program outside of the school setting, and documents  | 
| such participation as determined by the school board. A school  | 
|  | 
| board may also excuse pupils in grades 9 through 12 enrolled
in  | 
| a Reserve Officer's Training Corps (ROTC) program sponsored by  | 
| the school
district from engaging in physical education  | 
| courses.
School boards which choose to exercise this authority  | 
| shall establish a policy
to excuse pupils on an individual  | 
| basis.
 | 
|     (c) The provisions of this Section are subject to the  | 
| provisions of
Section 27-22.05.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-116, eff. 7-29-13.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/27-7)  (from Ch. 122, par. 27-7)
 | 
|     Sec. 27-7. Physical education course of study.
A physical  | 
| education course of study shall include a developmentally  | 
| planned and sequential curriculum  that fosters the development  | 
| of movement skills, enhances health-related fitness, increases  | 
| students' knowledge, offers direct opportunities to learn how  | 
| to work cooperatively in a group setting, and encourages  | 
| healthy habits and attitudes for a healthy lifestyle. A  | 
| physical education course of study shall provide students with  | 
| an opportunity for an appropriate amount of daily physical  | 
| activity.  A physical education course of study must be part of  | 
| the regular school curriculum and not extra-curricular in  | 
| nature or organization.
 | 
|     The State Board of Education
shall prepare and make
 | 
| available guidelines for the various grades and types of  | 
| schools in
order to make effective the purposes set forth in  | 
|  | 
| this Section and the
requirements provided in Section 27-6, and  | 
| shall see that the general
provisions and intent of Sections  | 
| 27-5 to 27-9, inclusive, are
enforced.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 94-189, eff. 7-12-05; 94-200, eff. 7-12-05.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/27-8.1)  (from Ch. 122, par. 27-8.1) | 
|     Sec. 27-8.1. Health examinations and immunizations.  | 
|     (1) In compliance with rules and regulations which the  | 
| Department of Public
Health shall promulgate, and except as  | 
| hereinafter provided, all children in
Illinois shall have a  | 
| health examination as follows: within one year prior to
 | 
| entering kindergarten or the first grade of any public,  | 
| private, or parochial
elementary school; upon entering the  | 
| sixth and ninth grades of any public,
private, or parochial  | 
| school; prior to entrance into any public, private, or
 | 
| parochial nursery school; and, irrespective of grade,  | 
| immediately prior to or
upon entrance into any public, private,  | 
| or parochial school or nursery school,
each child shall present  | 
| proof of having been examined in accordance with this
Section  | 
| and the rules and regulations promulgated hereunder. Any child  | 
| who received a health examination within one year prior to  | 
| entering the fifth grade for the 2007-2008 school year is not  | 
| required to receive an additional health examination in order  | 
| to comply with the provisions of Public Act 95-422 when he or  | 
| she attends school for the 2008-2009 school year, unless the  | 
| child is attending school for the first time as provided in  | 
|  | 
| this paragraph.  | 
|     A tuberculosis skin test screening shall be included as a  | 
| required part of
each health examination included under this  | 
| Section if the child resides in an
area designated by the  | 
| Department of Public Health as having a high incidence
of  | 
| tuberculosis.  Additional health examinations of pupils,  | 
| including eye examinations, may be required when deemed  | 
| necessary by school
authorities.  Parents are encouraged to have  | 
| their children undergo eye examinations at the same points in  | 
| time required for health
examinations. | 
|     (1.5)  In compliance with rules adopted by the Department of  | 
| Public Health and except as otherwise provided in this Section,  | 
| all children in kindergarten and the second and sixth grades of  | 
| any public, private, or parochial school shall have a dental  | 
| examination.  Each of these children shall present proof of  | 
| having been examined by a dentist in accordance with this  | 
| Section and rules adopted under this Section before May 15th of  | 
| the school year.  If a child in the second or sixth grade fails  | 
| to present proof by May 15th, the school may hold the child's  | 
| report card until one of the following occurs:  (i) the child  | 
| presents proof of a completed dental examination or (ii) the  | 
| child presents proof that a dental examination will take place  | 
| within 60 days after May 15th.  The Department of Public Health  | 
| shall establish, by rule, a waiver for children who show an  | 
| undue burden or a lack of access to a dentist.  Each public,  | 
| private, and parochial school must give notice of this dental  | 
|  | 
| examination requirement to the parents and guardians of  | 
| students at least 60 days before May 15th of each school year.
 | 
|     (1.10)  Except as otherwise provided in this Section, all  | 
| children enrolling in kindergarten in a public, private, or  | 
| parochial school on or after the effective date of this  | 
| amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly and any student  | 
| enrolling for the first time in a  public, private, or parochial  | 
| school on or after the effective date of this amendatory Act of  | 
| the 95th General Assembly shall have an eye examination.  Each  | 
| of these children shall present proof of having been examined  | 
| by a physician licensed to practice medicine in all of its  | 
| branches or a  licensed optometrist within the previous year,  in  | 
| accordance with this Section and rules adopted under this  | 
| Section, before October  15th of the school year.  If the  child  | 
| fails to present proof by October  15th, the school may hold the  | 
| child's report card until one of the following occurs:  (i) the  | 
| child presents proof of a completed eye examination or (ii) the  | 
| child presents proof that an eye examination will take place  | 
| within 60 days after October  15th.  The Department of Public  | 
| Health shall establish, by rule, a waiver for children who show  | 
| an undue burden or a lack of access to a physician licensed to  | 
| practice medicine in all of its branches who provides eye  | 
| examinations  or to  a  licensed optometrist.  Each public,  | 
| private, and parochial school must give notice of this eye  | 
| examination requirement to the parents and guardians of  | 
| students in compliance with rules of the Department of Public  | 
|  | 
| Health. Nothing in this Section shall be construed to allow a  | 
| school to exclude a child from attending because of a parent's  | 
| or guardian's failure to obtain an eye examination for the  | 
| child.
 | 
|     (2) The Department of Public Health shall promulgate rules  | 
| and regulations
specifying the examinations and procedures  | 
| that constitute a health examination, which shall include an  | 
| age-appropriate developmental screening, an age-appropriate  | 
| social and emotional screening, and the collection of data  | 
| relating to obesity
(including at a minimum, date of birth,  | 
| gender, height, weight, blood pressure, and date of exam),
and  | 
| a dental examination and may recommend by rule that certain  | 
| additional examinations be performed.
The rules and  | 
| regulations of the Department of Public Health shall specify  | 
| that
a tuberculosis skin test screening shall be included as a  | 
| required part of each
health examination included under this  | 
| Section if the child resides in an area
designated by the  | 
| Department of Public Health as having a high incidence of
 | 
| tuberculosis.
With respect to the developmental screening and  | 
| the social and emotional screening, the Department of Public  | 
| Health must develop rules and appropriate revisions to the  | 
| Child Health Examination form in conjunction with a statewide  | 
| organization representing school boards; a statewide  | 
| organization representing pediatricians; statewide  | 
| organizations representing individuals holding Illinois  | 
| educator licenses with school support personnel endorsements,  | 
|  | 
| including school social workers, school  psychologists, and  | 
| school nurses; a statewide organization representing  | 
| children's mental health experts; a statewide organization  | 
| representing school principals; the Director of Healthcare and  | 
| Family Services or his or her designee, the State  | 
| Superintendent of Education or his or her designee; and  | 
| representatives of other appropriate State agencies and, at a  | 
| minimum, must recommend the use of validated screening tools  | 
| appropriate to the child's age or grade, and, with regard to  | 
| the social and emotional screening, require recording only  | 
| whether or not the screening was completed. The rules shall  | 
| take into consideration the screening recommendations of the  | 
| American Academy of Pediatrics and must be consistent with the  | 
| State Board of Education's social and emotional learning  | 
| standards. The Department of Public Health shall specify that a  | 
| diabetes
screening as defined by rule shall be included as a  | 
| required part of each
health examination.
Diabetes testing is  | 
| not required. | 
|     Physicians licensed to practice medicine in all of its  | 
| branches, licensed advanced
practice nurses, or licensed  | 
| physician assistants shall be
responsible for the performance  | 
| of the health examinations, other than dental
examinations, eye  | 
| examinations, and vision and hearing screening, and shall sign  | 
| all report forms
required by subsection (4) of this Section  | 
| that pertain to those portions of
the health examination for  | 
| which the physician, advanced practice nurse, or
physician  | 
|  | 
| assistant is responsible.
 If a registered
nurse performs any  | 
| part of a health examination, then a physician licensed to
 | 
| practice medicine in all of its branches must review and sign  | 
| all required
report forms.  Licensed dentists shall perform all  | 
| dental examinations and
shall sign all report forms required by  | 
| subsection (4) of this Section that
pertain to the dental  | 
| examinations.  Physicians licensed to practice medicine
in all  | 
| its branches or licensed optometrists shall perform all eye  | 
| examinations
required by this Section and shall sign all report  | 
| forms required by
subsection (4) of this Section that pertain  | 
| to the eye examination. For purposes of this Section, an eye  | 
| examination shall at a minimum include history, visual acuity,  | 
| subjective refraction to best visual acuity near and far,  | 
| internal and external examination, and a glaucoma evaluation,  | 
| as well as any other tests or observations that in the  | 
| professional judgment of the doctor are necessary.   Vision and
 | 
| hearing screening tests, which shall not be considered  | 
| examinations as that
term is used in this Section, shall be  | 
| conducted in accordance with rules and
regulations of the  | 
| Department of Public Health, and by individuals whom the
 | 
| Department of Public Health has certified.
In these rules and  | 
| regulations, the Department of Public Health shall
require that  | 
| individuals conducting vision screening tests give a child's
 | 
| parent or guardian written notification, before the vision  | 
| screening is
conducted, that states, "Vision screening is not a  | 
| substitute for a
complete eye and vision evaluation by an eye  | 
|  | 
| doctor. Your child is not
required to undergo this vision  | 
| screening if an optometrist or
ophthalmologist has completed  | 
| and signed a report form indicating that
an examination has  | 
| been administered within the previous 12 months." | 
|     (2.5) With respect to the developmental screening and the  | 
| social and emotional screening portion of the health  | 
| examination, each child may present proof of having been  | 
| screened in accordance with this Section and the rules adopted  | 
| under this Section before October 15th of the school year. With  | 
| regard to the social and emotional screening only, the  | 
| examining health care provider shall only record whether or not  | 
| the screening was completed. If the child fails to present  | 
| proof of the developmental screening or the social and  | 
| emotional screening portions of the health examination by   | 
| October 15th of the school year, qualified school support   | 
| personnel may, with a parent's or guardian's consent, offer the  | 
| developmental screening or the social and emotional screening  | 
| to the child. Each public, private, and parochial school must  | 
| give notice of the developmental screening and social and  | 
| emotional screening requirements to the parents and guardians  | 
| of students in compliance with the rules of the Department of  | 
| Public Health. Nothing in this Section shall be construed to  | 
| allow a school to exclude a child from attending because of a  | 
| parent's or guardian's failure to obtain a developmental  | 
| screening or a social and emotional screening for the child.  | 
| Once a developmental screening or a social and emotional  | 
|  | 
| screening is completed and proof has been presented to the  | 
| school, the school may, with a parent's or guardian's consent,  | 
| make available appropriate school personnel to work with the  | 
| parent or guardian, the child, and the provider who signed the  | 
| screening form to obtain any appropriate evaluations and  | 
| services as indicated on the form and in other information and  | 
| documentation provided by the parents, guardians, or provider. | 
|     (3) Every child shall, at or about the same time as he or  | 
| she receives
a health examination required by subsection (1) of  | 
| this Section, present
to the local school proof of having  | 
| received such immunizations against
preventable communicable  | 
| diseases as the Department of Public Health shall
require by  | 
| rules and regulations promulgated pursuant to this Section and  | 
| the
Communicable Disease Prevention Act. | 
|     (4) The individuals conducting the health examination,
 | 
| dental examination, or eye examination shall record the
fact of  | 
| having conducted the examination, and such additional  | 
| information as
required, including for a health examination
 | 
| data relating to obesity
(including at a minimum, date of  | 
| birth, gender, height, weight, blood pressure, and date of  | 
| exam), on uniform forms which the Department of Public Health  | 
| and the State
Board of Education shall prescribe for statewide  | 
| use.  The examiner shall
summarize on the report form any  | 
| condition that he or she suspects indicates a
need for special  | 
| services, including for a health examination factors relating  | 
| to obesity. The duty to summarize on the report form does not  | 
|  | 
| apply to social and emotional screenings. The confidentiality  | 
| of the information and records relating to the developmental  | 
| screening and the social and emotional screening shall be  | 
| determined by the statutes, rules, and professional ethics  | 
| governing the type of provider conducting the screening.  The  | 
| individuals confirming the administration of
required  | 
| immunizations shall record as indicated on the form that the
 | 
| immunizations were administered. | 
|     (5) If a child does not submit proof of having had either  | 
| the health
examination or the immunization as required, then  | 
| the child shall be examined
or receive the immunization, as the  | 
| case may be, and present proof by October
15 of the current  | 
| school year, or by an earlier date of the current school year
 | 
| established by a school district.  To establish a date before  | 
| October 15 of the
current school year for the health  | 
| examination or immunization as required, a
school district must  | 
| give notice of the requirements of this Section 60 days
prior  | 
| to the earlier established date.  If for medical reasons one or  | 
| more of
the required immunizations must be given after October  | 
| 15 of the current school
year, or after an earlier established  | 
| date of the current school year, then
the child shall present,  | 
| by October 15, or by the earlier established date, a
schedule  | 
| for the administration of the immunizations and a statement of  | 
| the
medical reasons causing the delay, both the schedule and  | 
| the statement being
issued by the physician, advanced practice  | 
| nurse, physician assistant,
registered nurse, or local health  | 
|  | 
| department that will
be responsible for administration of the  | 
| remaining required immunizations.  If
a child does not comply by  | 
| October 15, or by the earlier established date of
the current  | 
| school year, with the requirements of this subsection, then the
 | 
| local school authority shall exclude that child from school  | 
| until such time as
the child presents proof of having had the  | 
| health examination as required and
presents proof of having  | 
| received those required immunizations which are
medically  | 
| possible to receive immediately.  During a child's exclusion  | 
| from
school for noncompliance with this subsection, the child's  | 
| parents or legal
guardian shall be considered in violation of  | 
| Section 26-1 and subject to any
penalty imposed by Section  | 
| 26-10. This subsection (5) does not apply to dental  | 
| examinations, eye examinations, and the developmental  | 
| screening and the social and emotional screening portions of  | 
| the health examination. If the student is an out-of-state  | 
| transfer student and does not have the proof required under  | 
| this subsection (5) before October 15 of the current year or  | 
| whatever date is set by the school district, then he or she may  | 
| only attend classes (i) if he or she has proof that an  | 
| appointment for the required vaccinations has been scheduled  | 
| with a party authorized to submit proof of the required  | 
| vaccinations. If the proof of vaccination required under this  | 
| subsection (5) is not submitted within 30 days after the  | 
| student is permitted to attend classes, then the student is not  | 
| to be permitted to attend classes until proof of the  | 
|  | 
| vaccinations has been properly submitted. No school district or  | 
| employee of a school district shall be held liable for any  | 
| injury or illness to another person that results from admitting  | 
| an out-of-state transfer student to class that has an  | 
| appointment scheduled pursuant to this subsection (5).  | 
|     (6) Every school shall report to the State Board of  | 
| Education by November
15, in the manner which that agency shall  | 
| require, the number of children who
have received the necessary  | 
| immunizations and the health examination (other than a dental  | 
| examination or eye examination) as
required, indicating, of  | 
| those who have not received the immunizations and
examination  | 
| as required, the number of children who are exempt from health
 | 
| examination and immunization requirements on religious or  | 
| medical grounds as
provided in subsection (8).  On or before  | 
| December 1 of each year, every public school district and  | 
| registered nonpublic school shall make publicly available the  | 
| immunization data they are required to submit to the State  | 
| Board of Education by November 15.  The immunization data made  | 
| publicly available must be identical to the data the school  | 
| district or school has reported to the State Board of  | 
| Education. | 
|     Every school shall report to the State Board of Education  | 
| by June 30, in the manner that the State Board requires, the  | 
| number of children who have received the required dental  | 
| examination, indicating, of those who have not received the  | 
| required dental examination, the number of children who are  | 
|  | 
| exempt from the dental examination on religious grounds as  | 
| provided in subsection (8) of this Section and the number of  | 
| children who have received a waiver under subsection (1.5) of  | 
| this Section. | 
|     Every school shall report to the State Board of Education  | 
| by June 30, in the manner that the State Board requires, the  | 
| number of children who have received the required eye  | 
| examination, indicating, of those who have not received the  | 
| required eye examination, the number of children who are exempt  | 
| from the eye examination as provided in subsection (8) of this  | 
| Section, the number of children who have received a waiver  | 
| under subsection (1.10) of this Section, and the total number  | 
| of children in noncompliance with the eye examination  | 
| requirement. | 
|     The reported information under this subsection (6) shall be  | 
| provided to the
Department of Public Health by the State Board  | 
| of Education. | 
|     (7) Upon determining that the number of pupils who are  | 
| required to be in
compliance with subsection (5) of this  | 
| Section is below 90% of the number of
pupils enrolled in the  | 
| school district, 10% of each State aid payment made
pursuant to  | 
| Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 to the school district for such year  | 
| may be withheld
by the State Board of Education until the  | 
| number of students in compliance with
subsection (5) is the  | 
| applicable specified percentage or higher. | 
|     (8) Children of parents or legal guardians who object to  | 
|  | 
| health, dental, or eye examinations or any part thereof, to  | 
| immunizations, or to vision and hearing screening tests on  | 
| religious grounds shall not be required to undergo the  | 
| examinations, tests,  or immunizations to which they so object  | 
| if such parents or legal guardians present to the appropriate  | 
| local school authority a signed Certificate of Religious  | 
| Exemption detailing the grounds for objection and the specific  | 
| immunizations, tests,  or examinations to which they object.  The  | 
| grounds for objection must set forth the specific religious  | 
| belief that conflicts with the examination, test,  | 
| immunization, or other medical intervention.  The signed  | 
| certificate shall also reflect the parent's or legal guardian's  | 
| understanding of the school's exclusion policies in the case of  | 
| a vaccine-preventable disease outbreak or exposure.  The  | 
| certificate must also be signed by the authorized examining  | 
| health care provider responsible for the performance of the  | 
| child's health examination confirming that the provider  | 
| provided education to the parent or legal guardian on the  | 
| benefits of immunization and the health risks to the student  | 
| and to the community of the communicable diseases for which  | 
| immunization is required in this State.  However, the health  | 
| care provider's signature on the certificate reflects only that  | 
| education was provided and does not allow a health care  | 
| provider grounds to determine a religious exemption. Those  | 
| receiving immunizations required under this Code shall be  | 
| provided with the relevant vaccine information statements that  | 
|  | 
| are required to be disseminated by the federal National  | 
| Childhood Vaccine Injury Act of 1986, which may contain  | 
| information on circumstances when a vaccine should not be  | 
| administered, prior to administering a vaccine. A healthcare  | 
| provider may consider including without limitation the  | 
| nationally accepted recommendations from federal agencies such  | 
| as the Advisory Committee on Immunization Practices, the  | 
| information outlined in the relevant vaccine information  | 
| statement, and vaccine package inserts, along with the  | 
| healthcare provider's clinical judgment, to determine whether  | 
| any child may be more susceptible to experiencing an adverse  | 
| vaccine reaction than the general population, and, if so, the  | 
| healthcare provider may exempt the child from an immunization  | 
| or adopt an individualized immunization schedule. The  | 
| Certificate of Religious Exemption shall be created by the  | 
| Department of Public Health and shall be made available and  | 
| used by parents and legal guardians by the beginning of the  | 
| 2015-2016 school year.  Parents or legal guardians must submit  | 
| the Certificate of Religious Exemption to their local school  | 
| authority prior to entering kindergarten, sixth grade, and  | 
| ninth grade for each child for which they are requesting an  | 
| exemption. The religious objection stated need not be directed  | 
| by the tenets of an established religious organization.  | 
| However, general philosophical or moral reluctance to allow  | 
| physical examinations, eye examinations, immunizations, vision  | 
| and hearing screenings, or dental examinations does not provide  | 
|  | 
| a sufficient basis for an exception to statutory requirements.  | 
| The local school authority is responsible for determining if
 | 
| the content of the Certificate of Religious Exemption
 | 
| constitutes a valid religious objection.
The local school  | 
| authority shall inform the parent or legal guardian of  | 
| exclusion procedures, in accordance with the Department's  | 
| rules under Part 690 of Title 77 of the Illinois Administrative  | 
| Code, at the time the objection is presented.   | 
|     If the physical condition
of the child is such that any one  | 
| or more of the immunizing agents should not
be administered,  | 
| the examining physician, advanced practice nurse, or
physician  | 
| assistant responsible for the performance of the
health  | 
| examination shall endorse that fact upon the health examination  | 
| form. | 
|     Exempting a child from the health,
dental, or eye  | 
| examination does not exempt the child from
participation in the  | 
| program of physical education training provided in
Sections  | 
| 27-5 through 27-7 of this Code. | 
|     (9) For the purposes of this Section, "nursery schools"  | 
| means those nursery
schools operated by elementary school  | 
| systems or secondary level school units
or institutions of  | 
| higher learning. | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-673, eff. 6-30-14; 99-173, eff. 7-29-15;  | 
| 99-249, eff. 8-3-15; 99-642, eff. 7-28-16; 99-927, eff.  | 
| 6-1-17.)
 | 
|  | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/27-24.2)  (from Ch. 122, par. 27-24.2) | 
|     Sec. 27-24.2. Safety education; driver education course.  | 
| Instruction shall be given in safety education in each of  | 
| grades one through 8, equivalent to one class period each week,  | 
| and any school district which maintains
grades 9 through 12  | 
| shall offer a driver education course in any such school
which  | 
| it operates. Its curriculum shall include content dealing with  | 
| Chapters 11, 12, 13, 15, and 16 of the Illinois Vehicle Code,  | 
| the rules adopted pursuant to those Chapters insofar as they  | 
| pertain to the operation of motor vehicles, and the portions of  | 
| the Litter Control Act relating to the operation of motor  | 
| vehicles.  The course of instruction given in grades 10 through  | 
| 12 shall include an emphasis on the development of knowledge,  | 
| attitudes, habits, and skills necessary for the safe operation  | 
| of motor vehicles, including motorcycles insofar as they can be  | 
| taught in the classroom, and instruction on distracted driving  | 
| as a major traffic safety issue.  In addition, the course shall  | 
| include instruction on special hazards existing at and required  | 
| safety and driving precautions that must be observed at  | 
| emergency situations, highway construction and maintenance  | 
| zones, and railroad crossings and the approaches thereto.  | 
| Beginning with the 2017-2018 school year, the course shall also  | 
| include instruction concerning law enforcement procedures for  | 
| traffic stops, including a demonstration of the proper actions  | 
| to be taken during a traffic stop and appropriate interactions  | 
| with law enforcement.  The course of instruction required of  | 
|  | 
| each eligible student at the high school level shall consist of  | 
| a minimum of 30 clock hours of classroom instruction and a  | 
| minimum of 6 clock hours of individual behind-the-wheel  | 
| instruction in a dual control car on public roadways taught by  | 
| a driver education instructor endorsed by the State Board of  | 
| Education. Both the classroom instruction part and the practice  | 
| driving
part of such driver education course shall be open to a  | 
| resident or
non-resident student attending a non-public school  | 
| in the district wherein the
course is offered. Each student  | 
| attending any public or non-public high school
in the district  | 
| must receive a passing grade in at least 8 courses during the
 | 
| previous 2 semesters prior to enrolling in a driver education  | 
| course, or the
student shall not be permitted to enroll in the  | 
| course; provided that the local
superintendent of schools (with  | 
| respect to a student attending a public high
school in the  | 
| district) or chief school administrator (with respect to a
 | 
| student attending a non-public high school in the district) may  | 
| waive the
requirement if the superintendent or chief school  | 
| administrator, as the case
may be, deems it to be in the best  | 
| interest of the student. A student may be allowed to commence  | 
| the
classroom instruction part of such driver education course  | 
| prior to reaching
age 15 if such student then will be eligible  | 
| to complete the entire course
within 12 months after being  | 
| allowed to commence such classroom instruction. | 
|     A school district may offer a driver education course in a  | 
| school by contracting with a commercial driver training school  | 
|  | 
| to provide both the classroom instruction part and the practice  | 
| driving part or either one without having to request a  | 
| modification or waiver of administrative rules of the State  | 
| Board of Education if the school district approves the action  | 
| during a public hearing on whether to enter into a contract  | 
| with a commercial driver training school. The public hearing  | 
| shall be held at a regular or special school board meeting  | 
| prior to entering into such a contract.  If a school district  | 
| chooses to approve a contract with a commercial driver training  | 
| school, then the district must provide evidence to the State  | 
| Board of Education that the commercial driver training school  | 
| with which it will contract holds a license issued by the  | 
| Secretary of State under Article IV of Chapter 6 of the  | 
| Illinois Vehicle Code and that each instructor employed by the  | 
| commercial driver training school to provide instruction to  | 
| students served by the school district holds a valid teaching  | 
| license issued under the requirements of this Code and rules of  | 
| the State Board of Education.  Such evidence must include, but  | 
| need not be limited to, a list of each instructor assigned to  | 
| teach students served by the school district, which list shall  | 
| include the instructor's name, personal identification number  | 
| as required by the State Board of Education, birth date, and  | 
| driver's license number. Once the contract is entered into, the  | 
| school district shall notify the State Board of Education of  | 
| any changes in the personnel providing instruction either (i)  | 
| within  15 calendar days after an instructor leaves the program  | 
|  | 
| or (ii) before a new instructor is hired.  Such notification  | 
| shall include the instructor's name, personal identification  | 
| number as required by the State Board of Education, birth date,  | 
| and driver's license number.   If the school district maintains  | 
| an Internet website, then the district shall post a copy of the  | 
| final contract between the district and the commercial driver  | 
| training school on the district's Internet website. If no  | 
| Internet website exists, then the school district shall make  | 
| available the contract upon request. A record of all materials  | 
| in relation to the contract must be maintained by the school  | 
| district and made available to parents and guardians upon  | 
| request. The instructor's date of birth and driver's license  | 
| number and any other personally identifying information as  | 
| deemed by the federal Driver's Privacy Protection Act of 1994  | 
| must be redacted from any public materials.  | 
|     Such a course may be commenced immediately after the  | 
| completion of a prior
course. Teachers of such courses shall  | 
| meet the licensure certification requirements of
this Code Act  | 
| and regulations of the State Board as to qualifications. | 
|     Subject to rules of the State Board of Education, the  | 
| school district may charge a reasonable fee, not to exceed $50,  | 
| to students who participate in the course, unless a student is  | 
| unable to pay for such a course, in which event the fee for  | 
| such a student must be waived.  However, the district may  | 
| increase this fee to an amount not to exceed $250 by school  | 
| board resolution following a public hearing on the increase,  | 
|  | 
| which increased fee must be waived for students who participate  | 
| in the course and are unable to pay for the course. The total  | 
| amount from driver education fees and reimbursement from the  | 
| State for driver education must not exceed the total cost of  | 
| the driver education program in any year and must be deposited  | 
| into the school district's driver education fund as a separate  | 
| line item budget entry.  All moneys deposited into the school  | 
| district's driver education fund must be used solely for the  | 
| funding of a high school driver education program approved by  | 
| the State Board of Education that uses driver education  | 
| instructors endorsed by the State Board of Education.  | 
| (Source: P.A. 99-642, eff. 7-28-16; 99-720, eff. 1-1-17.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/27A-9)
 | 
|     Sec. 27A-9. Term of charter; renewal. 
 | 
|     (a) For charters granted before January 1, 2017 (the  | 
| effective date of Public Act 99-840) this amendatory Act of the  | 
| 99th General Assembly, a charter may be granted for a period  | 
| not less than 5 and not
more than
10
school years.  For charters  | 
| granted on or after January 1, 2017 (the effective date of  | 
| Public Act 99-840) this amendatory Act of the 99th General  | 
| Assembly, a charter shall be granted for a period of 5
school  | 
| years. For charters renewed before January 1, 2017 (the  | 
| effective date of Public Act 99-840) this amendatory Act of the  | 
| 99th General Assembly, a charter may be renewed in incremental  | 
| periods not to exceed
5
school years. For charters renewed on  | 
|  | 
| or after January 1, 2017 (the effective date of Public Act  | 
| 99-840) this amendatory Act of the 99th General Assembly, a  | 
| charter may be renewed in incremental periods not to exceed 10  | 
| school years; however, the Commission may renew a charter only  | 
| in incremental periods not to exceed 5 years. Authorizers shall  | 
| ensure that every charter granted on or after January 1, 2017  | 
| (the effective date of Public Act 99-840) this amendatory Act  | 
| of the 99th General Assembly includes standards and goals for  | 
| academic, organizational, and financial performance.  A charter  | 
| must meet all standards and goals for academic, organizational,  | 
| and financial performance set forth by the authorizer in order  | 
| to be renewed for a term in excess of 5 years but not more than  | 
| 10 years.  If an authorizer fails to establish standards and  | 
| goals, a charter shall not be renewed for a term in excess of 5  | 
| years.  Nothing contained in this Section shall require an  | 
| authorizer to grant a full 10-year renewal term to any  | 
| particular charter school, but an authorizer may award a full  | 
| 10-year renewal term to charter schools that have a  | 
| demonstrated track record of improving student performance. 
 | 
|     (b) A charter school renewal proposal submitted to the
 | 
| local school board or the Commission, as the chartering entity,
 | 
| shall contain:
 | 
|         (1) A report on the progress of the charter school in  | 
| achieving the goals,
objectives, pupil performance  | 
| standards, content standards, and other terms of
the  | 
| initial approved charter proposal; and
 | 
|  | 
|         (2) A financial statement that discloses the costs of  | 
| administration,
instruction, and other spending categories  | 
| for the charter school that is
understandable to the  | 
| general public and that will allow comparison of those
 | 
| costs to other schools or other comparable organizations,  | 
| in a format required
by the State Board.
 | 
|     (c) A charter may be revoked
or not renewed if the local  | 
| school board or the Commission, as the chartering
entity,
 | 
| clearly demonstrates that the
charter school did any of the
 | 
| following, or otherwise failed to comply with the requirements  | 
| of this law:
 | 
|         (1) Committed a material violation of any of the  | 
| conditions, standards, or
procedures set forth in the  | 
| charter.
 | 
|         (2) Failed to meet or make reasonable progress toward  | 
| achievement of the
content standards or pupil performance  | 
| standards identified in the charter.
 | 
|         (3) Failed to meet generally accepted standards of  | 
| fiscal management.
 | 
|         (4) Violated any provision of law from which the  | 
| charter school was not
exempted.
 | 
|     In the case of revocation, the local school board or the  | 
| Commission, as the chartering entity, shall notify the charter  | 
| school in writing of the reason why the charter is subject to  | 
| revocation.  The charter school shall submit a written plan to  | 
| the local school board or the Commission, whichever is  | 
|  | 
| applicable, to rectify the problem.  The plan shall include a  | 
| timeline for implementation, which shall not exceed 2 years or  | 
| the date of the charter's expiration, whichever is earlier.  If  | 
| the local school board or the Commission, as the chartering  | 
| entity, finds that the charter school has failed to implement  | 
| the plan of remediation and adhere to the timeline, then the  | 
| chartering entity shall revoke the charter.  Except in  | 
| situations of an emergency where the health, safety, or  | 
| education of the charter school's students is at risk, the  | 
| revocation shall take place at the end of a school year.   | 
| Nothing in Public Act 96-105 this amendatory Act of the 96th  | 
| General Assembly shall be construed to prohibit an  | 
| implementation timetable that is less than 2 years in duration.  | 
|     (d) (Blank).
 | 
|     (e) Notice of a local school board's decision to
deny,  | 
| revoke, or not to
renew a charter shall be provided to the  | 
| Commission and the State Board.
The Commission may reverse a  | 
| local board's
decision
if the Commission finds
that the charter  | 
| school or charter school proposal (i) is in compliance with
 | 
| this Article, and (ii) is in the best interests of the students  | 
| it is designed
to serve.
 The Commission may condition the  | 
| granting of an appeal on the acceptance by
the charter school  | 
| of funding in an amount less than that requested in the
 | 
| proposal submitted to the local school board.
Final decisions  | 
| of the Commission shall be subject
to judicial review under the  | 
| Administrative Review Law.
 | 
|  | 
|     (f) Notwithstanding other provisions of this Article, if  | 
| the Commission
on appeal reverses a local board's decision
or  | 
| if a charter school is
approved by referendum,
the Commission
  | 
| shall act as the
authorized chartering entity for the charter  | 
| school.
 The Commission shall
approve the charter and shall  | 
| perform all functions
under this
Article otherwise performed by  | 
| the local school
board.  The State Board shall determine whether  | 
| the charter proposal approved by the Commission is consistent  | 
| with the provisions of this Article and, if the approved  | 
| proposal complies, certify the proposal pursuant to this  | 
| Article. The State Board shall
report the aggregate number of  | 
| charter school pupils resident in a school
district to that  | 
| district
and shall notify the district
of the amount of
funding  | 
| to be paid by the State Board to the charter school enrolling  | 
| such
students.
The Commission shall require the
charter school  | 
| to maintain accurate records of daily attendance that shall be
 | 
| deemed sufficient to file claims under Section 18-8.05 or  | 
| 18-8.15 notwithstanding any
other requirements of that Section  | 
| regarding hours of instruction and teacher
certification.
The  | 
| State Board shall withhold from funds otherwise due the  | 
| district
the funds authorized by this Article to be paid to the  | 
| charter school and shall
pay such amounts to the charter  | 
| school.
 | 
|     (g)  For charter schools authorized by the Commission, the  | 
| Commission shall quarterly certify to the State Board the  | 
| student enrollment for each of its charter schools. | 
|  | 
|     (h)  For charter schools authorized by the Commission, the  | 
| State Board shall pay directly to a charter school any federal  | 
| or State aid attributable to a student with a disability  | 
| attending the school.  | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-739, eff. 7-16-14; 99-840, eff. 1-1-17;  | 
| revised 10-27-16.)
 
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/27A-11)
  | 
|     Sec. 27A-11. Local financing. 
 | 
|     (a) For purposes of the School Code, pupils enrolled in a  | 
| charter school
shall be included in the pupil enrollment of the  | 
| school district within which
the
pupil resides.  Each charter  | 
| school (i) shall determine the school district in
which each  | 
| pupil who is enrolled in the charter school resides,
(ii) shall
 | 
| report the aggregate number of pupils resident of a school  | 
| district who are
enrolled in the charter school to the school  | 
| district in which those pupils
reside, and (iii) shall maintain  | 
| accurate records of daily attendance that
shall be deemed  | 
| sufficient to file claims under Section 18-8 or 18-8.15  | 
| notwithstanding
any other requirements of that Section  | 
| regarding hours of instruction and
teacher certification.
 | 
|     (b) Except for a charter school established by referendum  | 
| under Section
27A-6.5, as part of a charter school contract,  | 
| the charter school and the
local
school board shall agree on  | 
| funding and any services to be provided by the
school district  | 
| to the charter school.
Agreed funding that a charter school is  | 
|  | 
| to receive from the local school
board for a school year shall  | 
| be paid in
equal quarterly installments with the payment of the
 | 
| installment for the first quarter being made not later than  | 
| July 1, unless the
charter establishes a different payment  | 
| schedule. However, if a charter school dismisses a pupil from  | 
| the charter school after receiving a quarterly payment, the   | 
| charter school shall return to the school district, on a  | 
| quarterly basis, the prorated portion of public funding  | 
| provided for the education of that pupil for the time the  | 
| student is not  enrolled at the charter school. Likewise, if a  | 
| pupil transfers to a charter school between quarterly payments,  | 
| the school district shall provide, on a quarterly basis, a  | 
| prorated portion of the public funding to the charter school to  | 
| provide for the education of that pupil. 
 | 
|     All services centrally or otherwise provided by the school  | 
| district
including, but not limited to, rent, food services,  | 
| custodial services,
maintenance,
curriculum, media services,  | 
| libraries, transportation, and warehousing shall be
subject to
 | 
| negotiation between a charter school and the local school board  | 
| and paid
for out
of the revenues negotiated pursuant to this  | 
| subsection (b); provided that the
local school board shall not  | 
| attempt, by negotiation or otherwise, to obligate
a charter  | 
| school to provide pupil transportation for pupils for whom a  | 
| district
is not required to provide transportation under the  | 
| criteria set forth in
subsection (a)(13) of Section 27A-7.
 | 
|     In no event shall the funding be less than 97% 75% or more  | 
|  | 
| than 103%
125% of the
school district's per capita student  | 
| tuition multiplied by
the
number of students residing in the  | 
| district who are enrolled in the charter
school.
 | 
|     It is the intent of the General Assembly that funding and  | 
| service agreements
under this subsection (b) shall be neither a  | 
| financial incentive nor a
financial disincentive to the  | 
| establishment of a charter school.
 | 
|     The charter school may set and collect reasonable fees.   | 
| Fees collected
from students enrolled at a charter school shall  | 
| be retained
by the charter school.
 | 
|     (c) Notwithstanding subsection (b) of this Section, the  | 
| proportionate share
of State and federal resources generated by  | 
| students with disabilities or staff
serving them shall be  | 
| directed to charter schools enrolling those students by
their  | 
| school districts or administrative units.  The proportionate  | 
| share of
moneys generated under other federal or State  | 
| categorical aid programs shall be
directed to charter schools  | 
| serving students eligible for that aid.
 | 
|     (d) The governing body of a charter school is authorized to  | 
| accept
gifts,
donations, or grants of any kind made to the  | 
| charter school and to expend or
use gifts, donations, or grants  | 
| in accordance with the conditions prescribed by
the donor;  | 
| however, a gift, donation, or grant may not be accepted by the
 | 
| governing body if it is subject to any condition contrary to  | 
| applicable law or
contrary
to the terms of the contract between  | 
| the charter school and the local school
board.  Charter schools  | 
|  | 
| shall be encouraged to solicit and utilize community
volunteer  | 
| speakers and other instructional resources when providing  | 
| instruction
on the Holocaust and other historical events.
 | 
|     (e) (Blank).
 | 
|     (f) The Commission shall provide technical assistance to
 | 
| persons and groups
preparing or revising charter applications.
 | 
|     (g) At the non-renewal or revocation of its charter, each
 | 
| charter school
shall refund to the local board of education all  | 
| unspent funds.
 | 
|     (h) A charter school is authorized to incur temporary,  | 
| short
term debt to
pay operating expenses in anticipation of  | 
| receipt of funds from the local
school board.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-640, eff. 6-9-14; 98-739, eff. 7-16-14; 99-78,  | 
| eff. 7-20-15.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/29-5)  (from Ch. 122, par. 29-5) | 
|     Sec. 29-5. Reimbursement by State for transportation.   Any  | 
| school
district, maintaining a school, transporting resident  | 
| pupils to another
school district's vocational program,  | 
| offered through a joint agreement
approved by the State Board  | 
| of Education, as provided in Section
10-22.22 or transporting  | 
| its resident pupils to a school which meets the
standards for  | 
| recognition as established by the State Board of Education
 | 
| which provides transportation meeting the standards of safety,  | 
| comfort,
convenience, efficiency and operation prescribed by  | 
| the State Board of
Education for resident pupils in  | 
|  | 
| kindergarten or any of grades 1 through
12 who: (a) reside at  | 
| least 1 1/2 miles as measured by the customary route of
travel,  | 
| from the school attended; or (b) reside in areas where  | 
| conditions are
such that walking constitutes a hazard to the  | 
| safety of the child when
determined under Section 29-3; and (c)  | 
| are transported to the school attended
from pick-up points at  | 
| the beginning of the school day and back again at the
close of  | 
| the school day or transported to and from their assigned  | 
| attendance
centers during the school day, shall be reimbursed  | 
| by the State as hereinafter
provided in this Section.
 | 
|     The State will pay the cost of transporting eligible pupils  | 
| less the prior year
assessed valuation in a dual school  | 
| district maintaining secondary
grades 9 to 12 inclusive times a  | 
| qualifying rate of .05%; in elementary
school districts  | 
| maintaining grades K to 8 times a qualifying rate of
.06%; and  | 
| in unit districts maintaining grades K to 12, including  | 
| optional elementary unit districts and combined high school -  | 
| unit districts, times a qualifying
rate of .07%; provided that  | 
| for optional elementary unit districts and combined high school - | 
|  unit districts, prior year assessed valuation for high school  | 
| purposes, as defined in Article 11E of this Code, must be used.  | 
| To be eligible to receive reimbursement in excess of 4/5
of the  | 
| cost to transport eligible pupils, a school district shall have  | 
| a
Transportation Fund tax rate of at least .12%.  If a school  | 
| district
does not have a .12% Transportation Fund tax rate, the  | 
| amount of its
claim in excess of 4/5 of the cost of  | 
|  | 
| transporting pupils shall be
reduced by the sum arrived at by  | 
| subtracting the Transportation Fund tax
rate from .12% and  | 
| multiplying that amount by the district's prior year districts  | 
| equalized or
assessed valuation, provided, that in no case  | 
| shall said reduction
result in reimbursement of less than 4/5  | 
| of the cost to transport
eligible pupils.
 | 
|     The minimum amount to be received by a district is $16  | 
| times the
number of eligible pupils transported.
 | 
|     When calculating the reimbursement for transportation  | 
| costs, the State Board of Education may not deduct the number  | 
| of pupils enrolled in early education programs from the number  | 
| of pupils eligible for reimbursement if the pupils enrolled in  | 
| the early education programs are transported at the same time  | 
| as other eligible pupils.
 | 
|     Any such district transporting resident pupils during the  | 
| school day
to an area vocational school or another school  | 
| district's vocational
program more than 1 1/2 miles from the  | 
| school attended, as provided in
Sections 10-22.20a and  | 
| 10-22.22, shall be reimbursed by the State for 4/5
of the cost  | 
| of transporting eligible pupils.
 | 
|     School day means that period of time which the pupil is  | 
| required to be
in attendance for instructional purposes.
 | 
|     If a pupil is at a location within the school district  | 
| other than his
residence for child care purposes at the time  | 
| for transportation to school,
that location may be considered  | 
| for purposes of determining the 1 1/2 miles
from the school  | 
|  | 
| attended.
 | 
|     Claims for reimbursement that include children who attend  | 
| any school
other than a public school shall show the number of  | 
| such children
transported.
 | 
|     Claims for reimbursement under this Section shall not be  | 
| paid for the
transportation of pupils for whom transportation  | 
| costs are claimed for
payment under other Sections of this Act.
 | 
|     The allowable direct cost of transporting pupils for  | 
| regular, vocational,
and special education pupil  | 
| transportation shall be limited to the sum of
the cost of  | 
| physical examinations required for employment as a school bus
 | 
| driver; the salaries of full or part-time drivers and school  | 
| bus maintenance
personnel; employee benefits excluding  | 
| Illinois municipal retirement
payments, social security  | 
| payments, unemployment insurance payments and
workers'  | 
| compensation insurance premiums; expenditures to independent
 | 
| carriers who operate school buses; payments to other school  | 
| districts for
pupil transportation services; pre-approved  | 
| contractual expenditures for
computerized bus scheduling; the  | 
| cost of gasoline, oil, tires, and other
supplies necessary for  | 
| the operation of school buses; the cost of
converting buses'  | 
| gasoline engines to more fuel efficient engines or to
engines  | 
| which use alternative energy sources; the cost of travel to
 | 
| meetings and workshops conducted by the regional  | 
| superintendent or the
State Superintendent of Education  | 
| pursuant to the standards established by
the Secretary of State  | 
|  | 
| under Section 6-106 of the Illinois Vehicle Code to improve the  | 
| driving skills of
school bus drivers; the cost of maintenance  | 
| of school buses including parts
and materials used;  | 
| expenditures for leasing transportation vehicles,
except  | 
| interest and service charges; the cost of insurance and  | 
| licenses for
transportation vehicles; expenditures for the  | 
| rental of transportation
equipment; plus a depreciation  | 
| allowance of 20% for 5 years for school
buses and vehicles  | 
| approved for transporting pupils to and from school and
a  | 
| depreciation allowance of 10% for 10 years for other  | 
| transportation
equipment so used.
Each school year, if a school  | 
| district has made expenditures to the
Regional Transportation  | 
| Authority or any of its service boards, a mass
transit  | 
| district, or an urban transportation district under an
 | 
| intergovernmental agreement with the district to provide for  | 
| the
transportation of pupils and if the public transit carrier  | 
| received direct
payment for services or passes from a school  | 
| district within its service
area during the 2000-2001 school  | 
| year, then the allowable direct cost of
transporting pupils for  | 
| regular, vocational, and special education pupil
 | 
| transportation shall also include the expenditures that the  | 
| district has
made to the public transit carrier.
In addition to  | 
| the above allowable costs school
districts shall also claim all  | 
| transportation supervisory salary costs,
including Illinois  | 
| municipal retirement payments, and all transportation
related  | 
| building and building maintenance costs without limitation.
 | 
|  | 
|     Special education allowable costs shall also include  | 
| expenditures for the
salaries of attendants or aides for that  | 
| portion of the time they assist
special education pupils while  | 
| in transit and expenditures for parents and
public carriers for  | 
| transporting special education pupils when pre-approved
by the  | 
| State Superintendent of Education.
 | 
|     Indirect costs shall be included in the reimbursement claim  | 
| for districts
which own and operate their own school buses.   | 
| Such indirect costs shall
include administrative costs, or any  | 
| costs attributable to transporting
pupils from their  | 
| attendance centers to another school building for
 | 
| instructional purposes.  No school district which owns and  | 
| operates its own
school buses may claim reimbursement for  | 
| indirect costs which exceed 5% of
the total allowable direct  | 
| costs for pupil transportation.
 | 
|     The State Board of Education shall prescribe uniform  | 
| regulations for
determining the above standards and shall  | 
| prescribe forms of cost
accounting and standards of determining  | 
| reasonable depreciation. Such
depreciation shall include the  | 
| cost of equipping school buses with the
safety features  | 
| required by law or by the rules, regulations and standards
 | 
| promulgated by the State Board of Education, and the Department  | 
| of
Transportation for the safety and construction of school  | 
| buses provided,
however, any equipment cost reimbursed by the  | 
| Department of Transportation
for equipping school buses with  | 
| such safety equipment shall be deducted
from the allowable cost  | 
|  | 
| in the computation of reimbursement under this
Section in the  | 
| same percentage as the cost of the equipment is depreciated.
 | 
|     On or before August 15, annually, the chief school  | 
| administrator for
the district shall certify to the State  | 
| Superintendent of Education the
district's claim for  | 
| reimbursement for the school year ending on June 30
next  | 
| preceding.  The State Superintendent of Education shall check  | 
| and
approve the claims and prepare the vouchers showing the  | 
| amounts due for
district reimbursement claims. Each fiscal  | 
| year, the State
Superintendent of Education shall prepare and  | 
| transmit the first 3
vouchers to the Comptroller on the 30th  | 
| day  of September, December and
March, respectively, and the  | 
| final voucher, no later than June 20.
 | 
|     If the amount appropriated for transportation  | 
| reimbursement is insufficient
to fund total claims for any  | 
| fiscal year, the State Board of Education shall
reduce each  | 
| school district's allowable costs and flat grant amount
 | 
| proportionately to make total adjusted claims equal the total  | 
| amount
appropriated.
 | 
|     For purposes of calculating claims for reimbursement under  | 
| this Section
for any school year beginning July 1, 1998, or  | 
| thereafter, the
equalized
assessed valuation for a school  | 
| district used to compute reimbursement
shall be computed in the  | 
| same manner as it is computed under paragraph (2) of
subsection  | 
| (G) of Section 18-8.05.
 | 
|     All reimbursements received from the State shall be  | 
|  | 
| deposited into the
district's transportation fund or into the  | 
| fund from which the allowable
expenditures were made.
 | 
|     Notwithstanding any other provision of law, any school  | 
| district receiving
a payment under this Section or under  | 
| Section 14-7.02, 14-7.02b, or
14-13.01 of this Code may  | 
| classify all or a portion of the funds that it
receives in a  | 
| particular fiscal year or from general State aid pursuant to
 | 
| Section 18-8.05 of this Code
as funds received in connection  | 
| with any funding program for which it is
entitled to receive  | 
| funds from the State in that fiscal year (including,
without  | 
| limitation, any funding program referenced in this Section),
 | 
| regardless of the source or timing of the receipt.  The district  | 
| may not
classify more funds as funds received in connection  | 
| with the funding
program than the district is entitled to  | 
| receive in that fiscal year for that
program.  Any
 | 
| classification by a district must be made by a resolution of  | 
| its board of
education.  The resolution must identify the amount  | 
| of any payments or
general State aid to be classified under  | 
| this paragraph and must specify
the funding program to which  | 
| the funds are to be treated as received in
connection  | 
| therewith.  This resolution is controlling as to the
 | 
| classification of funds referenced therein.  A certified copy of  | 
| the
resolution must be sent to the State Superintendent of  | 
| Education.
The resolution shall still take effect even though a  | 
| copy of the resolution has
not been sent to the State
 | 
| Superintendent of Education in a timely manner.
 No
 | 
|  | 
| classification under this paragraph by a district shall affect  | 
| the total amount
or timing of money the district is entitled to  | 
| receive under this Code.
  No classification under this paragraph  | 
| by a district shall
in any way relieve the district from or  | 
| affect any
requirements that otherwise would apply with respect  | 
| to
that funding program, including any
accounting of funds by  | 
| source, reporting expenditures by
original source and purpose,
 | 
| reporting requirements,
or requirements of providing services.
 | 
|     Any school district with a population of not more than  | 
| 500,000
must deposit all funds received under this Article into  | 
| the transportation
fund and use those funds for the provision  | 
| of transportation services.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 95-903, eff. 8-25-08; 96-1264, eff. 1-1-11.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/34-2.3)  (from Ch. 122, par. 34-2.3)
 | 
|     Sec. 34-2.3. Local school councils - Powers and duties.  | 
| Each local school
council shall have and exercise, consistent  | 
| with the provisions of
this Article and the powers and duties  | 
| of
the board of education, the following powers and duties:
 | 
|     1. (A) To annually evaluate the performance of the  | 
| principal of the
attendance
center
using a Board approved  | 
| principal evaluation form, which shall include the
evaluation  | 
| of
(i) student academic improvement, as defined by the
school  | 
| improvement plan, (ii)
student absenteeism rates
at the school,  | 
| (iii) instructional leadership, (iv) the effective
 | 
| implementation of
programs, policies, or strategies to improve  | 
|  | 
| student academic achievement,
(v) school management, and (vi)  | 
| any other factors deemed relevant by the local
school council,  | 
| including, without limitation, the principal's communication
 | 
| skills and ability to create and maintain a student-centered  | 
| learning
environment, to develop opportunities for  | 
| professional development, and to
encourage parental  | 
| involvement and community partnerships to achieve school
 | 
| improvement;
 | 
|     (B) to determine in the manner provided by subsection (c)  | 
| of Section
34-2.2 and subdivision 1.5 of this Section whether  | 
| the performance contract
of the principal shall be
renewed; and
 | 
|     (C) to directly select, in the manner provided by
 | 
| subsection (c) of
Section 34-2.2, a new principal (including a  | 
| new principal to fill a
vacancy)
-- without submitting any list  | 
| of candidates for that position to the
general superintendent  | 
| as provided in paragraph 2 of this Section -- to
serve under a  | 
| 4 year performance contract; provided that (i) the  | 
| determination
of whether the principal's performance contract  | 
| is to be renewed, based upon
the evaluation required by  | 
| subdivision 1.5 of this Section, shall be made no
later than  | 
| 150 days prior to the expiration of the current  | 
| performance-based
contract of the principal, (ii) in cases  | 
| where such performance
contract is not renewed -- a
direct  | 
| selection
of a
new principal -- to serve under a 4 year  | 
| performance contract shall be made by
the local school council  | 
| no later than 45 days prior to the expiration of the
current  | 
|  | 
| performance contract of the principal, and (iii) a
selection by
 | 
| the local school council of a new principal to fill a vacancy  | 
| under a 4 year
performance contract shall be made within 90  | 
| days after the date such vacancy
occurs.  A Council shall be  | 
| required, if requested by the principal, to provide
in writing  | 
| the reasons for the council's not renewing the principal's  | 
| contract.
 | 
|     1.5. The local school council's determination of whether to  | 
| renew the
principal's contract shall be based on an evaluation  | 
| to assess the educational
and administrative progress made at  | 
| the school during the principal's current
performance-based  | 
| contract.  The local school council shall base its evaluation
on  | 
| (i) student academic improvement, as defined by the school  | 
| improvement plan,
(ii) student absenteeism rates at the school,  | 
| (iii) instructional leadership,
(iv) the effective  | 
| implementation of programs, policies, or strategies to
improve  | 
| student academic achievement, (v) school management, and (vi)  | 
| any
other factors deemed relevant by the local school council,  | 
| including, without
limitation, the principal's communication  | 
| skills and ability to create and
maintain a student-centered  | 
| learning environment, to develop opportunities for
 | 
| professional development, and to encourage parental  | 
| involvement and community
partnerships to achieve school  | 
| improvement.  If a local school council
fails to renew the  | 
| performance contract of a principal rated by the general
 | 
| superintendent, or his or her designee, in the previous years'  | 
|  | 
| evaluations as
meeting or exceeding expectations, the  | 
| principal, within 15 days after the
local school council's  | 
| decision not to renew the contract, may request a review
of the
 | 
| local school council's principal non-retention decision by a  | 
| hearing officer
appointed by the American Arbitration  | 
| Association.  A local school council
member or members or the  | 
| general superintendent may support the principal's
request for  | 
| review.
During the period of the hearing officer's review of  | 
| the local school
council's decision on
whether or not to retain  | 
| the principal, the local school council shall maintain
all  | 
| authority
to search for and contract with a person to serve
as  | 
| interim or acting
principal, or as the
principal of the  | 
| attendance center under a 4-year performance contract,
 | 
| provided that any performance contract entered into by the  | 
| local school council
shall be voidable
or
modified in  | 
| accordance with the decision of the hearing officer.
The  | 
| principal may request review only once while at that
attendance  | 
| center.  If a local school council renews the contract of a
 | 
| principal who failed to obtain a rating of "meets" or "exceeds  | 
| expectations" in
the general superintendent's evaluation for  | 
| the previous year, the general superintendent,
within 15
days  | 
| after the local
school council's decision to renew the  | 
| contract,
may request a review of
the local school council's  | 
| principal retention decision by a hearing officer
appointed by  | 
| the American Arbitration Association.  The general  | 
| superintendent may request a review only
once
for that  | 
|  | 
| principal at that attendance center.  All requests to review the
 | 
| retention or non-retention of a principal shall be submitted to  | 
| the general
superintendent, who shall, in turn, forward such  | 
| requests, within 14 days of
receipt, to the American  | 
| Arbitration Association.
The general superintendent shall send  | 
| a contemporaneous copy of the request
that was forwarded to the  | 
| American Arbitration Association to the principal and
to each  | 
| local school council member and shall inform the local school  | 
| council
of its rights and responsibilities under the  | 
| arbitration process, including the
local school council's  | 
| right to representation and the manner and process by
which the  | 
| Board shall pay the costs of the council's representation.
If  | 
| the local school council retains the
principal and the general  | 
| superintendent requests a review of the retention
decision, the  | 
| local school council and the general
superintendent shall be  | 
| considered parties to the arbitration, a hearing officer shall
 | 
| be
chosen between those 2
parties pursuant to procedures  | 
| promulgated by the State Board of Education,
and the principal  | 
| may retain counsel and participate in the arbitration.  If the  | 
| local school council does not retain the principal and
the  | 
| principal requests a review of the retention decision, the  | 
| local school
council and the principal shall be considered  | 
| parties to the
arbitration and a hearing
officer shall be  | 
| chosen between those 2 parties pursuant to procedures
 | 
| promulgated by the State Board of Education.
The hearing shall  | 
| begin (i)
within 45 days
after the initial request for review  | 
|  | 
| is submitted by the principal to the
general superintendent or  | 
| (ii) if the
initial request for
review is made by the general  | 
| superintendent, within 45 days after that request
is mailed
to  | 
| the American Arbitration Association.
The hearing officer  | 
| shall render a
decision within 45
days after the hearing begins  | 
| and within 90 days after the initial request
for review.
The  | 
| Board shall contract with the American
Arbitration Association  | 
| for all of the hearing officer's reasonable and
necessary  | 
| costs.  In addition, the Board shall pay any reasonable costs
 | 
| incurred by a local school council for representation before a  | 
| hearing
officer.
 | 
|     1.10. The hearing officer shall conduct a hearing, which  | 
| shall include (i)
a review of the principal's performance,  | 
| evaluations, and other evidence of
the principal's service at  | 
| the school, (ii) reasons provided by the local
school council  | 
| for its decision, and (iii) documentation evidencing views of
 | 
| interested persons, including,
without limitation, students,  | 
| parents, local school council members, school
faculty and  | 
| staff, the principal, the general superintendent or his or her
 | 
| designee, and members of the community. The burden of proof in  | 
| establishing
that the local school council's decision was  | 
| arbitrary and capricious shall be
on the party requesting the  | 
| arbitration, and this party shall sustain the
burden by a  | 
| preponderance of the evidence.
The hearing officer shall set  | 
| the
local school council decision aside if that decision, in  | 
| light of the record
developed at the hearing, is arbitrary and  | 
|  | 
| capricious.  The decision of the
hearing officer may not be  | 
| appealed to the Board or the State Board of
Education.  If the  | 
| hearing officer decides that the principal shall be
retained,  | 
| the retention period shall not exceed 2 years.
 | 
|     2. In the event (i) the local school council does not renew  | 
| the
performance contract of the principal, or the principal  | 
| fails to receive a
satisfactory rating as provided in  | 
| subsection (h) of Section 34-8.3,
or the principal is
removed  | 
| for cause during the term of his or her performance contract
in  | 
| the manner provided by Section 34-85, or a vacancy in the  | 
| position
of principal otherwise occurs prior to the expiration  | 
| of the term of
a principal's performance contract, and (ii) the  | 
| local school council
fails to directly select a new principal  | 
| to serve under a 4 year performance
contract,
the local school  | 
| council in such event shall submit to the general
 | 
| superintendent a list of 3 candidates -- listed in the local  | 
| school
council's order of preference -- for the position of  | 
| principal, one of
which shall be selected by the general  | 
| superintendent to serve as
principal of the attendance center.   | 
| If the general superintendent
fails or refuses to select one of  | 
| the candidates on the list to serve as
principal within 30 days  | 
| after being furnished with the candidate list,
the general  | 
| superintendent shall select and place a principal on an interim
 | 
| basis (i) for a period not to exceed one year or (ii) until the  | 
| local school
council selects a new principal with 7 affirmative  | 
| votes as
provided in subsection (c) of Section 34-2.2,  | 
|  | 
| whichever occurs first.  If the
local school council
fails or  | 
| refuses to select and appoint a new principal, as specified by
 | 
| subsection (c) of Section 34-2.2, the general superintendent  | 
| may select and
appoint a new principal on an interim basis for
 | 
| an additional year or until a new contract principal is  | 
| selected by the local
school council.  There shall be no  | 
| discrimination on the basis of
race, sex, creed, color or
 | 
| disability unrelated to ability to perform in
connection with  | 
| the submission of candidates for, and the selection of a
 | 
| candidate to serve as principal of an attendance center.  No  | 
| person shall
be directly selected, listed as a candidate for,  | 
| or selected to serve as
principal of an attendance center (i)  | 
| if such person has been removed for cause
from employment by  | 
| the Board or (ii) if such person does not hold a valid
 | 
| administrative certificate issued or exchanged under Article  | 
| 21 and
endorsed as required by that Article for the position of  | 
| principal.  A
principal whose performance contract is not  | 
| renewed as provided under
subsection (c) of Section 34-2.2 may  | 
| nevertheless, if otherwise qualified
and certified as herein  | 
| provided
and if he or she has received a satisfactory rating as  | 
| provided in subsection
(h) of Section 34-8.3, be included by a  | 
| local school council as
one of the 3 candidates listed in order  | 
| of preference on any candidate list
from which one person is to  | 
| be selected to serve as principal of the
attendance center  | 
| under a new performance contract.  The initial candidate
list  | 
| required to be submitted by a local school council to the  | 
|  | 
| general
superintendent in cases where the local school council  | 
| does not renew the
performance contract of its principal and  | 
| does not directly select a new
principal to serve under a 4  | 
| year performance contract shall be submitted
not later than
30  | 
| days prior to the expiration of the current performance  | 
| contract.  In
cases where the local school council fails or  | 
| refuses to submit the candidate
list to the general  | 
| superintendent no later than 30 days prior to the
expiration of  | 
| the incumbent principal's contract, the general superintendent
 | 
| may
appoint a principal on an interim basis for a period not to  | 
| exceed one year,
during which time the local school council  | 
| shall be able to select a new
principal with 7 affirmative  | 
| votes as provided in subsection (c) of Section
34-2.2.  In cases  | 
| where a principal is removed for cause or a
vacancy otherwise  | 
| occurs in the position of principal and the vacancy is
not  | 
| filled by direct selection by the local school council, the  | 
| candidate
list shall be submitted by the local school council  | 
| to the general
superintendent within 90 days after the date  | 
| such
removal or
vacancy occurs.
In cases where the local school  | 
| council fails or refuses to submit the
candidate list to the  | 
| general superintendent within 90 days after the date of
the  | 
| vacancy, the general superintendent may appoint a principal on  | 
| an interim
basis for a period of one year, during which time  | 
| the local school council
shall be able to select a new  | 
| principal with 7 affirmative votes as provided in
subsection  | 
| (c) of Section 34-2.2.
 | 
|  | 
|     2.5. Whenever a vacancy in the office of a principal occurs  | 
| for any reason,
the vacancy shall be filled in the manner  | 
| provided by this Section by the
selection of a new principal to  | 
| serve under a 4 year performance contract.
 | 
|     3. To establish additional criteria
to be included as part  | 
| of
the
performance contract of its principal, provided that  | 
| such additional
criteria shall not discriminate on the basis of  | 
| race, sex, creed, color
or
disability unrelated to ability to  | 
| perform, and shall not be inconsistent
with the uniform 4 year  | 
| performance contract for principals developed by
the board as  | 
| provided in Section 34-8.1 of the School Code
or with other  | 
| provisions of this Article governing the
authority and  | 
| responsibility of principals.
 | 
|     4. To approve the expenditure plan prepared by the  | 
| principal with
respect to all funds allocated and distributed  | 
| to the attendance center by
the Board.  The expenditure plan  | 
| shall be administered by the principal.
Notwithstanding any  | 
| other provision of this Act or any other law, any
expenditure  | 
| plan approved and
administered under this Section 34-2.3 shall  | 
| be consistent with and subject to
the terms of any contract for  | 
| services with a third party entered into by the
Chicago School  | 
| Reform Board of Trustees or the board under this Act.
 | 
|     Via a supermajority vote of 7 members of the local school  | 
| council or 8
members of a high school local school council, the  | 
| Council may transfer
allocations pursuant to Section 34-2.3  | 
| within funds; provided that such a
transfer is consistent with  | 
|  | 
| applicable law and
collective bargaining
agreements.
 | 
|     Beginning in fiscal year 1991 and in each fiscal year
 | 
| thereafter, the
Board may reserve up to 1% of its total fiscal  | 
| year budget for
distribution
on a prioritized basis to schools  | 
| throughout the school system in order to
assure adequate  | 
| programs to meet the needs of
special student populations as  | 
| determined by the Board.  This distribution
shall take into  | 
| account the needs catalogued in the Systemwide Plan and the
 | 
| various local school improvement plans of the local school  | 
| councils.
Information about these centrally funded programs  | 
| shall be distributed to
the local school councils so that their  | 
| subsequent planning and programming
will account for these  | 
| provisions.
 | 
|     Beginning in fiscal year 1991 and in each fiscal year  | 
| thereafter, from
other amounts available in the applicable  | 
| fiscal year budget, the board
shall allocate a lump sum amount  | 
| to each local school based upon
such formula as the board shall  | 
| determine taking into account the special needs
of the student  | 
| body.  The local school
principal shall develop an expenditure  | 
| plan in consultation with the local
school council, the  | 
| professional personnel leadership
committee and with all
other  | 
| school personnel, which reflects the
priorities and activities  | 
| as described in the school's local school
improvement plan and  | 
| is consistent with applicable law and collective
bargaining  | 
| agreements and with board policies and standards; however, the
 | 
| local school council shall have the right to request waivers of  | 
|  | 
| board policy
from the board of education and waivers of  | 
| employee collective bargaining
agreements pursuant to Section  | 
| 34-8.1a. 
 | 
|     The expenditure plan developed by the principal with  | 
| respect to
amounts available from the fund for prioritized  | 
| special needs programs
and the allocated lump sum amount must  | 
| be approved by the local school council.
 | 
|     The lump sum allocation shall take into account the
 | 
| following principles:
 | 
|         a. Teachers: Each school shall be allocated funds equal  | 
| to the
amount appropriated in the previous school year for  | 
| compensation for
teachers (regular grades kindergarten  | 
| through 12th grade) plus whatever
increases in  | 
| compensation have been negotiated contractually or through
 | 
| longevity as provided in the negotiated agreement.   | 
| Adjustments shall be
made due to layoff or reduction in  | 
| force, lack of funds or work, change in
subject  | 
| requirements, enrollment changes, or contracts with third
 | 
| parties for the performance of services or to rectify
any  | 
| inconsistencies with system-wide allocation formulas or  | 
| for other
legitimate reasons.
 | 
|         b. Other personnel: Funds for other teacher  | 
| certificated and
uncertificated personnel paid through  | 
| non-categorical funds shall be
provided according to  | 
| system-wide formulas based on student enrollment and
the  | 
| special needs of the school as determined by the Board.
 | 
|  | 
|         c. Non-compensation items: Appropriations for all  | 
| non-compensation items
shall be based on system-wide  | 
| formulas based on student enrollment and
on the special  | 
| needs of the school or factors related to the physical
 | 
| plant, including but not limited to textbooks, electronic  | 
| textbooks and the technological equipment necessary to  | 
| gain access to and use electronic textbooks, supplies,  | 
| electricity,
equipment, and routine maintenance.
 | 
|         d. Funds for categorical programs: Schools shall  | 
| receive personnel
and funds based on, and shall use such  | 
| personnel and funds in accordance
with State and Federal  | 
| requirements applicable to each
categorical program
 | 
| provided to meet the special needs of the student body  | 
| (including but not
limited to, Federal Chapter I,  | 
| Bilingual, and Special Education).
 | 
|         d.1. Funds for State Title I:  Each school shall receive
 | 
| funds based on State and Board requirements applicable to  | 
| each State
Title I pupil provided to meet the special needs  | 
| of the student body.  Each
school shall receive the  | 
| proportion of funds as provided in Section 18-8 or 18-8.15  | 
| to
which they are entitled.  These funds shall be spent only  | 
| with the
budgetary approval of the Local School Council as  | 
| provided in Section 34-2.3.
 | 
|         e. The Local School Council shall have the right to  | 
| request the
principal to close positions and open new ones  | 
| consistent with the
provisions of the local school  | 
|  | 
| improvement plan provided that these
decisions are  | 
| consistent with applicable law and
collective bargaining
 | 
| agreements.  If a position is closed, pursuant to this  | 
| paragraph, the local
school shall have for its use the  | 
| system-wide average compensation for the
closed position.
 | 
|         f. Operating within existing laws and
collective  | 
| bargaining agreements,
the local school council shall have  | 
| the right to direct the principal to
shift expenditures  | 
| within funds.
 | 
|         g. (Blank).
 | 
|     Any funds unexpended at the end of the fiscal year shall be  | 
| available to
the board of education for use as part of its  | 
| budget for the following
fiscal year.
 | 
|     5. To make recommendations to the principal concerning  | 
| textbook
selection and concerning curriculum developed  | 
| pursuant to the school
improvement plan which is consistent  | 
| with systemwide curriculum objectives
in accordance with  | 
| Sections 34-8 and 34-18 of the School Code and in
conformity  | 
| with the collective bargaining agreement.
 | 
|     6. To advise the principal concerning the attendance and
 | 
| disciplinary policies for the attendance center, subject to the  | 
| provisions
of this Article and Article 26, and consistent with  | 
| the uniform system of
discipline established by the board  | 
| pursuant to Section 34-19.
 | 
|     7. To approve a school improvement plan developed as  | 
| provided in Section
34-2.4. The process and schedule for plan  | 
|  | 
| development shall be publicized
to the entire school community,  | 
| and the community shall be afforded the
opportunity to make  | 
| recommendations concerning the plan.  At least twice a
year the  | 
| principal and
local
school council shall report publicly on
 | 
| progress and problems with respect to plan implementation.
 | 
|     8. To evaluate the allocation of teaching resources and  | 
| other
certificated and uncertificated staff to the attendance  | 
| center to determine
whether such allocation is consistent with  | 
| and in furtherance of
instructional objectives and school  | 
| programs reflective of the school
improvement plan adopted for  | 
| the attendance center; and to make
recommendations to the  | 
| board, the general superintendent
and the
principal concerning  | 
| any reallocation of teaching resources
or other staff whenever  | 
| the council determines that any such
reallocation is  | 
| appropriate because the qualifications of any existing
staff at  | 
| the attendance center do not adequately match or support
 | 
| instructional objectives or school programs which reflect the  | 
| school
improvement plan.
 | 
|     9. To make recommendations to the principal and the general  | 
| superintendent
concerning their respective appointments, after  | 
| August 31, 1989, and in the
manner provided by Section 34-8 and  | 
| Section 34-8.1,
of persons to fill any vacant, additional or  | 
| newly created
positions for teachers at the attendance center  | 
| or at attendance centers
which include the attendance center  | 
| served by the local school council.
 | 
|     10. To request of the Board the manner in which training  | 
|  | 
| and
assistance shall be provided to the local school council.   | 
| Pursuant to Board
guidelines a local school council is  | 
| authorized to direct
the Board of Education to contract with  | 
| personnel or not-for-profit
organizations not associated with  | 
| the school district to train or assist
council members.  If  | 
| training or assistance is provided by contract with
personnel  | 
| or organizations not associated with the school district, the
 | 
| period of training or assistance shall not exceed 30 hours  | 
| during a given
school year; person shall not be employed on a  | 
| continuous basis longer than
said period and shall not have  | 
| been employed by the Chicago Board of
Education within the  | 
| preceding six months.  Council members shall receive
training in  | 
| at least the following areas:
 | 
|         1. school budgets;
 | 
|         2. educational theory pertinent to the attendance  | 
| center's particular
needs, including the development of  | 
| the school improvement plan and the
principal's  | 
| performance contract; and
 | 
|         3. personnel selection.
 | 
| Council members shall, to the greatest extent possible,  | 
| complete such
training within 90 days of election.
 | 
|     11. In accordance with systemwide guidelines contained in  | 
| the
System-Wide Educational Reform Goals and Objectives Plan,  | 
| criteria for
evaluation of performance shall be established for  | 
| local school councils
and local school council members.  If a  | 
| local school council persists in
noncompliance with systemwide  | 
|  | 
| requirements, the Board may impose sanctions
and take necessary  | 
| corrective action, consistent with Section 34-8.3.
 | 
|     12. Each local school council shall comply with the Open  | 
| Meetings Act and
the Freedom of Information Act.  Each local  | 
| school council shall issue and
transmit to its school community  | 
| a detailed annual report accounting for
its activities  | 
| programmatically and financially.  Each local school council
 | 
| shall convene at least 2 well-publicized meetings annually with  | 
| its entire
school community.  These meetings shall include  | 
| presentation of the
proposed local school improvement plan, of  | 
| the proposed school expenditure
plan, and the annual report,  | 
| and shall provide an opportunity for public
comment.
 | 
|     13. Each local school council is encouraged to involve  | 
| additional
non-voting members of the school community in  | 
| facilitating the council's
exercise of its responsibilities.
 | 
|     14. The local school council may adopt a school
uniform or  | 
| dress
code policy that governs the attendance center and that  | 
| is
necessary to maintain the orderly process of a school  | 
| function or prevent
endangerment of student health or safety,  | 
| consistent with the policies and
rules of the Board of  | 
| Education.
A school uniform or dress code policy adopted
by a  | 
| local school council: (i) shall not be applied in such manner  | 
| as to
discipline or deny attendance to a transfer student or  | 
| any other student for
noncompliance with that
policy during  | 
| such period of time as is reasonably necessary to enable the
 | 
| student to acquire a school uniform or otherwise comply with  | 
|  | 
| the dress code
policy that is in effect at the attendance  | 
| center into which the student's
enrollment is transferred; and  | 
| (ii) shall include criteria and procedures under
 which the  | 
| local school council will accommodate the needs of or otherwise
 | 
| provide
appropriate resources to assist a student from an  | 
| indigent family in complying
with an applicable school uniform  | 
| or dress code policy.
A student whose parents or legal  | 
| guardians object on religious grounds to the
student's  | 
| compliance with an applicable school uniform or dress code  | 
| policy
shall not be required to comply with that policy if the  | 
| student's parents or
legal guardians present to the local  | 
| school council a signed statement of
objection detailing the  | 
| grounds for the objection.
 | 
|     15. All decisions made and actions taken by the local  | 
| school council in
the exercise of its powers and duties shall  | 
| comply with State and federal
laws, all applicable collective  | 
| bargaining agreements, court orders and
rules properly  | 
| promulgated by the Board.
 | 
|     15a. To grant, in accordance with board rules and policies,
 | 
| the use of assembly halls and classrooms when not otherwise  | 
| needed,
including lighting, heat, and attendants, for public  | 
| lectures, concerts, and
other educational and social  | 
| activities.
 | 
|     15b. To approve, in accordance with board rules and  | 
| policies, receipts and
expenditures for all internal accounts  | 
| of the
attendance center, and to approve all fund-raising  | 
|  | 
| activities by nonschool
organizations that use the school  | 
| building.
 | 
|     16. (Blank).
 | 
|     17. Names and addresses of local school council members  | 
| shall
be a matter of public record.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 96-1403, eff. 7-29-10.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/34-18)  (from Ch. 122, par. 34-18)
 | 
|     Sec. 34-18. Powers of the board. The board shall exercise  | 
| general
supervision and jurisdiction over the public education  | 
| and the public
school system of the city, and, except as  | 
| otherwise provided by this
Article, shall have power:
 | 
|         1. To make suitable provision for the establishment and  | 
| maintenance
throughout the year or for such portion thereof  | 
| as it may direct, not
less than 9 months, of schools of all  | 
| grades and kinds, including normal
schools, high schools,  | 
| night schools, schools for defectives and
delinquents,  | 
| parental and truant schools, schools for the blind, the
 | 
| deaf and persons with physical disabilities, schools or  | 
| classes in manual training,
constructural and vocational  | 
| teaching, domestic arts and physical
culture, vocation and  | 
| extension schools and lecture courses, and all
other  | 
| educational courses and facilities, including  | 
| establishing,
equipping, maintaining and operating  | 
| playgrounds and recreational
programs, when such programs  | 
| are conducted in, adjacent to, or connected
with any public  | 
|  | 
| school under the general supervision and jurisdiction
of  | 
| the board; provided that the calendar for the school term  | 
| and any changes must be submitted to and approved by the  | 
| State Board of Education before the calendar or changes may  | 
| take effect, and provided that in allocating funds
from  | 
| year to year for the operation of all attendance centers  | 
| within the
district, the board shall ensure that  | 
| supplemental general State aid or supplemental grant funds
 | 
| are allocated and applied in accordance with Section 18-8,  | 
| or 18-8.05, or 18-8.15.  To
admit to such
schools without  | 
| charge foreign exchange students who are participants in
an  | 
| organized exchange student program which is authorized by  | 
| the board.
The board shall permit all students to enroll in  | 
| apprenticeship programs
in trade schools operated by the  | 
| board, whether those programs are
union-sponsored or not.   | 
| No student shall be refused admission into or
be excluded  | 
| from any course of instruction offered in the common  | 
| schools
by reason of that student's sex.  No student shall  | 
| be denied equal
access to physical education and  | 
| interscholastic athletic programs
supported from school  | 
| district funds or denied participation in
comparable  | 
| physical education and athletic programs solely by reason  | 
| of
the student's sex.  Equal access to programs supported  | 
| from school
district funds and comparable programs will be  | 
| defined in rules
promulgated by the State Board of  | 
| Education in
consultation with the Illinois High School  | 
|  | 
| Association.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this  | 
| Article, neither the board
of education nor any local  | 
| school council or other school official shall
recommend  | 
| that children with disabilities be placed into regular  | 
| education
classrooms unless those children with  | 
| disabilities are provided with
supplementary services to  | 
| assist them so that they benefit from the regular
classroom  | 
| instruction and are included on the teacher's regular  | 
| education
class register;
 | 
|         2. To furnish lunches to pupils, to make a reasonable  | 
| charge
therefor, and to use school funds for the payment of  | 
| such expenses as
the board may determine are necessary in  | 
| conducting the school lunch
program;
 | 
|         3. To co-operate with the circuit court;
 | 
|         4. To make arrangements with the public or quasi-public  | 
| libraries
and museums for the use of their facilities by  | 
| teachers and pupils of
the public schools;
 | 
|         5. To employ dentists and prescribe their duties for  | 
| the purpose of
treating the pupils in the schools, but  | 
| accepting such treatment shall
be optional with parents or  | 
| guardians;
 | 
|         6. To grant the use of assembly halls and classrooms  | 
| when not
otherwise needed, including light, heat, and  | 
| attendants, for free public
lectures, concerts, and other  | 
| educational and social interests, free of
charge, under  | 
| such provisions and control as the principal of the
 | 
|  | 
| affected attendance center may prescribe;
 | 
|         7. To apportion the pupils to the several schools;  | 
| provided that no pupil
shall be excluded from or segregated  | 
| in any such school on account of his
color, race, sex, or  | 
| nationality.  The board shall take into consideration
the  | 
| prevention of segregation and the elimination of  | 
| separation of children
in public schools because of color,  | 
| race, sex, or nationality.  Except that
children may be  | 
| committed to or attend parental and social adjustment  | 
| schools
established and maintained either for boys or girls  | 
| only.  All records
pertaining to the creation, alteration or  | 
| revision of attendance areas shall
be open to the public.   | 
| Nothing herein shall limit the board's authority to
 | 
| establish multi-area attendance centers or other student  | 
| assignment systems
for desegregation purposes or  | 
| otherwise, and to apportion the pupils to the
several  | 
| schools.  Furthermore, beginning in school year 1994-95,  | 
| pursuant
to a board plan adopted by October 1, 1993, the  | 
| board shall offer, commencing
on a phased-in basis, the  | 
| opportunity for families within the school
district to  | 
| apply for enrollment of their children in any attendance  | 
| center
within the school district which does not have  | 
| selective admission
requirements approved by the board.   | 
| The appropriate geographical area in
which such open  | 
| enrollment may be exercised shall be determined by the
 | 
| board of education.  Such children may be admitted to any  | 
|  | 
| such attendance
center on a space available basis after all  | 
| children residing within such
attendance center's area  | 
| have been accommodated.  If the number of
applicants from  | 
| outside the attendance area exceed the  space available,
 | 
| then successful applicants shall be selected by lottery.   | 
| The board of
education's open enrollment plan must include  | 
| provisions that allow low
income students to have access to  | 
| transportation needed to exercise school
choice.  Open  | 
| enrollment shall be in compliance with the provisions of  | 
| the
Consent Decree and Desegregation Plan cited in Section  | 
| 34-1.01;
 | 
|         8. To approve programs and policies for providing  | 
| transportation
services to students. Nothing herein shall  | 
| be construed to permit or empower
the State Board of  | 
| Education to order, mandate, or require busing or other
 | 
| transportation of pupils for the purpose of achieving  | 
| racial balance in any
school;
 | 
|         9. Subject to the limitations in this Article, to  | 
| establish and
approve system-wide curriculum objectives  | 
| and standards, including graduation
standards, which  | 
| reflect the
multi-cultural diversity in the city and are  | 
| consistent with State law,
provided that for all purposes  | 
| of this Article courses or
proficiency in American Sign  | 
| Language shall be deemed to constitute courses
or  | 
| proficiency in a foreign language; and to employ principals  | 
| and teachers,
appointed as provided in this
Article, and  | 
|  | 
| fix their compensation.  The board shall prepare such  | 
| reports
related to minimal competency testing as may be  | 
| requested by the State
Board of Education, and in addition  | 
| shall monitor and approve special
education and bilingual  | 
| education programs and policies within the district to
 | 
| assure that appropriate services are provided in  | 
| accordance with applicable
State and federal laws to  | 
| children requiring services and education in those
areas;
 | 
|         10. To employ non-teaching personnel or utilize  | 
| volunteer personnel
for: (i) non-teaching duties not  | 
| requiring instructional judgment or
evaluation of pupils,  | 
| including library duties; and (ii) supervising study
 | 
| halls, long distance teaching reception areas used  | 
| incident to instructional
programs transmitted by  | 
| electronic media such as computers, video, and audio,
 | 
| detention and discipline areas, and school-sponsored  | 
| extracurricular
activities.  The board may further utilize  | 
| volunteer non-certificated
personnel or employ  | 
| non-certificated personnel to
assist in the instruction of  | 
| pupils under the immediate supervision of a
teacher holding  | 
| a valid certificate, directly engaged in teaching
subject  | 
| matter or conducting activities; provided that the teacher
 | 
| shall be continuously aware of the non-certificated  | 
| persons' activities and
shall be able to control or modify  | 
| them.  The general superintendent shall
determine  | 
| qualifications of such personnel and shall prescribe rules  | 
|  | 
| for
determining the duties and activities to be assigned to  | 
| such personnel;
 | 
|         10.5. To utilize volunteer personnel from a regional  | 
| School Crisis
Assistance Team (S.C.A.T.), created as part  | 
| of the Safe to Learn Program
established pursuant to  | 
| Section 25 of the Illinois Violence Prevention Act
of 1995,  | 
| to provide assistance to schools in times of violence or  | 
| other
traumatic incidents within a school community by  | 
| providing crisis
intervention services to lessen the  | 
| effects of emotional trauma on
individuals and the  | 
| community; the School Crisis Assistance Team
Steering  | 
| Committee shall determine the qualifications for  | 
| volunteers;
 | 
|         11. To provide television studio facilities in not to  | 
| exceed one
school building and to provide programs for  | 
| educational purposes,
provided, however, that the board  | 
| shall not construct, acquire, operate,
or maintain a  | 
| television transmitter; to grant the use of its studio
 | 
| facilities to a licensed television station located in the  | 
| school
district; and to maintain and operate not to exceed  | 
| one school radio
transmitting station and provide programs  | 
| for educational purposes;
 | 
|         12. To offer, if deemed appropriate, outdoor education  | 
| courses,
including field trips within the State of  | 
| Illinois, or adjacent states,
and to use school educational  | 
| funds for the expense of the said outdoor
educational  | 
|  | 
| programs, whether within the school district or not;
 | 
|         13. During that period of the calendar year not  | 
| embraced within the
regular school term, to provide and  | 
| conduct courses in subject matters
normally embraced in the  | 
| program of the schools during the regular
school term and  | 
| to give regular school credit for satisfactory
completion  | 
| by the student of such courses as may be approved for  | 
| credit
by the State Board of Education;
 | 
|         14. To insure against any loss or liability of the  | 
| board,
the former School Board Nominating Commission,  | 
| Local School Councils, the
Chicago Schools Academic  | 
| Accountability Council, or the former Subdistrict
Councils  | 
| or of any member, officer, agent or employee thereof,  | 
| resulting
from alleged violations of civil rights arising  | 
| from incidents occurring on
or after September 5, 1967 or  | 
| from the wrongful or negligent act or
omission of any such  | 
| person whether occurring within or without the school
 | 
| premises, provided the officer, agent or employee was, at  | 
| the time of the
alleged violation of civil rights or  | 
| wrongful act or omission, acting
within the scope of his  | 
| employment or under direction of the board, the
former  | 
| School
Board Nominating Commission, the Chicago Schools  | 
| Academic Accountability
Council, Local School Councils, or  | 
| the former Subdistrict Councils;
and to provide for or  | 
| participate in insurance plans for its officers and
 | 
| employees, including but not limited to retirement  | 
|  | 
| annuities, medical,
surgical and hospitalization benefits  | 
| in such types and amounts as may be
determined by the  | 
| board; provided, however, that the board shall contract
for  | 
| such insurance only with an insurance company authorized to  | 
| do business
in this State.  Such insurance may include  | 
| provision for employees who rely
on treatment by prayer or  | 
| spiritual means alone for healing, in accordance
with the  | 
| tenets and practice of a recognized religious  | 
| denomination;
 | 
|         15. To contract with the corporate authorities of any  | 
| municipality
or the county board of any county, as the case  | 
| may be, to provide for
the regulation of traffic in parking  | 
| areas of property used for school
purposes, in such manner  | 
| as is provided by Section 11-209 of The
Illinois Vehicle  | 
| Code, approved September 29, 1969, as amended;
 | 
|         16. (a) To provide, on an equal basis, access to a high
 | 
| school campus and student directory information to the
 | 
| official recruiting representatives of the armed forces of  | 
| Illinois and
the United States for the purposes of  | 
| informing students of the educational
and career  | 
| opportunities available in the military if the board has  | 
| provided
such access to persons or groups whose purpose is  | 
| to acquaint students with
educational or occupational  | 
| opportunities available to them.  The board
is not required  | 
| to give greater notice regarding the right of access to
 | 
| recruiting representatives than is given to other persons  | 
|  | 
| and groups.  In
this paragraph 16, "directory information"  | 
| means a high school
student's name, address, and telephone  | 
| number.
 | 
|         (b) If a student or his or her parent or guardian  | 
| submits a signed,
written request to the high school before  | 
| the end of the student's sophomore
year (or if the student  | 
| is a transfer student, by another time set by
the high  | 
| school) that indicates that the student or his or her  | 
| parent or
guardian does
not want the student's directory  | 
| information to be provided to official
recruiting  | 
| representatives under subsection (a) of this Section, the  | 
| high
school may not provide access to the student's  | 
| directory information to
these recruiting representatives.   | 
| The high school shall notify its
students and their parents  | 
| or guardians of the provisions of this
subsection (b).
 | 
|         (c) A high school may require official recruiting  | 
| representatives of
the armed forces of Illinois and the  | 
| United States to pay a fee for copying
and mailing a  | 
| student's directory information in an amount that is not
 | 
| more than the actual costs incurred by the high school.
 | 
|         (d) Information received by an official recruiting  | 
| representative
under this Section may be used only to  | 
| provide information to students
concerning educational and  | 
| career opportunities available in the military
and may not  | 
| be released to a person who is not involved in recruiting
 | 
| students for the armed forces of Illinois or the United  | 
|  | 
| States;
 | 
|         17. (a) To sell or market any computer program  | 
| developed by an employee
of the school district, provided  | 
| that such employee developed the computer
program as a  | 
| direct result of his or her duties with the school district
 | 
| or through the utilization of the school district resources  | 
| or facilities.
The employee who developed the computer  | 
| program shall be entitled to share
in the proceeds of such  | 
| sale or marketing of the computer program.  The
distribution  | 
| of such proceeds between the employee and the school  | 
| district
shall be as agreed upon by the employee and the  | 
| school district, except
that neither the employee nor the  | 
| school district may receive more than 90%
of such proceeds.   | 
| The negotiation for an employee who is represented by an
 | 
| exclusive bargaining representative may be conducted by  | 
| such bargaining
representative at the employee's request.
 | 
|         (b) For the purpose of this paragraph 17:
 | 
|             (1) "Computer" means an internally programmed,  | 
| general purpose digital
device capable of  | 
| automatically accepting data, processing data and  | 
| supplying
the results of the operation.
 | 
|             (2) "Computer program" means a series of coded  | 
| instructions or
statements in a form acceptable to a  | 
| computer, which causes the computer to
process data in  | 
| order to achieve a certain result.
 | 
|             (3) "Proceeds" means profits derived from  | 
|  | 
| marketing or sale of a product
after deducting the  | 
| expenses of developing and marketing such product;
 | 
|         18. To delegate to the general superintendent of
 | 
| schools, by resolution, the authority to approve contracts  | 
| and expenditures
in amounts of $10,000 or less;
 | 
|         19. Upon the written request of an employee, to  | 
| withhold from
the compensation of that employee any dues,  | 
| payments or contributions
payable by such employee to any  | 
| labor organization as defined in the
Illinois Educational  | 
| Labor Relations Act.  Under such arrangement, an
amount  | 
| shall be withheld from each regular payroll period which is  | 
| equal to
the pro rata share of the annual dues plus any  | 
| payments or contributions,
and the board shall transmit  | 
| such withholdings to the specified labor
organization  | 
| within 10 working days from the time of the withholding;
 | 
|         19a. Upon receipt of notice from the comptroller of a  | 
| municipality with
a population of 500,000 or more, a county  | 
| with a population of 3,000,000 or
more, the Cook County  | 
| Forest Preserve District, the Chicago Park District, the
 | 
| Metropolitan Water Reclamation District, the Chicago  | 
| Transit Authority, or
a housing authority of a municipality  | 
| with a population of 500,000 or more
that a debt is due and  | 
| owing the municipality, the county, the Cook County
Forest  | 
| Preserve District, the Chicago Park District, the  | 
| Metropolitan Water
Reclamation District, the Chicago  | 
| Transit Authority, or the housing authority
by an employee  | 
|  | 
| of the Chicago Board of Education, to withhold, from the
 | 
| compensation of that employee, the amount of the debt that  | 
| is due and owing
and pay the amount withheld to the  | 
| municipality, the county, the Cook County
Forest Preserve  | 
| District, the Chicago Park District, the Metropolitan  | 
| Water
Reclamation District, the Chicago Transit Authority,  | 
| or the housing authority;
provided, however, that the  | 
| amount
deducted from any one salary or wage payment shall  | 
| not exceed 25% of the net
amount of the payment.  Before the  | 
| Board deducts any amount from any salary or
wage of an  | 
| employee under this paragraph, the municipality, the  | 
| county, the
Cook County Forest Preserve District, the  | 
| Chicago Park District, the
Metropolitan Water Reclamation  | 
| District, the Chicago Transit Authority, or the
housing  | 
| authority shall certify that (i) the employee has been  | 
| afforded an
opportunity for a hearing to dispute the debt  | 
| that is due and owing the
municipality, the county, the  | 
| Cook County Forest Preserve District, the Chicago
Park  | 
| District, the Metropolitan Water Reclamation District, the  | 
| Chicago Transit
Authority, or the housing authority and  | 
| (ii) the employee has received notice
of a wage deduction  | 
| order and has been afforded an opportunity for a hearing to
 | 
| object to the order.  For purposes of this paragraph, "net  | 
| amount" means that
part of the salary or wage payment  | 
| remaining after the deduction of any amounts
required by  | 
| law to be deducted and "debt due and owing" means (i) a  | 
|  | 
| specified
sum of money owed to the municipality, the  | 
| county, the Cook County Forest
Preserve District, the  | 
| Chicago Park District, the Metropolitan Water
Reclamation  | 
| District, the Chicago Transit Authority, or the housing  | 
| authority
for services, work, or goods, after the period  | 
| granted for payment has expired,
or (ii) a specified sum of  | 
| money owed to the municipality, the county, the Cook
County  | 
| Forest Preserve District, the Chicago Park District, the  | 
| Metropolitan
Water Reclamation District, the Chicago  | 
| Transit Authority, or the housing
authority pursuant to a  | 
| court order or order of an administrative hearing
officer  | 
| after the exhaustion of, or the failure to exhaust,  | 
| judicial review;
 | 
|         20. The board is encouraged to employ a sufficient  | 
| number of
certified school counselors to maintain a  | 
| student/counselor ratio of 250 to
1 by July 1, 1990.  Each  | 
| counselor shall spend at least 75% of his work
time in  | 
| direct contact with students and shall maintain a record of  | 
| such time;
 | 
|         21. To make available to students vocational and career
 | 
| counseling and to establish 5 special career counseling  | 
| days for students
and parents.  On these days  | 
| representatives of local businesses and
industries shall  | 
| be invited to the school campus and shall inform students
 | 
| of career opportunities available to them in the various  | 
| businesses and
industries.  Special consideration shall be  | 
|  | 
| given to counseling minority
students as to career  | 
| opportunities available to them in various fields.
For the  | 
| purposes of this paragraph, minority student means a person  | 
| who is any of the following:
 | 
|         (a) American Indian or Alaska Native (a person having  | 
| origins in any of the original peoples of North and South  | 
| America, including Central America, and who maintains  | 
| tribal affiliation or community attachment). | 
|         (b) Asian (a person having origins in any of the  | 
| original peoples of the Far East, Southeast Asia, or the  | 
| Indian subcontinent, including, but not limited to,  | 
| Cambodia, China, India, Japan, Korea, Malaysia, Pakistan,  | 
| the Philippine Islands, Thailand, and Vietnam). | 
|         (c) Black or African American (a person having origins  | 
| in any of the black racial groups of Africa). Terms such as  | 
| "Haitian" or "Negro" can be used in addition to "Black or  | 
| African American". | 
|         (d) Hispanic or Latino (a person of Cuban, Mexican,  | 
| Puerto Rican, South or Central American, or other Spanish  | 
| culture or origin, regardless of race). | 
|         (e) Native Hawaiian or Other Pacific Islander (a person  | 
| having origins in any of the original peoples of Hawaii,  | 
| Guam, Samoa, or other Pacific Islands).
 | 
|         Counseling days shall not be in lieu of regular school  | 
| days;
 | 
|         22. To report to the State Board of Education the  | 
|  | 
| annual
student dropout rate and number of students who  | 
| graduate from, transfer
from or otherwise leave bilingual  | 
| programs;
 | 
|         23. Except as otherwise provided in the Abused and  | 
| Neglected Child
Reporting Act or other applicable State or  | 
| federal law, to permit school
officials to withhold, from  | 
| any person, information on the whereabouts of
any child  | 
| removed from school premises when the child has been taken  | 
| into
protective custody as a victim of suspected child  | 
| abuse.  School officials
shall direct such person to the  | 
| Department of Children and Family Services,
or to the local  | 
| law enforcement agency if appropriate;
 | 
|         24. To develop a policy, based on the current state of  | 
| existing school
facilities, projected enrollment and  | 
| efficient utilization of available
resources, for capital  | 
| improvement of schools and school buildings within
the  | 
| district, addressing in that policy both the relative  | 
| priority for
major repairs, renovations and additions to  | 
| school facilities, and the
advisability or necessity of  | 
| building new school facilities or closing
existing schools  | 
| to meet current or projected demographic patterns within
 | 
| the district;
 | 
|         25. To make available to the students in every high  | 
| school attendance
center the ability to take all courses  | 
| necessary to comply with the Board
of Higher Education's  | 
| college entrance criteria effective in 1993;
 | 
|  | 
|         26. To encourage mid-career changes into the teaching  | 
| profession,
whereby qualified professionals become  | 
| certified teachers, by allowing
credit for professional  | 
| employment in related fields when determining point
of  | 
| entry on teacher pay scale;
 | 
|         27. To provide or contract out training programs for  | 
| administrative
personnel and principals with revised or  | 
| expanded duties pursuant to this
Act in order to assure  | 
| they have the knowledge and skills to perform
their duties;
 | 
|         28. To establish a fund for the prioritized special  | 
| needs programs, and
to allocate such funds and other lump  | 
| sum amounts to each attendance center
in a manner  | 
| consistent with the provisions of part 4 of Section 34-2.3.
 | 
| Nothing in this paragraph shall be construed to require any  | 
| additional
appropriations of State funds for this purpose;
 | 
|         29. (Blank);
 | 
|         30. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act or  | 
| any other law to
the contrary, to contract with third  | 
| parties for services otherwise performed
by employees,  | 
| including those in a bargaining unit, and to layoff those
 | 
| employees upon 14 days written notice to the affected  | 
| employees.  Those
contracts may be for a period not to  | 
| exceed 5 years and may be awarded on a
system-wide basis.   | 
| The board may not operate more than 30 contract schools,  | 
| provided that the board may operate an additional 5  | 
| contract turnaround schools pursuant to item (5.5) of  | 
|  | 
| subsection (d) of Section 34-8.3 of this Code;
 | 
|         31. To promulgate rules establishing procedures  | 
| governing the layoff or
reduction in force of employees and  | 
| the recall of such employees, including,
but not limited  | 
| to, criteria for such layoffs, reductions in force or  | 
| recall
rights of such employees and the weight to be given  | 
| to any particular
criterion.  Such criteria shall take into  | 
| account factors including, but not be
limited to,  | 
| qualifications, certifications, experience, performance  | 
| ratings or
evaluations, and any other factors relating to  | 
| an employee's job performance;
 | 
|         32. To develop a policy to prevent nepotism in the  | 
| hiring of personnel
or the selection of contractors;
 | 
|         33. To enter into a partnership agreement, as required  | 
| by
Section 34-3.5 of this Code, and, notwithstanding any  | 
| other
provision of law to the contrary, to promulgate  | 
| policies, enter into
contracts, and take any other action  | 
| necessary to accomplish the
objectives and implement the  | 
| requirements of that agreement; and
 | 
|         34. To establish a Labor Management Council to the  | 
| board
comprised of representatives of the board, the chief  | 
| executive
officer, and those labor organizations that are  | 
| the exclusive
representatives of employees of the board and  | 
| to promulgate
policies and procedures for the operation of  | 
| the Council.
 | 
|     The specifications of the powers herein granted are not to  | 
|  | 
| be
construed as exclusive but the board shall also exercise all  | 
| other
powers that they may be requisite or proper for the  | 
| maintenance and the
development of a public school system, not  | 
| inconsistent with the other
provisions of this Article or  | 
| provisions of this Code which apply to all
school districts.
 | 
|     In addition to the powers herein granted and authorized to  | 
| be exercised
by the board, it shall be the duty of the board to  | 
| review or to direct
independent reviews of special education  | 
| expenditures and services.
The board shall file a report of  | 
| such review with the General Assembly on
or before May 1, 1990.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 99-143, eff. 7-27-15.)
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/34-18.30)
 | 
|     Sec. 34-18.30. Dependents of military personnel; no  | 
| tuition charge. If, at the time of enrollment, a dependent of  | 
| United States military personnel is housed in temporary housing  | 
| located outside of the school district, but will be living  | 
| within the district within 60 days after the time of initial  | 
| enrollment, the dependent must be allowed to enroll, subject to  | 
| the requirements of this Section, and must not be charged  | 
| tuition. Any United States military personnel attempting to  | 
| enroll a dependent under this Section shall provide proof that  | 
| the dependent will be living within the district within 60 days  | 
| after the time of initial enrollment. Proof of residency may  | 
| include, but is not limited to, postmarked mail addressed to  | 
| the military personnel and sent to an address located within  | 
|  | 
| the district, a lease agreement for occupancy of a residence  | 
| located within the district, or proof of ownership of a  | 
| residence located within the district.  Non-resident dependents  | 
| of United States military personnel attending school on a  | 
| tuition-free basis may be counted for the purposes
of  | 
| determining the apportionment of State aid provided under  | 
| Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 95-331, eff. 8-21-07.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/34-43.1)  (from Ch. 122, par. 34-43.1)
 | 
|     Sec. 34-43.1. (A) Limitation of noninstructional costs. It  | 
| is the
purpose of this Section to establish for the Board of  | 
| Education and the
general superintendent of schools  | 
| requirements and standards which maximize
the proportion of  | 
| school district resources in direct support of
educational,  | 
| program, and building maintenance and safety services for the
 | 
| pupils of the district, and which correspondingly minimize the  | 
| amount and
proportion of such resources associated with  | 
| centralized administration,
administrative support services,  | 
| and other noninstructional services.
 | 
|     For the 1989-90 school year and for all subsequent school  | 
| years, the Board
of Education shall undertake budgetary and  | 
| expenditure control actions which
limit the administrative  | 
| expenditures of the Board of Education to levels,
as provided  | 
| for in this Section, which represent an average of the
 | 
| administrative expenses of all school districts in this State  | 
|  | 
| not subject
to Article 34.
 | 
|     (B) Certification of expenses by the State Superintendent  | 
| of Education.
The State Superintendent of Education shall  | 
| annually certify, on or before
May 1, to the Board of Education  | 
| and the School Finance Authority, for the
applicable school  | 
| year, the following information:
 | 
|         (1) the annual expenditures of all school districts of  | 
| the State not
subject to Article 34 properly attributable  | 
| to expenditure functions
defined by the rules and  | 
| regulations of the State Board of Education as:
2210  | 
| (Improvement of Instructional Services); 2300 (Support  | 
| Services -
General Administration) excluding, however,  | 
| 2320 (Executive Administrative
Services); 2490 (Other  | 
| Support Services - School Administration); 2500
(Support  | 
| Services - Business); 2600 (Support Services - Central);
 | 
|         (2) the total annual expenditures of all school  | 
| districts not subject to
Article 34 attributable to the  | 
| Education Fund, the Operations, Building and
Maintenance  | 
| Fund, the Transportation Fund and the Illinois Municipal
 | 
| Retirement Fund of the several districts, as defined by the  | 
| rules and
regulations of the State Board of Education; and
 | 
|         (3) a ratio, to be called the statewide average of  | 
| administrative
expenditures, derived by dividing the  | 
| expenditures certified pursuant to
paragraph (B)(1) by the  | 
| expenditures certified pursuant to paragraph (B)(2).
 | 
|     For purposes of the annual certification of expenditures  | 
|  | 
| and ratios
required by this Section, the "applicable year" of  | 
| certification shall
initially be the 1986-87 school year and,  | 
| in sequent years, each
succeeding school year.
 | 
|     The State Superintendent of Education shall consult with  | 
| the Board of
Education to ascertain whether particular  | 
| expenditure items allocable to
the administrative functions  | 
| enumerated in paragraph (B)(1) are
appropriately or  | 
| necessarily higher in the applicable school district than
in  | 
| the rest of the State due to noncomparable factors.  The State
 | 
| Superintendent shall also review the relevant cost proportions  | 
| in other
large urban school districts.  The State Superintendent  | 
| shall also review
the expenditure categories in paragraph  | 
| (B)(1) to ascertain whether they
contain school-level  | 
| expenses.  If he or she finds that adjustments to the
formula  | 
| are appropriate or necessary to establish a more fair and
 | 
| comparable standard for administrative cost for the Board of  | 
| Education or
to exclude school-level expenses, the State  | 
| Superintendent shall recommend
to the School Finance Authority  | 
| rules and regulations adjusting particular
subcategories in  | 
| this subsection (B) or adjusting certain costs in
determining  | 
| the budget and expenditure items properly attributable to the
 | 
| functions or otherwise adjust the formula.
 | 
|     (C) Administrative expenditure limitations.  The annual  | 
| budget of the
Board of Education, as adopted and implemented,  | 
| and the
related annual expenditures for the school year, shall  | 
| reflect a limitation
on administrative outlays as required by  | 
|  | 
| the following provisions, taking
into account any adjustments  | 
| established by the State Superintendent of
Education: (1) the  | 
| budget and expenditures of the Board of Education for
the  | 
| 1989-90 school year  shall reflect a ratio of administrative
 | 
| expenditures to total expenditures equal to or less than the  | 
| statewide
average of administrative expenditures for the  | 
| 1986-87 school year as
certified by the State Superintendent of  | 
| Education pursuant to paragraph
(B)(3); (2) for the 1990-91  | 
| school year and for all subsequent school
years, the budget and  | 
| expenditures of the Board of Education shall reflect
a ratio of  | 
| administrative expenditures to total expenditures equal to or
 | 
| less than the statewide average of administrative expenditures  | 
| certified by
the State Superintendent of Education for the  | 
| applicable year pursuant to
paragraph (B)(3); (3) if for any  | 
| school year the budget of the Board of
Education reflects a  | 
| ratio of administrative expenditures to total
expenditures  | 
| which exceeds the applicable statewide average, the Board of
 | 
| Education shall reduce expenditure items allocable to the  | 
| administrative
functions enumerated in paragraph (B)(1) such  | 
| that the Board of Education's
ratio of administrative  | 
| expenditures to total expenditures is equal to or
less than the  | 
| applicable statewide average ratio.
 | 
|     For purposes of this Section, the ratio of administrative  | 
| expenditures to
the total expenditures of the Board of  | 
| Education, as applied to the budget
of the Board of Education,  | 
| shall mean: the budgeted expenditure items of
the Board of  | 
|  | 
| Education properly attributable to the expenditure functions
 | 
| identified in paragraph (B)(1) divided by the total budgeted  | 
| expenditures of
the Board of Education properly attributable to  | 
| the Board of Education
funds corresponding to those funds  | 
| identified in paragraph (B)(2),
exclusive of any monies  | 
| budgeted for payment to the Public School Teachers'
Pension and  | 
| Retirement System, attributable to payments due from the
 | 
| General Funds of the State of Illinois.
 | 
|      The annual expenditure of the Board of Education for 2320
 | 
| (Executive Administrative Services) for the 1989-90 school  | 
| year shall be no
greater than the 2320 expenditure for the  | 
| 1988-89 school year.  The annual
expenditure of the Board of  | 
| Education for 2320 for the 1990-91 school year
and each  | 
| subsequent school year shall be no greater than the 2320
 | 
| expenditure for the immediately preceding school year or the  | 
| 1988-89 school
year, whichever is less.  This annual expenditure  | 
| limitation may be
adjusted in each year in an amount not to  | 
| exceed any change effective
during the applicable school year  | 
| in salary to be paid under the collective
bargaining agreement  | 
| with instructional personnel to which the Board is a
party and  | 
| in benefit costs either required by law or such collective
 | 
| bargaining agreement.
 | 
|     (D) Cost control measures.  In undertaking actions to  | 
| control or reduce
expenditure items necessitated by the  | 
| administrative expenditure
limitations of this Section, the  | 
| Board of Education shall give priority
consideration to  | 
|  | 
| reductions or cost controls with the least effect upon
direct  | 
| services to students or instructional services for pupils, and  | 
| upon
the safety and well-being of pupils, and, as applicable,  | 
| with the
particular costs or functions to which the Board of  | 
| Education is higher
than the statewide average.
 | 
|     For purposes of assuring that the cost control priorities  | 
| of this
subsection (D) are met, the State Superintendent of  | 
| Education shall, with
the assistance of the Board of Education,  | 
| review the cost allocation
practices of the Board of Education,  | 
| and the State Superintendent of
Education shall thereafter  | 
| recommend to the School Finance Authority rules
and regulations  | 
| which define administrative areas which most impact upon
the  | 
| direct and instructional needs of students and upon the safety  | 
| and
well-being of the pupils of the district.  No position  | 
| closed shall be
reopened using State or federal categorical  | 
| funds.
 | 
|     (E) Report of Audited Information.  For the 1988-89 school  | 
| year and for
all subsequent school years, the Board of  | 
| Education shall file with the
State Board of Education the  | 
| Annual Financial Report and its audit, as
required by the rules  | 
| of the State Board of Education.  Such reports shall
be filed no  | 
| later than February 15 following the end of the school year of
 | 
| the Board of Education, beginning with the report to be filed  | 
| no later
than February 15, 1990 for the 1988-89 school year.
 | 
|     As part of the required Annual Financial Report, the Board  | 
| of Education
shall provide a detailed accounting of the central  | 
|  | 
| level, district, bureau
and department  costs and personnel  | 
| included within expenditure functions
included in paragraph  | 
| (B)(1).  The nature and detail of the reporting
required for  | 
| these functions shall be prescribed by the State Board of
 | 
| Education in rules and regulations.  A copy of this detailed  | 
| accounting
shall also be provided annually to the School  | 
| Finance Authority and the
public.  This report shall contain a  | 
| reconciliation to the board of
education's adopted budget for  | 
| that fiscal year, specifically delineating
administrative  | 
| functions.
 | 
|     If the information required under this Section is not  | 
| provided by the
Board of Education in a timely manner, or is  | 
| initially or subsequently
determined by the State  | 
| Superintendent of Education to be incomplete or
inaccurate, the   | 
| State Superintendent shall, in writing, notify the Board
of  | 
| Education of reporting deficiencies.  The Board of Education  | 
| shall,
within 60 days of such notice, address the reporting  | 
| deficiencies
identified.   If the State Superintendent of  | 
| Education does not receive
satisfactory response to these  | 
| reporting deficiencies within 60 days, the
next payment of  | 
| general State aid or evidence-based funding due the Board of  | 
| Education under Section
18-8 or Section 18-8.15, as applicable,  | 
| and all subsequent payments, shall be withheld by the State
 | 
| Superintendent of Education until the enumerated deficiencies  | 
| have
been addressed.
 | 
|     Utilizing the  Annual Financial Report, the State  | 
|  | 
| Superintendent of
Education shall certify on or before May 1 to  | 
| the School  Finance Authority
the Board of Education's ratio of  | 
| administrative expenditures to total
expenditures for the  | 
| 1988-89 school year and for each succeeding school
year.  Such   | 
| certification shall indicate the extent to which the
 | 
| administrative expenditure ratio of the Board of Education  | 
| conformed to the
limitations required in subsection (C) of this  | 
| Section, taking into account
any adjustments of the limitations  | 
| which may have been recommended by the
State Superintendent of  | 
| Education to the  School Finance Authority.  In
deriving  the  | 
| administrative expenditure ratio of the Chicago Board of
 | 
| Education, the State Superintendent of Education shall utilize  | 
| the
definition  of this ratio prescribed in subsection (C) of  | 
| this Section,
except that the actual expenditures of the Board  | 
| of Education shall be
substituted for budgeted expenditure  | 
| items.
 | 
|     (F) Approval and adjustments to administrative  expenditure  | 
| limitations.
The School Finance Authority organized under  | 
| Article 34A shall monitor the
Board of Education's adherence to  | 
| the requirements of this Section.  As
part of its responsibility  | 
| the School Finance Authority shall determine
whether the Board  | 
| of Education's budget for the next school year, and the
 | 
| expenditures for a prior school year, comply with the  | 
| limitation of
administrative expenditures required by this  | 
| Section.  The Board of
Education and the State Board of  | 
| Education shall provide such information
as is  required by the  | 
|  | 
| School Finance Authority in order for the Authority
to  | 
| determine compliance with the provisions of this Section.  If  | 
| the
Authority determines that the budget proposed by the  Board  | 
| of Education
does not meet the cost control requirements of  | 
| this Section, the Board of
Education shall undertake budgetary  | 
| reductions, consistent with the
requirements of this Section,  | 
| to bring the proposed budget into compliance
with such cost  | 
| control limitations.
 | 
|     If, in formulating cost control and cost reduction  | 
| alternatives, the
Board of Education believes that meeting the  | 
| cost control requirements of
this Section related to the budget  | 
| for the ensuing year would impair the
education, safety, or  | 
| well-being of the pupils of the school district, the
Board of  | 
| Education may request that the School Finance Authority make
 | 
| adjustments to the limitations required by this Section.  The  | 
| Board of
Education shall specify the amount, nature, and  | 
| reasons for the relief
required and shall also identify cost  | 
| reductions which can be made in
expenditure functions not  | 
| enumerated in paragraph (B)(1), which would serve
the purposes  | 
| of this Section.
 | 
|     The School Finance Authority shall consult with the State  | 
| Superintendent
of Education concerning the reasonableness from  | 
| an educational
administration perspective of the adjustments  | 
| sought by the Board of
Education.  The School Finance Authority  | 
| shall provide an opportunity for
the public to comment upon the  | 
| reasonableness of the Board's request.  If,
after such  | 
|  | 
| consultation, the School Finance Authority determines that all
 | 
| or a portion of the adjustments sought by the Board of  | 
| Education are
reasonably appropriate or necessary, the  | 
| Authority may grant such relief
from the provisions of this  | 
| Section which the Authority deems appropriate.
Adjustments so  | 
| granted apply only to the specific school year  for which
the  | 
| request was made.
 | 
|     In the event that the School Finance Authority determines  | 
| that the Board
of Education has failed to achieve the required  | 
| administrative expenditure
limitations for a prior school  | 
| year, or if the Authority determines that
the Board of  | 
| Education  has not met the requirements of subsection (F), the
 | 
| Authority shall make recommendations to the Board of Education  | 
| concerning
appropriate corrective actions.   If the Board of  | 
| Education fails to
provide adequate assurance to the Authority  | 
| that appropriate corrective
actions have been or will be taken,  | 
| the Authority may, within 60 days
thereafter, require the board  | 
| to adjust its current budget to correct for
the prior year's  | 
| shortage or may recommend to the members of the General
 | 
| Assembly and the Governor such  sanctions or remedial actions as  | 
| will serve
to deter any further such failures on the part of  | 
| the Board of Education.
 | 
|     To assist the Authority in its monitoring  | 
| responsibilities, the Board of
Education  shall provide such  | 
| reports and information as are from time to
time required by  | 
| the Authority.
 | 
|  | 
|     (G) Independent reviews of administrative expenditures.   | 
| The School
Finance Authority may direct independent reviews of  | 
| the administrative and
administrative support expenditures  and  | 
| services and other
non-instructional expenditure functions of  | 
| the Board of Education.  The
Board of Education shall afford  | 
| full cooperation to the School Finance
Authority in such review  | 
| activity.  The purpose of such  reviews shall be
to verify  | 
| specific targets for improved operating efficiencies of the  | 
| Board
of Education, to identify other areas of potential  | 
| efficiencies, and to
assure full and proper compliance by the  | 
| Board of Education with all
requirements of this Section.
 | 
|     In the conduct of reviews under this subsection, the  | 
| Authority may
request the assistance and consultation of the  | 
| State Superintendent of
Education with regard to questions of  | 
| efficiency and effectiveness in
educational administration.
 | 
|     (H) Reports to Governor and General Assembly.  On or before  | 
| May 1, 1991
and no less frequently than yearly thereafter, the  | 
| School Finance Authority
shall provide to the Governor, the  | 
| State Board of Education, and the
members of the General  | 
| Assembly an annual report, as outlined in Section
34A-606,  | 
| which includes the following information: (1) documenting the
 | 
| compliance or non-compliance of the Board of Education with the
 | 
| requirements of this Section; (2) summarizing the costs,  | 
| findings, and
recommendations of any reviews directed by the  | 
| School Finance Authority,
and the response to such  | 
| recommendations made by the Board of Education;
and (3)  | 
|  | 
| recommending sanctions or legislation necessary to fulfill the
 | 
| intent of this Section.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 86-124; 86-1477.)
 
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 5/34-53)  (from Ch. 122, par. 34-53)
 | 
|     Sec. 34-53. Tax levies; purpose; rates. For the purpose of
 | 
| establishing and supporting free schools for not fewer than 9  | 
| months in
each year and defraying their expenses the board may  | 
| levy annually, upon all taxable
property of such district for  | 
| educational purposes a tax for
the fiscal years 1996 and each  | 
| succeeding fiscal year at a rate of not to exceed the sum of  | 
| (i) 3.07% (or such other rate as may be set
by law
independent  | 
| of the rate difference described in (ii) below) and (ii) the
 | 
| difference between .50% and the rate per cent of taxes extended  | 
| for a
School Finance Authority organized under Article 34A of  | 
| the School Code,
for the calendar year in which the applicable  | 
| fiscal year of the board
begins as determined by the county  | 
| clerk and certified to the board
pursuant to Section 18-110 of  | 
| the Property Tax Code, of the value as
equalized or assessed by  | 
| the Department of Revenue for the year in which
such levy is  | 
| made. 
 | 
|     Beginning on the effective date of this amendatory Act of  | 
| the 99th General Assembly, for the purpose of making an  | 
| employer contribution to the Public School Teachers' Pension  | 
| and Retirement Fund of Chicago,  the board may levy annually for  | 
| taxable years prior to 2017, upon all taxable property located  | 
|  | 
| within the district, a tax at a rate not to exceed 0.383%.  | 
| Beginning with the 2017 taxable year, for the purpose of making  | 
| an employer contribution to the Public School Teachers' Pension  | 
| and Retirement Fund of Chicago, the board may levy annually,  | 
| upon all taxable property within the district, a tax at a rate  | 
| not to exceed 0.567%.  The proceeds from this additional tax  | 
| shall be paid, as soon as possible after collection, directly  | 
| to Public School Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of  | 
| Chicago and not to the Board of Education. The rate under this  | 
| paragraph is not a new rate for the purposes of the Property  | 
| Tax Extension Limitation Law. Notwithstanding any other  | 
| provision of law, for the 2016 tax year only, the board shall  | 
| certify the rate to the county clerk on the effective date of  | 
| this amendatory Act of the 99th General Assembly, and the  | 
| county clerk shall extend that rate against all taxable  | 
| property located within the district as soon after receiving  | 
| the certification as possible. | 
|     Nothing in this amendatory Act of 1995
shall in
any way  | 
| impair or restrict the levy or extension of taxes pursuant to  | 
| any
tax levies for any purposes of the board lawfully made  | 
| prior to the
adoption of this amendatory Act of 1995.
 | 
|     Notwithstanding any other provision of this Code and in
 | 
| addition to any other methods provided for increasing the tax  | 
| rate
the board may, by proper resolution, cause a
proposition  | 
| to increase the annual tax rate for educational purposes to
be  | 
| submitted to the voters of such district at any general or  | 
|  | 
| special
election.  The maximum rate for educational purposes  | 
| shall not exceed
4.00%.  The election called for such purpose  | 
| shall be governed by
Article 9 of this Act.  If at such election  | 
| a majority of the votes cast
on the proposition is in favor  | 
| thereof, the Board of Education may
thereafter until such  | 
| authority is revoked in a like manner, levy
annually the tax so  | 
| authorized.
 | 
|     For purposes of this Article, educational purposes for  | 
| fiscal years
beginning in 1995 and each subsequent year shall  | 
| also include, but not be
limited to, in addition to those  | 
| purposes authorized before this amendatory Act
of 1995,  | 
| constructing, acquiring, leasing (other than from the Public  | 
| Building
Commission of Chicago), operating, maintaining,  | 
| improving, repairing, and
renovating land, buildings,  | 
| furnishings, and equipment for school houses and
buildings, and  | 
| related incidental expenses, and
provision of special  | 
| education, furnishing free textbooks and
instructional aids  | 
| and school supplies, establishing, equipping, maintaining,
and  | 
| operating supervised playgrounds under the control of the  | 
| board, school
extracurricular activities, and stadia, social  | 
| center, and summer swimming pool
programs open to the public in  | 
| connection with any public school; making an
employer  | 
| contribution to the Public School Teachers' Pension and  | 
| Retirement
Fund as required by Section 17-129 of the Illinois  | 
| Pension Code; and providing
an agricultural science school,  | 
| including site development and improvements,
maintenance  | 
|  | 
| repairs, and supplies.  Educational purposes also includes  | 
| student
transportation expenses.
 | 
|     All collections of all taxes levied for fiscal years ending  | 
| before 1996 under
this
Section or under Sections 34-53.2,  | 
| 34-53.3, 34-58, 34-60, or 34-62 of this
Article as in effect  | 
| prior to this amendatory Act of 1995 may be used for any
 | 
| educational purposes as defined by this amendatory Act of 1995  | 
| and need not be
used for the particular purposes for which they  | 
| were levied.
The levy and extension of taxes pursuant to this  | 
| Section as amended by this
amendatory Act of 1995 shall not  | 
| constitute a new or increased tax rate within
the meaning of  | 
| the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law or the One-year
 | 
| Property Tax Extension Limitation Law.
 | 
|     The rate at which taxes may be levied for the fiscal year  | 
| beginning
September
1, 1996, for educational purposes shall be  | 
| the full rate authorized by this
Section for such taxes for  | 
| fiscal years ending after 1995.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 99-521, eff. 6-1-17.)
 | 
|     Section 970. The Educational Opportunity for Military  | 
| Children Act is amended  by changing Section 25 as follows:
 | 
|     (105 ILCS 70/25)
 | 
|     Sec. 25. Tuition for children of active duty military  | 
| personnel who are transfer students. If a student who is a  | 
| child of active duty military personnel is (i) placed with a  | 
|  | 
| non-custodial parent and (ii) as a result of placement, must  | 
| attend a non-resident school district, then the student must  | 
| not be charged the tuition of the school that the student  | 
| attends as a result of placement with the non-custodial parent  | 
| and the student must be counted in the calculation of average  | 
| daily attendance under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of the School  | 
| Code.
 | 
| (Source: P.A. 98-673, eff. 6-30-14.)
 | 
|     Section 995. Inseverability. The provisions of this Act are  | 
| mutually dependent and
inseverable. If any provision is held  | 
| invalid other than as applied to a particular person or
 | 
| circumstance, then this entire Act is invalid.
 | 
|     Section 997. Savings clause. Any repeal or amendment made  | 
| by this Act shall not affect or impair any of the following:   | 
| suits pending or rights existing at the time this Act takes  | 
| effect; any grant or conveyance made or right acquired or cause  | 
| of action now existing under any Section, Article, or Act  | 
| repealed or amended by this Act; the validity of any bonds or  | 
| other obligations issued or sold and constituting valid  | 
| obligations of the issuing authority at the time this Act takes  | 
| effect; the validity of any contract; the validity of any tax  | 
| levied under any law in effect prior to the effective date of  | 
| this Act; or any offense committed, act done, penalty,  | 
| punishment, or forfeiture incurred or any claim, right, power,  |